. .'.V •; ^^v •. .AW ■! .• •.* .■ • •••' •>* .••• ‘ *. ... . , ' • .... , • V ■. k','.' \ wv'ti'i'Viv . ' ' % '-iV \ ■ v\ ‘ \ \\ .W ,1^- \ , .V V'. . ■.>. V\ . \ ' \.V\ ‘.'v . \ . V iS,‘. . V-, ‘ ^ \ iSV. - \ VVV \ \ \ i VV\V\\V\«.\.V\\\\\\V\\V\\^\\ VVVVWW'- VVVW \V \\\\\> k ■ '. \ VWVVW V, «\»\\V\V»4\Vi%\Vk*VVV‘^4n,«.v^ Vv\v\v\\\\v\\w\x\N\\v\-»\ vx v\ vvy^v-rT*,^ V\ i x ■_ ... s x \ xx x wvxx v v x i xx x x» x<. XXX\\V'‘i^y V'-X\XXVX\\XV\X\\\Xi VXWXxXXXXVXkXW • ^\\VV\\\X\\\XXV\\V\X\‘. •■ xx\ \ X \ i » V\\\\\\%XX\XX\*.^y • Xxxxxxwxxxxx-.. X. v\^\v\ \ \ \\ vx\\\\vsVxX'rv^ykVVXxx \ %\\\\\'s,xvv\VVXV'V'x\xxv \ v,\v vvx x • ■ s \ \ V \ \ X \ >. •. X \ '\ \ \ X X V ■ ]>x»Jx‘ ‘ ‘X'.XWXXXXXXWXxyXXXVtXXXVXxXX.X x’*V XX X X X « » '. .'. X, x\ X X V \ \ X X f '' I >> 'i' " X X •> x x •* x x>. ^ X- X X X XX X X X X XXXX\\x/y'y^f y X iJ>.\XX xi. X X/ j'x X i , \ X^ X/. |'x,v t X Xxxyxx i X X XX X^ XX X X . X X X" .x.wXXxxxxxxxxvxx X »' xxiyxxvxxX'S, jCs j-V | x^ y , \ x x x x v x x x x x x x x x\ x X x X . x x > .\XXXXXXX\XX\\ \ i'Y ' y-xxxX X V X X XV X X X V \.s . . X . . .. . •. ■ '. X X X X XX \ X XX V V '/\\ V - * \ i» ;/ X'j' \ xf XX xXXXX X X V \ X X X V X \X X -. S X \ •. ' / 'V >L* r f t /■ T • •• V ^ / .I,-. -. ' X ' sxvsxxxxxxxxxx-'xxxxxU XX X x’fc.s^., y>'x '>.y V ,A •' ^ v. y^» x x x x x Wxv x > x » » \ x •. x x . * SS))S)S)SSS^S'I " ■ ^N\N\\\\\V\Ns/v\\\V\VVV VV V / . V V V / V , ^ ^ a “ vv X \ t \ X V a • . f ////// f J f f / e\ / ^ [ >•/ f /// /v Aw /. A /.>>••/ hj VrV ' Nx'ivN\\v\\\\\\\ •n '•v^f vv X'v: • ’^V'SxJ' ■ f i / / ' y* ’ V ' - .///W// / ^ ^ J / ■ ' V“ j ' V ’ W W / / W / / / / ///y V ' V ' ^ ^ ^ f ' ' A . t ff 0 r t J f t 9^4 t ^ ?)* ^ *:’ ‘' '/. ^ ^ ' ’ ///^* V f i / w ) / f .. I w 4 / 9 » # - tv. . • . . >VNV\\\W\\>V/ -i f / \ ' \ i'i.C ' V. V • • X . - » > % • ? • f • ■ - y V • ' 9 ’'tff 9 f 9 rrg/ . . \ t i ^ .r/ K^7 f g t 9 9 » t\ » 9 g f 9 ' ^ t *\ y * . s { r y • >t r >? ;> rjT ■ f ' ^ y ;v j ■ f f " ' f ■ - ’ ' ' ■ , . ^ 9 99 999 9 9 ^'^9999/ t / 9 9 9 mT/ 9 • 9 1 1 9 t?* 9 f * .ll f 9 9 f ( ij 9 9 f 9 9 y 7 9 ^ ^ ' > ' ' / ' ( •///>/).//># / / f / ' * .#y* »• / ? f f ■- / ) i ,-^f 9 9 r 9 ^ y ] i t VfT t f ^ .//>/>))/ / ^ f ig y f -■* -y '/ r w * ■ - ■■ ■ > ^ • '*• '■ ■' f 9 9 9 9 f 9 9 9 * i 9 9 9 9 f'i 1 9 9 9 9 9 f 1 ^ j y ¥ 9 » r / e y 9 ■/ V 9 9 9 9 '9 -f 9 : / t * ■ t 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 t * r J f t 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 } I ¥ 9 y i 9 9 -r if 7 9 9 9 *• 9 •* f 7 r ¥ 9 9 y'f f 9 V 9 9 9 9 i ■/ 9 ■• H 9 if 9 f 9 ■..! ' ^ i : 9 } ^ ^ •)f f) 9 99 » if 9 9 9 9 •} 09 i'g f f 9 9 99 9 f ^ 9 9 it 9 9 f 9 9 i / 9 9 i r j 9 9 9 9 9 9 » 3 M 9 1 9 9 9 t 9 S fi ft 9 9 U 9 9 'i > 9 ^ ^ . 9 if 9 9 9 9 ,f 9 9 9 3 9 9 f 9 9 9 9 9 i i f 9 ■¥ y f 9 V tf t 9 9 t, tr M i '99 9 9 9 i i i 9» 9 9 9 f i * 9 9 9 y // 9 9 7 i 1 9 7 f 9 § 9 j. r .t ff 9 . 99999999999999997997 ' J 9 • 9 f 7 e 9 9 't • ti >f f. t(M t k' 99 9 9 99 99*9999 99 19999999./ 797 ft 99 9 9. .t ■ » 9 f 9 i 9 0 9 9 (} t 9 9 f 3 9 9 } 99 0 9 9 9 9 9 99 9 9 9 : 9 9 99 g 9 9 9 99 9 99 } Hi 9 39 9 9 if 9 i 9 9i>> 9 t 9 - ■ P i >// /^ # a -• v ♦ 9 ft 9 / 9^9 9 i 99 * 9 f ^ ' i ^ ^ f f) 9 9 1 9 9 9 9 f 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 } 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 4 9 9 9 9 7 9 >f t4 i 9 ft * i k W' ^ 9 ^ 1 9 9 99 9 9 * i ^ S g it g 9 i - 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 9 ti 9 9 9 99 r c P 99 9 9 9 i 9 9 9 9 9 9 999 i'Vft 9 9 9 9 7 ff ft y 4 :, k u 9 9 tf tf'l ■■ - ’ t’ k' ' 1 1 !) 1 1 1 ! ntf If fi f! ‘ I rn ft utiP fepiiift ft 3 ft ninit ft!- t/rntt fit f ffj > ?//,-/, -vV /- * •.,■... i : ' : f 1 1 ; <^ t ! ; if } } 1 tf !; i f e 1 1 f f f t s f 1 1 1 f 1 1 1 ! f f 1 1 f f f f f r } » t f t f ! f i t f e f ) f f 1 1 / / ■' ?c <"''*■'’ :'•••'»•'’ ■ f I '■• : 3 } ; n ; ; } i 3 f ! f t } I i it t f n f ft 1 1 1 If t f f 9 1 ) i f t .nt f f f t / 1 f f f f f f n a 9 sa B fi n i'l'i ■■’ ■; X o f ■' i ! ! ! ! t i t ; .' i .7 f } 3 ■ 3 It ! t ( f e f i ftSfttfeftiftittniittiitttfeiiUftettfeiit ft} ft vi'/ii:!) '■•■•' V///. If: r II ■•> c ! f !f t n ft f t ft tut f ft ft ft Btfn t t/i ft fi ft St f fit tiff ft ft imi’i f e-i f :■ rf '. : ■• • •:if.'i"^fttiiB)i!-'t. : •■/;: ■: rt;;; 7 - ;.fj ; ; : . ’ 1 1 c t f f t s 1 1 1 f t i 1 1 1 1 1 tt 1 1 f e t it 1 1 1 « 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 f 1 1 » n t s j a a a t/ 1 1. 1 1 n: ■ ■ . .'. • 7; :: : . : tfiiritiifttfttitktiiftfttttiittttitisttii .•"’lira ■tuo'jur-ti a '.•/. '.■'■•/. ■ ::. ■ ‘•;f tn r -tf e tt ttr ft e r ; 1 1 1 att tier 7 att n - 1 /■ 1 > t ar. r : r ctt rttf ctt t s t-r ctt: s ” : aa /■"'.■ • ‘-.iiirr/. ;ct/:erttte:cfte.'i>tffttgcttttkiu.^ a ■ , •r./ttn ‘ ' r r t r c P : r •'’ * r C ^ t. f ’i r, S P C ' C f. :‘. • ’ ■ k • ft ta 9 f i i‘ t f *< Pg 9 9 9 9 ^ U9rg£g9i4 99SlSf9i'9-\ t ^ ■ ( t ' i ( i iAXii-\V, 9 9i 9 ’iff I < 1 1 f ""'''•VORK : ®RoadwavI L T B R R Y Theological Seminary PRINCETON. N. J. / Case ‘SCTi) ^ - - Shelf. I / I Book i ? ir'f* ✓ 4 % ■ i.' ■ - V .» - BUDDHISM IN TIBET. INCLUDING A UESCKIPTION OK THE MATERIALS COLLECTED BY H„ A.. & R. DE SCHLAGINTWEIT DURING THE SCIENTIFIC MISSION TO INDIA AND HIOII ASIA. BUDDHISM m TIBET ILLUSTRATED BY LITERARY D0CU3IENTS AND OBJECTS OF RELIGIOUS WORSHIP. WITH AN ACCOUNT OF THE BUDDHIST SYSTEMS PRECEDING IT IN INDIA. BY EAIIL SCHLAGINTWEIT, LE. D. WITH A FOLIO ATLAS OF TWENTY PLATES AND TWENTY TABLES OF NATIVE PRINT IN THE TEXT. LEIPZIG: F. A. BROCKHAUS. LONDON: TRUBNER & CO. MDCCCLXIII. Jlic right of Translation is reserved. TO HIS ]\rOST GRACIOUS MAJESTY WILLIAM L, KING OF WURTTEAIBERG. Sire, Most respectfully I a])])roacli to present to Your Majesty my researches on the Buddhist religion in Tibet; and I do so with a feeling of the deepest gratitude for Yonr Majest^^’s gracious per- mission. For even if I recall to my mind the far distant origin of the Buddhist faith, the various changes it has undergone, and its still existing influence as the dominant religion of hundreds of millions, the share such considerations might have had in my venturing to address Yonr Majesty, must disappear before the gracious, encouraging condescendence with which Yonr Majesty was pleased to receive a personal explanation of the materials Avhich are now published in this work. ' I am, with profound respect. Your Majesty’s Most humble and (d)edient servant, MUNICH, May 18G3. THE AUTHOR. Digitized by the Internet Archive in 2016 https://archive.org/details/buddhismintibetiOOschM PREFACE. The religious systems of all ages — paganism in its rudest form perhaps excepted — have undergone changes and modifications which, if not materially affecting their principles, have at least exercised a certain influence upon their development. Buddhism may be considered a remarkable illustration of this; for not only have the rites suffered notable changes, but even the dogmas themselves have, in the course of time, become much altered. Although plain and simple in the earlier stages of its existence, it was in time greatly modified by the successive introduction of new doctrines, laws, and rites; so-called reformers arose, who assembled around them a greater or less number of followers; and these by degrees formed schools, which by-and-by developed into sects. The shifting of its original seat also exer- cised a considerable influence; the difference between a tropical and a cold and desert region, and between the physical character of tribes separated by the distinctive vm PEEFACE. marks of tlie Arian and Turanian races, had to be smoothed over, partly at least, and obliterated by the influence of time. Tlie present work has for its object the description of Buddhism as we now find it in Tibet, after an existence in this country of upwards of twelve centuries. The information obtained by my brothers Hermann, Adolphe, and Robert de Schlagintweit, when on the scien- tific mission undertaken between the years 1854-58, which gave them the opportunity of visiting various parts of Tibet and of the Buddhist countries in the Himalaya, has been the chief source on wliich I have drawn for my remarks and descriptions. The reports of former travellers have also been consulted and compared with the contribu- tions received from my brotliers. Hot less important for my subject, as enabling one to judge of the fundamental laws of Buddhism, and their subsequent modifications, were the researches of the oriental philologists and in- telligent writers on Buddhist doctrines, amongst whom Hodgson and Burnouf have so successfully led the way to the analysis of the original native works. For the greater part of the olqects here treated of and for most of the native explanatory remarks, I am indebted to my brother Hermann. He had engaged in Sikkim the services of Chibu Lama, a very intelligent Lepcha, then a political agent of the Raja of Sikkim at Darjiling. Through this personage he was enabled to PEEFACE. IX obtain numerous objects wliich bad come from Lliassa, the centre of the Buddhist faith in Tibet. Mr. Hodgson and Dr. Campbell, besides giving him much valuable in- formation, were also so kind as to present him with various articles of interest for this subject. In Western Tibet, it was particularly at the monastery of Himis and in Leh, the capital of Ladak, that Hermann’s wishes were the most readily accomplished. In Gnari Kliorsmn Adolphe, who was at that time accompanied by Eobert, succeeded in persuading the Lamas of Gyungul and IMangnang to sell him even objects which he had seen treated with the greatest respect and awe. The folio atlas of twentj" plates, two feet high and one and a half broad, contains facsimiles of represen- tations of deities and of objects used for keeping off evil spirits. The originals were reproduced by means of transfer-paper, a method which has the great advan- tage that the alterations are entirely avoided which the artists are but too willing to make. The drawings being mechanically copied, retain entirely the stamp of foreign art. The details in reference to the method employed for the reproduction are given in the introduction to the atlas. The plates have been printed in the lithographic establishment of Dr. C. Wolf and Son at Munich. Eor the illustrations accompanying the text I selected those of a more scientific nature in preference to those of a descriptive character. They consist of copies taken X PEEFACE. from original woodcuts, and of prints in Tibetan characters of the texts translated. These tables have been executed in the imperial printing office at Vienna. Their correct execution was kindly undertaken by ]\tr. de Auer, the director of this institution, so well known for its excel- lence in typographical and artistical reproductions. In my studies of Tibetan I have been greatly assisted by Mr, A. Schiefner at St, Petersburg, to whose publi- cations I shall often have occasion to allude, Tliis gentle- man also afforded me the welcome opportunity of laymg the verbal explanatory details of the priests in loco a second time before a Lama, the Buriat Galsang Gombojew, who is engaged at St, Petersburg as teacher of Mongo- lian; he made for me, besides, various abstracts from books contained in the imperial oriental libraries having a bearing upon these objects, I may be allowed to mention that I had the honour of presenting to the Royal Academy of Munich the Address to the Buddhas of Confession (contained in Chapter XI,), a sacred imploration, of which a translation in German was inserted in the Proceedings of this Institution (February, 1863 ), ALPHABET USED FOE TRANSCEIPTION. a (a a a), ii; b; cb; chh; d; e (e e e); f; g; h; i (i i); j; k; 1; m; n; o (o o), 6; p; r; s; sh; t; ts (ts'li); u (ii u), ii; v; y; z; zhd 1. RULES FOR PRONOUNCIATION. Vowels. 1. a, e, i, 0 , u, as in German and Italian. 2. d, d, ii, as in German. 3. Diphthongs give the sound of the two component vowels combined. Consonants. 1. b, d, f, y, li, k, I, m, n, r, s, t, are pronounced as in German and English. * This is the same that has been adopted by my brothers in their “ Results of a scientific Mission to India and High Asia;” for details sec Vol. I., pp. G(> to 70; Vol. III., pp. 148-160. XII ALPHABET USED FOE TEAXSCEIPTIOX. 2. /i, after a consonant is an audible aspiration ex- cept in ch, sit, zlt. In ti It it is separated from ts by the (Ireek spiritns asper ' , in order to prevent this letter from being pronounced as t and sli. 3. di, as in English (diurdi). 4. sh, as in English {shade). 5. j, as in English (Just). (3. V, as the w in German (TT"as5er), being different from V in very, and tv in ivater. 7. y, as y in the Enghsh word yes, and j in the German ja. 8. z, soft as in English {zeal). 0. zlt, sounds like the French j in jour. Signs. 1. ” over a vowel indicates that it is long. 2. “ this, the sign of imperfect formation (=: u in hut, e in herd) placed over a and e, I had no occasion to use in Tibetan and Sanskrit terminology; it occurs, however, in modern geographical names, as e. g. Berma. 3. ' indicates a nasal sound of the vowel. 4. ' marks the syllable on which the accent falls. Accents have been, however, introduced in geographical names only; in the other native words I have limited myself to distinguishing the quantity of the syllables which are long. ALPHABET USED FOB TKANSCRIPTION. XIII 5. the Greek S2)'uit2(s lenis 1 used for rendering tlie Tibetan soft aspirate; in this I followed the advice of Prof. Lepsius, in his recent supplement to his well-known “ Standard Alphabet.” ‘ 2. DETAILED TKANSLITERATION OF THE TIBETAN ALPHABET. The thirty simple letters of the Tibetan language are represented in Roman characters in the following manner : ^ k; p kh; ^ g; K ng; ^ ch; chh; The point separating the syllables in Tibetan words and sentences, is rendered by a small horizontal line. The compound letters, seventy-four in number, and formed by having another letter subjoined or surmounted, are transliterated thus: the subjoined letter is written behind the radical, as e. g. ^ is rendered by hr, — the surmounting precedes the radical letter, as e. g. ^ Ih. * “Ueber Chinesische und Tibetanische Lautverhiiltnisse, und iiber die Umschrift jener Sprachen.” Abhandlungen der Akademie der Wissenschaften von Berlin, 18G1, p. 479. ^ c c ^ p; ^ ph; ^ b; m; -S ts; oo ts'h; 3 Z; a UJ y; r; ^1; •fj sh; ^ s; ^ h; GM a. XIV ALPHABET USED FOR TRANSCRIPTION. The letters which according to grammatical rules ought to be silent, are printed with Italics, as e. g. rk is printed rk. In order to facilitate the reading, I have spelt the Tibetan terms as they sound (with the omission of the mute letters) ; the reprinting in Tibetan letters is also left out in the text, but an alphabetical Glossary of Tibetan terms has been added at the end of the volume, in wliich the native spelling of every word and the detailed transliteration are given. CONTENTS PART L THE VARIOUS SYSTEMS OF BUDDHISM. SECTION 1. INDIAN BUDDHISM. Page CHAPTER I. Sketch of the Life op Sakyamoni, the Founder of Buddhism. Origin. — The principal events in his life. — His attainment of the per- fection of a Buddha. — Period of his existence 3 CHAPTER II. Gradual Rise and Present Area of the Buddhist Religion. Development and decline in India. — Extension over various parts of Asia. — Comparison of the mimher of Buddhists with that of Christians 9 CHAPTER III. The Religious System of Sakyamuni. The fundamentat laiv. — The dogma of the Four Truths, and the paths leading to salvation 15 CHAPTER IV. The HInayana System. Controversies about Sdkgamuni’s laws 19 The Hlnaydna doctrines. The twelve Nidanas; character of the pre- cepts; incitation to abstract meditation; gradations of perfection ... 22 XVI CONTENTS. CHAPTER V. The Mahaya.va Systems. Nugurjwia 30 The fundamental Mahdydna principles 32 The contemplative Mahdydna (Yoydchdrya) system 3i) The Trasanya-21adhyumika school 41 CHAPTER VI. The System of Mysticism. General character. — 'Ihe Kdla Chakra system ; its origin and dogmas 4() SECTION II. TIBETAN BUDDHISM. CHAPTER VII. Historical Account op the Introduction of Buddhism INTO Tibet. Earliest religion of the Tibetans G1 Introduction of Buddhist dogmas into Eastern Tibet. Era of King Srongtsan Gampo and King Thisrong de tsan. — The reforms of the Lama Tsonkhapa G2 Vropagation of Buddhism into China, Laddk, and Eastem Himalaya 71 Buddhist sects in Tibet 72 CHAPTER VHI. The sacred Literature. IPoj-/;s translated from Sanskrit, and works written in Tibetan.... 7G The two compilations of Kanjur and Tanjur 78 Tibetan literature in Europe 81 Analysis of the Mani Kambum 84 Names and representations of Padmapdni 88 CHAPTER IX. Views on Metemsychosis. Be-births IH Means of deliverance from re-birth 94 Sukharati, the abode of the blessed 98 CHAPTER X. Details characteristic of the Religion of the People. Amount of religious knowledge 103 Gods, genii, and malignant spirits. The spirits Lhamayin and Dudpos. The legends about Lhamo, Tsangpa, and Chakdor 107 Prayers 117 CHAPTER XL Translation of an Address to the Buddhas op Confession. Translation and explanatory remarks 122 {For additions see p. .393.) rONTENTS. XV J I 1‘AR r IT. PRESENT LAMAIC INSTITUTIONS. Page CHAPTER XII. The Tibetan Priesthood. Materials contained in reports of European travellers 145 Fundamental laws 148 Hierarchical system •. 152 Organization of the clergy. Principles of its constitution 159 Revenues 160 Grades amongst the Lamas 161 Number of Lamas 164 Occupations 165 Diet 167 Dress. {Caps and hats; gown; inner vest; cloak; boots; shoes; rosaries; amulet-boxes) 170 CHAPTER XIII. Religious Buildings and Monuments. Ceremonies preceding the erection 177 Monasteries * 179 Historical document relating to the foundation of the monastery of Himis, in Laddk 183 Temples 188 Religious monuments. 1. Chortens 192 2. Manis 196 3. Dei'choks and Lapchas 198 CHAPTER XIV. Representations op Buddhist Deities. l)eities represented 201 Methods of executing sacred objects. Drawings and paintings. Statues and bas-reliefs 202 Characteristic types. Genei-al attitude of the body and position of the fingers 207 Buddhas 208 Bodhisattvas ' 212 Priests, ancient and modern 213 Dragsheds 214 Illustrations derived from Measurements 216 XVIII CONTENTS. Page CHAPTER XV. Worship of the Deities, and religious Ceremonies. Daily service 227 Offerings. Musical instruments 228 Prayer-cylinders 229 Performance of religious Dramas 232 Sacred days and festivals. Monthly and annual festivals 237 The ceremony Tuisol 239 The ceremony Nyungne 240 Piles for the attainment of supernatural faculties 242 Peculiar cere^nonies for ensuring the assistance of the gods. 1. The rite Dubjed 247 2. The Burnt-offering 249 3. Invocation of Lungta 253 4. The Talisman Changpo 256 5. The magical figure Phurhu 257 6. The ceremony Thugdam Kantsai 260 7. Invocation of Nagpo Chenpo by “moving the arrow” 261 8. The ceremony Yangug 263 9. Ceremonies performed in cases of Illness 265 10. Funeral rites 269 CHAPTER XVI. The Systems of reckoning Time. 1. Calendars and Astrological tables 273 2. The various modes of Chronology- Duo cycle of twelve years 275 Counting back from the current year 276 The cycle of sixty years 276 The cycle of two hundred and fifty-two years 284 3. The Year and its divisions 287 CHAPTER XVII. Description of various Tables used for Astrological PURPOSES. Importance attributed to Astrology 290 I. Tables for indicating lucky and unlucky periods. 1. The elements and cyclic animals 293 2. The spirits of the season 298 3. Figures and oracles for determining the character of a given day 300 f'ONTENTS. XIX II. Tables for direction in important undertakings. 1. The square tortoise 304 2. The circular tortoise 311 III. Tables of destiny in cases of sickness. 1. The human figures 313 2. Allegorical figures ami dice 314 IV. Tables of marriage. 1. Table with numerals 315 2. Table with cyclic animals 318 V. A Soothsaying table ivith numerous figures and sentences 320 APPENDIX. A. LITERATURE; an alphabetical list of the works and memoirs con- nected with Buddhism, its dogmas, history and geographical distribution 331 B. GLOSSARY OF TIBETAN TERMS, their spelling and translitera- tion with a reference to the explanations contained in this volume 371 C. ADDITIONS TO THE ADDRESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CON- FESSION, translated in Chapter XI 393 INDEX 397 LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS, T’late I. .. II. ). III. .. IV. .. V. » VI. ). VII. .. VIII. » IX. » X. .. XI PLATES OF THE ATLAS. Group I. Ueprescntations of Deities. The thirty-five Buddhas of Confession, in Tibetan Tungshakchi sangye songa. Vajrasattva, in Tibetan Dorjesempa, the God above all The Dhyani Buddha Amitabha, in Tibetan Odpagmed. Padmapani, in Tibetan Chenresi, the particular Protector of Tibet. Maitreya, in Tibetan Jampa, the Buddha to come. ManjusrI, in Tibetan Jamjang, the God of wisdom. The goddess Doljang, the deified consort of king Srongtsan Gampo (a.d. 617 - 98 ). Dzambhala, or Dodnevangpo, the God of wealth, with his assistants. Bihar Gyalpo, the Patron of monasteries and temples. Choichong Gyalpo, the God of astrology, and Protector of man against evil spirits. Dzambhala, or Dodnevangpo, the God of wealth. XXII LI8T OF ILLUSTEATIONS. Plate XII. >. XIII. Padmapaiii, in Tibetan Chenresi, the particular Protector of Tibet. Padma Sambhava, a deified Indian sage of the eight century a.d. Group 11. Sentences and Figures for averting the dangers arising from evil spirits. Plate XIV. » XV. « XVI. .. XVII. » XVIII. » XIX. » XX. The six-syllabic prayer: “Oni mani padme hum.” The six-syllabic prayer: “Om mani padme hum.” The magical figure Dabchad, “octagon.” Mystical sentences with the Figure of the Airy Horse. The magical figure Phurbu, with the face of Tamdin. A Soothsaying Table, with numerous figures and sentences. Table to indicate lucky and unlucky periods, as well as the chances of undertakings. TABLES OF NATIVE PWNT IN THE TEXT. Cage Plate 1. The fundamental Dogma of the Buddhist Faith. 1. In Sanskrit, written with Tibetan characters. 2. A Tibetan translation of the same Hi « II. -\ddress to the Goddess Lhamo, in Sanskrit KaladevI 114 >1 111. Vajrapaui, or Chakdor, the Subduer of the Evil Spirits. Reduced from the original, which is cut into a prayer- stone put upon a prayer-wall in Sikkim 114 )i IV. The six-syllabic 2 >i’ayer — “Om mani jiadme hum.” Taken from a woodcut from Eastern Tibet 120 LIST OF ILLUSTEATIONS. XXIIl Page Plate V. to VIII. Digpa thanichad shagpar terclioi, an Address to the Buddhas of Confession 142 » IX. Historical Document relating to the Foundation of the Mon- astery of Himis, in Ladak 188 » X. Melhai Gyalpo, the Lord of the Genii of Fire. From a woodcut from Eastern Tibet 2.52 j) XI. Mystical sentences, with the figure of the Airy Horse. From Ilimis. The letters are here inverted, the same having been cut into the block itself in their positive form 2.54 » XII. Forms of invocations of Lungta, the Airy Horse. No. 1. Print from a Tibetan woodcut from Sikkim. » 2. Copies of formulae, obtained at the Monastery of Himis, in Ladak 254 » XIII. The Talisman Change. From Daba in Gnari Khorsum.... 256 » XIV. Print from slips of wood used in Tibet as a supposed pro- tection against Evil Spirits. No. 1., from Sikkim 268 )) XV. Prints from slips of wood used in Tibet as a supposed pro- tection against Evil Spirits. No. 2., from Sikkim 268 I) XVI. Prints from slips of wood used in Tibet as a supposed pro- tection against Evil Spirits. No.- 3., from Sikkim 268 n XVII. Treaty between Adolphe Schlagintweit and the Chinese Authorities of Daba. This was in reference to the routes he and his brother Robert should be allowed to take in Gnari Khorsum. . 278 » XVIII. Divination Formulae. Taken from Figure-tables from Lhassa. 1. To calculate the direction favourable for an undertaking; 2. For learning beforehand the issue of an illness 308 XXIV lilST OF ILLUSTEATIONS. Plate XIX. Divination Formulae. Taken from Figure-tables from Gnari Khorsum. 1. For the interpretation of oracles. (The oracles to which they refer are given on Plate XX.) 2. Rythmical sen- tences concerning the influence of the elements, for good or bad, upon a proposed marriage 318 » XX. Queries and Answers. Taken from a soothsaying-table from Gnari Khorsum ... . 322 ERRATA. Page 3 in the heading; for existence » 9 » » » » developement » 16, line 26; for fourtth » 35, » 10 » kundzabchi » 37, » 23 » well-towards-disposed » 42, » 10 » Togpa nyi » 78, » 12 » Palchen » 97, » 11 » Staviras » 129, » 13 » rNams-par » 133, note 1 » Nyon-thos » 258, line 27 » Lhonab » 276, » 6 » Chag read existence. » development. » fourth. « kuudzobchi. » well-disposed towards. » Togpa nyid. » Phalchen. » Sthaviras. » rNam-par. » Nyan-thos. » Lhonub. » Phag. Errors in Tables V. to VIII. of Native Print: Page 2, line 12; for gshegs-sa read gshegs-pa. M 3 M 8 » rnams-par » rnam-par. » 4 » 3 )) mi-dkor » me-dkor. » 11 )) rnam-la-phyag » rnanis-la-phyag. » 5 » 2 » nyon-thos )) nyan-thos. » 6 » 5 » bshas-pa-rnam bshas-pa-rnams. )) 7 » thar-par » thar-bar. )) 11 » bskal-ba )» bskal-pa. » 7 )} 1 » mts'hun )) nits' hon. » 2 )> rnam-sa )> rnam-pa. » 2 » glu-ru-len » glu-rum-len. PART 1. THE VARIOUS SYSTEMS OF BUDDHISM. SECTION I. INDIAN BUDDHISM. 1 CHAPTER I. SKETCH OF THE LIFE OF SAKYAxMUXI, THE FOUNDER OF BUDDHISM. Origin. — The Principal Events in his Life. — His Attainment of the Perfection of a Buddha. — Period of his Exislence. Although the numerous legends respecting the life and -works of Sakyamuni, the reputed founder of the Buddhist faith, contain much that is fabulous, yet most of the incidents mentioned therein, when deprived of the marvellous ^arb -with which early historians invariably used to embellish their tales, seem to be based on matters of fact. At present scientific researches have put Sakya- muni’s real existence beyond a doubt C but the period in which he lived will ever remain somewhat vaguely defined. * See for details the biographies published by Csoma de Kbros, “Notices of the life of Shakya,” in the Asiatic Eesearches, Vol. XX., pp. 285-318; Hardy, “Manual of Buddhism,” pp. 138-359; Schiefner, “Eine tibetanische Lebensbeschreibung Sakyamuni’s,” in the “Memoires des Savants etrangers,” Vol. VI., pp. 231-332. For Tibetan and Singhalese traditions about the. Sakya race, see Foe koue ki, English translation, Calcutta, 1848, p- 203. 1 * 4 LIFE OF SAKYAMUNI, Sakyamuni was born at Kapilavastu in (ilorakhpur. 'I’he legends tell us that his father, the king Sud- dhodana (in Tibetan Zastang), requested one hundred and eight learned Brahmans to inform him of his son’s destiny; the Brahmans, the legends say, after a careful examination of the prince’s body, expressed their con- viction that, “if he remained a layman during his life- time, he would become a powerful monarch of vast territories; but in the event of his turning recluse, he would enter the state of a supreme Buddlia or wise man; and in solemn assembly they declared that this prince would hereafter prove a blessing to the world, and that he himself would also enjoy great prosperity.” It was in consequence of this answer, that the prince received the name of Siddhartha, “the establisher.’' ‘ Siddhartha proved to be endowed with extraordinary faculties, and the legends even go so far as to assert that, w'hen he w'as about to be taught his letters, he could already distinguish them, and his eminent qualities were manifest, not only in his mental, but also in bodily perfection. It is added as particular!}" characteristic that already in his youth he was inclined to retirement and ' In the sacred legends he is generally characterised by other names. Those of Sakyamuni— in Tibetan Shakya Thub-pa, “Sakya, the mighty” — Gautama, or Sramana Gautama, “the ascetic of the Gautamas,” refer alike to his family and career. The names of Bhagavat, “the fortunate,” Sugata, “the welcome,” Buddha, “the wise,” designate his supreme perfection. A name which is very frequently given to the Buddhas in sacred books is Tathagata, in Tibetan Dezhin, or Dezhin shegpa, “he who has gone in the manner of his predecessors.” See Abel Remusat, “Note sur quelques epithetes descriptives de Bouddha.” Journ. des Savans, 1817, p. 702. Burnouf “In- , troduction.” p. 70 et seq. Barthelemy St. Hilaire, “Le Bouddha et sa Religion”, p. 75. UFK OF SAKYAMUNI. 5 soKtude: he abandoned his gay, playt'nl comrades and buried himself in the dark recesses of dense forests, where he gave himself up to profound meditation. Suddhodana, the father, however, wished his son to become rather a powerful monarch, than a lonel}’’ ascetic. When, there- fore, after a renewed consultation with the Brahmans, he learned that Siddhartha would certainly leave his magnificent palace and become an ascetic, in the event of his seeing four things, viz. decrepitude, sickness, a dead body, and a recluse, he placed guards on all sides of the palace, in order that these dreaded objects might not come near his beloved son. Moreover, in order to weaken his love of solitude and meditation, he married him to Gopa (in Tibetan Sa Tsoma), the daughter of Dandapani, of the race of the Sakyas, and gave orders that he should be provided with every kind of pleasure. But all these precautions proved futile. Siddhartha, though living in the midst of festivities and in the enjoyment of all wordly pleasures, never ceased to reflect upon the pains which arise from birth, sickness, decay, and death; upon their causes, and upon the remedies to be used against them. He found that existence is the real cause of these pains, that desire produces existence, and that the extinction of desire causes cessation of existence. He then determined — as he had already done a hundred times before — to lead human beings to salvation by teaching them the practice of virtues and by detaching them from the service of the world. Although he had hitherto often hesitated, his resolution to renounce the world and to become an ascetic was finally put into G LIFE OF SAKYAMUNT. execution, when ‘he happened, on his walk to a garden in the vicinity of the ]3alace, to meet at four different periods an old man, a leper, a dead body, and a man in a religions garb. He had attained the age of twenty- nine years, when he left his palace, his wife, and the infant son to whom she is said to have given birth at the very moment of her husband’s meeting with the recluse. ‘ Siddhartha began his ascetic life by assiduously study- ing the doctrines of the Brahmans and by becoming tlie disciple of the most learned of them. Being, however, dissatisfied with their theories and practices, which, he declared, did not offer the true means of salvation, he left them altogether, and gave himself up during the next six years to earnest meditation and the exercise of great austerities; the latter, however, he soon renounced, perceiving from his own experience, that the mortifi- cations practised by tlie Brahmans were not of a nature to lead to the attainment of perfection. The six yeai’s past, he proceeded to the holy spot Bodhimauda, where the Bddhisattvas become Buddhas ; and it was here, that, having seated himself upon a couch of grass of the husa species, he arrived at supreme perfection, which became manifest by his remembering the exact circumstances of all human beings that had ever existed; by his obtain- ' It is more probable, says Wassiijew, in his “Biiddhismus,” p. V2, that Sakyainuni was led to view existence as the cause of pain and sorrow in consequcnec of a war in which the Siikya tribe was defeated, and which obliged him to wander about, rather than by Ins seeing the four dreadeil objects mentioned ; for there is a legend which says that the Sakya race was almost entirely exterminated during the life of the lluddha. LIFE OF SAKYAMUXI. 7 iiig the divine eye, by the aid of whicli he could see all things within the s})ace of the infinite worlds, and by his receivino- the knowledge that unfolds the causes of the ‘ ever-recurring circle of existence. Sakvamnni being now endowed with all these wonder- fill and marvellous faculties, became the wisest man, the most perfect Buddha. But having arrived at this state of perfection, he still hesitated whether he should make known his doctrines and propound them to men, his principles being, in his opinion, opposed to all those then adhered to. He was, at first, afraid of being exposed to the insults of animated beings, who are unwise and filled with evil designs. But, moved by compassion, and reflecting, that there would i-emain nevertheless many beings who would understand him and be delivered by liim from existence — the cause of pains and sorrows — he at once resolved to teach the law that had been revealed to him. ‘ iSakyamuni died, the books say, after having attained an age of eighty years. The data contained in the sacred books as the year of this event, differ consi- derably, the most distant periods mentioned being the years 2422 and 544 b.c. Lassen, in his examination of these materials, gives preference to the litei'ature of the southern Buddhists, which places his death in 544 or 543 b.c. Westergaard, however, in a recent essay on this subject, believes even this epoch to be by far too early, and calculates his death to have taken Bartlielctny St. Hilaire, ‘‘Lc Buddlia cl sa Kcligion,” p. il2. 8 LIFE OF SAKYAMUNI place ill the period from 370 to 368 b.c.. or about one generation before Alexander the Great took the throne. ' ' Lassen •‘Indisehe Alterthuiuskunde,” Vol. 11., p. 51. Wcstergaaril, “Ueber Buddlia’s Todesjahr:” German translation, p. 94. CHAPTER II. GRADUAL RISE AND PRESENT AREA OF THE BUDDHIST RELIGION. Developement AND Decline in India. — Extension oveii various parts of Asia. — Comparison of the Number of Buddhists with that op Christians. ycAECELY had 8akyaiiiuni begun to teach his new re- ligion in India, when he obtained a great many followers. His system had an extraordinary success both on account of its simplicity and of the abolition of castes ; the Buddha admits to the blessings of which he is the dispenser the highest classes of man (Brahmans) as well as the lowest. Already at his death the number of Buddhists seems to have been very considerable; and about the middle of the third century B.C., during the reign of Asoka. Buddhism began to spread all over India. It then continued to flourish for eight hundred years (till the fifth century of our era), when a series of vio- lent persecutions was commenced (instituted by Brah- manical sectaries, particularly by the adherents to the 10 PKESEXT AREA OP BUDDHISM. worship of Siva) which almost caused the extirpation of Buddhism. Hiuen Thsang, a Chinese* pilgrim who had passed much of his life in India during extensive travels between the years 629 and 645 a.d., mentions numerous Buddhist temples, monasteries, and monuments, which in his time were already deserted, and even fallen into ruins — buildings which, two centuries before. Fa Hian, another Chinese traveller, had found in the most pros- perous condition. Nevertheless, in many parts of India, Buddhists were still in existence, and in Benares, now again a centre of Brahmanism, they are reported to have been the prevalent sect until the eleventh century, and in the northern parts of Gujrat even as late as the tweltli. After that period, Buddhism ceased to exist in India, by reason of a combination of circumstances, amongst which the jealousy of the various schools and the invasion of the Mussalmans are to be mentioned as jjerhaps the most important. ^ As present the area of Buddhism includes vast terri- tories, from Ceylon and the Indian Archipelago in the south to the Baikal Lake in Central Asia, and from the Caucasus eastward to Japan; and the number of its adherents may be considered as being at least equal to, if it does not exceed, that of the followers of the Christian religion, as will be seen from the lollowing data.^ ‘ C<)in 2 )arc Mouiitstuart Eliiliiiistonc’s “History of India,” Vol. L, ii. 212. Lassen, “Ind. Altertliuinskunde,” Vol. IV., j). 707. - Prof. Neumann of Munich has computed the number of Buddhists in China, Tibet, the Indo-Chinese countries, and Tartary at 309 millions. Unge- witter, “Kcueste Erdbcschrcibung,” Yol. I., p. bl, estimates the total oi NU31BEE OF BUDDHISTS. 1 1 The late Professor JJieterici, in his well-known coin- ]>ilation of the census of the globe, ‘ estimates the popu- lation of China at four hundred millions, oi Japan at thirty- five; and for the Indo-Chinese Peninsula he gives fifteen millions as .the number of inhabitants in the independent territories. The data for the Indian dependencies in the [)cninsula are of great variety. Thornton’s “Gazeteer” gives for Arrakan, Pegu, and Tenasserim a population of about one million; but in a note contained in Allens In- dian Mail, 1801 , the inhabitants of Pegu alone are cal- culated to amount to one million. An average of two millions for these three provinces is, perhaps, most in accordance with their area when compared with the remainder of the peninsula. ^ The inhabitants of the Indo-Chinese Archipelago are set down by Dieterici at eighty millions, of which twenty belong to the Dutch and Spanish possessions. The population of Ceglon^ which is all Buddhist, exceeds, according to M*’Carthey, two millions.'* In India Proper there are scarcely any Buddhists at all. For these regions of Asia we obtain, therefore, ac- Buddliists at 325 millions. Colonel Sykes, whose accuracy in every branch oi‘ science, especially, however, in statistics, is so well known, also considers it certain that the Buddhists out-number the followers of any other creed : sec his essay “On Indian Characters.” London 1859. ' “Die Bevolkerung der Erde,” in Petermaiin’s “Geographischc MitUiei- hmgcn,” 1859, p. 1. Thornton’s “Gazeteer.” Allen’s Indian Mail, 18(51, p. 802. Report of the Proceedings of the fourth Session of the International Statistical Congress; London, 1861, p. 84. Compare Hardy, “Eastern Mo- nachism,” p. 31(t 12 PRESENT AREA OF BUUDHIS:M. cording to these calculations an approximate total of 534 millions of inhabitants. At least two-thirds of this population may be considered to be Buddhists ; the remainder includes the followers of Confucius and Lao-tse, the adherents of religions prevalent among the inhabitants of China Proper,* the Mussalmans (numerous in Chinese Tartary), and the Pagan tribes of the Chinese peninsula and the Archipelago; the numbers of the latter are com- paratively small, since in their districts the population is very thin. We may therefore estimate the total of Buddhists to amount to 340 millions. The contribution to this number from other parts of the globe is comparatively small, but nevertheless it seems to amount to more than a million. The eastern provinces of the Russian Empire contain some 400,000 Buddhists, viz. 82,000 Kirghises and 119,162 Kalmuks inhabiting Europe,^ and the Buriats (to the number of about 190,000 souls) living in Sibiria; these are almost all followers of Buddhism.'* There are still to be added for the Himalaya and AVestern Tibet, independant of China, the inhabitants of Bhutan, to the number of 145,200, the whole of them, according to Pemberton, ' For China, Gutzlafi’ states the Buddhists to be “the most popular and numerous seet,” adding “that their religious establishments may be estimated at two-thirds of the whole of the religious edifices throughout China.’’ R. As. Soc., Vol. XVI., p. 89. Schott, “Buddhaismus,” p. 28, was of the opinion (in 1844) that the Buddhists were the minority. 2 Notices taken from P. v. Kdppen’s memoir “Ueber die Anfertigung der cthnogi'aphischen Kartc des europaischen Russlands.” Bulletin hist.-phil. de I’Academie de St. Petersbourg, Vol. IX., Table to face p. 335. ’ Latham, “Descriptive Ethnology,” Vol. I., ]> 'I he same was told me by Gombojew, a Buriat of Scleiiginsk. N'UMBKU OF BUDDHISTS. K-i belonging to the Buddhist faitli. ‘ The population of Sikkim, together with the Buddhist inhabitants of Nepal, which chiefly include those of Tibetan origin, I estimate at 500,000 to 550,000.^ The Buddhist province of Spiti, under English protection, was found, according to the census made by Major Hay in the year 1849, to have a population of 1,607.'’ I^adak, now a province of the kingdom of Kashmir, is reported by Cunningham to be inhabited by 178,000 souls; the native population is exclusively Buddhist, but since the annexation to Kashmir some Hindu members of the administration and some Mussalman merchants have settled there. The total of this group would amount even to one million and a quarter.'* For the sake of comparison I add that Prof. Hiete- rici found the total number of Christians spread over ' Report oil Bhutan, p. 151. A recent estimate by Hughes, quoted by the AUgetneine Zeitttng, Jan. 18G2, gives 1.500,000 inhabitants, a number which appears to be somewhat too large. - Hughes estimates Nepal to contain 1,940,000 inhabitants, of which 500,000 Buddhists. This number will not appear too high, if we remember that the actual professed Buddhists in Nepal are divided into four sects, and that Buddhist doctrines have passed to a great extent into the primi- tive creed of the various tribes of Tibetan origin inhabiting this kingdom. See Hamilton, as quoted by Ritter. “Asien,” Vol. III., pp. 120, 123, 125, 129; Hodgson, “Languages,” &c.; As. Res., Vol. XVI., p. 435; the same on the Aborigines of the Sub-Himalayan in “Records of the Govt of Bengal,” p. 129. ’ Report on the valley of Spiti, in .Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XIX., p. 437. * Buddhism had also become known in Mexico by Chinese priests in the fifth century a.d., and had followers in that country until the thirteenth cen- tury; but the victorious Azteks, who took possession of Mexico in the beginning of that century, put an end to Buddhism. See Lassen, “Ind. Alterth.,” Vol. IV., pp. 749 et seq. 14 JMIK8ENT AREA OF RUI)DHIs:M. tlie globe to be 385 millions, of which 170 millions are Koman Catholics. 89 millions Protestants, and 7G millions belone: to the Greek chnrch; their numerical strength appears therefore to be five millions less than the average estimate of Buddhists given above. CHAPTER 111. THE RELIGIOUS SYSTEM OF SAKYAMUNL 'J'liF. Fi’ndamektal Law. — T ire Dogjia of thf. Four Truths, axu the Paths READING TO SALVATION. Sakyamuxi, altliougli the founder of Buddhism, is, at the present day, no longer considered to have been the t hrst Buddha. Many most perfect Buddhas preceded liim (so it is now believed), and many more shall appear here- after; but tliey all teach the same law. ‘ The original religions system, as taught b}^ Sakya- muni himself, is plain in its principles, but characterized by bold, philosophical speculation: fimdamental dogma is the following: — All existence is an evil; for birth originates sorrow, ’ This theory seems to have been introduced into Buddhist mythology already by the Sautrantika school. See Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 314. To this dogma also the name of Tathagata refers (see p. 4); for the philoso- phical explanation of this term with “thus gone,” quoted by Hodgson from original works, see Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 75. * See the valuable exposition of Koppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” pp. 213 — 26. Notices on the earliest dogma of Buddhism occur in numerous passages of Burnoufs “Introduction dans le Buddliisme Indien,” and “Lotus de la Bonne Loi;” in Hardy’s “Eastern Monacliism,” and “Manual of Buddhism.” 16 THE SYSTEM OF SAKYAMUNI. pain, decay, and death. The present life is not the first one ; innumerable births have preceded it in previous ages. The reproduction of a new existence is the consequence of the desire for existing objects, and of the works which have been aggregated in an unbroken succession from the commencement of existence. Proneness to the pleasures of life produces the new being; the works of the former existences fix the condition in which this new beins is to be born. If these works have been wod the beiim will O O come to existence in a state of happiness and distinction ; if, on the contrary, they have been bad, the being will be born into a state of misery and degradation. The absolute annihilation of the conditions and pains of existence — Nirvana — is attained by the most perfect dominion over jiassion, evil desire, and natural sensation. Sakyamuni has explained this fundamental doctrine in the theory of the four excellent truths: The Pain, the Pkoduction, the Cessation, the Path; they are called in JSanskrit Aryani Satyani, and in Tibetan Phagpai denpa zhi. Their meaning may be defined as follows; 1. Pain cannot be separated from existence. 2. Existence is produced by passions and evil desires. 8. Existence is brought to an end by the cessation of evil desires. 4. Revelation of the path to this cessation. In detailing the moral precepts of the fourtth truth he has indicated eight good paths: 1. The right opinion or orthodoxy. 2. The right judgment, which dissipates every doubt and incertitude. To face p. 1^. Plate I. THE FUNDAMENTAL DOGMA OF THE BUDDHIST FAITH. 1. In Sanskrit, wiitten with Tibetan characters. -S ‘V-’CN ^ O C\ o 2. A Tibetan translation of the same. (In ^VTT|^r"n-^tr]-5^T:-aB y vSisy-^y y ■.■'•!*'> ‘•■■1 1-- ■' tsni«(l,, - . f -Mcu.-.' ..4 ■ i ■ ifr -f •; 1.14^" ' ^ ",■■•■''=" ... ,., .',v. % JI--:’t' ' .' ' iSrc^ JiL^- »' ‘'fl!fv -i ■•,V‘i ^^a!6•'"^■?■.:♦5^^ " ".'.V "v' : . : .^■■,v';n ,'v.,>irr^/.:-..>,r. X. ■ » *■ '..'J ■■' ' t ':' .. . . I'lIK FOUB TRUTHS. 17 y>. Tho right words, or perfect meditation. 4. The right mode of acting, or of keeping in view in every action a pure and honest aim. 5. 'i’he right way of supporting life, or of gaining a subsistence by an honest profession unstained by sins. (i. The rightly directed intelligence, which leads to final salvation (“to the other side of the river”). 7. The right memory, which enables man to impress strongly in his mind what should not be forgotten. S. The right meditation, or tranquil mind, by which alone steadiness in meditation can be attained, undisturbed by any event whatever. It has been doubted with much reason, whether .Sakyamuni taught the four truths in this form; but as he must have spoken about the means of arriving at final liberation, or salvation, I have added here these eight classes of the path, which are suggested to him already in very early Sutras.^ The theory of the four truths has been formulated in a short sentence, which has been discovered on many an- cient Buddhist images, and which is besides actually recited as a kind of confession of faith, and added to religious treatises. It runs thus; “Of all things i)roceeding from cause, the cause of their procession hath the Tathagata explained. The great Sramana has likewise declared the cause of the extinction of all things.”^ Tathagatha and ‘ Concerning the four truths see: Csoma “Notices,” in As. Res., Vol. XX., pp. 294, 303; Rumours “Introduction,” pp. 290, 629, and “Le Lotus de la Ronne Loi,” App. V. Another series of eight classes, which is decidedly the produce of the later schools, will be noticed in the next chapter. - This sentence is also the conclusion in the address to the Ruddhas of o 18 I'HH SYSTEM OF SAIvYAMUNJ. Sramana are two epithets of Sakyamimi, as explained before. The aneieiit religious works ap})ly to Sakyainimi’s followers the title of Sravakas hearers," a naine also having reference to their spiritual perfection. Tlie Buddhists of this period seem to have called themselves Sramanas, “those wlio restrain their thoughts, the j)urel}^ acting,” in allusion to their moral virtues as well as their general conduct. ^ confession, for which see Cliapter XL — In the translation of this sentence I have followed Hodgson; see his “Illustrations,” p. 158. Other translations of various readings have been published by Prinsep, Csoma, Mill, and recently compared by Colonel Sykes. See his “Miniature Chaityas and inscriptions of the Buddhist religious dogma,” in R. As. Soc., Vol. XVI., p. 37. The Sanskrit text written with Tibetan characters, and the Tibetan version is given in Plate I. ' Wassiljew, “Der Buddhisinus,” p. 09. ClfAPTEK IV. THE HIXAYANA SYSTEM. Controversies about Sakyamuni’s Laws.— The HInayana Doctrines. The twelve Nidanas; character of the precepts; incitation to abstract meditation: gradations of perfection. At the time of Sakyamuni’s death the inhabitants of India were not yet so advanced in civilisation as to have a literature, and the claims of the Buddhist to scriptural documents of his law written down during his life (as the Nepalese believe), or imme- diately after his death (which is the opinion of the Chinese), are decidedly groundless. New researches have made it very probable that the alphabets in which the earliest historical records we know, the inscriptions of king Asoka (about 250 b.c.), are written, were imitated from the Phoenician alphabet, communicated to the Indians by merchants of that nation as early per- haps as the fifth century b.c., at which period alreadj^ Greek letters became known in the ancient districts of Gandhara and Sindhu, the countries at the foot of the 20 TIIH mXAYAXA SYSTFAl. Hiinala}’'a Jraiiied by the Indus.* We are now able to assert that the words and doctrines attributed to .Sakyamnni were transmitted orally down to the first century before the Christian era. The scriptural record was undertaken by the southern and the northern Buddhists independently of each other. In Ceylon the priests wrote them down during the reign of kingW'artagamani, 88 — 76 b.c. ; their northern brethern brought them into a written form at an assembly of the priests, or synod, arranged by the Turuschka king Kanishka, 10 — 40 a.d. The Singhalese chose the vernacular language, from which the books were trau!^ lated into the sacred Pali dialect at the beginning of the fifth century a.d. ; the northern branch used the Sanskrit.*^ Up to this periods, the religion had been preserved orally, and although, according to Buddhist history, Sakyamuni’s words were brought into a well- defined and precise form already in the year of his death, yet it is very doubtful whether the natural changes to which oral tradition is subject allowed his original law to remain unaltered. Moreover, we have a positive proof that arbitrary alterations and additions have been jiurposely made, especially with reference to the historical details given in the earlier comjiilations. ' A. Weber, Zschr. d. d. Morgeiil. Ges., Vol. X., p. 39G. Westergaard, “Ueber den altesten Zeitrauni der Indischen Geschichte,” pp. 35. seq. 80. Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 30, is, however, of opinion that Buddhist missionaries had become acquainted with Greek letters in tlie third cen- tury B.c. in Bactria, and induced Asoka to model after them the alphabets used in his inscriptions. - 'J'urnour, “Mahavanso,” p. 207. Lassen, “Indische Alt.,” Vol. II., pj). 435, 490. Westergaard, 1. c., p. 41. OIUUIN OF SKCTS. 21 Such changes soon became numerous and assumed an importance not properly belonging to them, owing to the claim set forth by each new sect, that its peculiar dogmas had been revealed by Sakyamuni. The ortho- doxy of each new and dogmatic school is maintained on the supposition, that the word of the Buddha is to be taken in a double sense, as he had often been compelled, in consideration of the mental capabilities of his hearers to give explanations about certain sub- jects quite at variance with his real opinion, and the new sects do not base their existence upon the rejection of previous works as spurious, but claim to have discovered the true meaning/ During the first century after Sakyamuni’s death there was no controversy about his laws, but after this period a numerous fraternity of monks (12,000 it is said) asserted the validity of ten indulgences. Their doctrine was rejected by the assembled priests at the synod of Vaisali, a place north of Patna (Pataliputra), on the eastern bank of the Gandak river, and as they would not submit to the judgment, the first schism took place. ^ At this new * Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 219; AVassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” pp. 7, 329. - See Tumour, Pali Buddhistical Annals. Jouru. As. Soc. Beng. Vol. VI., p. 729. It was at this synod that the following dogma was propounded; “That can only pass as the true doctrine of the Buddha which is not in contradiction to sound reason”. The formation of various schools was the immediate consequence of the acceptance of such a doctrine, and these schools, in their frequent attacks on each other, essayed to prove the correctness of their dogmas in solemn disputation before a great assembly of priests and laymen. In the earlier stage of Buddhism, only the leaders of the antagonistic schools were allowed to engage in disputation, and the vanquished controversialist was compelled cither to put an end to his existence, to become the slave of his more successful opponent, to adojit the other’s creed, or, if in possession of wealth. 22 THE HIXAYANA SYSTEM. stage of Buddhism, in which the fundamental dogmas of Sakyamuni began to be interpreted from various points of view, the ancient sects are called the Hinayana system.^ The name means “little vehicle,” and has originated with the later Buddhists. The epithet “little” was given because the adherents of this system restrict themselves to morality and to external observance only, without making use of such an abstruse, refined, and highly mystical theology, as did, at a later period, the Mahaj'ana schools, or those of the “ great vehicle.” Yana, vehicle, is a mystical expression, indicating, that man may escape the troubles attendant upon birth and death by practising the virtues inculcated by the Buddhas, and finally attain salvation. The following details may be quoted as particularly characteristic of the Hinayana system." I. It distinguishes itself from the Sravakas in the mode of explaining the principle of Buddhism; that the world must be abandoned because it entails upon man existence, pain and death. The source of existence is no longer demonstrated from the four truths oidy, but to relinquish the same in favour of the victor. But in later periods entire monasteries took part in such disputations, and the establishments of the defeated party were destroyed — a circumstance which propably explains in many instances the radical disappearance of monasteries in India. Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 72. Further particulars about the ancient schools may be found in the work of Vasumitra, a translation of which is added as an aj>pendix to Wassiljew’s work, pp. 244-84. — About the geographical position of Pataliputra and Vaisali, see Foe koue ki, English translation, p. 25!), where an interesting note is added to the French original; compare also Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 8(>. ' Sec Foe koue ki, ji. !). K6pj)cn, “Die Religion des Buddha.” Vol. 1., p. 417. * Concerning its dogmas sec Wassiljew, jqi. !>7-128, 110. THE NIDANAS. 23 also from the twelve Nidanas (in Tibetan Tenbrel cliugnyi), which are based upon the four truths. The Xidanas, the theory of the causal connection, or concatenation of the causes of existence, are formulated as follows: “On account of ignorance, merit and demerit are produced ; on account of merit and demerit, con- sciousness; on account of consciousness, body and mind; on account of body and mind, the six organs of sense; on account of the six organs of sense, touch (or con- tact) ; on account of contact, desire ; on account of desire, sensation (of ])leasure or pain); on account of sensation, cleaving (or clinging) to existing objects; on account of clinging to existing objects, renewed existence (or repro- duction after death); on account of reproduction of existence, birth ; on account of birth, decay, death, sorrow, pain, disgust, and passionate discontent. Thus is ^^roduced the complete body of sorrow. From the complete separ- ation from and cessation of ignorance, is the cessation of merit and demerit; from the cessation of merit and demerit is the cessation of consciousness; from the ces- sation of consciousness is the cessation of (the existence of) body and mind; from the cessation of (the existence of ) body and mind is the cessation of (the production of ) the six organs ; from the cessation of (the production of) the six organs is the cessation of touch; from the ces- sation of touch is the cessation of desire ; from the cessation of desire is the cessation of (pleasurable or painful) sensation; from the cessation of sensation is the cessation of the cleaving to existing objects; from the cessation of cleaving to existing objects is tlie cessation 24 THE HIXAYANA SYSTEH. of a reproduction of existence; from the cessation of a reproduction of existence is the cessation of birth; from the cessation of birth is the cessation of decay. Thus the whole body of sorrow ceases to exist.”' 11. In the books of discipline attached to this system we also meet wuth a vast accumulation of precepts and rules intended to release its followers from the ties binding’ them to the present and future states of ex- istence, and to strengthen them in moral virtues. One curious feature predominating throughout is worthy of mention. The whole of the precepts (which are com- prised in 250 articles) display a negative character; thus, charity is inculcated, not by the command “to give,” but by the prohibition “to take.” save when the gift b(^ offered as alms. Already this school had put forth the doctrine, that perfection in abstract meditation is indispensable for final salvation; this perfection guarantees an energy not to be derived from the mere practice of simple virtues. Never- theless the idea is not carried so far as to assign to mental speculation a higher value, than to virtues. Assi- duity in undisturbed reflection was, however, found under any circumstances to be a most difficult task; certain })reparatory exercises are, therefore, recommended, in order to finally lead the mind to abstraction from outward (worldly) objects; but here already we meet in Buddhism with decided extravagances in moral considerations. The countins’ of inhalations and exhalations is named as an ' Hardy’s “Manual of Buddhisni,” p. dlil- Burnouf, “Lc Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” Apijcndix No. VI., “Introduction,” p. 62B. Foe koue ki, p. 291. (JKADATIONS OF I’FKFFCTJON. 25 excellent means for obtaining tranquillity of mind. Detes- tation of the world is said to result from meditating upon the attributes of the body; if, therefore, one begins with regarding his body as an abscess, he will be con- vinced that the body contains nothing but misery and decay, and he will then easily cast off all affection for it, and will even end by considering food also as a mass of putridity, with which he will become disgusted.’ 111. As regards the degree of perfection which man has attained in virtues and science, this system acknow- ledges several gradations, which are based upon the following philosophical considerations. The comprehension of the doctrines as taught by Sakyamuni is different with different men. There are several degrees of com- prehension. Those who have succeeded in arriving at the highest degree are superior to those of a lower one. There are four paths to comprehension, and in order to arrive at ffnal emancipation from re-birth, at Nirvana, it is indispensable to have entered one of them at least. Emancipation takes place either instantaneously, on ac- count of the merit accumulated in previous existences, or by assiduous attention to the various exercises prescribed. To each of the four paths to comprehension are assigned jmrticular faculties arising from its pursuit. Those who have not yet entered any of the paths, are designated in the sacred books by the name of “unwise ' Such moral fanaticism does not seem, however, to liavc liad its exclus- ive origin in Buddhism, for the Buddhists themselves state, that these practices were known also to the Tirthikas, the Brahmanical ascetics, or the “unbelievers.” See Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” p. 250. Hurnouf, “Intro- duction,” p. 280. 2G THE HTNAYANA SYSTEM. men,” or those who live in the meshes of the clea\Tn<>' to existence, of evil desire, ignorance, and impurity. These unwise men have not availed themselves of the means revealed by the Buddha to obtain freedom from metempsychosis; “their minds are still obscure, slow, incapable of clear comprehension; such beings are not in the path securing final liberation, which is only accorded to one of the paths of wisdom.” The gradually increasing importance of the four paths is defined by the Buddhists as follows: — ‘ First path. This is attained by the Srotapatti, or “the man who have entered the stream” leading to Xir- vana, and have thus advanced one step towards salvation. Xirvana is reached by rejecting the error which teaches “1 am,” or “this is mine,” by not doubting the real existence of the Buddhas, and by perceiving that the })ractises and exercises ordained by them must be care- fully attended to. From the time of entering this path up to the attainment of Xirvana itself, there remain only seven more births, but none can take place in any of the four hells; such a saint constantly wanders about, and according to Cliinese notions, his migrations last 80,000 kalpas, or periods of a mundane revolution. Second path. The graduate is here called Sakri- dagamin, “he who will receive birth once more.” Such a graduate’s mind is enlightened upon the subject of the three doctrines understood by tlie Srdtapatti, and is, ‘ See Foe koue ki, Engl, traiisl., p. D-l. Burnouf, “Introduction,” pp. :^8S-98. Hardy, “Eastern Monacliisni,” Chajiter XXII. Each path is sub- divided into two classes, and thus wc get the otlicr system of eight paths, to which I have already alluded. See p. 17. GKADATIOXS OF PERFECTION. 27 moreover, freed from the dct^iro of cleaving to sensuous objects, and of wishing evil to others. He may either enter this path in the world of men and afterwards be born in a world appropriated to gods, or he may enter it in a world of gods, and afterwards be born in the world of men. He has still to wait 60,000 kalpas, be- fore he arrives at Nirvana. Third path. Here the graduate, Anagamin, “he who will not be born again,” is free from the five errors already cast off by the Sakridagamin, and also from evil desire, ignorance, doubt of the precepts of the sceptics, and hatred. He may enter, by the apparitional birth, a world of gods, and from that world attain Nir- vana, for which, however, he has still to wait 40,000 kalpas. Fourth path. This, the highest path to perfection, is attained by the Arhats, Arhants, or Archats, a title meaning that they deserve to become members of the assembl}' of the faithfuls (samgha). In the earliest period of Buddhism the name Arhat was given to every one who had arrived at the comprehension of the four truths. But such a steadiness of the mind, the Hlnayana followers say, can only be attained by those who have renounced the world, viz. by the priests ; and these alone conse- quently enjoy the advantages of entering the fourth path, which consists in nothing less than the emanci- pation from re-birth, and the possession of five super- natural faculties, or the Abhijnas. To allege of any one that he has “seen Nirvana,” is the same as saying, that he has become Arhat. The restriction of Nirvana to the clergy cannot be imputed to f'akyamuni, who, 28 THK HtN'AYAXA SYSTEM. on the contrary, admits all liis followers to the full blessings of his law.' At the early period of the Hinayana s}’stem the list of the different gradations must have been closed with the Arhats, the Buddha even not being originally called by another name; but in the progressive developement of this system the Arhat was superseded by the Pratyeka Buddhas, the Bddhisattvas, and the most perfect Buddhas. Fratyeka Buddhas are those men who, though attain- ing by their own unaided exertions the Bodhi of the supreme Buddhas, remain limited in their powers as well as their intellects. They are unable to release any one from the repetition of existence, as they only care for their own salvation, without contributing in the least towards that of other men. Pratyeka Buddhas are ac- cordingly never said in the legends to have accom- })lished miraculous works similar to tliose of the supreme Buddhas, and are further considered never to appear when a real Buddha is living upon earth.' BodhisaUvas are the candidates for the Buddhaship, or those men who, by assiduity in the practice of virtues and meditation, have finally arrived at the intelligence, or Bodhi, of the supreme Buddha. Whoever strives to attain this sublime rank, has to pass through countless phases of existence, during which he gradually accumu- ' 1 shall have occasion, in the chapter on Tibetan ju’icsthooil, to resume the admittance or non-admittance of this dogma hy the various schools. — About the Abhijntis, see Burnouf, “ Le Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. Si'tt. - See Foe koue ki, English translation, pp. ID, 95, 158; Bunioul’s “In- troduction." \>. 2!t7; Hardy’s “Moiiachism,” and “Manual,” Indc-x, cocc Pa.se Buddha. « ( ) 1 ) 1 1 1 S A T T V A S . 1 ! U I) I ) 1 1 A S . 29 lates a greater degree of merit; he gains thereby the favour of a Biiddlia of contemporaneous existence on eartli, and by his assistance he rises to one of the ce- lestial regions above the earth, where he awaits his next birth as Saviour. Such candidates are not enumerated in the sacred Hinayana books amongst the coni})anions of the Buddha Sakyamuni, with whom indeed no Bodhi- sattva could be contemporaneous; nor are they believed to take an active part in the general welfare of man. The title simply denotes the condition of those who shall attain the Buddhaship at their following birth. ^ The most ijerfect Buddhas (whose plurality has been promulgated by the Santrantika- Hinayana) are those Bodhisattvas who, at their last birth, have arrived at the sublime wisdom which enables them to direct man to the path leading to the cessation of existence. From the moment of departure from earth they have left behind them every kind of personality and form, and all connection with the world ; they interfere with nothing and leave it to man to seek salvation by his own energy. This dogma was still further enlarged by some of the Hinayana sects, the Mahasamghika school even going so far as to discuss the infinity, eternity, and omnipotence of the Buddha. * Burnouf’s “Introduction,” p. 110; Hardy, 1. c.. Index, voce Bodhisattva. CHAPTER V. THE MAHAYANA SYSTEMS. Nagarjuna.— The Fundamental Mahayana Principles.— The contemplative Mahay'ana (Yooaciiarya) System. — The Prasanga-Madhyamika School. X a g a r j u ii a. Most of the sacred Tibetan writers consider Nagar- jnna (in Tibetan Lngrub) as the founder of this system, wliich means “great vehicle.” Xagarjnna is reported in their books to have lived in the southern parts of India, four hundred years after the death of the Buddha Sa- kyamuni or according to Westergaards calculation in the first century a.d.; the sacred books of the Southern Buddhists give the second century b.c.^ The Tibetan historiograph Taranatha, however, is of opinion, that the most important Mahayana books had already appeared ' See p. 7. — The Tibetans are decidedly wrong in considering Kiigarjuna as the author of the numerous Mahayana writings ; for the treatises which they refer to him are ascribed in the Chinese translations to other authors. According to Wassiljew’s opinion he is most probably a mythological personage, without any real existence; in which case w'e should have to regard Nagarjuna as the generic name of the various authors who wrote upon the Mahayana doctrine before the time of Aryiisanga. See his “ Buddhismus,” pp. 140,21!). NAGAKJUNA. 31 in tlie Time of Sri Saralui, or Kaliulabliadra, wlio lived shortl}’ before Nagarjuna. According to some Tibetan legends, Aagarjnna re- ceived the book Taraniartlia, according to others the book Avatamsaka, from tlie Nagas, fiibulons creatures of the nature of serpents, who occupy a place among the beings siiperior to man, and are regarded as pro- tectors of the law of the Bnddha. ^ To these spiritual beings Sakyamuni is said to have taught a more philo- sophical religious system than to men, who were not sufficient!}" advanced to understand it at the time of his appearance. In a Chinese biography Nagarjuna is described as an exceedingly clever man, who considered his theory to be entirely different from that of Buddhism in its contemporaneous form, until, after conversation with the Nagas, he discovered an exactly similar doctrine to have been taught by the Buddha Sakyamuni himself. Hence the biographer infers the system to contain the same principles as those of genuine Buddhism, though it is more sublime. This vindication of orthodoxy natur- ally leads to the conclusion, that Nagarjuna’s followers were well aware of their being in opposition to the Hlnayana schools, which they would have reproached with heresy, had the latter not adopted some of the principles established in the new system, and by doing so, admitted the correctness of the innovations thus introduced. The Hlnayana system existed still for many centuries; Hiuen Thsang, in his reports, frequently mentions that he has met during his travels adherents of the “little vehicle.” Concerning the Nagas see, Foe koue ki, English translation, p. 1.55. 32 TlfE MAHAYANA SYSTEMS. In none of the sacred books treating on the Mahaj'ana system do we find a record of the historical development of its theories prior to the appearance of Aryasanga (in Tibetan Chagpa thogmed), a reformer who founded the Yogacharya school (in Tibetan, Xaljor chodpa).' It is impossible, therefore, to indicate, with any approximation to accuracy, either the origin, or the authors, of the divergent theories to be clearly traced in the Mahayana religious books, which were all of them written before Aryasanga’s time. In the works relating to this system two divisions essentially different are apparent: the first illustrating the principles of Aagarjuna, which have been adopted by the Madhyamika schools (Tib. Bumapa); the second, which is the more developed one, being appropriated by the Y^ogacharya school, or the contemplative Mahayana. I shall treat these divisions separate!}" as also the pecu- liarities that developed in the Prasanga branch, the most important of the Madhyamika system. The fundamental Mahayana principles. The leading principles of this doctrine are to be found in the earliest works attributed to Nagarjuna, among * Aryasanga is said to have been taught his doctrine by the future Buddha Maitreya, the president of the region Tushita, from whom he received back the five short treatises in verse known in Tibet as “the five books of Maitreya,” or Champai chos nga. Csoma places him in tlie seventh century, but according to Wassiljew’s researches (pp. 225, 230) he must have lived much sooner, as the biography of his younger brother, Vasubandhu, was translated by the celebrated Tshin thi into Chinese under the dynasty Tshin, who ruled between the years 557-588 a.d. Also the the remarks of Wilson in R. As. Soc., Vol. VI., p. 240, on the period when the principal works still extant in Sanskrit were w’ritten, may be quoted in prove of the period being an earlier one. He believes it now “established, that they have .been written at the latest, from a century and a half before to as much after, the era of Christianity.” F U N 1 ) A J[ K N T A 1 i L A \V S. which may bo specially mentioned; Samadhiraja. Ihiddha- vatamsaka. and Ratnaknta. I. The fimdamental dogma is that of the emptiness, or nothingness of things (in Tib. Tongpaiivid, in Sanskrit Sfnu-ata); it is also called Prajna Paramita (in Tib. Pharchin, also Sherchin), “the supreme intelligence which arrives at the other side of the river.” ^ This dogma, it is evident, is simply an enlargement and development of the prin- cipal law of Buddhism: — All is perishable, or partakes of impermanence, misery, and unreality. Tho idea of emptiness is referred both to single objects and also to absolute existence in general. When relating to single objects, the expression “void or ideal” signifies that which we consider in any object as original, existing by itself, and permanent; hence, even the Buddha is but the product of judicious reflection and meditation. When referred to absolute existence, emptiness is the abstract essence, existing in every thing without causal con- nexion, and comprising all though containing nothing. Sakyamuni is said to have connected this dogma with the consideration, “that no existing object has a nature. Ngovonyid, whence it follows, that there is neither begin- ning nor end — that from time immemorial all has been perfect quietude, Zodmanas zhiba (viz. nothing has mani- fested itself in any form), and is entirely immersed in Nirvana.” The Mahayana schools demonstrate the doctrine of voidness by the dogma of the three characteristic * There is an interesting treatise on nothingness, called the Vajramanda DharanI, which contains a resume of the ideas connected with this dogma. It is translated by Burnouf, in his “Introduction,” p. .543. Concerning the dogmas of the Mahayana system see Wassiljew, 1. c., pp. 128-43, 319-24, 330. 3 34 TIIK MAHAYANA SYSTEMS. marks, and of the two truths; the three cliaract eristic marks enumerating the properties of any existing object, and the two truths showing how by the perfect under- standing of these properties clear comprehension sliall be attained. The three characteristic marks are the following: Parikalpita (Tib. Kun tag), Paratantra (Tib. Zhan yang), and Parinishpanna (Tib. Yong grub). Parikalpita is the supposition, or the error. Of this kind is the belief in absolute existence to which those beings adhere who are incapable of understanding that every thing is empty; of this kind is also whateyer exists in idea only, without specific quality; or, in other words, whateyer is attributed by our reflections and meditations to any object. The error can be two-fold; some belieying a thing existing which does not, as e. g. the iS on-ego; others assert the real existence of an object which only exists in the idea, as e. g. all outward things. Paratantra is whatever exists by a dependent or causal connexion; it forms the basis of the error. Of this kind are: the soul, the sense, comprehension, and also imperfect philosophical meditation. Every object exists by concatenation, and has a speciflc nature ; therefore, it is called dependent upon others, Paratantra. Parinishpanna, ‘‘completely perfect,’’ or simply “per- fect,’’ is the unchangeable and unassignable true existence, which is also the scope of the path, the summum ho- num, the absolute. Of this kind can be only that which enters the mind clear and undarkened, as for instance, F UN DA IMEN '1' A I, LA W S. the emptiness, or tlie Non-ego. In order, tlierefore, that liis mind may become free from all that would in any way attract his attention, it is necessary that man view every thing existing as ideal, because it is dependent upon something else; then only — as a natural consequence — he arrives at a right understanding of the Non-ego, and to a knowledge of how the voidness is alone self-existent and perfect.' We now come to the two truths. They are: Sam- ^Titisatya (Tib. Kundzabchi denpa) and Paramarthasatya (Tib. Dondampai denpa), or the relative truth and the absolute one. Numerous are the definitions given of these technical terms in the sacred books, but the two principal stand as follows: — 1. Samvriti is that which is supposed as the efficiency of a name, or of a characteristic sign ; Paramartha is the opposite. A difference prevails between the Yoga- charyas and the Madhyamikas with reference to the in- terpretation of Paramartha; the former say that Para- martha is also what is dependent upon other things (Paratantra); the latter say that it is limited to Parinish- panna, or to that which has the character of absolute per- fection. In consequence, for the Yogacharyas Samvriti is Parikalpita and Paratantra, for the Madhyamikas Pari- kalpita only. 2. Samvriti is that which is the origin of illusion, but Paramartha is the self-consciousness^ of the saint in • These technical terms were introduced by the Yogacharya school. — For a comparison of Nirvana with the wind, to illustrate the nature of Nirvana, see Hardy’s Eastern Monachism, p. 295. ^ Sanskrit Svasamvedana, “the reflection which analyses itself.” 3* 36 THE :niahayaxa systems. his self-meditation, Mhich is able to dissipate illusions, i. e., which is above all (parama) and contains the true understanding (artha). II. The world, or the Samsara, must be renounced, not because it is a source of sorrow and pain, as Sakya- muni himself and the Hlnayana followers sav, but on account of its unreality, as it contains nothing which can satisfy the mind. III. Besides the cleaving to existing objects, even thinking of any object or properties whatever, is suffi- cient to hinder final perfection, and the obtaining of the intelligence (Bodhi) of a Buddha. Man must, therefore, not only curb his passions and abstain from the pleasures of life, but it is not even permissible for him to allow an}' notion to become the object of his meditation. IV. Ordinary morality is not sufficient for deliverance from metempsychosis. Those who really strive after fimal emancipation, must assiduously practise the six trans- cendental, or cardinal virtues. These cardinal virtues are; — ' 1. Charity. 3. Patience. 5. Meditation. 2. Morality. 4. Industry, or earnest application. G. Ingenuity. Y. The term “ Bodhisattva” has almost entirely lost its original meaning, and is now used in a double sense. In the one sense it is applied to all those who practise the six Paramitas; in the other to the perfect beings who pass between the dift'erent worlds. AVe find * In numerous religious books four more virtues are added: 1. Method, or manner; 2. Wish, or prayer; .3. Fortitude; 4. Fore-knowledge, or know'- ledge. See Csoma, in As Res., Vol. XX., p. 399; Rurnouf, “Le Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 544. F I ; X D A > I X T A L LA \V S . 37 them ill the legends conteiiipoi'aneous with the Buddhas, travelling with them, and listening to the words of the Buddhas, wdio occasionally send them to remote regions to deliver a message, or receive particular in- structions. These Bddhisattvas are subdivided into several classes, the most sublime among them being nearly equal to the Buddhas, from whom also it is possible they may have emanated; to some of them indeed a rank seems to have been assigned (though apparently without success) which is superior even to that of the Buddhas. They have fulfilled all the conditions for the attainment of the Buddhaship, and might immediately become most perfect Buddhas, did they not prefer, from unlimited charity towards animated beings, to remain still subject to the law of metempsychosis, and to re-incor- porate themselves in human shape for the benefit of man. When once arrived at the estate of a most per- fect Buddha it would be beyond their power to contri- bute to man’s salvation, the Buddhas caring no longer for the world when they have once left it. ^ In cases of need, therefore, prayers for assistance are addressed not to the Buddhas, but to the Bodhisattvas, who have shown themselves so friendly and well-to wards disposed man. The addressing of prayers to the Buddhas re- siding in other regions, we must consider as only a furthei- development of Mahayana Buddhism.' ' Concerning this important dogma see Hardy ‘'Eastern Monachism,” p. 228. ^ The dogma of celestial Bodhisattvas, the progeny of such Buddhas, has been developed only in mysticism, and not in the genuine Mahayana system. 38 THE MAHAYANA SYSTEJIS. Yl. The Mahayana system does not exclude laymen from Nirvana; it admits every one, layman as well as priest, to the condition of a supreme Buddha, and applies this name to all who have attained Niiwana. With regard to the nature of the Buddhas, their dehnition is materially altered; they are no longer entirely deprived of every personahty, and are believed to have a body with certain qualities, and to possess various faculties. By the Mahayanas they have three different kinds of bodies ascribed to them, and, on leaving the world to return to the higher regions, are supposed to strip off only the last and least sublime of these earthly encum- brances, called the Nirmanakaya. These bodies are styled : — 1. Nirmanakaya (Tib. Prulpai ku), which is the Nir- vana with the remains, or body in which the Bddhisattva appears upon earth in order to teach man, after entering by the six Paramitas, the path, or career of the Buddhas. 2. Sambhogakaya (Tib. Longchod dzogpai ku), or the body of bliss and the reward of fulfilling the three con- ditions of perfection. 3. Dharmakaya (Tib. Chos ku), or the Nirvana without any remains. This ideal body (the most sublime one) is obtained by the Buddha who abandons the world for ever, and leaves behind evervthing that has any con- nexion with it.^ ’ Schott, “ Buddhaismus,” p. 9; Csoma, •' Notices” in Journ. As. Soc. Bcng., Vol. VIL, p. 142; Schmidt, “Grimdlehren,” in Memoires de rAcadcinie de St. Petersbourg, Vol. I., pp. 224 et se?. For the Tibetan terms, sec A. Schiefner, “Buddhistische Triglotte.” leaf 4. TJIK YOdAt'HARYA SiSTK.M. 39 'riie C'o iite 111 plati ve Mali ay an a ( Yogacliary a) system. Tiie contemplative system is described in those works which, in viewing the doctrine of the Paramitas, have started from the consideration that the three worlds exist only in imagination (Tib. Seintsamo). »Such works are the Ghanavyuha (the Gandavyuha of Burnouf), the Mahasamaya, and certain others. The saints Nanda (Tib. Gavo), Utarasena (Tib. Dampai de), and Saniyaksatya (Tib. Yangdag den), are probably among the number teaching in this sense previous to Aryasanga; the latter, however, must be considered as the real founder of the system.^ Like the preceding, the present system also requires abstinence from every kind of reflection, as interfering with clear comprehension ; but the most important dogma established by this theory is decidedly the personification of the voidness, by supposing that a soul, Alaya (Tib. Tsang. also Xyingpo), is the basis of every thing. This soul exists from time immemorial, and in every object; ”it reflects itself in every thing, like the moon in clear and tranquil water.” It was the loss of its original purity that caused it to wander about in the various spheres of existence. The restoration of the soul to its purity can be attained by the same means as in the pre- ceding system ; but now the motive and the success become evident; ignorance is annihilated and the illusion that anything can be real is dissipated; man understands at Wassiljcw, 1. c., pp. 11.3 et scq.-, 161, 171, 331-17. 40 THE MAHAYANA SYSTEMS. length clearly, that the three worlds are but ideal; he gets rid of impurity, and returns to his original nature, and it is thus that he becomes emancipated from me- tempsychosis. Of course, as ’with everything belonging to the world, this nature also is only ideal; but the dogma once established that an absolute pure nature exists, Buddhism soon proceeded in the mystical school further to endow it with the character of an all-embracing deity.^ A material modification of its original character was thus established. This idea of the soul, Alaya, is the chief dogma of the Yooacharva system, which is so called because “he O it- who is strong in the Yoga (meditation) is able to intro- duce his soul by means of the Y"oga into the true na- ture of existence.” There occur, however, amongst tlie Tibetans, several explanations of this term, as well as other titles given to this school ; but this name is the most common, and the line of arguments already instanced is ascribed to Aryasanga. To the importance which, from the very first, this school has attributed to meditation, may be traced the germs which subsequently led to its losing itself in mysticism. Aryasanga and his successors managed to endow their doctrines with such splendour, that the Aagarjuna school with the principles taught by it (which had been adopted by the Madhyamikas, Tib. Bumapa) had sunk almost entirely into oblivion for many centuries. It revived, however, * Japanese Buddhism also speaks of a supreme Buddha, who sits throned in the diamond world and has created all the Buddhas. See Hoifmann, “Buddha Pantheon von Jsippon,” in v. Siebold’s '‘Bcschreibung von Japan,” Vol. II.. p. 57. THK rRASAXGA-MADllYA:MlKA SCHOOL. 41 in the seventh century under the name of the Prasanga branch; and this still remains to be treated before con- cluding our notices of the ^lahavana systems. The Prasanga-Madhyamika school. This school/ in Tibetan probably called Thai gyurva. was founded by Buddhapalita. and soon succeeded in superseding all other schools of the Mahayana system, notwithstanding the attacks made upon it by Bhavya, the originator of the Svatantra-Madhyamika school. The success attained by the Prasanga school is due, in a great measure, to the excellent commentaries and introductory works written in the eighth and ninth centuries by Chandrakirti (Tib. Dava Dagpa) and other learned men. These events coinciding with a numerous immigration of Indian priests into Tibet, caused the Prasanga school to be at present considered by the Tibetan Lamas as that which alone taught and gave the true explanation of the faith revealed by the Buddha. The Prasanga school obtained its name from the pe- culiar mode which it adopted of deducing the absurdity and erroneousness of every esoteric opinion. “The Pra- sangas say that the two truths, Samvriti and Paramartha, cannot be maintained as either identical or different; if they were identical, we should strip off the Paramartha together with Samvriti, and if they were different, we should not be able to become delivered from .Samvriti. * Wassiljew, *‘Der Buddhisiiius,” pp. 327; 357-67. Couij.are Csomas' Notices, in Jouni. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VII., p. 1 14- 42 THE MAHAYANA SYSTEMS. Ill understanding by the term Kon-ego all objects which are compound, or exist in Samvriti, we attribute to .it a character identical with being existent and uncom- poiiiided (Paramartha); but if this is already the cha- racter of Samvriti, it denotes that the objects have already a perfect existence ; hence they have already arrived at salvation (Tib. Dolzin). Prom such and similar hair-splitting considerations the Prasangas deduce that both truths have ‘one and the same nature’ (Tib. Ngovo chig), but two distinct meanings (Tib. Togpa nyi). These speculations are called Prasanga.” The Prasanga school maintains that the doctrines of the Buddha establish two paths — one leading to the highest regions of the universe, to the heaven, Sukhavatl,^ where man enjoys perfect happiness but connected with personal existence; the other conducting to entire emancipation from the world, viz. to Nirvana. The I'onner path is attained by the practice of \urtues, the latter by the highest perfection of intelligence. They reckon eight (according to some writers even eleven) peculiarities by which their system distinguishes itself from all the others; out of these eleven peculiarities, as given by the Tibetan Jam yang shadpa, I select the following as the most characteristic, the others being but a rei)etition of ge- neral Mahayana ])rinciples, or deductions contained in their own. 1. ’The principal dogma is the negation of existence as well as of non-existence; they admit neither self- existence (absolute existence), Pai’amartha. nor existence ' See for parLicular.s Chapter IX. TIIK PRASANGA-MAUHYAMIKA SCHOOL. 43 by causal connexion, Samvriti: in order not to fall into extremes. For, not to say of what has never existed, to be; and of the truly existing, not to be; this is to take a middle way, iMadhyama. ^ This dogma is formulated as follows: — "By denying the extreme of ex- istence is also denied, in consequence of conditional appearance, the extreme of non-existence, which is not in Paramartha.” The arguments in proof of this thesis are most circumstantial ; the following most curious syl- logisms occur in Jam yang shadpa’s work: — 1. If the plant grew by its own specific nature, it would not be a composition, Tenbrel; it is de- monstrated, however, that it is a composition. 2. If anything in nature were self-existent, we should certainly hear and see it; for the sensation of seeing and hearing would in this case be abso- lutely identical. 3. The quahty of being general would not be pe- culiar to many things, because it would be an indivisible unity, as such a unity we should be obliged to take the e(/o, if there were an ego. 4. The plant would not be compelled to grew anew, because it would continue to exist. 5. If any Skandha,- as sensation, were self-existent, * They are also called, on account of this theory, “those who deny ex- istence (nature),” in Tibetan, Xgovonyid inedpar mraba. - The Buddhists enumerate five essential pi-operties of sentient existence, which are styled Skandhas, or Sllaskandhas, in Tibetan, Tsulkhrim kyi phungpo, “the aggi’egates of morals.” They are; 1. The organized body; 2. Sensation; 3. Perception; 4. Discrimination; 5. Consciousness. See Bur- nouf. Index, voce Skandha; Hardy’s Manual of Buddhism, pp. :388, oO‘J-424. — For the Tibetan designations of the five Skandhas see “ Buddhistische Triglotte,” by A. Schicfner, leaf 9. 4i THE :mahayana systems. another fSkandlia, as e. g. the organized bod}^, would be also sell-existent; but it is impossible to pro- duce by the self-existence of sensation that of the organized body, because the plastic power and the object to be formed are identical. 2. The Alaya has an absolute eternal existence; those treatises do not teach the right doctrine which attribute to it only a relative existence. 3. Xot only the Arhats, but also simple men, if they have entered the path, can arrive at the rude comj)re- hension of the sixteen kinds of the four truths by “very evident (earnest) meditation” (Tib. Aaljor ngonsum) ; but those systems are considered wrong which pretend, as the Hlnayana, that the knowledge (Yishnana) derived from such meditation (which is nothing but a mani- festation of the Alaya) be not liable to errors (Sansk. Vikalpa, Tib. Namtog). Even the Arhat goes to hell in case he doubt anything. This reproach is meant to be made to the schools by w'hich the Arhats are admitted to Nirvana under any condition. ‘ 4. The three periods: the present, the past, and the future, are compounds, correlative to each other. The Buddha has declared: “A harsh word, uttered in past times, is not lost (literally destroyed)^ but returns again;” and, therefore, the past time is the present time, as is also the future, though as yet it has not come into existence. 5. The Buddha has two kinds of Nirvana: Nirvana with remains and Nirvana without remains; the latter ' The means of avoiding the error have been more fully developed by mysticism in the exigencies of Vipasyana and Saniatha. See p 51. THE PI?.VSAN(iA-MAI)llVA:\llKA SllOOL. 4 5 kind only is entire extinction of personality, or the state where the notion of ego ceases, where the outward and inward man is destroyed. In this state, the Buddha has assumed the body Dharmakaya, in which there is neither beginning nor end; whilst in the Nirvana with remains he has obtained only the Nirmanakaya body, in which, though rendered impervious to outward impressions, he has not yet thrown oft’ habitual errors (the influence of passions), of which nothing remains in the other kind of Nirvana. The Prasangas admit as orthodox the greater part of the hymns in the Tanjur, and those of the Sutras which are contained in the Kanjur; in these, they say, the true meaning of the word of the Buddha (viz. the Madhya- mika doctrine) is explained. There exist a large number of such books, the most important of which are the seventeen books of the Prajnaparamita, then the Akshaya- matinirdesa, the Samadhiraja, the Anavataptapariprichchha, DharmasamgTti, the Sagarapariprichchha, the Manjusrl- vikrldita, the first chapter of the Ratnakuta, and the chapter of Kasyapa, which is quoted by Nagarjuna and his disciples in support of their dogmas.' It is remarkable to see at what extravagances Buddhist speculation has arrived by its tendency to follow abstract ideas without the consideration of the limits presented by bodily experience and the laws of nature. But the case is rather not an isolated one; we meet instances of analogous dreams in ancient and modern times. ’ Wassiljew in his examination of the most important Mahayana Sutras, pp. 1.57-202, presents an analysis of the ManjusrivikrTdita and the Ratnakuta. CHAPTER VI. THE SYSTEM OF MYSTICISM. General Character. — The Kala Chakra System; its Orioin and Doomas. The contact of tlie Buddhists with their various pagan, neighbours gradually introduced into their creed ideas foreign to Buddhism, and the consequence of this was the rise of a new system full of mystic modifications. We see already in the later Alahayana schools, particu- larly in the Yogacharya branch, a more general yielding to the current superstitious notions; but the principles of mystic theology such as we find them in the actual Buddhism of the present day have chiefly been developed in the most modern system, which originated indepen- dently of the earlier ones, in Central Asia. Its theories were afterwards even engrafted upon later productions by a subsequent incorporation, to such a degree, that without a knowledge of this system, we should often GKNEKA E f’HAI{A(’TEK. 47 be almost at a loss how to understand the ^Vlahayana sacred books. European orientalists use to appl}' to this third system the name of Yogacharya ; and if we bear in mind, that Yoga means in Sanskrit “abstract devotion, by which supernatural faculties are acquired,”^ it becomes evident that they were led to do so by the conformity of the name with the system to which they applied it. But Wassiljew has clearly proved in his work, that Y'ogacharya is but a branch of the Mahayana system, and he therefore substituted the name of “Mysticism,” which I have also adopted. This name was chosen because this system places meditation, the recital of certain prayers, and the practise of mystical rites above the observance of precepts and even above moral deportment. Mysticism appears for the first time as a specific system in the tenth century of our era; it is called in the sacred books Dus kyi khorlo, in Sanskrit Kala Chakra, “the circle of time.”® It is reported to have originated in the fabulous country Sambhala (Tib. Dejung), “source or origin of happiness.” Csoma, from careful investigations, places this country beyond the Sir Deriau (Yaxartes) between 45° and 50° north latitude. It was first known in India in the year 965 a.d.; and it was in- * Wilson, “Glossary of Judicial and Revenue Terms,” see the article Yoga. - See Csoma, “On the origin of the Kala Chakra system,” Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. II., p. 57. “Grammar,” 192. “Analysis,” As. Res., Vol. XX., pp. 488, 564. Compare also Burnouf, “Introduction,” Section V. Hodgson, “Notice on Buddhist Symbols,” R. As. Soc., Vol. XVIH., p. 397. Wilson, “Sketch of the Religious Sects of the Hindus,” As, Res., Vol. XVII., p. 216-29. 48 MYSTICTS^r. trodiicetl, they go on to say, into Tibet from India via Kashmir, in the year 1025 a.d. I cannot believe it accidental that the beginning of the Tibetan era of counting time, about which I shall have occasion to say some words in a later chapter, coincides with the intro- duction of this system. 1 am rather inclined to think (though as far as I know, this has not yet been pointed out as particularly important) that the readiness with which this system was received made it appear at once so important, that events were dated from its introduction. The principal rites and formulse of mysticism and tlie theories about their efficacy bear an extraordinary analogy to the Shamanism of the Siberians, and are, besides, almost identical with the Tantrika ritual of the Hindus; for it promises endowment with supernatural faculties far superior to the energy to be derived from virtue and abstinence, and capable of leading to the union with the deity, to the man who keeps in mind that all three worlds exist in the imagination only and regulates his actions accordingly. Its theories are laid down in two series of works, which are known under the collective titles of Dharanis (in Tibetan Zung), and Tantras (in Ti- betan Giyut). The DharanI formulae may be of con- siderable antiquity, and it is not unhkely that already the Mahay ana leaders took some of them into theii- books. The Tantras are of a more modern date, espe- cially those of them, in which the observance of magical practices is carried to a point which is an extreme even for mysticism in any form. Wilson believes Tan- trika notions to have originated in India in the early THE KALA OH AREA SYSTEM. 4 !) centuries of (Christianity, but the present Hindu ritual seems to him not to date back beyond the tenth cen- tury; about at the same time the Tantras were pro- bably introduced also into the Buddhist sacred literature. Their modern origin is proved by the statement of the Tibetan autorities respecting the appearance of the Dus Ivyi khorlo system, which makes the deliverance from metempsychosis dependent upon the knowledge of the Tantras. So at least says Padma Karpo, a Tibetan Lama, who lived in the sixteenth century, in his description of these doctrines. “He who does not know the Tan- trika principles and all such, is a wanderer in the orb of transmigration and is out of the way (path) of the supreme triumphator, Sanskrit Bhagavan Vajra- dhara.”' Another and indirect proof of their recent origin is the fact, that there are much fewer works on Tantrika principles existing in the Chinese language ; had the Chinese Buddhist pilgrims who travelled in India still during the seventh century a.d. found such treatises (had they existed at all, they would soon have become acquainted with them), they would certainly have brought them home in order to have them translated into the Chinese language ; and then, also, in this particular branch the Chinese Buddhist literature would be richer than the Tibetan, whilst the reverse is actually the case. Besides, it is also reported, that the most expert Indian magicians, or Tantrists. did not exist till after the travels of the * The claim that Sakyamuni is their original author, is undoubtedly in- admissable, both on account of their style and contents, as well as of histori- cal dates. 4 50 MYSTICISM. Cliinese pilgrims in India, and that the most important Tantras had been translated into Chinese during the reign of the northern Song d^ynasty which ruled from the years 960 to 1127 a.d. Kala Chakra is also the title of the principal work of this system; it stands at the head of the Gyut di- vision of the Kanjur, as well as, the Tanjur, and was ex- plained and repeatedly commented on by several learned men who lived in the fourteenth, fifteenth, and sixteenth centuries, of whom the most celebrated were Pnton or Boston, Khetiip, and Padmo Karpo. I have arranged the dogmas propounded by mysti- cism in four groups. I. There is a first, chief Buddha, Adi Buddha, in Tibetan Chogi dangpoi saugye, who is without beginning or end; none of the human Buddhas have arrived at the Buddhaship for the first time, and the Sambhogakaya, or body of blissfulness of the Buddhas has existed from all eternity and will never perish. This first of the Buddhas is called in the Tantras Yajradhara (in Tibetan Dorjechang or Dorjedzin), and Yajrasattva (in Tibetan Dorjesempa). ' As Yajradhara he is epitheted “the su- preme Buddha, the supreme trinmphator, the lord of all mysteries,^ the prime minister of all Tathagatas, the being who is without beginning or end, the being who has the soul of a diamond (Yajrasattva).” It is he to whom the subdued and conquered evil spirits swear tliat ‘ Dorjechang ami Dorjedzin have the same meaning, “holding the diamond (Vnji’a).” Senipa (sems-pa) means “the soul.” - Sanghai Dagiio, “concealed lord,” in Sanskrit Guhyapali. DOEJECHANG. DOEJESEMPA. 51 they will no longer hinder the propagation of the faith of the Buddha, nor in future do any mischief to man. To Yajrasattva the epithets are given of “the supreme intelligence, the chief (Tsovo), the president of the five Dhyani Buddhas.”' But Vajradhara and Vajrasattva are also considered as two different beings, as they occur in several treatises both at the same time, the one putting questions, the other answering them. Their respective position may be explained the best by supposing Vajra- dhara to be too great a god and too much lost in divine quietude to favour man’s undertakings and works with his assistance, and that he acts through the god Vajrasattva, who would be to him in the relation of a Dhyani Buddha to his human Buddha. This explana- tion is also supported by the epithet of “president of the Dhyani Buddhas.” By the name of Dhyani Buddha,^ “Buddha of con- templation,” or by the term Anupadaka, “without parents,” celestial beings are designated corresponding to the human Buddhas teaching upon earth, who are called “Manushi Buddhas.” The Buddhists believe that each Buddha when preaching the law to men, manifests himself at the same time in the three worlds which their cosmographical system acknowledges. In the world of desire, the lowest of the three to which the earth belongs, he appears in ' See Csoma, As. Res., Vol., 20, pp. 496, 503, 549, 550. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. II., p. 57. Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 205. ^ Respecting the theory of the Dhyani Buddhas see Schmidt, “Grund- lehren,” Mem. de I'Acad. de Petersb., Vol. I, p. 104. Burnouf, “Introduction,” pp. 116, 221, 525, 627. “Ijotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 400. The more theistical ideas of the Nepalese about their origin are noknot \vn to the Tibetan Buddhists. 4* 52 MYSTK’ISM. human v shape. In the world of forms he manifests himself in a more sublime form as Dhyani Buddha. In the highest world, the one of the incorporeal heings, he has neither shape nor name. The Dhyani Buddhas have the faculty of creating from themselves by virtue of Dhyana, or abstract meditation, an equally celestial son, a Dhyani Bodhisattva, who after the death of a Manushi Buddha is charged with the continuance of the work undertaken liy the departed Buddha till the next epoch of religion begins, when again a subsequent Manushi Buddha appears. * Thus, to each human Buddha belongs a Dhyani Buddha and a Dhyani Bodhisattva,^ and the unlimited number of the former also involves an equally unlimited number of the latter. Out of this vast number the five Buddhas of the actual period of the universe are particularly worshipped. , Four of these Buddhas have already appeared; Sakyamuni is the fourth and the last who has appeared till now; his Dhyani Buddha is Amitabha, in Tibetan Odpagmed; his Dhyani Bodhisattva Avolokitesvara, or Padmapani, in Tibet generally implored under the name of Chenresi. To the Dhyani Buddhas of these five Manushi Buddhas is added, as a sixth and the highest in rank, Vajrasattva. To him or occasionally also to Amitabha who then takes his place, the Tibetans attribute the function of the “ God * The Buddhas are men and subjected to the physical conditions esta- blished for human creatures; it is in consequence of this principle that the stay of every Buddha upon earth is limited by the laws which fix for the Ijeriod during which he appears, the life-time of man, which varies from S0,0()0 to 10 years. When this period had elapsed he dies, or as the Buddhists say, he returns to Nirvana. lie has, besides, a female companion, a Sakti. DORJECHANG. DORJESEMPA. 53 above all.” One of these two divine persons is addressed in such ceremonies as are believed to grant success to undertakings, and the belief in the absolute necessity of their assistance is so positive that a Lama told my brother that ‘‘a ceremony which does not include an address to Dorjesempa (Vajrasattva) is similar in efficacy to a bird which, with its wings cut, tries to fly.”' AVith reference to the representations of these divine persons in drawings I am able to add the following details. A picture on canvas received by Adolphe from Tholing, in Gnari Khorsum, represents Vajrasattva with rosy complexion, holding the Dorje in his right hand and a bell in his left; the latter, in Tibetan called Drilbu, is identical in shape with those used in sacred choral songs to mark the pauses. Vajrasattva is surrounded by various groups of gods representing protectors of men against evil spirits. — Amitabha is represented in all the images I have examined, with a ^dvid red complexion ; in a very nicety executed picture from Mangnang in Gnari Khorsum were subjoined beneath the seat the seven precious things, in Tibetan called Rinchen na dun. They are: — Khorlo (Sanskr. Chakra), “the wheel;” Norbu (Sanskr. Mani), “the precious stone;” Tsunpo, “the royal consort;” Lonpo, “the best treasurer;” Tachog, “the * A vci’y ijowerful prayer is that which concludes the address to the Buddhas of confession, see Plates V et scq . — The fact of the fre(iuent iniploration of the Dhyani Buddhas shows that the Tibetan Buddhists dift'er in this point from those of Nepal, who believe the Dhyani Buddhas to be absolutely inactive. 54 MYSTICISM. best horse;” Langpo, “the elephant;” Maglon, “the best leader.” ‘ II. Worldly notions or phenomena dare not be selected for contemplation; but from assiduous medi- tation in which any religious object is analysed (Zhine lhagthong, Sankr. Vipasyana), man acquires new faculties, provided he most earnestly concentrates his thoughts upon one object. Such a state of calmness and tran- quillity, in Sanskrit Samatha, occasions, however, great trouble, and it is considered as not at all easy to con- centrate the mind, this requiring long practice; but if man has once succeeded, aided by preparatory exercises,^ in bringing himself to meditate with unmoved mind upon the deepest religious abstractions in the four degrees of meditation, Dhyana (in Tibetan Samtan), he finally arrives at entire imperturbability, Samapatti (in Tibetan, Nyompa), which has also four gradations. First of all, a perfect absence of all idea of individuality is the result; then secrets and powers hitherto concealed to him become at once unveiled, and he has now en- tered “the path of seeing,” Thonglam; by continued, uninterrupted meditation on the four truths, his mind becomes supernaturally pure, and gradually rises to the most perfect states, called the Top, Tsemo (in Sanskrit Murdhan), patience, Zodpa (in Sanskrit Kshanti), and the supreme in the world (in Sanskrit Lokottaradharma).'’ — * Compare about them I. J. Schmidt, “Ssaiiaug Ssetseu,” p. 471. - A Tibetan mode of keeping the thoughts together, shall be noticed in Chapter XV. * See Burnouf, “Le Lotus,” pp. 348, 800. Hardy, “Eastern Monaehism,” ]). 270. Wassiljcw, “Her Buddliismus,” ]>. 149. DirAEANiS. 55 This dogma is in decided contradiction to the Mahayana principle that tlie meditation on any object ivhatever keeps man back from arriving at the highest degree of per- fection.' III. The recital of m3’^stical words and sentences, the Dharams (Tib. Zimg), bestows upon man ever}' kind of bliss and obtains for him the assistance of the Buddhas and Bbdhisattvas. These Dharanls^ have been decidedly adopted from the generally felt want of incantations as remedies against fear of danger, though the Buddhists believe them to have been delivered b}' Sakyamuni, oi’ by those Buddhas, Bodhisattvas, and gods over whom Dharaius are supposed to exercise an influence. The number of the formulfe taught by these gods is described in the sacred books as enormous, and each is considered as equally efficacious. But Wassiljew is of opinion that the great number alluded to most likely is to be re- ferred to so many verses (Gathas) or even single words of the treatises which describe their powers and the ceremonies in the performance of which they are recited. These formulae are either short sentences or even only a few words, as e. g. the names and the epithets of tlie Buddhas and Bodhisattv'as. There are some Dharams which are equal to the practise of the Paramitas, others subdue gods and genii, or call for Buddhas and Bodhisattvas; some impart longevity or accomplish every wish; others cure diseases. &c. It is even assumed, that by a mere ' See p. 36. ^ Compare Burnouf, “Introduction,” jip. .522 — 74. Wassiljew, 1. c., pp. 153, 5f) MYSTICISM. uttering of the letters of which the Dharain is composed — nay even by their aspect alone — power may be gained over those beings of which they treat, or for such purposes for which they are supposed to grant help. They dare not be altered when recited or written, as each letter has its own magical power, and it is owing to this belief that they have not been translated into Tibetan, and that the Tibetan alphabet has been adapted to the exact rendering of every Sanskrit letter. ‘ The magical influence of words is deduced from the unreality of all existing objects; all existence being but ideal, the name is just as much as the object itself; consequently, if a man holds sway over a word expres- sive of anything, he also disposes of the thing itself. The same influence is also attributed to conventional signs formed by a certain placing of the fingers, Chakja, in Sanskrit Mudra. All objects being identical with re- ference to their nature, signs which symbolize the attri- butes of a god produce the same effect as words and offerings. IV. The reciting of Dharanis, if combined with the practise of magical rites and supported by morality and contemplation, leads to superhuman faculties (in Sanskrit Siddhi) — nay, even to the union with the deity. This is a doctrine which, in all probabilitity, has ' The S.nnskrit names of the Buddhas and Bodhisattvas have been, however, translated into Tibetan, but these names are rendered as literally as possible. I quote as examples Araitabha and Odpagmed; ManjusrI and .lamjang; Avalokita and Chenresi; Vajrasattva and Dorjeseinpa; Vajradhara and Dorjechang.— For the alphabetieal seheme of the Sanskrit language when written with Tibetan charaeters see Csoma’s Grammar, p. 20. TANTllAS. 57 grown up very recently. The compendious l)ooks Tan- tra ti-eat of this dogma and say, that by magical arts either worldly purposes can be attained, as longevity and riches, or also religious ones, as dominion over malignant spirits, the aid of a Buddha or Bbdhisattva, or the removal l)y him of any doubt or uncertainty with regard to any of the dogmas. But the chief aim is to obtain tinal emancipation from metempsychosis, and acquire re-birth in Amitabha’s celestial mansion, which latter, by means of such magical ceremonies, can be obtained al- read}’- in one existence, instead of being the reward of uninterrupted privations in an unlimited series of existences. * * The observances in connexion with such magical arts, and the description of magical rites, &c., is given in Chapter XV. -rl»y *|T#» '‘|HI|^ ‘ ' ^lUt’.>|filr .i|pi-» ■jirJ.^^»|. ■ ^ • ' - ' • ’jt ,vtf1u^i> '»U» Aiijr*llif*l(i#-I»jr"ii-'4V !('; Mfiijii -tri* > * mwtr> »rf< S 'f pi’* ^ H.* fln>'»3ir' >> ; rt.'*rt *• ' . *l4* ♦. || i- ^ » * np^ V» 4Airti I 5Wlp:«— ■■«- / V'- "*^i/ • >*' »'*'■ > -'4 i gA .' *^^?Wv -T*-- ■■ ^ • •• -^1 CHAPTER VII. HISTORICAL ACCOUNT OF THE INTRODUCTION OF BUDDHISM INTO TIBET. Earliest Religion op the Tibetans. — Introduction of Buddhist Dogmas INTO Eastern Tibet. — Era of King Srongtsan Gampo and King Thisrong de tsan. — The reforms of the Lama Tsonkhapa. — Propagation of Buddhism into China, Ladak and Eastern Himalaya. Before the propagation of Buddhist doctrines in Tibet the religion of the inhabitants of this country was most probably a kind of worship differing but little from that prevalent among all rude nations, viz, a mingled system of idolatry and sorcery administered by priests enjoying great reputation and power, in consequence of their supposed intercourse with the Gods, and presumed know- ledge of the means whereby the divine favour and as- sistance can be obtained. The first attempt of Buddhist followers to extend their creed to Tibet doubtless met with general opposition at the hands of both priesthood and people. The latter indeed must have found it far less troublesome to pay a clerical class to obtain a sensual prosperity for them, than by painful discipline. G2 BUDDHISM IX TIBET. combined with profound meditation, to seek salvation and eternal welfare in a future re-birth and final emanci- pation from metempsychosis. In order to attain success and the more readih’ impose upon the tribes they were about to convert to a new religion, the first teachers of Bnddliism in Tibet were most probably induced to ascribe to themselves supernatural qualities, and to yield, in minor points of discipline, to some of the ideas of their neophytes. Many suggestions to this effect are to be found in the sacred Tibetan books, as in the Bodliimor, and in the history of Ssanang Ssetsen, which teems with the miraculous and wonderful works performed by early Buddhist priests. Again, it is related that Padma Sam- bhava’s first labour was the subduing of the dreadful demon who rose up in opposition to prevent his enter- ins: Tibet. His scholars are said to have derived from the instructions he gave them on the proper employ- ment of charms, the power of performing most extra- ordinary deeds. ‘ Thus, they caused good harvests, and similar prosperous events, taught the Tibetans some of the arts and sciences which were then practised in the more advanced civilization of China and India (whence they came), but were discreet enough, after, a wliile, to attribute all their successes to the worship of the images and relics of 8akyamuni. With regard to the introduction of Buddhism into the Eastern part of Tibet we are now in possession of many })ositive data, though here also the early history is in- ’ Schmidt, '‘Ssanang Ssetsen’s Geschichte der Ostmongolen,” pp. 41, 43, 3.’i.'). Compare Forschungen,” p. 13(>. ITS INTEODUCTION INTO EASTERN TIRET. ()3 volved ill darkness and myth. The first attempts ap- parently led to very unsatisfactory results; at least, the monastery which is reported to have been erected in the year 137 b.c. on the slopes of the Kailas range seems to have been soon abandoned and to have fallen into ruins.' The legends attribute the conversion of the Tibetans to Buddhism to the Dhyani Bbdhisattva Avo- lokitesvara, the celestial son of Amitabha, whose chosen land is Tibet; many of the rulers and priests who took an active part in the consolidation of Buddhist faith in this country were regarded by its inhabitants as in- carnations of these two sacred persons. We here give the following as a narrative of some historical facts intimately connected with Buddhism.^ In the year 371 a.d. there suddenly appeared five foreigners before the king Thothori Kyan tsan, who in- structed him, how he might use for the general welfare 1 Lassen, ‘4ud. Alterthumskunde,” Vol. II., p. 1072. - See. Csoma’s Chronological Table, extracted from an historical book written by Tisri, the regent at Lhassa in the year 168G a.d.; in the notes, Csoma adds further details from other original books. See his “Grammar,” pp. 181 — 98.— Ssanang Ssetsen, “Geschichte der Ostmongolen,” aus dem Mongolischen ubersetzt von I. J. Schmidt; Chapter III., treats of the history of Tibet from the years 407 to 1054 a.d. The annotations to Ssanang Ssetsen contain translations from the Bodhimbr, and other Mongolian books. “ Chro- nologic Bouddhique, traduite du Mongol,” par Klaproth. Fragments Bouddhiques = Nouveau Journal Asiatique, 1831. — The data of these three authors differ as far as the eleventh century, from which period Csoma’s and Klaproth’s lists agree, saving a constant diversity of two years, which results from the circumstance that the one counts from the Tibetan era, whilst the other brings the data in accordance with the Chinese years (see Chapter XVI.). In the text I have adopted Csoma’s dates, with the single exception of the time of Srongtan Gampo’s birth, which, it is more probable, took place in the year 617 a.d. (Klaproth and Ssanang Ssetsen), instead of the year 627. See Kbppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” Vol. II., p. 54. In the notes I have added the dates given by Ssanang Ssetsen and Klajiroth. G4 BUDDHISM IN TIBET. of Tibet four objects, which, in the year 331 a.d., ‘ had fallen from heaven, enclosed in a precious chest, but of the intrinsic value of which no one had hitherto enter- tained any adequate idea. These instructions being given, the five foreigners at once disappeared. The four precious objects were: — 1. Two hands folded in prayer. 2. A small Chorten.^ 3. A gem with an inscription of the prayer: Om mani padme hum.® 4. The religious work Zamatog, “constructed vessel,’’ a work on moral subjects forming part of the Kanjur. The king Thothori strictly obeyed the ad\dce received from the five foreigners, and paid great reverence to the said four objects ; by their blessing and powerful influence he contrived to live one hundred and nineteen years, during which time universal prosperity and welfare prevailed throughout the kingdom. Ssanang Ssetsen connects the introduction of Buddhism with the date of this event; but according to Tibetan historians “the earliest period of the propagation of Buddhism,” which reached down till the end of the tenth * Ssanang Ssetsen, anno 367, calls this king Lhatotori; Csoma’s authorities have Thothori Nyan tsan. The above is the version according to Ssanang Ssetsen ; Csoma, p. 194, relates ‘ that a voice was heard from heaven, saying, that after so many generations (in the seventh century), the contents of the book should be made known’. — It is not stated whence these five men pro- ceeded, but I believe them, for reasons which will hereafter become apparent, to have been Chinese Buddhist priests. See p. 68. ® About Chortens, see Chapter XIII. ^ See Chapter X. KING SRONGTSAN GAMPO. 05 century a.d., begins with King Srongtsan Gampo, wlio was born in the year 617 a.d. and died 698/ This king is highly extolled by them on account of his suc- cessful efforts in propagating Buddhism. He even went so far as to send to India, in the year 632 a.d., his prime- minister, Thumi Sambhota, with sixteen companions, who had orders to study carefully the sacred Buddhist books and the Indian language; the members of this mission were also instructed to bring back to Tibet a complete system of the alphabet as used in India, with a view to its being hereafter adapted to the Tibetan language.^ After the safe return of the party from a journey which is described as fraught with incredible difficulties, Thumi Sambhota constructed the Tibetan letters from the Devanagari alphabet, whereupon King Srongtsan Gampo ordered the sacred Indian books treating on Buddhists doctrines to the translated into Tibetan.'* At the same time he * Respecting this distinction of the two periods see Csoma’s Grammar, p. 196, Note 18. — The year of Srongtsan’s death is given on the authority of Ssanang and Klaproth; in Csoma’s list it is not mentioned. A previous mission is said to have been compelled by the malignant spirits to return, after reaching the frontier. For Tibetan accounts of the attempts of Srongtsan to form a Tibetan alphabet, see Schmidt’s notes to “Ssanang Ssetsen,” p. 326. ^ Respecting the striking resemblance of the Tibetan capital letters to the ancient Devanagari characters much interesting information is furnished in the comparative tables given by Hodgson in his “Notices,” As. Res., Vol. XVI. , p. 420. Schmidt, “Ueber den Ursprung der tib. Schrift,” Mem. de I’Acad. de Pet., Vol. I., p. 41. Csoma, “Grammar,” p. 204. — Thumi Sam- bhota is said to be an incarnation of the Bodhisattva Manjusri. This divine person, in Tibetan called Jamjang, is to be viewed in a double sense. He appears to be an historical personage who taught Buddhist doctrines in Nepal in the 8th or 9th century a.d.; but he is also worshipped as a mythological person of the divine nature of a Bodhisattva (his Sakti is Sarasvatl, Tib. Ngagi lhamo), who is believed to have inspired with his (divine intelligence many a person who has much contributed to the propagation of Buddhist theories. He is 66 BUDDHISM IN TIBET. issued severe laws with tlie intent of abolishing once and for ever some of the rude manners of his subjects. In all these praiseworthy actions King Srongtsan Gampo was most energetically supported by his two wives, one of whom was a Nepalese the other a Chinese princess; both of them, who throughout their life-time proved most faithful votaries to the faith of Buddha, are w'orshipped either under the general name of Dolma (in Sanskrit Tara), or under the respective names of Dolkar and Doljang. These princesses are said to have brought with them to Tibet a variety of valuable re- ligious books, w'ith wonderful miracle-working images, and relics of Sakyamuni, besides building numerous temples and colleges.' Attracted by these acts of bene- volence, which soon became widely known, many foreign priests settled in Tibet during the lifetime of these the God of wisdom, swinging the “sword of wisdom'’ (Tib. Shesrab ralgih) with a flamed point to dissipate the darkness among men. Chinese books say of his faculties: “W’hen he preaches the great law, every demon is subjugated, every error that may deceive man is dissipated, and there is not a heretic but returns to his duty.” ManjusrI is also “ the ruler of the year,” which epithet refers to the first day of the year being consecrated to him. Foe koue ki, p. 116. Compare Hodgson, “Classification of the Nevars,” in Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XII., p. 216. Burnouf, “Le Lotus,” pp. 4i)8-.511. Lassen, “Indische Alterthumskunde,” Vol. III., p, 777. ' In pictures they are both represented in identical attitudes, the right foot hanging down over the throne, the right hand holding the blue lotus Utpala {Kelumbium speciosum, “Encyclopedia of India,” by Balfour, p. 1261, a plant which occurs in Kashmir and Persia). But the complexion is difiierent; Dolkar is of white colour, Doljang of green colour. Doljang is also implored by women for fecundity, and it is in allusion to this virtue that in a picture of ours a flat dish in which apples are heaped up, is drawn at their feet. The fullest Tibetan account of the legends concerning these deities is found in the Mani Kambum (see p. 84) and in a book mentioned to Adolph to be entitled, “a clear mirror of royal pedigree.” A hymn addressed to Doljang is given by Klaproth, “Reisc in den Kaukasus,” Vol. I., p. 21.'). KING THISEONG DE TSAN. ()7 princesses, and thus contrihnted to a more general know- ledge of Buddhism. Under the successors of King Srongtsan Gampo the religion did not greatly flourish, but under one of them, Thisrong de tsan, who lived in the years 728-786 a.d.^ Buddhism began to revive, owing to the useful regulations proclaimed by this king. He it was who successfully crushed an attempt made by the chiefs during his minority to suppress the new creed, and it is principally due to him that the Buddhist faith became lienceforth permanently established. He induced the learned Pandit Santa Rakshita (Tib. Zhiva tso), commonly called Bbdhisattva, to leave Bengal and settle in Tibet; and at his recommendation the great Guru Padma Sambhava (in Tibetan Padma jungne, or Urgyen) from Kafiristan (Udyana), who was famed far and wide for his extraordinary knowledge of Dharanis and their appli- cation and rites, also changed his residence to become a Tibetan subject. The Indian sages who were now induced to settle in Tibet for ever superseded the influence of the Chinese priests and the doctrines propounded by them. The latter had been the first Buddhist mission- aries in Tibet, and seem to have taught the principles of Kagarjuna with the modifications established by the Yogacharya school; for we learn from the history of Bud- dhism of the Tibetan Puton or Buston, who wrote in the fourteenth century, that in their system man is not allowed to make any notion the object of his meditation. Padma Sganang Ssetsen, 787-845. Klaproth, 778. 5* 68 BUDDHISM IM TIBKT. Sambhava and subsequent Indian , priests, however, ex- plained the law in the sense of the Madhyamika school, which in India at this period had just gained influence over the Yogacharya system ; they insisted upon assi- duity in undisturbed meditation. But King Thisrong de tsan, who did not wish two opposing doctrines to be taught, ordered a disputation to take place between the Chinese Mahayana (a name evidently symbolical of the system he defended) and the Hindu Kamalasila. Mahayana was defeated and obliged to leave Tibet, and since this period Indian priests only were called and Madhyamika doctrines taught.^ King Thisrong built the large monastery and temple of Bima at Samye, and ordered the translation of the sacred books into the Tibetan language to be carried on energetically. A later ruler of the name of Langdar, or Lang- dharma, again tried to abolish Buddhist doctrines. He commanded all temples and monasteries to be demolished, the images to be destroyed, and the sacred books to be burnt ; but so intense was the indignation excited by these acts of sacrilege, that he was murdered, in the year 900 A.D.' Langdar’s son and successor is also said to have died in his 64th year “without religion.” Bilamgur Tsan, Langhdarma’s grandson, proved, on the other hand, * See p. 54.— Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. ,3/iO; comp. pp. 324, 355. Remusat, Nouv. Journ. As. 1832, p. 44. The Bhodimor designates the two doctrines sTonniin and Tsemin; Georgi, “Alphab. Tibet,” p. 222, by Dote (from the jnDo or Sutras) and Gyute (from the Gyut or Tantras); these names imply that Tantrika principles had gradually crept into the Madhyamika systems. ^ Ssanang Ssetsen post-dates this event to the year 925. Langdharma was born, according to Csoma, in 861 ; Ssanang Ssetsen says 863 and Klaproth 901. THE LAMA TSONKHAPA. 09 favourably inclined to Buddhism; he re-built eight temples, and died after a glorious reign of eighteen years. With this period we have to connect “the second pro- jiagation of Buddhism;” it received, especially from the year 971, a powerful impetus from the joint endeavours of the returned Tibetan priests (who had fled the country under the preceding kings), and of the learned Indian priest Pandita Atisha and his pupil Bromston. Shortly before Atisha came to Tibet, 1041 a.d., the Kala Chakra doctrine, or Tantrika mysticism, was introduced into Tibet, and in the twelth and thirteenth centuries, many Indian refugees settled in the country, who greatly assisted the 'Tibetans in the translation of Sanskrit books. Three hundred years from the time of Atisha’s death bring us to the period of Tsonkhapa, the extra- ordinary reformer, who was born in the year 1355 a.d., in the district of Amdo, where is now the famous monastery of Kunbum. Tsonkhapa had imposed upon himself the difficult task of uniting and reconciling the dialectical and mystical schools which Tibetan Buddhism had brought forth, and also of eradicating the abuses gradually introduced by the priests, who had returned to the ordinary tricks and pretended miracles of charlatanism, in order to prove to the crowd their extraordinary mission. Tsonkhapa strictly prohibited such proceedings, and enforced a rigid observance of the laws binding upon the priests; he also distinguished himself by publishing most comprehensive works, in which the principles of the faith of the Buddha are explained from his particular point of view. — Traditions 70 BUDDHISM IN TIBET. report him to have had some intercourse with a stranger from the west who was remarkable for a long nose. Hue believes this stranger to have been a European mis- sionary, and connects the resemblance of the religious service in Tibet to the Roman Catholic ritual with the informations which Tsonkhapa might have received from this Roman Catholic priest. We are not yet able to decide the question as to how far Buddhism may have borrowed from Christianity; but the rites of the Bud- dhists enumerated by the French missionary can for the most part either be traced back to institutions peculiar to Buddhism, or they have sprung up in periods posterior to Tsonkhapa.^ Though all the innovations introduced by Tsonkhapa, were never universally acknowledged, yet he obtained numerous followers, whose numbers rapidly increased during the next two centuries, until they predominated in Tibet and High Asia. The rigour of his ordinances against the priests has been, however, considerably relaxed, and how widely the practice now differs from theory, we may infer from the fact, that the entrance into the clerical profession is an object of general ambition, and that a considerable part of the priestly revenues is derived from rites of an emphatically shaman character, performed at the request of the lay population to drive oft the evil spirits. ' Csoma, Jourii. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VII., p. 145. Hue, “Christianity in China, Tartary and Thibet,’' Vol. II., p. 10. Wassiljew, “Notices sur les ouvrages eu laiigue de I’Asie orientale,” &c., Bull, hist.-phil. de St. Pet.. Vol. XIII., pp. 233, 242. Koppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” Vol. II., j). 117. About the miracles executed by Buddhist priests itrevious to Tsonkhapa, sec Marsden “The travels of Marco Polo,” p. IGO. BUDDHISM IN (HINA, LADAK, AND SIKKIM. 71 With reference to the introduction of Buddhisni into China Proper, 1 will only add, that as early as the year 217 B.c. an Indian missionary is said to have preached in that country, but the Emperor sent him away, and Buddhism in China did not become fully established till the year 65 a.d., when it was received with universal pleasure. * According to Cunningham,^ Buddhism was introduced into Laddk about the year 240 b.c., but its final domesti- cation in the country, seems not to have been anterior to the first century before the Christian era. The histo- rical books concerning the early history of Ladak are said to have been destroyed about at the end of the sixteenth century by the fanatic Mussalrnans of Skardo who invaded the country, burned the monasteries, tem- ples, and religious monuments, and threw the contents of the various libraries into the river Indus. But the reign of the Mussulmans was of but short duration, and the Buddhists have not been oppressed since this period. In the Eastern Himalaya, in Bhutan and Sikkim, the conversion of the inhabitants to Buddhism was effected at a comparatively modern date, namely about the sixteenth century of the Christian era.^ The cir- * Lassen, “Indische Alterthumskunde,” Vol. II., p. 1078, Vol. IV., p. 741. W. Schott, “Ueber den Buddhaismus in Hochasien,” p. 18. About the fate of Buddhism in China see “Nouveau Journal Asiatique,” 1856, pp. 106, 137, 1.39. C. Giitzlaff, R. As. Soc., Vol. XVI., p. 73. - Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 317. When at Leh, my brothers came into possession of several large historical books. A particular value was laid upon two books entitled Gyelrap salvai melong “a true mirror of the Gyelrap,” or the genealogy of the Rajas of Ladak, which were obtained from Chigmet Choiki Senge, a descendant of the former Rajas. ’ Hooker, “Himalayan Journals,” Vol. 1., p. 127. Kbppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” Vol. II., j). .360. 72 BUDDHISM IN TIBET. cumstances attending the introduction of the new re- ligion are well known to the lamas of these countries, who are still in possession of many historical books treating of this interesting subject. Of works of this class we have, in our own private library, a manuscript account of “ The first arrival of the Lamas in Sikkim,” in twelve leaves, written witli small characters; besides a printed, “History of the Erection of Colleges,” consisting of no less than three hundred and seventy-five leaves. Both of these books were originally contained in the library of Pemiongchi, and were obtained in Sikkim by my brother Hermann. Buddhist sects in Tibet. Sects did not exist in Tibet previous to the eleventh century; nine are still existing and are con- sidered orthodox, we know, however, but few details about them. The sect founded by Tsonkhapa and its later subdivisions have chosen the yellow colour for their dress; the others wear in preference a red garb. The sects are;‘ 1. The Nyigmapa sect is the most ancient, to which the Lamas of Bhutan, Gnari Khorsum and Ladak belong. This sect adheres strictly to the ancient rites and ceremonies in the manner probably taught by the earliest Chinese priests, and possesses some pe- ’ Sec Csoina’s Chronological table, Note 18 in his “Grammar,’ p. 19 < ; Colloquial phrases, ibid. p. 175; Notices, Journ. As. Soc. Bengal., Vol. VII., p. 146; Cunningham, “Ladak,” pp. 367-72; Koppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” Index. THE DIEFEKENT SECTS. 73 culiar symbolical works which have not been embodied in the large compilations of the Kanjur and Tanjur works. 2. The Urgijenpa sect (disciples of Urgyen, or Padina Sambhava) is also one of the most ancient, and has its adherents especially in those parts of Tibet which border on Xepal and the Himalayan provinces of India; but the principal monastery of this sect is at Samye, in Eastern Tibet. The Urgyenpas differ from the Nyigmapas in the worship of the incarnation of Amitabha as Padma Sambhava. 3. The Kadampa sect, founded by Bromston (born in the }'ear 1002 a.d.), limits itself to the observance of the “precepts” (6ka’), and does not care for the acquire- ment of the higher branches of transcendental wisdom. The followers of this sect wear red dresses. 4. Respecting the sect SaJ^yapa^ nothing is known, except that its followers wear a red costume. 5. The Geliikpa, or Galdanpa and Geldanpa sect, a name derived from its principal monastery, called Galdan, at Lhassa, which had been erected by Tsonkhapa: this sect adheres to his doctrines and institutions. Its members wear a yellow costume, and are now the most numerous sect in Tibet. 6. The adherents of the Kargyutpa sect, “the be- lievers in the succession of precepts,” are satisfied with the observance of the Ho (Sutras or aphorisms), and do not care either for the attainment of the esoteric doc- trines of the Prajna Paramita, or for the transcendental wisdom. 74 BUDDHISM IN TIBET. 7. The Karmapa sect, “the believers in the efficacy of works,” seems to be nearly identical with the Kar- mika sect of Nepal. ^ 8. The Brikimgpa sect derives its name from the monastery Brikung in Eastern Tibet. This sect, as well as the two preceding ones (the Kargyiitpa and Karmapa), are offshoots of the Gelnkpa sect, and also adhere to their rule of dressing in yellow. 9. The Brugpa (also Dugpa or Dad Dugpa) sect has established a particular worship of the Dorje (Vajra, or thunderbolt), which descended from heaven and fell upon the earth at Sera in Eastern Tibet. This sect seems, moreover, to be particularly addicted to the Tantrika mysticism, in which the Dorje is considered as a very important and powerful instrument. To these nine sects must be still added the Bon religion, which has many followers called Bonpas, and numerous and wealthy monasteries in Eastern Tibet. As yet little is known about the Bon religion. Judging from the way in which Tibetan books speak of the followers of this sect, it is probable that the name Bonpa was restricted to those who neglected to embrace Buddhism upon its first introduction. By degrees they have, however, adopted Buddhist principles, still rigorously preserving as far as we are able to infer from the meagre infonnation hitherto known about them, the ancient superstitious ideas and rites of the primitive inhabitants of Tibet. This o})inion is also that of Csoma, and is ' About these see Ilodgsoii, “Illustrations,” pii. 82, 112. THE DIFFERENT SECTS. 75 later supported by Hodgson, who has recently published several engravings of their deities; it is further corro- borated by the important fact, that to the exorcists of some of the rudei’ Himalayan tribes, as the Murmis and Sunvars, the name of “13onpa” is applied even to the present day.‘ ' The Bodhimor in Ssanang Ssetsen’s history, pp. 351, 367. Csonin, “Geographical Notice of Tibet,” in “Journ. As. Soc, Beng.,” Vol. 1., p. 124; “Dictionary of the Tibetan language,” p. 94. B. H. Hodgson, “Notice on Buddhist symbols,” in Royal As. Soc., Vol. XVIII., p. 396. The identity of these Bonpa images with those met with in the temples of the orthodox Buddhists (the only difference existing in the name) is a further corroboration of the close alliance (already examined p. 48) of the Buddhist faith with pagan rituals and ideals. CHAPTER Vm. THE SACRED LITERATURE. Works translated from Sanskrit, and Works written in Tibetan. — The two Co.mpilations Kanjur and Tanjur.— Tibetan Literature in JIdrope. — Analysis of the Mani Kambum. — Names and Representations OF Padmapani. The earlier religious books published in Tibetan are simply translations from the Sanskrit, undertaken by Indian priests, Tibetan translators (Lotsavas), and also Chinese. The work of translation was carried on with remarkable zeal and energy ; for the sake of uniformity a vocabulary of the Sanskrit proper names, and of the technical and philosophical terms occurring in the original texts, Avas prepared, and the latter was ordered to be adhered to. ^ But it is to be regretted that the trans- 1 The first steps of this undertaking date perhaps from the times of Srongtsan Gampo and Thumi Sambhota. This vocabulary still exists in three editions, varying according to the greater or smaller number of terms con- tained in them; that of middle size was composed in the time of Ralpachen, or Khiral, who ruled in the ninth century: it is comprised in the Tanjur. AVilson, “Note on the literature of Tibet.” Gleanings in science, Vol. III., p. 247. Compare also Hodgson, As. Res., A"ol. XAH., p. 434.— For many books the names of the translators have been preserved to us. TKANSLATIONS FROM SANSKRIT. 77 lators, instead of supplying ns with correct versions, have interwoven them witli their own commentaries, for the purpose of justifying the dogmas of their several schools. To these alterations of the genuine text is chiefly owing the obscurity that has so long shrouded the subject and prevented a clear understanding of the principles of the original Buddhism and its subsequent divisions. Simultaneously with the formation of a Tibetan alpha- bet, books were also written in the native tongue. The Mani Kambum, which is an historical work attributed to Srongtsan Gampo, is the production of a Tibetan ; and, besides this, the “Grammatical Introduction,” and the “Characteristic Letters” of Thumi Sambhota, as well as the historical works on Tibet written by the ancient Tibetan translators, appear to have been composed in the vernacular tongue.^ Brom the fourteenth century, beginning with Tsonkhapa, native literature developed itself on a large scale. Tsonkhapa himself published systematic works of a most voluminous character; his principal works are the Bodhi-mur, the Tarnim-mur, the Altanerike, and the Lamrim “a degree to advance,” a title which has also been employed by other writers. Many learned Tibetans also used the vernacular in composing their numerous commentaries on Buddhist dogmas and history; and in writing in Tibetan they were followed even by the Mongolians, who were obliged to learn Tibetan because it formed (then, as now) the sacred language of divine service. ' Also Csoma, in his paper on historical and grammatical works in Tibet, does not mention Sanskrit titles for these books, as he otherwise usuallj^ does when treating of works translated from Sanskrit. 78 THE SACKED LITERATUKE. All the Sanskrit translations were again collected, in the form of compilations, in two large and voluminous works, which contain irrespectively the sacred and the profane publications of different periods. These compi- lations bear the titles of Kanjur, “ translation of the com- mandments (of the Buddha),” and Tanjur, “translation of the doctrine.” The Kanjur consists of one hundred and eight large volumes, which are classed under the following seven principal divisions: — 1. Dulva, or “disciphne.” 2. Sherchin, or “transcendental wisdom.” 3. Palchen, or “association of Buddhas.” 4. Kontseg, or “jewel peak.” 5. Do, Sutras, or “aphorims.” 6. Myangdas, treating on the doctrine of “deliverance from emancipation from existence.” 7. Gyut, “Tantra,” treating on mysticism. Each of these divisions is composed of a greater or smaller number of treatises. The Kanjur is reputed to contain the “word of the Buddha,” its principal contents being the moral and religious doctrines originally taught by Sakyamuni and his disciples. The Tanjur comprises 225 volumes, which are divided into two great classes: Gyut and Do. Its content is of a more miscellaneous char- acter; there are also treatises on the different philo- sophical schools, besides various works on logic, rhetoric, and Sanskrit grammar. In several volumes the subject is the same as in the Kanjur. 'The principal works in these collections were trans- lated about in the ninth century, and other articles, THE KANJUR AND TANJUK. 79 especially those in the G^nit division, even mnch later. For instance, the Kfila Chakra, or Dus kyi khorlo, which is contained in the latter, was not introduced into Tibet previous to the eleventh century; also the trans- lation of the Do class of the Tanjur occupied no doubt a longer period on account of the greater variety of its contents. Although it still remains impossible to determine exactly the time when these two collections were first compiled yet it is very likely, that the present arrangement of the volumes is not previous to the beginning of the last century; similar compilations may have existed in earlier times, but it is not very probable that they were exactly the same. We owe an abstract of the contents of the Kanjur and Tanjur to Csoma de Koros, whose analysis has been abridged by Wilson. An Index to the Kanjur was edited by the Imperial Kussian Academy of St. Petersburg!! in the year 1845, with a preface by I. J. Schmidt; a memoir by Schiefner treats of the logical and grammatical works embodied in the Tanjur. ^ These collections were printed by order of Mivang, regent of Lhassa, in the years 1728-46; the first edition being prepared at Narthang, a town near Tashilhunpo, still celebrated for its typographical productions. At the present day they are printed in many of the monasteries ; * See about these collections H. H. Wilson, “Note on the literature of Tibet; ” Gleanings in science, Vol. III., p. 243. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. I. Csoma, “Analysis,” As. Res., Vol. XX. A. Schiefner, Bull. hist. phil. de St. Pet., Vol. IV., No. 18. Wassiljew, “Notices sur les ouvrages en langue de I’Asie orientale.” Bullet. Vol. XIII. Nos. 13. 14. 80 THE SACKED LITEEATUKE. but tlie paper as well as the impressions of those copies at least which are sold at Pekin, are for the greater part so bad, and the text is so full of errors, that al- together they are scarcely legible. For printing Tibetan only capital letters (Tib. Vuchan) are used, as far as I know; for manuscripts small letters (Yumed) are frequently employed, which, for the requirements of running-hand, are often somewhat modified. When Indian letters are employed for Sanskrit sentences, the Panja alphabet, called by the Tibetans Lantsa, is used in which also most of the ancient Sanskrit works discovered in Nepal are written; this Kanja, or Lantsa, alphabet is a variety of the Devanagari alphabet, and is particularly em- ployed for writing the mystical Sanskrit sentences, the Dha- ranls, which must be written without any alteration in order to the preservation of their efficacy ; and though the Tibetan letters have been adapted to their exact transhteration, yet we see the Eanja alphabet preferred in many instances. ‘ Tibetan books are spread all over Central Asia, owing to the great reputation enjoyed by everything that has its origin in Tibet, the chosen land of Padma- pani. The art of printing, long-known to the Tibetans, and for which they employ engraved wooden blocks, must also have greatly favoured their dissemination. There is no Buddhist monastery which does not contain a series of works in the Tibetan language, and the sums which the Buriats and Kalmuks occasionally pay for the most ’ Compare: Hodgson, “Illustrations,’’ p. 171; Schmidt, Mem. de I’Acad. des Sciences, Tom. I., p. 41. — Concerning the Tibetan mode of printing, and the technical terms for printing, printers’ ink, (See., see Hodgson, As. Res.. Vol. XVI., p. 421; Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 393. TIBETAN LITERATURE IN EUROPE. 81 sacred of them, as e. g. the Kanjiir and Tanjiir, have amounted in some cases to nearly j62,000. A great many Tibetan books, as well original as trans- lations from the Sanskrit, have reached Europe and Cal- cutta through the zealous exertions of Csoma, Schilling von Canustadt, Hodgson, some English gentlemen resid- ing at the Hill Stations, and the members of the Russian embassy at Pekin. The library and the museum of the India Office, so richly supplied in every branch of scien- tific and practical objects referring to oriental life, pos- sesses also a great number of important Tibetan works, of which, however, till now no catalogue has been pubhshed. The whole of the Kanjur and Tanjur are to be found there. Another copy of the two collections exist in the library of St. Petersburg!!, which has, besides, obtained the greatest number of important works on Buddhism written in Tibetan, Mongolian and Chinese. The Imp. library at Paris has the Kanjur only. The Asiatic Society of Bengal has likewise a complete copy of the Kanjur; its copy of the Tanjur is incomplete, or at least was so in 1831. An index of the Tibetan books in the Asiatic Museum of the Imperial Academy at St. Peters- burgh, including the works it contained up to the year 1847, was published by I. J. Schmidt and O. Boehtlingk; an appendix by Schiefner registers also the later works sent from Pekin. ^ A new and detailed catalogue is now in progress of publication, and will, no doubt, furnish * Bulletin hist. -phil. de St. Petersb., Vol. IV.; IX. — Concerning the astonishing number of important works so liberally presented by B. II. Hodgson to London and Paris, see Wilson, “Buddha and Buddhism.” R. As. Soc., Vol. XVI., p. 234. d 82 THE SACKED LITEEATUEE. inaiiy interesting facts connected with Buddhism, and greatly enlarge our knowledge of Tibetan literature in general. Of the Tibetan books contained in the library of the Asiatic Society of Bengal Csoma de Kords had begun to compile a detailed catalogue, when the under- taking was stopjied by his death, and has not, I believe, been continued. The Tibetan langnatje has become known in Europe only of late years, the claims to a detailed and scientific acquaintance put forward by Fourmont, Muller, and Georgi being very exaggerated. The first inquirer who placed the Tibetan language within the reach of Euro- pean students, was Csoma de Koros, a zealous and indefatigable Hungarian from Transylvania, who had made it the principal object of his long and laborious researches to discover the original seats of the Hungarians (in German Himen), whose native land he expected to find in Asia. Having failed in his attempts in Western Asia, he retired, in 1827, for some months to the monasteries of Zankhar, where he devoted himself to the study of Tibetan literature, and succeeded in nearly com- pleting — though he had to undergo many hardships — a dictionary and grammar of the Tibetan language, which were published fin English) at Calcutta in the year 1832.^ Eater, in 1839 and 1841, L fh Schmidt published another * See some interesting remarks on his opinions, and an account of his death in the Jonrn. of the As. Soc. of Bengal, Vol. XL, p. 303; Vol. XIV., p. .323, by Dr. Campbell. — There are two tribes in the mountains who have preserved the designation of “Huns;” the one residing in Gnari Khorsum, who call themselves “llunia;” the other being the Limbu in Nepal and Sikkim, a large division of whom goes by the name of the “Hungs.” Comp. Campbell, Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IX., p. 599. TIBETAN LITERATURE IK EUROPE. 83 'ribotaii grammar and dictionary in German, which is like- wise based n])on original works and Tibetan -Mongolian- Manjn dictionaries. The contents of Schmidt’s dictionary exceed that of Csoma by about 5,000 words and terms. Further notices on Tibetan grammar have been published by Schiefner in the Bulletins of the St. Petersburgh Academy, and more recently by Foucanx in his Grammaire TibHaine. In theyear 1845 Schmidt published the translation of the large Tibetan treatise I)sang-hm, “the wise and the unwise,” tog-ether with the original text.' Foucaux next followed with a translation of the Eyya chher rol pa. In addition to these publications I must still allude to the numerous important translations by Schiefner and Wassiljew. In connexion with my inquiries about a picture of the goddess Doljang (see p. 66), I also obtained from the Buriat Lama Gombojew an abstract of the Mani Kambum, an ancient historical work the authorship of which is attributed to king Srongtsan Gampo. Schmidt had already drawn attention to the great reputation of this work among the Buddhists of High Asia; he was not, however, so fortunate (in 1829) as to procure for himself the Mani Kambum, which has but recently reached St. Petersburgh. As at present we have nothing but an abstract of the first chapter, by Jahring, the interpreter of Pallas, 1 give here Gombojew’s cursory note on the general contents of this important work, which, short though it is, will at least furnish an idea concerning one of the most ancient historical books of Tibetan literature. ‘ Additions and emendations to Schmidt’s edition were published by Schiefner in 1852. 84 thj: sacked litekature. Analysis of the book Mani Kambnm. The book Mani Kambnm (a name also softened into jNlani Gambum), or literally Mani 6ka’ ’bum, “a hundred thousand precious commandments,” contains in twelve chapters a most detailed account of the numerous legend- ary tales respecting Padmapani’s merits as the propa- gator of Buddhism in Tibet, and a statement of the origin and application of the sacred formula, “ Om mani padme hum.” Some liistorical events are further added with reference to Srongtsan Gampo (who lived from 617 to 698 A.D.) and liis wives, as also a general explanation of the leading doctrines of Buddhism. Chapter I. begins with a description of the wonderful region Sukhavatl (Tib. Devachan),^ where Amitabha (Tib. Odpagmed) sits enthroned, and wherein those are received, who have merited the most perfect blissfulness of existence. Once upon a time Amitabha, after giving himself up to earnest meditation, caused a red^ ray of light to issue from his right eye, which brought Padmapani Bodhisattva into existence ; while from his left eye burst forth a blue ray of light, which becoming incarnate in the virgins Dolma (in Sanskrit Tara, the two wives of king Srongtsan), had power to enlighten the minds of living beings. Amitabha then blessed Padmapani Bodhisattva by laying his hands upon him, when, by virtue of this benediction, he brought forth the prayer “Om mani padme hum.” Padmapani moreover made a solemn vow to rescue all * See the following Chapter. * In Pallas' translation, p. 39G, this ray is of a white colour. ANALYSIS OF THE MANI KAMBUM. 85 living beings from existence, and to deliver all the wretched souls in hell from their pains; and, in token of his sincerity, he added the wish, that his head shovdd split into a thousand pieces, did he not succeed. To fulfil his vow, he gave himself up to earnest meditation, and after remaining absorbed in contemplation for some time, he proceeded, full of wisdom, to look into the various divisions of hell, expecting that its former in- habitants had ascended by virtue of his meditations to the higher classes of beings which indeed had taken place. But who can describe his amazement on seeing the compartments of hell again as full as ever, the places of the outgoing tenants being supplied by an equal number of new-comers. This sight, so dreadful and overpower- ing, proved too much for the unfortunate Bbdhisattva, who considered the cause of this apparent failure to lie in the weakness of his meditations. His head instantly split into a thousand pieces, he fainted, and fell heavily to the ground. Amitabha, deeply moved by the pains of his unfortunate son, hastened to his assistance. He formed the thousand pieces into ten heads, and assured him, for his consolation, as soon as he had recovered his senses, that the time had not yet arrived to deliver all beings, but that his wish should yet be accomplished. From this moment Padmapani redoubled his praisewor- thy exertions. ‘ * This legend is somewhat differently given in the Mongolian work Norn Gharchoi Todorchoi Tolli, translated by Schmidt, “Forschungen,” pp. 202— 20G. Padmapani had vowed not to return to Sukhavati until all beings, and the Tibetans in particular, should be brought through him to 86 THE SACEED LITEKATCEE. Then succeeds a history of the creation of the uni- verse and of the animal beings; the twelve acts, the Dzadpa chugnj/i, of Sakyamuni are enumerated,^ and an account of the erection of the palace on the top of the mountain Potala is given, followed by a sketch of the propagation of Buddhism from its beginning till the death of Srongtsan Gampo. Chapter II. gives instructions concerning the prayers to be addressed to Padmapani, and enumerates the im- mense advantages offered by the frequent perusal, and recital of the prayer “Om mani padme hum.” A discourse on “voidness” forms the conclusion. Chapter III. gives the meaning of the prayer “Om mani padme hum.” Kemarks are also made upon the different representations of Padmapani; it is also ex- plained wliy he is sometimes rejmesented with three faces and eight hands, again with eighteen faces and salvation ; but when he saw that but the hundredth part of the Tibetans had entered the paths of salvation, the longing to return to Sukhavati, came upon him; and it was in consequence of this desire that his head clove into ten pieces (not into a thousand pieces as the Mani Kambum has it) and his body was divided into a thousand pieces; Amitabha afterwards repaired the corporeal damages. ' The Tibetan biographies of Sakyamuni are divided into tw’elve chapters, taken from his twelve acts, which are as follows : “ 1. He descended from among the Gods; 2. he entered into the womb; 3. he was born; 4. he displayed all kinds of arts; 5. he was married, or enjoyed the pleasures of the conjugal state; 6. he left his house and took the religious character; 7. he performed penances; 8. he overcame the devil, or god of pleasures; 9. he arrived at supreme perfection, or became Buddha; 10. he turned the wheel of the law, or published his doctrine; 11. he was delivered from pain, or died; 12. his remains were deposited (in a Chorten).” Csoma, “Notices on the life of Shakya.” A. R. Vol. XX., p. 285. Compare also Schmidt, “Ssanang Ssetsen,” p. 312. Schiefner, “Tib. Lcbcnsbeschreibung Sakyamuni’s.” Memoires des sav. etrang., Vol. VI., p. 232. ANALYSIS OF THE 3MAN1 KAMBUM. 87 eight hands, and occasionally even with 1,000 laces and as many hands and feet. Next is related the manner in which Srongtsan Gampo became acquainted with the tenets of Buddhism ; in conclusion, some particular facts are given respecting the general propagation of Buddhism in Tibet and the mission of Thumi Sambhota to India. Chapters IV. to VIII. are full of information respect- ing the qualities of Samsara, and the ethics and religious ordinances of Buddhism. The illiterate state of the Ti- betans is lamented; and then follows a short biography of Padmapani Bodhisattva during his existence as King Srongtsan Gampo. A discourse is reported, in which this King enun- ciates, in reply to a question respecting the faculties of the mind, that happiness and salvation depend upon a man’s own energy and conduct, and if one wish to break the fetters of Samsara he can effect this by reciting the prayer “Om mani padme hum,” the power of which is irresistible. Srongtsan takes upon himself to interpret this prayer: he teaches it to his parents and waves, and explains the duties to be observed by those who believe in the truth of the doctrines revealed by the Buddha. These explanations are calculated for practical use,' and relate to such topics as ignorance, sins, virtues, and their influence. Chapters IX. and X. recount the legends wdiich are intimately connected with Buddhist doctrines. Chapter XI. treats of the end of Srongtsan’s life. • Concerning the number of prescriptions to be observed and dogmas to be believed in by the lower classes see p. 103—7. 88 THE SACRED LITERATURE. Chapter XII. speaks of the translation of the iSanskrit books into Tibetan, as also of Thumi Sambhota’s mission to India, and of the alphabet he had formed from the Devanagari. The Mani Kambum has been translated into Mon- golian and into Dsungarian. The latter version was executed, at the command of Dalai Khan, in the seven- teenth century, by a Dsungarian Lama who had resided for several years in Lhassa, and was distinguished, on account of his translation, by the honourable title of Pandit. The Dhyani Bodhisattva Padmapani, or Avalokites- vara, who is the subject of this work, is, of all the gods, the one most frequently implored, on account of his being the representative of Sakyamuni and the guardian, and propagator of his faith until the appearance of the future Buddha Maitreya, as well as on account of his particular protection of Tibet. In order to show the Tibetans the path to ulti- mate happiness, he has been pleased, they say, to manifest himself, from age to age, in human shape. They believe that his descent and incarnation in the Dalai Lama takes place by the emission of a beam of light, and that he shall be finally born as most ]ierfect Buddha in Tibet, instead of in India, where his predecessors had appeared. Padmapani has in the sacred books a great many names, and' is represented under various figures. Most frequentl}' he is addressed by the name of Chen- NAMES AND KEI’EESENTATIONS OF I’ADMAPANI. 89 resi, or more fully Chenresi vanchug', “the powerful, looking with the eyes,” in Sanskrit Avalokitesvara. To this name, as well as to that of Phagpa Chenresi, in Sanskrit Aryavalokita, or Chugchig zhal, “eleven- faced,” correspond the representations of him with eleven faces and eio;ht hands. The eleven faces form a pyramid, and are ranged in four rows. Each series of heads has a particular complexion; the tlmee faces which base upon the neck are white, the three following yellow, the next three red, the tenth is blue and the eleventh {the face of Amitabha) is red. Such is the arrangement in all the Tibetan and Mongolian images I had occasion to examine; but in the Japanese images presented in the Mppon Pantheon the eleven faces are much smaller, and are arranged similar to a crown; its centre is formed by two entire figures: the lower one is sitting, the other is standing above it; and ten smaller heads are combined with these two figures in a kind of radial arrangment; six are resting immediately on the forehead, the four other, form the second row above them. Like Chagtong Kliorlo, “the thousand-handed circle,” or as Thugje chenpo chugchig zhal, “the great pitier with eleven fac&s,” he has likewise eleven faces, but the number of his hands amounts to a thousand. As Chag zhipa, “four — armed,” he is represented with one head and four arms; two are folded, the third holds a lotus-flower, the fourth a rosary or a snare. As Chakna padma karpo (in Sanskrit Padmapilni), “holding in the hand a white lotus,” he has two arms, one of which supports 90 THE SACKED LITERATURE. a lotus. He is called Cliantong, “with a thousand eyes,” on account of having “the eye of wisdom” upon each palm of his thousand hands. The name Jigten Gonpo (in iSanskrit Lokapati, or Lokanatha), “lord of the world, protector, saviour,” is an allusion to his causing deliverance from sins and protecting against all kinds of evil. CHAPTER IX. VIEWS ON METEMPSYCHOSIS. Re-births. — Means of Deliverance from Re-birth. — Sokhavatl the Abode OF THE Blessed. He- births. Whek treating the developement of Buddhism, 1 had repeated occasion to allude to metempsychosis, or the migration of the souls of animated beings, as one of the established laws of Buddhism, according to which maiTs soul migrates as long as the causes of re-birth have not been taken away from it. The forms under which any living being may be re-born, are sixfold: — ■ 1. The highest class are the Lha, “spirits, highest beings, gods,” Sanskr. Deva; they rank next to the Buddhas, and inhabit the six celestial regions (Sanskr. Devalokas). Two of these regions belong to the earth ; but the four others, which are considered as superior mansions, lie in the atmos]ihere, far beyond the earth. 92 YIEWS OX METEMPSYCHOSIS. 2. The second class is formed by men, called Mi. 3 . The third class are the Lhamayin, “the evil spirits” literally, not a god (in Sanskrit Asuras). They are the adversaries of the Devas, and the most powerful of the evil spirits; they dwell in the regions below the mountain Meru (Tib. Lhungpo). 4. The fourth class are the brutes (beasts), Dudo, or Jolsong. 5. The fifth class is formed by the Yidags, imaginary monsters representing the state of a wretched being (Sanskrit Preta). They do not receive food or water, though greatly in want of both. Ac- cordingly they ever remain in a state of extreme hunger and thirst; their mouth has the size of a needle’s eye, but their bodies are twelve miles in height. 6. The sixth and lowest class of beings is composed of the wretched iidiabitants of the hell, Myalba (Sanskrit Naraka), a place of dreadful punishment for the wicked, who are tormented there most cruelly. Of the six classes, those of gods and men are styled the good grades, the four others being called the bad conditions. ^ ' Respecting these six orders of sentient existence see Burnouf, “Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 300; Pallas “Mongol. Volkerschaften,” Vol. II., p. 95; Schmidt, “Leber die dritte Welt der Buddhisten,” Mem. de I’Acad. des sciences, Vol. II., pp. 21-39. The Mongolian authorities place the Lhamayin before man, degrading the latter to the third class; but the works consulted by Burnouf, Remusat, Hardy, &c., classify them in the order given in our text. In many sacred books, however, only five classes are enumerated, the Singhalese, for instance, omitting the class of Asuras. Hardy’s Manual, KE-15TRTTIS. 93 The class in ^vllich any animated being’ is to be re- born depends upon the actions, or works, “Las,” which he has performed, either in the present life, or in a previous existence ; they are the destiny (in Tibetan Kalba) of the Buddhists, good works involving re-birth in one of the superior classes, evil conduct in the bad states of existence. The valuation of the works, viz. the deter- mination of the moment in which the present existence has to end, and of the class in which man has to be reborn, is the particular business of Shinje, “the Lord of the dead,” also called Choigyal (in Sanskrit Dharma raja), “the king of the law.” Shinje possesses a wonder- ful mirror, which shows him all the good and bad actions of men; with a balance he weighs both the good and he bad, and, if in this manner he finds that the present existence of an individual has to cease, he orders one of ’ his servants, who are also styled Shinjes, to seize the soul and bring it before him, in order that its future may be announced. It not unfrequently happens, that the messenger seizes a wrong soul by mistake, or in some instances by design, being bought off by offerings. The Lord of death, after revealing by his mirror that the soul brought before him is the wrong one, then dismisses it, and'threatens his servant with severe punish- ment in the event of the mistake proving an intentional one. At the same time, he orders another servant, to bring him the right soul, which, pending the discovery, p. 37; Burnouf, p. 377. For the description and divisions of hell see Foe koue ki, Engl. Transl., p. 133; Hardy’s Manual, pp. 2, 27; Pallas, Vol. II., p. .’)3. 94 VIEWS OK METEMPSYCHOSIS. lias remained nndisturlied in the body. Hence it appears that the life of a being can be lenghtened by propitiating the servant of the Lord of death.‘ Means of deliverance from re-birth. Re-birth is to be regarded in the light of an ex- ])iation of sins. The pains to be endured through being subjected to migration are, however, considered so terrible, that the Buddhist faith has offered its vo- taries the means of atoning, even during their lifetime, for a portion at least of the evil they have committed. Emancipation may be obtained by subduing evil desires, by the assiduous practise of virtues, of Dharanis, and Tantras, and by confession. Already in the early history of Buddhism we find confession of sins enjoined by authority. Thus the novices had to perform this rite before they were received into the congregation of the faithful; the predominant character of jmblic worship, also, when performed according to the prescriptions of the book Pratimoksha, is decidedly that of a solemn con- fession (Poshadha) before the assembly of priests. This renewal of priestly vows was, in fact, the original purport ’ Shinje answers to the god Yama of the Hindus, about whom compare Coleman, “Mythology of the Hindus,” p. 112. The Mongolians call him Erlik Khan, or Yamantaka; Pallas, “Mongol. Volker.” Vol. 11., pp. 95, 61. “Voyages,” Vol. I., p. .553. Pallas was told that the good and bad actions are recorded by two spirits, the one favourable, the other ill-natured. These, by order of Shinje, bring the soul before him and mark the number of its good and bad actions by white and black pebbles, a proceeding which Shinje controls by the book Bealtan Tooli, in which the deeds of every individual are registered. CONFESSION'. 95 of confession; the dogma that it confers entire absolution from sins (“from the root, tsava nas”) was established by the Mahay ana schools. ‘ Up to the present day this is also the character of confession amongst the Tibetan Buddhists, who consider it of the greatest influence for a happy metempsychosis and the attainment of Nirvana. The confession (in Ti- betan Sobyong) always includes an open repentence of the sins and the promise to commit no more. Also the solicitation of the gods is indispensable, but various are the modes which may accompany the avowal and the prayers addressed to the deities for abolishment of one's sins. As the most easy may be named the use of the water which has been consecrated by the Lamas in the divine ceremony Tuisol, “entreaties for ablution ; ” but also the abstinence from food and the tiresome reciting of prayers may be combined with it, a kind of confession which bears the name of Nyungne, “to con- tinue abstinence.”^ Such painful modes of getting rid of sins are, however, not greatly in favour, and the less as a simple address to the gods is considered to be almost equally efficacious. The gods who have the faculty of delivering from sins, are for the greater part imaginar}" Buddhas ‘ See Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 299. Csoma, “Analysis,” As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 58. Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” pp. 92, 100, 291. Prati- moksha is a Manual containing the laws of the Buddhist priesthood. A translation by the Rev. Gogerly appeared in the “Ceylon Friend,” 1839; an analysis is to be found in Csoma, 1. c., with whom compare Burnoufs “ Introduction,” p. 300. Hardy gives numerous extracts from its precepts. - ’Khrus, “to be thoroughly washed;” gso\, “prayer, entreaty;” snung, “to reduce (in food);” g^nas, “to continue.” For details I refer to Chapter XV. 90 VIKWS OX METEJIPSYI'HOSIS. who are considered to have preceded Sakyamnni; others are the holy spirits equal in power to the Buddhas, such as the Herukas. Samvaras, &c. From all these deities thirty-five Buddhas are considered the most effectual in taking away sins, and to them accordingly the prayers of the contrite are most frequently addressed. These Buddhas are styled Tiingshakchi sangye songad “the thirty-five Buddhas of confession.’’ Already in the two highly esteemed Mahayana compilations, the Eatnaktita and Mahasamaya, the adoration of these Buddhas is strongly recommended;^ and beautiful colom’ed images of them adorn the interior of numerous monasteries, where they take their places by the side of the most celebrated Indian and Tibetan priests and gods. Prayers to these Buddhas are also included in almost every Ti- betan liturgy, or compilation of the daily prayers, such as the Eabsal, “principal clearness,” and Zundui. “collection of charms.” The number of the Buddhas implored has not been, however, limited to thirty-five ; in one of these petitionary addresses, the translation of which is the object of Chapter XI, I found their number to be fifty-one; also to the Buriats Tibetan treatises of this kind are known in which more than the original number of thirty-five Buddhas occurs. One of these Buddhas is also tSakyamuui; he is called in the address just mentioned by his Tibetan name, Shakya Thub-pa, and is the twenty-seventh of the list; it * itung-feshags, “confession of sins;” kyi (chi) = the genitive case; so-?nga “thirty-five.” - Wassiljew, “Der Butldhisinus,” pp. 170, ISG. THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. 97 is said that “if a man once utter this name he shall bo purified from all sins committed in anterior existences.” In sacred images representing the Buddhas of confession his figure is regularly the central and the most prominent one, the other thirty-four Buddhas being smaller and ranged above his head. In a picture which had been hung up in the temple of Gyungul, in Gnari Khorsum, the images of various sacred persons are added to these; thirty-five Buddhas. Amongst the additional figures the persons in the clerical garb of the ancient Indian priests are the sixteen Netan (Sanskrit Staviras), who are said in the sacred books to have visited Ceylon, Kashmir, and the southern foot of the Kailasa or Trans Satlej range already shortly after the first convocation of the Bikshus, held immediately after Sakyamuni’s death, and to have spread in these countries Buddhist theories.^ Six other priests in Tibetan lamaic dress have each some words vTitten beneath them, xiz. Je Tsonkhapa; Prulku thongva dondon; Khetup sangye; Jampaijang lhai thama shesrab od; Khetub chakdor gyatso; Grubchen tsulkhrim gyatso. Tsonkhapa, the famous Lama, who was born 1355 a.d., is honoured, by the title of reverence, rje; Thongva dondon (prulku, the word preceding his name, means incarnation) was born in 1414; Khetup sangye is pro- bably the Khetup pal-gyi senge of Csoina (born 1535); * See their Tibetan names in A. Schiefner’s “ Tibetanische Lebensbe- schreibung Sakyamuni’s,” Note 43. Csoma, As. Res , Yol. XX., p. 439, has for several of them other names. The Xetans enjoy great reputation amongst the Tibetans, who have recited on various occasions a hymn in their honour, entitled Netan chudrugi todpa “praise of the sixteen Netan.” The library of the St. Petersburgh university has a copy of it. 98 VIEWS ON jVIETEJI PSYCHOSIS. Tsiilklirim gyatso (grubchen— very perfect) is probably the tenth Dalai Lama, who ruled from 1817 — 35;* concerning the other two Lamas I know no particulars. An additional figure in Chinese dress has the words Genyen darma written at his feet; Gen}’en (Sanskrit Upasaka) denotes him to be an adherent to the Buddhist I'aith, Darma is most probably his proper name. He carries a basket filled with the sheets of a religious book, pro- bably the Prajna Paramita; this very ancient mode of using a basket-case for the palm-leaves, which in former times served as paper, is said to be actually still in use in Tibet, the single volumes of larger works being put together into a common basket. Beneath the throne is represented the goddess Lhamo (Sanskr. KaladevI), with her attendants; Tsepagmed (Sanskr. Amitayus), the god of longevity; and the five great kings (in Tibetan Ku nga gyalpo).^ Sukhavatl, the abode of the blessed. Complete deliverance from existence, or from the world in its most general meaning, is comprised under the name of Nirvana (Tib. Nyangan las daspa, by con- traction Nyangdas).^ The essence of Nirvana is not clearly ])ointed out in the sacred books; and this, indeed, is * See Csoma, “Grammar,” pp. 181 seq. “ About Lhamo see p. 112; concerning Tsepagmed see p. 12i(; about the live great Kings see Chapter XIII. '•* Respecting the difference between the genuine idea of Nirvana, and the Tibetan opinion, see Kdppen, “Die Religion des I’uddha,” Vol. I., p. 307. SUKHAVATI, THE ABODE OF THE BLESSED. 99 not possible in a philosophical system in which negation of reality is the fundamental principle;^ and the sacred Buddhist books also declare at every occasion that it is impossible positively to define the attributes and properties of Nirvana. The secondary kind of happiness, to which the Buddha has likewise revealed the path,^ is the enjoyment of Sukhavatl, the abode of the blessed, into which ascend those who have accumulated much merit by the practise of virtues. Already the entering into Sukhavatl involves the deliverance from metemphsychosis, but not from ab- solute existence, nor is the perfection of the Buddhas yet attained. In general, the Tibetans of the present day do not properly distinguish between Nirvana and Sukhavatl, their highest ideal being attained by liberation from rebirth and the reception into Sukhavatl. My brothers who have had frequent opportunity of consulting Tibetan Lamas, learned that particular stress is now laid upon the complete emancipation from metempsychosis. It is believed, that then they have no feeling whatever about their existence ; a Lama once compared them to a healthy man, who, though provided with a stomach, lungs, a liver &c., experiences no feeling of their presence. How greatly freedom from metempsychosis is prized, appears from a conversation, which Hermann once held with a Lama of Bhutan. This man who had been at Lhassa during the residence there of the French niission- ‘ See p. 33. - Compare p. 42. VIEWS OX METEMPSYCHOSIS. 1 00 ai’ios, Hue and Gabet, had seen some coloured litho- graphs representing our Saviour Jesus Christ, and various e})isodes of Bible histoiy. The Lama alleged against the creed of these missionaries, that it does not afford final emancipation. According to the principles of their re- ligion, he said, the pious arc rewarded with a re-birth among the servants of the supreme God, when they are obliged to pass an eternity in reciting hymns, psalms, and ])rayers, in his glory and honour. Such beings, he argued, are consequently not }’et freed from metemp- sychosis ; for who can assert, that, in the event of their relaxing in the duty assigned them, they shall not be expelled from the world where God resides, and in punishment be re-born in the habitation of the wretched. ^ Buddhist doctrines, the Lama concluded, are certainly preferable to tins theory; they do not allow a man to be deprived of the fruits of the good works performed during life; and if once arrived at final perfection, he is never again, under any circumstances, subjected to metempsychosis, although, at the same time, if desiring to benefit animated beings, he is at liberty to re-assume the human form, Avhenever it pleases him, without being obliged to retain it or to suffer from any of its disadvantages. The happy region Sukhavatl, where thrones Amitabha, lies towards the west." In Sanskrit it is called Sukha- ' In the prints seen bj' the Lama angels were doubtless depicted soaring in the air and hovering round the chief figures of the picture. He must have also heard of the expulsion of the bad angels from heaven. ^ Genuine Buddhism rejects the idea of a particular localitj' being aj*- lU’opriated to Nirvana. In the remarkable treatise entitled Milindn prasna, SUKHAVATI, TIIH ABODE OF THE BLESSED. 101 vatT, “abounding in pleasures;” in Tibetan Devachan, “the happy;” the Chineses designate it Ngyan-lo, “pleas- ure;” Kio-lo “the greatest pleasure;” Tsing-tu “pure or glorious land;” and in sacred treatises it is denominated “the pure region, a kind of prosperity.” We find an account of this glorious region of Ainitabha in many religious books.' SukhavatT is declared to be a large lake, the surfiice of which is covered with lotus-flowers (Padmas), red and white, with perfumes of rare odour. These flowers form the couches for pious men, whose virtues were the cause of their growth, while yet sojourners upon earth. Such men, after being purified from their sins, soar up into their lotus-flowers. The inhabitants of this paradise are moved to earnest devotion by the beautiful song of paradisiacal birds, and receive food and clothes for the mere wishing, without any exertion on translated by Hardy in his works on Buddhism, the priest Nagasena (Nagarjuna), is said to have replied to the King Milinda of Sangala (who ruled about 140 b.c. ; see A. 'Weber, Indische Studien, Yol. III., p. 121), in answer to his inquiries about the nature, essence, and locality of Nirvana: “Nirvana is wherever the precepts can be observed; and there may be the observance in Yawana, China, Milata, Alasanda, Nikumba, Kasi, Kosala, Kasmira, Ghandhara, the summit of Maha Meru, or the Brahma-lbkas ; it may be anywhere; just as he who has two eyes can see the sky from any or all of these places; or as any of these places may have an eastern side.” Eastern Monachism, p. 300. ' Some descriptions of this region were translated from the Mongolian and Chinese into European languages by Pallas, “Mongol. Vblker,” Vol. II. p. 63 (his description, however, seems not to have been correctly be rendered from the original text, see Schott) ; Schmidt, “ Geschichte Ssanang Ssetsens,” p. 323 (from the Bodhimbr); Kowalewsky in his “Mongolian Chrestomathy ” (in Russian), Vol. II., p. 31‘J. Schott, “Der Buddhaismus in Ilochasien,” pp. 50-0. Compare also the analysis of the Sukhavatl vyuha in Burnoufs “Intro- duction,” p. 99, and in Csoma’s paper. As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 439. Among other Tibetan books containing a description of it, are the Maui Kambum and the Odpagmed kyi shing kod, “construction of Amitabha’s land.” The library of St. Petersburgh has a cojjy of it in a Mongolian translation, entitled; Abida in oronu dsokiyal. 102 VIEWS ON METE3IPSYCHOSIS. tlieir part. They have not yet reached the estate of a Buddha, but have entered the direct path which leads to it; they are endowed with the faculty of assuming human forms and descending upon earth; although when doing so, they are not subjected to a repetition of births, but rise again to the region they have left. Re-birth into a Padmaflower of this paradise is obtained by invocations of the Buddhas, and more particularly of Amitabha; a form of devotion, according to tlie Tsing tu nen, trans- lated by Schott, involving greater merit, than that of offerings and mortitications. CHAPTER X. DETAILS CHARACTERISTIC OF THE RELIGION OF THE PEOPLE. Amount of religious Knowledge. — Gods, Genu and Malignant Spirits. The spirits Lhainayin and Dudpos. The legends about Lhamo, Tsangpa, and Chakdor.— Prayers. Amount of religious knowledge. It is evident that a religion containing so much of philosophical speculation and divided into many various systems, schools and sects, cannot be known in its full extent by the lower classes forming the bulk of the population, but only by those of a certain degree of education. Csoma, who paid great attention during his personal intercourse to the general amount of religious knowledge amongst the various classes, gives the following details in his “Notices “The systems A^aibhashika, Sautrantika, Yogacharya, and Madhyamika, are well known to many of the learned * Jouiu. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VII., p. 145. 1 04 DETAILS CHAllAC'TEEISTIC OF THE KELIG. OF THE PEOI'LE. in Tibet; but tliere are, on the other hand, many who are acquainted with their names only. The works ex- ])lanatory of the Yogacharya and Madhyamika theories can be understood oidy by the learned, because they deal with too many abstract terms and minute distinctions, while the generality of the religious persons (or the clergy) prefer reading Tantrika works, and of the Kanjnr, the Dulva (or discipline), and some tracts of the Do (or Sutra) class.” He adds, that the Tibetans are tolerably familiar with the dogma of the “three vehicles” (Tib. Thegpasum, Sanskr. Triyana). ' This dogma, which has been taken from the Mahayana schools, is explained in detail in the Tibetan compendiums entitled Lamrim, or the gradual way to perfection, of which the most cele- l^rated was written by Tsonkhapa. The argumentations of these books are taken from the consideration, that tlie dogmas of the Buddha are intended alike for the lowest, the mean or middle, and the highest capacities; as they contain low, or vulgar, middle, and high prin- ciples; thus, from the knowledge of each of these classes a particular degree of perfection is deducible. They then describe what a man must believe according to his ca- pacities, in the following terms; 1. “Men of vulgar capacities must believe, that there is a Grod, that there is a future life, and that they shall earn the fruits of their works in this, their worldly life. 2. Those that are in a middle degree of intellectual and moral capacity, besides admitting the former ‘ Compare p. 22. 105 AMOUNT OF HFLIUIOUS KNOWLEDGE. poisitioiis, must know, that every compound tiling- is perishable, that there is no reality in things; that every imperfection is pain, and that deliv- erance from pain, or bodily existence, is final happiness or beatitude. o. Those of the highest capacities must know, in addition to the above enumerated dogmas, that from the body, or last object, to the supreme soul, nothing is existent by itself; neither can it be said that it will continue always or cease ab- solutely, but that every thing exists by a depend- ent, or causal connexion (or concatenation). 5. Witli respect to practice, those of vulgar capacity are content with the exercise of the ten virtues. Those of a middle degree, besides fulfilling the ten virtues, endeavour to excel in morality, medi- tation, and ingenuity, or wisdom. Those of the highest capacities, besides the former virtues, will perfectly exercise the six transcendental virtues.” Also with reference to the summum honiim of beat- itude or perfection, three degrees are distinguished. Some are already content with a happy transmigration, and limit their wishes to be re-born as gods, men or Asiu’as. Others hope to be rewarded by a re-birth in Sukhavatl, and to be delivered from pain and bodily existence. A third class wishes not only to attain Nirvana for themselves, but also to show others the paths leading to it in a future period as most perfect Buddhas. Such a power, however, can only be gained by those 1 OG DETAILS CUAK ACTEEISTIC OF THE RELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. who enter the priesthood, or, as the Lamas say, who take the vows, Dom. There are many legends illustrat- ing the merits to be acquired by entering the religious order and inculcating the necessity of doing so.^ The idea at last grew into an undisputable dogma, that laymen cannot gain the Bodhi in their present existence, but only in a future state; their actual religious occu- ])ations will secure the reward of re-birth in a happy condition, or in Amitabha’s celestial region, but, with respect to the supreme rank of a Buddha, their attempts are nothing but preparations. Clear and intelligible as these principles are, they have been found nevertheless, too learned for the lay I'ollowers of Buddhism; and for a more general diffusion, a code of eight specific duties was drawn up, forming a practical summary of the laws of the Buddhist faith. The contents of the popular code are given in Csoma’s paper as follows; 1. To take refuge only with Buddha. 2. To form in one’s mind the resolution to strive to attain the highest degree of perfection, in order to be united with the supreme intelligence. 3. To prostrate one’sself before the image of Buddha ; to adore him. 4. To bring offerings before him, such as are pleas- . ing to any of the six senses: as, lights, flowers, garlands, incenses, perfumes; all kinds of edible and trinkable things (whether raw, or prepared); ' See p. 27, 38. -I cite as an example Schmidt, “Dsang-lun, der Wcisc und dev Thor,” p. 108. GODS, GEXII, AND MALIGNANT SPllUTS. 107 stutt's, cloths, &c. for garments and hanging ornaments. 5. To make music, sing hymns, and utter the praises of Buddha, respecting his person, doctrine, love or mercy, ])erfections or attributes; and his acts, or performances, for the beneht of all animal beino’s. O (). To confess one’s sins with contrite heart; to ask forgiveness for them and to resolve sincerely not to commit the like hereafter. 7. To rejoice in the moral merits of all animal beings, and to wish that they may therel)y obtain hiial emancipation or l)eatitude. To pray and entreat all the Buddhas that arc now in the world to turn the wheel of religion (or to teach their doctrines), and not to leave the world too soon, but to remain here for many ages, or Kalpas. (rods, genii, and malignant spirits. The Tibetan Buddhists believe well-being and mis- fortune alike to depend upon the action of gods, genii, and malignant spirits.' The gods are considered to exist in large numbers; they derive their divine nature from having received a particle of the supreme intelligence, which possesses such power and is of such ' Many instances of this belief, coinnion to all the Buddhist races of Asia (Schmidt, “Forschungeii,'’ p. 137; “ Ssanaiig Ssetsen,” p. 3;’)2; Marsden, “‘The travels of Marco Polo,” jip. If)!', 1(53), will be found in the writers on Tibet. 1 08 DETAILS CH AK ACTEEISTIC OF THE EELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. illimitable extent as to allow of a division amongst an\^ number of beings. All gods are, therefore, embodiments and multiplications of one and the same supreme wisdom, created for the purpose of choosing the most suitable way for the salvation of mankind from Samsara (the world). ‘ In the face of all these gods, the Lamas emphatically maintain monotheism to be the real character of Buddhism. In Tibetan the collective name for deity (god and genius) is Lha, an appellative similar to its Sanskrit equivalent Deva, meaning a god, a divinity. The deities have each their particular names, by which they are worshipped, as also their definite spheres, beyond which they cannot exercise any power, but within which they cannot be influenced by another god. They materially assist man in his undertakings, and remove the dangers with which they may be threatened from natural phenom- ena — acts in which they feel great delight and pleasure and which they perform in a state of calmness, Zhiva. There exist male as well as female deities, the latter being either the wives of male deities, deriving from the husband the same power of which he is the pos- sessor, or they are endowed with special faculties of their own. Of this kind are%the Samvaras (in Tibetan Dechog), and the Herukas, female genii eipial in power to the Buddhas, whose images occur in numerous religious pictures. ' ' Schmidt, in Mem. de I’Acad. dc I’etcrsb., Vol. I., p. 110. “ Csoiiia in his Analysis, As. Kcs., Vol. XX., p. 480, considers these divine beings as two gods or demons, and, in an other passage, p. 401, he calls the Ileruka a deified saint of the character of Siva, and the Samvara a Dakinl. He THE LHAMAYIN. 109 The malignant spirits are designated by names ex- pressive of their hostilit}' towards man, as Da, “enemy,” Geg, “de\’il;” the most dreaded arc the Lhamayin and the Diidpos. To the Lhamayin, amongst wliich also man may be re-born (see p. 92), the Yakshas, the Nagas, the Rrdi^shasas, and many other groups of illnatured spirits are subjected; their particular adversaries are the four Maharajas (Tib. Gyalchen zhi), who dwell upon the fourth step of the mount Meru.' Amongst these evil spirits those deserve a particular notice who cause the Dus- mayinpar chi, or “untimely death.” According to the belief of the Tibetans, that is considered an untimely death, which, in opposition to the ordinary course of nature, is accelerated by the evil spirits, such as Sringan, Dechad, Jungpo, and others. As a consequence of prem- ature decease, the “Bardo,” is prolongated. This is the middle state between the death and the new re-birth, which does not follow immediately, but there exists an interval, which is shorter for the good than for the bad. The prolongation of this intermediate state is con- sidered as a punishment caused by evil spirits who have only power over sinful men. The soul exists during this interval \vithout any shape whatever, and the also treats of both in the singular number; but Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 538, doubts whether Samvara be a proper name; and his opinion is supported by the fact that various Samvaras and Herukas occur in pictures ; as well as by the Tibetan treatise Dechogi gyut, in which numerous Samvaras and Herukas are mentioned. The case appears to be similar to that of Shinje, the judge of the dead (see p. 93), whose assistants, the Dudpos, are likewise styled Shinjes. ' See Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 603. Schmidt, in Mem. de I’Acad. dc I’etersb., Vol. II., 33 et seq. 110 DETAILS C'HAE ACTERISTIC OF THE RELIG. OP THE PEOPLE. wretched ones, wlio have been seized by the spirits, make earnest efforts bnt without success to get placed within a body. At such moments they appear to men as a raw, shapeless piece of meat, and such a vision is considered nnlnck}-, boding illness and even death. Bhriranis and particular offerings are supposed to keep oft’ such dreaded visions, and the wealthy have magical sentences and treatises printed, of which the following are the most frequently met with : ^ Choichi gyalpoi shed dul, “to break the power of Choigyal,” an epithet of Shinje; Tamdin gyalpoi sri nanpa, “to subdue the hon- ourable King Tamdin”; Dragpo chinsreg, “the fierce sacrifice;”^ Jig grol gyi pavo “the hero delivering from the danger (of Bardo).”^ The Dndpos, the assistants of Shinje, the judge of the dead, and often likewise called Shinjes, inhabit the region Paranirmita Vasavartin (“that exercises a power over the metamorphoses produced by others”), the highest in the world of desire. They try to hinder the de- population of the world by supporting man in evil desire, and by keeping off the Bodhisattvas fi'om attaining the Bodhi; it is they who disturb the devoutness of assem- bled Buddhists, and put an end to steady meditation by assuming the shape of a beautiful woman, or by snggest- * Untimely death is also enumerated in a Tantra of the Kanjur amongst the objects of fear against which protection is obtained by the Dharanls therein mentioned. Csoma, “Analysis,” As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 519. Respect- ing the dogma of the Bardo, see Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 110. 2 Chinsreg is the Tibetan name for the burnt-offering, a description of which is to be found in Chapter XV., No. 2; about Tamdin compare No. 5. 5 In full title: Bardo phrang grol gyi sol debjig grol gyi pavo zhechava “a petition protecting from the chasm of Bardo, or a hero delivering from the danger (of Bardo).” THE GODS DRAGSHED. 1 1 1 ing ludicrous ideas, by asserting that tliose who do not enjoy the pleasures of life shall be re-born in hell, with many other tricks of a similar nature. But they are also those spirits who, when the time of death has arrived, seize the released soul and bring it before Shinje, their King, to be tried and sentenced according to its works. The apparent contradiction of this function with their tendency to induce man to abandon himself to pleasure in existence, is to be explained from the dogma, “that birth and decay cannot be separated;” whence it results that the gods who cause existence simultaneously bring into action the destructive power, which is the unavoidable consequence of existence.^ To subdue the evil spirits, is one of the most im- portant duties of the gods and genii, and they assume a horrible aspect when fighting with the evil spirits; during these such dreadful encounters, they are supposed to become highly inflamed with rage. Though any god is at liberty to subdue any of the evil spirits, yet there exist a particular class who have especially devoted themselves to the extirpation of evil spirits, in the pur- suance of which object they are further confirmed by an awful oath deposited in the hands of the Buddha Vajra- dhara. ^ These gods are called Dragsheds,^ “the cruel hangmen,” and their auger against the evil spirits — so ^ Foe koue ki, Engl, transl., p. 248. Schmidt, Mem. de I’Acad. de Petersb., Vol. II., p. 24. “Ssanang Ssetsen,” p. 310. - See about him p. 50 et seq. ’ From dragpo, “cruel, wrathful,” and ^fshed-ma “a hangman.” In Mongolia out of this variety of Dragsheds eight are particularly worshipped; they are styled, according to Pallas, “Mongol. Volker,” Vol. II., p. 95, Naiman Dokshot. 112 DETAILS CHAD ACTEEISTIC OF THE RELIO. OF THE PEOPLE. tlic legends relate — arose in consequence of the in- numerable tricks that had been played off upon them by the latter. There are again subdivisions amongst the Dragsheds themselves. The one called Yab yum chudpa, “the father embracing his mother,” in addition to his power of successfully keeping off a legion of evil spirits, is also able to deliver man from his sins, if the latter sincerely repent and confess them prostrate before his image. These representations show them in a curious position, with a female tenderly clasped round their bodies. As an addition to the number of the legendary tales communicated bv Pallas concerning the eight Dragsheds whom the Mongolians predominantly implore, I insert here the legends about Lhamo (Sanskr. KaladevI), Tsangpa (Sanskr. Brahma), and Chakdor or Chakna dorje (Sanskr. Yajrapani). ha^•ing become the adversaries of the evil spirits. The legend ahoui Lhamo (Sanshr. KaladevI). The goddess Lhamo' was married to Shinje, the king of the Dudpos, who at the time of the marriage had assumed the form of the king of Ceylon. The goddess had made a vow, either to soften her husband's notoriously wild and wicked manners, and make him favourably disposed towards the religion of Buddha, or, failing in her })raiseworthy endeavours, to extirpate a royal race so ^ In a prayer addressed to this goddess, and which is printed on Plate No. III., she is also invoked by the name of Rimate — The iiresent legend is related in the book Paldan Lhamoi kang shag, “to perform confession before the venerated Lhamo,” a treatise which is read when olferings are presented to this goddess. A copy of this book in Tibetan and Mongolian is in the library of the Petersburg!! university. The Mongolian edition contains some details in Kalmnk, which are not met with in the Tibetan. LHAMO. 113 hostile to his creed by killing the children that might issue from the marriage. Unfortunately it was beyond her power to effect an improvement in the evil ways of the king, and, accordingly, she determined to kill their son, who was greatly beloved by his father because in him he had hoped to put a complete end to Buddhism in Ceylon. During a temporary absence of the king, the goddess put her design in execution; she flaj’^ed her son alive, drank the blood from out his skull, and even ate his flesh. She then left the palace and set out for her northern home, using her son’s skin as a saddle for the king’s best horse. On his return, seeing what had happened, the king at once seized a bow, and, with a terrible incantation, shot off a poisoned arrow after his dreadful wife. The arrow pierced the horse’s back, in which it stuck fast; but the queen, neutralizing the effi- cacy of the imprecation, took out the deadly weapon and uttered the following sentence: “May the wound of my horse become an eye large enough to overlook the twenty-four regions, and may I myself extirpate the race of these mahgnant kings of Ceylon!” The goddess then continued her journey towards the north, traversing in great haste India, Tibet, Mongolia, and part of China, and finally settling in the mountain Oikhan, in the district Olgon, which is supposed to be situate in Eastern Siberia. This mountain is said to be surrounded by large, uninhabited deserts, and by the ocean Muliding.^ * A portrait of Lhamo, who is identical with the goddess Okkin Tangri of the Mongolians, and with the Chammo or Lchamu of Pallas (Mongol. Volker- sehaften, Vol. II., p. 98), I found added to the picture of the thirty-five Buddhas 1 1 4 DETAILS CTIAE ACTERISTIC EOE TUE EELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. The legend about Tsangpa (Brahma). "I’sangpa, a follower of the Buddha, who had retired into the woods, was on the point of discovering the secrets of the Buddha doctrine by extraordinaiy meditation and the practice of virtues, when a Dudpo appeared before him in the shape of a beautiful woman, who offered him exquisite delicacies. Tsangpa incautiousl}’ partook of them, was soon drunk, and in his phrensy killed the ram upon which the demon had ridden. By this savage act he lost the merits of the good works which he had accumulated with so much pain and perseverance, and attained no higher degree than that of a common follower, or Upasaka (Tib. Genyen).^ Tsangpa was now filled with rage towards the evil spirits, and took an awful oath, in the hands of of the Buddha Vajradhara, vowing to do his utmost to extirpate the pernicious race through which he had lost his position.^ The legend ahoid Chahdor (Vajrapdni).'^ Once upon a time the Buddhas all met together on the top of Mount Meru, to deliberate upon the means of procuring the water of life, Dutsi (Sanskr. Amrita), which lies of confession described p. 97. There is a similar representation of her in Plate VI. of Pallas’s work, beneath the central figure; in Fig. 5, Plate IX., she is represented without the staff and the skull-cup. * I have already stated that these are not virtually admitted to the rank of a Buddha. See pp. 28, 38, 106. ^ This legend inclines me to believe that ManjusrI, a Bodhisattva, and the god of wisdom {see p. 65), did not, when repelling the obnoxious Choichishalba, take the dreadful form of Yamiintaka by order of Sakyamuni, as Pallas was informed (see his Mong. Volker., Vol. II., p. 96), but assumed it of his own free will, and in consequence of a similar snare laid for him. ® This legend is given in the book Drimed shel phreng, “spotless garland of crystals.” For an image of Vajrapani see Plate II. To 0 )!4. rinte TT. Vajrapani or Chakdor, the subduer of the evil spirits. Heduced from the origiuaK which cut into a ^>rayer■^lone put upon a prayer wall in Sikkim. To face p. U4. Plate III. ADDRESS TO THE GODDESS LHAMO, m SANSKRIT KALADEVi. cv cs c\ o -y- -v-cs :a-^-apz,^r-i3^^-a-a^-^a|-ai-zr]s^5/-a'^i,-|je^-^i:^77 TT K'-»-|7-v V# gv-.'fr..': '-''?*,^ ■ ?? '. ■.■■' '■•■'> h * V / ’ ’ r.^ Jr •; 4 ^'' :‘.. M "V _ 4^ . (t /- ■ >i#,\ i V*'- - - . ‘ # ■ ‘ • < ^ ' >rv - ^ - -a ,;« ,.™ . -»■:■-"'• - 'i,,-. ■ i. r^ 1 s ‘-TfeW ■ ■ |[*n^ r . ,.f <’ ■■■•'4m ^'•?» .x>' gi* .lU. U- > 1 ^ (’HAKl)OE. 115 i I i 1 concealed at the bottom of the deep ocean. In their I benevolence, they intended, as soon as they obtained possession of the water of life, to distribute it amongst the human race as a powerful antidote against the strong- poison Hala hala, which the evil demons, at this period, had been using with such mischievous effect against mankind. , In order to procure the antidote they determined to churn the ocean with the mountain Meru, and so cause the water of hfe to rise to the surface of the sea. This they did, and delivered the water of life to Vajrapani, I vith orders to secure it safely until a future meeting, when they would impart it to living beings. But the monster Eahu^ (Tib. Dachan), a Lhamayin, happened to hear of this precious discovery, and having carefully watched Vajrapani’s movements, seized an opportunity, in the absence of the latter, to drink the water of life; not satisfied with this act, he even voided his water dehberately into the vessel. He then hurried away as fast as possible, and had already proceeded a great distance, when Yajrapani came home, and having per- ceived the theft, instantly set out in pursuit of the culprit. In the course of his flight Rahu had passed the sun and * In his “ Manual of Buddhism,” p. 58, Hardy has extracted from Singha- lese books the follo\ving mythical measurements of Rahu’s hody: “Rahu is 76,000 miles high; 19,000 miles broad across the shoulders; his head is 14,500 miles round; his forehead is 4,800 miles broad; from eye brow to eye-brow he measures 800 miles; his mouth is 3,200 miles in size, and 4,800 miles deep; the palm of his hand is 5,600 miles in size; the joint of his fingers 800 miles; the sole of his foot 12,000 miles; from his elbow to the tip of his fingers is 19,000 miles ; and with one finger he can cover the sun or moon, so as to obscure their light.” 8* 1 1 G DETAILS CHAEACTEKISTIO FOR THE EELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. the moon, whom he menaced with vengeance, should they venture to betray him to Vajrapani. His searches prov- ing fruitless, Vajrapani betook himself to the sun, and asked him about Kahu. But the sun replied evasively, saying, that he had certainly seen somebody passing a long time ago, but had paid no particular attention as to who it was. The moon, on the other hand, returned a candid answer, only requesting that Vajrapani would not repeat it before Eahu. Upon this information Eahu was shortly afterwards overtaken, when he got such a terrible blow from Vajrapani’s sceptre that, besides re- receiving many wounds, his body was split into two parts, the lower part of the bod}" with the legs being entirely blowui off. The Buddhas once more held a meeting, in w’hich they deliberated upon the best means of disposing of Ifahu’s urine. To pour it out w"Ould have been most dangerous for living beings, as it contained a large quantity of the poison Hala hala; they therefore de- termined, that Vajrapani should drink it, in just punish- ment for the carelessness through which the water of life had been lost. Accordingly he w-as forced to do so, w"hen his fair, yellow' complexion w'as changed l)y the effects of this dangerous potion into a dark one. Vajrapani conceived, from his transfiguration, a most violent rage against all evil demons, and in particular against Eahu, who, notwithstanding his deadly wounds, was prevented from dying by the water of life. This powerful water, however, dropped from his wounds and fell all over the world, numerous medicinal herbs CHAKDOR. 117 springing up on the spots where it touched the soil. A severe punishment was also inflicted upon Rahu by the Buddhas themselves; they made a horrible monster of him, replaced his legs by the tail of a dragon, formed nine different heads from his broken one, the principal wounds were made into an enormous tliroat, and the lesser ones changed into so many eyes. Rahu, wdio had ever distinguished himself from his fellow-beings by his wickedness — in their earliest youth even the other gods had to suffer from his malignity — became, after this transformation, more dreadful than he was before. His rage was turned especially towards the sun and the moon, who had betrayed him. He is con- stantly trying to devour them, particularly the moon, who displayed the most hostile disposition towards him. He overshadow's them whilst trying to devour them, and thus causes eclipses; but owing to Vajrapani’s unceasing vigilance, he cannot succeed in destroying them.‘ Prayers. Prayers, in the usual sense of the word, as addresses to the deity imploring assistance, or in the form of ' This legend decidedly derives its origin from the Hindus, from whose tales it was taken almost without alteration. According to these, the water of life, Amrita, was also procured by churning the ocean, and was distrib- uted amongst the gods. Rahu, a monster with a dragon’s tail, disguised himself like one of the gods, and received a portion of it; his fraud having been discovered by the sun and moon, Vishnu severed his head; but the nectarean fluid setured his immortality. See Fr. Wilford, “On Egypt and the Nile,” As. Res., Vol. lU., p. 331, 419; “Essay on the Sacred Isles in the West,” As. Res., Vol. XL, p. 141. 118 DETAILS CHAKACTERISTIC FOE THE EELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. thanksgivings and praises for mercies received/ are known to genuine Buddhism only in the form of hymns for honouring and glorifying the Buddhas and Bodhisattvas, for having pointed out to man, by word and example, the right path leading to Nirvana. But in the Mahayana Buddhism man is not directed to perfection by information only, but he may hope to be actually supported by divine assistance ; for the Bodhisattvas, instead of emulating the quietness of the Buddhas, are supposed to wander about in the world and to ensure by their powerful assistance man’s attainment of eternal happiness. We here meet with implorations which, in their first stage, however, do not exliibit the character of petitions or thanks, but only express the desires of the votary to attain the same high faculties as the Bodhisattvas enjoy themselves. Whenever, in the legends, any Buddhist is about to per- form a meritorious work, he utters the words; “May I become delivered from pains on account of this work, and may I lead all beings to deliverance by my good example and these works.” But in the books belonging to the later Mahayana and the mystical schools, we see such wishes very closely allied to the dogma of an un- limited charity of the Bodhisattvas towards man. As an example of this I quote a Tantra of the Kanjur, in which seven imaginary Buddhas had each desired, when they were practising a holy life in order to become * Schott, “Ueber den Buddhaismus in Hochasien,” p. 58. Wassiljew, 1. c., pp. 136, 139, 166. Csoina, “Analysis,” As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 508. See also the Address to the Buddhas of Confession in the following chapter. — Con- cerning the Geyas, or works in metric form, to the glory of the Buddhas and Bodhisattvas, sec Burnouf’s Introduction, p. 52. TEAYEES. 119 liiiddlmis, that all animal beings (or creatures) that were suffering such and such specified kinds of misery or distress, might, at the time of their becoming Buddhas, enjoy all sorts of prosperity and liappiness. In the sacred writings of these systems the mythological Bud- dhas residing in the various regions beyond the earth are frequently addressed with prayers in the strict sense of the word, and the reciting of prayers is recommended as a most successful expedient for annihilating sins and for removing the impediments which hinder the attain- ment of final emancipation. In Tibet this is also the actual opinion respecting prayers (Tib. Monlam). The general confidence of the Tibetan Buddhists in their efficacy is more especially due to their enjoying the character and possessing the virtue of Dharanis; they are endowed with supernatural powers and are considered to exercise an irresistible magical influence over the deity implored. That this is the light in which they are viewed is clearly evident from the form of many prayers, which are frequently little more than mere incantations. Here, for in- stance, is an address to the goddess Lhamo, which runs thus: “I summon thee hither from the north-eastern region surrounded by the great ocean Muliding, by the blue letter Hum, which is traced upon my heart, spreading with its iron hook a beam of light; — thee, the mighty and powerful mistress and queen Rimate and thy attendants.” ^ * For the Tibetan text which Adolphe got written down by a Lama, see Plate No. III. 1 20 DETAILS CHARACTEKISTIC FOR THE RELIG. OF THE PEOPLE. Other prayers are, according to their form, praises, or hymns, or petitions in which the name of the god addressed is mentioned, as in the prayer; Om Vajrapani hum ; or is at times omitted altogether, as in the celebrated six -syllable prayer; Om mani padme hum, O, the Jewel in the Lotus; Amen. This prayer is an invocation of Padmapani (see p. 88), who is believed to have delivered it to the Tibetans; it is the most fre- quently repeated of all prayers, and has on this account excited the curiosity of the earliest visitors to Tibet. Its real meaning, however, was long involved in doubt, and it is onl}’' by the most recent researches that a po- sitive determination has been finally arrived at.^ The Lotus {Nymplicea Nelumbo, Linn.), is known to be the symbol of highest perfection, and is here employed in allusion to Padmapani’s genesis from ‘this flower. To each syllable of the prayer is attributed a special magical faculty,^ and this theory has perhaps more favoured its general application than its supposed divine origin. In the plates this prayer occurs in No. IV., which is a print from an original wood-block. In a prayer cylinder ^ which I had the opportunity of opening, I found the * See Klaproth, “Fragments Bouddhiques,” p. 27; Schmidt, Mem. de I’Acad. de Petersb., Vol. I., p. 112; Foe koue ki, Engl. Translation, p. 116; Hodgson’s “Illustrations,” p. 171; Schott, “Ueber den Buddhaismus,” p. 1); Hofmann, in “Beschreibung von Nippon,” Vol. V., p. 175. - Schmidt, “ Forschungen,” p. 200; Pallas, “Mongol. Vdlkerschaftcn,” Vol. II., p. 90. The power of any sentence or book is increased by being written in red, silver or gold. Red ink e.g. is considered to have exactly 108 times more power than black ink. Schilling de Canstadt, in Bull. hist, phil. dc Pet., Vol. IV., pp. 331, 333. ® Further information about these curious instruments will be given in a subsequent chapter. THE SIX-SYLLABIC PRAYER “OM IVIANI PADME HUM Taken from a wooileut from Eastern Tif)el. PRAYEKS. 121 . sentence printed in six lines and repeated innumerable ,^imes upon a leaf 49 feet long and 4 indies broad. V j When Baron Schilling de Canstadt paid a visit to the temple Subulin in Siberia, the Lamas were just occupied ^ with preparing 100 milhons of copies of this prayer ill to be put into a prayer cyhnder. His offer to have ^ - the necessary number executed at St. Petersburg was most ^ readily accepted, and he was presented, in return for the 150 millions of copies he forwarded to them, with an edition of the.Kanjur, the sheets of which amount to about 40,000. — When adorning the head of religious books, or when engraved upon the slabs resting on ^ the prayer walls, ^ the letters of the above-mentioned sentence are often so combined as to form an anagram. The longitudinal lines occurring in the letters “mani ^ ^ padme hum” are traced close to each other, and to I the outer longitudinal hue at the left are appended the Incurved lines. The letter “om” is replaced by a sym- S bolical sign above the anagram, showing a half-moon ^ surmounted by a disk indicating the sun, from which issues ^ I a flame. Such a combination of the letters is called in Tibetan Nam chu vangdan, “the ten entirely powerful ^ (viz. characters, six of which are consonants, and four vowels) ; ” and the power of this sacred sentence is su^jposed to be increased by its being written in this form. This kind of anagrams are always bordered by a pointed Irame indicating the leaf of a flg-tree. Sec about them Chapter XIII. CHAPTER XI. TRANSLATION OF AN ADDRESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. Tbanslation and explanatohy Remarks. In the chapter on “Metempsychosis” I have ah’eady alluded to the various means of purification from sins, a very efficacious one, it will be remembered, consisting in the supplication of the deities. I have likewise there referred to the addresses offered up to the Buddhas of confession, wliich are contained in various compilations of prayers, A sacred treatise of this nature forms the subject of the present chapter. The original I found concealed in a Chorten my brother Hermann had obtained from the Lama at Saimonbong, in Sikkim;^ it is written in small characters (the Vumed) on two sheets ' The Chorteu stood on the altar in the Lama’s praying-room already when Hooker was there. iSee the View of the interior of the house of the Lama at Saimonbong in his “Himalayan Journals.” DETAILS ABOUT TIU: DOCUMENT. 123 of unequal size. The larger is about four feet square, its height being two feet four inches, its breadth one foot nine inches; the smaller has the same breadth, but its height is only six inches, giving a surface of Yg square foot. These two sheets were lying one upon the other, but se- parated by grains of barley interposed between them. They were w'ound round a wooden four-sided obelisk which tilled the central part of the Chorten. The four sides of this obelisk were covered with Dharani inscriptions. As the size of the two sheets does not allow of my reproducing here this invocation of the Buddhas of con- fession in the. form of a facsimile, I preferred giving it transcribed in the head characters in the ordinary form of Tibetan books, at the end of the chapter. The con- tents of the two parts are separated by a distance left between them ; the beginning of the second part is besides also marked in the Tibetan text by the recur- rence of the initial sign.* Its full title runs thus: Digpa thamchad shagpar terchoi, “Repentance of all sins, doctrine of the hidden treasure.”" The words ter-choi were illegible in the sentence at the head of the treatise, and it was only through their occurring at the foot of the larger leaf in connexion with the rest of the phrase that the hiatus could be filled up. Here also the other words preceding them had suffered considerable injury, but the general * In the English translation the words in parenthesis are rather explanatory paraphrases, than literal translations of the Tibetan. ^ /Sdig-pa “sin, vice;” thams-chad “all;” 6shags-pa “repentant confes- sion;” r, the sign of the locative, is often used in stead of the genctive sign (comp. Foucanx, Gram. Tib., p. 04); fjtev “a treasury;” chhos “the doctrine.” 124 ADDRESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. context and the few letters still decipherable proved sufficient to remove all doubt that the title had been repeated. Another name for the petition, and one which we several times meet with in the text, is Digshag ser chi pugri, “the golden razor which taAes away sins,”‘ this designation evidently signif\dng its extraordinary efficacy in delivering the sinner, Tbe larger leaf commences with a general laudation of the Buddhas — past, present, and to come — who are considered to have approached nearest to perfection ; then fifty-one Buddhas are mentioned each by name; of some the region is stated in which they dwell, to others is added the number of their births from the moment in wliich they entered the Buddha career down to tlie time when they obtained the Buddhaship. 8ins are said to be annihilated by reading or uttering the names of these Buddhas, and the sins are specified from which each Buddha has the power to purily. The wickedness of the human race, which caused the destruction of the universe, is alluded to, and the prophecy is made that man shall have recourse to this treatise and derive from it great advantages. The second, smaller leaf, begins with the words; “Enshrined in the sacred box at the time of the uttering of benedictions,” which refer to the usual in- auguration ceremonies of religious buildings, as also to the blessings pronounced on such solemn occasions. Their effects upon the salvation of man, and the ad- * Gslt “gold;-’ kyi, chi, is the sign of the genitive case; spu-gri “a razor.’' TRANSLATION OF THE FIRST PART. 125 vantages which the inhabitants of the monastery shall derive from repeating them, are also again noticed. It concludes with four Dharanis. The address styles itself a Mahayana Sutra (in Tibetan, Thegpa chenpoi do), under which we should also have to class it from the nature of its contents.^ The addressing of imaginary Buddhas and the admission of a magical influence of prayers upon the deity implored is particularly to be mentioned in evidence of its being written in this period of mystic modification of Buddhism.^ Wo may also, with equal right, regard it as a translation from an ancient Sanskrit work, on account of the occurring of the title in Sanskrit. The personal names of the Buddhas, and the Ti- betan terms explained in the notes, are given in exact transliteration, and are not reprinted in the Glossary OF Tibetan Terms, Appendix B., if they occur in the text; the native spelling of the other words may be looked for in this Glossary. Translation of the first part. “In the Sanskrit language'^ .... Keverence be to the ' For the characteristic signs of a Mahayana Sutra, see Burnouf, “Intro- duction,” p. 121. ^ The Sutras Phal-po-chhe and Rim-pa-inga which are referred to for particulars concerning several Buddhas, are contained in the Kanjur. ^ My original is injured in this place, and the Sanskrit name cannot be read. — It is a curious custom, differing from translations in European languages, that books which have been translated from the Sanskrit have fre- quently two titles, the Sanskrit and the Tibetan one. Some larger works of the Kanjur also receive an additional title in the Tibetan dialect called Dulva zhi, “the basis of religious discipline.” See Csoma, “Analysis,” As. Res., Yol. XX., p. 44. 12G ADDRESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. very spotless Buddhas, who all came in the same way.' In Tibetan; Repentance of all sins” (or sdig-pa-tham.s- chad-^shags-par). “I adore the Tathagatas of the three periods,^ who dwell in the ten quarters of the world, ^ the subduers of the enemy, the very pure and perfect Buddhas, (I adore) 1 In the original, Na-mo-sarva-bi-ma-la-ta-tha-ga-ta-bud-dha; the words are all Sankrit. Tathagata, in Tibetan De-6zhin, or more fully De-6zhin-^shegs-pa, an epithet of the Buddhas who have appeared upon earth, implying that they have gone in the manner of their predecessors. Comp. pp. 4, 1.5. — In the sequel I shall translate De-tzhin-^rshegs-pa by its Sanskrit equivalent Tathagata, the literal rendering of the passage making the phrase incon- veniently long. Similar sentences begin religious treatises ; the Kanjur e. la-ma), a distinction strictly belonging only to the superiors of convents. The Gelongs must not care for riches or worldly prosperity; their breaking down inhabited places may mean, perhaps, their fighting against other monasteries or against rich men in general. * In Tibetan sngags-pa, one versed in 'charms. * In Tibetan i/yang-’gugs; a ceremony of this nature will be noticed in a subsequent chapter. The allusion here is to the abuse of it as a substitute for prayers. ® Boii-po is the name of the followers of the sect which adheres in the closest manner to the superstitious ideas transferred from the earlier Tibetan creed; comp. p. 74. 138 ADDEESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. chief; * when the learned and poor (= the priests) live in and preside over the nunneries;^ when the Zhanglons^ amuse themselves with their daughters-in-law; when men destroy (eat) the meat destined for the manes of the dead; when the head Lamas eat the meat prepared for offerings;^ when men' cut themselves off from the vital principle (commit suicide^); when bad actions increase upon earth; when the song Mani shall be returned in answer;® when the calves of the Dzo^ breed shall devastate (the fields); when men covet the goods of others; when the saints® travel and establish trade; * Dge-bsh.es, abreviated from dge-bai-6shes-^nyen,‘ in Sanskrit Kalyanamitra, meaning a learned priest, a friend to virtue. It is bardly necessary to say that the functions of a military chief do not agree very well with the clerical character. - The pi'iests are not allowed to have intercourse, with women, but the violation of this precept is but too probable by their dwelling under the same roof with nuns. 3 Zhang, “a maternal-uncle;” ?;lou, “a magistrate, an officer, a nobleman;” the two words in connexion designate a man of superior rank. The Tibetan has zan, which is explained in the dictionaries as “meat, a kind of thick potage, dough, or paste made of the meal or flour of parched grains.” As an instance of its use for food in general see the details in Hermann’s “Glossary,” *•. v. Zankhar, in Vol. III., of the “Results,” &c., and R. A. Soc., 1862. * Deliverance from existence is only the consequence of good actions; but suicide is also in the opinion of the Buddhists a bad action, and has a re-birth in a lower degree as one of its consequences, since the sins for the expiation of which the present existence had to be endured, are not yet atoned for, and also a new crime is committed. In the period of misery alluded to in the text, however, also this moral law will be overlooked. ® By Mani the famous six-syllable prayer Om mani padme hum, “0, the Jewel in the Lotus: Amen,” is to be understood; the allusion in the text refers to its conversion into a popular song. ^ WiDzo, a mixed breed, the ofi'spring of a Yak (bos gruniens) and a common common Indian Zhebu cow; in the language of the Himalaya tribes it is called Chubu. The Dzos are one of the few mi.xed species which are capable of propagation, and they outnumber in some valleys the pure Yaks. * In Tibetan nal-jor, in Sanskrit Yogilcharya, “a saint, a devotee,” is also the name of a religious sect, which enjoyed the most favour in India until the seventh century a.d. — Respecting its history and religious tenets, see Chapter V. TRANSLATION OF THE SECOND PART. 139 when fraud is committed with measure^ and weight; when the Chinese trade with little children (which they would obtain from the Tibetans); when under the gates (of the temples) illnsory miracles (sorcery) shall be practised; when men eat and drink and care but for this actual existence ; when there shall be no more gratuities; when the time shall arrive that old customs are disturbed (changed); when men shall be given up to the ravages of war and the enemy; when frost, hail, and drought shall spread (make general) famine;^ when men and animal beings shall have to suffer from bad actions:^ then, in this period of distress and misery this sDig-6shags-^ter-chhos will be an ablution for every kind of sin which has been accumnlated in the meantime; all animated beings shall read it, and on account of it all sins shall be wiped away.”^ Translation of the second part. “Enshrined in the sacred box at the time of the nttering of benedictions.^ “In this period of distress and misery, when many ' The Tibetan bre, also pronounced pre, is, according to Csoma’s Dictionary, “a dry measure, the twentieth part of a Tibetan bushel.” ^ Some words are here illegible. ^ For the Buddhist theory on the influence of good and bad actions upon well-being, see p. 93. * The last four lines of the original text have been so much injured that only a few of the words could be deciphered, enough, however, remaining to give a clue to the meaning. ’ With reference to the religious rites and ceremonies connected with the erection of Chortens, see Chapter XIII. 140 ADDKESS TO THE BUDDHAS OF CONFESSION. living’ beings shall suffer and sigh for deliverance, these benedictions shall afford great advantages to sinners. The sins which arise from discord and dispute among the inhabitants of this monastery^ shall be taken away througli them. “These blessings, if recited on the 8th, 15th, and 30th of every month, purify most surely from the five great crimes,' and from all sins, and deliver from the six kinds of hell. The 84,000 great emblems of the essence of the sublime doctrine shall be the same with every being. ^ The mind of man shall become unchangeably directed towards attaining the sanctity of a Buddha; he shall gain the energetic will of the Buddha, and shall in the end obtain the advantages of a Buddha himself. “This is the end of the Mahayana Sutra sUig-6shags- ^ser-gyis-spu-gri. “All beings be blessed!” * The name of the monastery is not given in the original, which only says, r/gon-pa “a monastery”. ^ The five great crimes of the Buddhists are: 1. The taking of life; 2. Theft; 3- Adultery; 4. Lying; 5. Drunkenness. See Burnouf, “Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 447; Hardy, “Manual of Buddhism,” Chapter X., p. 488. * This phrase refers, as may be seen from the sequel, to the inferior signs of a Buddha’s beauty. They are generally stated to be 80 in number, but other books, as c. g. the Rgya-chher-rol-pa (translated by Foucaux, Vol. II., p. 108) give 84, which, in the present treatise, have been multiplied by 1000. The number of 84,000 is a most favourite one in Buddhist cosmogony and seems to be used in the same way as Khrag-khrig, “a hundred thousand millions” (p. 130), and the Chinese Wan, or 10,000 (Ideler, “Ueber die Zeitrechnung der Chiucsen,” p. 10), as the designation of an infinite number. The extent, thickness, and diameter of the sakwalas can always be divided by 8; the prolongation of the age of mankind continues for 84,000 years. Sec Hardy, “Manual,” Chapter L; Foe koue ki, p. 127. TEANSLATIOX OF THE SECOND PAET. 141 (Tliree Dhavanis, in corrupt Sanskrit, now follow. The first DharanI is a mystic invocation of Dorjesempa, Sanskrit Vajrasattva (see p. 50); in the second DharanI is condensed the belief in the four truths (see p. 16); the third Dha- ranI is recited at the inauguration of the temples; now the text continues; ‘ “By means of these invocations the creatures become perfect in the two collections;'^ they shall be purified from their sins and blessed with the dignity of a most perfect Buddha. (A fourth DharanI follows). “This (DharanI) is raised (granted) as a favour^ to the wanderers in the orb for not having paid reverence to parents — instead of thankfully remembering favours received — nor to the holy Foundation-Lamas,^ who have obtained perfection by virtues. “All sins committed by taking life, together with the transgressions accumulated in previous existences, the sins of lying, envy, and wickedness which proceed from the mind — all these sins are abolished by this sublime doctrine. “Most perfect Sages, be gracious and clement, if I should not have rendered rightly the letters of the * The transcription of these three Dharanis has been omitted from con- siderations of brevity. ^ In Tibetan ts'hogs-gmyis; by this term is understood the combination of the highest perfection in the practice of virtues, and the highest degree of wisdom, both of which are reserved for the Buddhas ; but simple men can attain this sublimest rank by following the path revealed by Sakyamuni and his acknowledged predecessors. ’ It delivers from the sins specified. ‘ In Tibetan rtsa-vai-61a-ma ; in a foregoing passage they were styled hla-ma-dam-pa-hrgyud. See p. 13G. 142 ADDRESS OF THE BUDDHAS TO CONFESSION. alphabet.' Mi-rgan-sde-//sal-rdo-rje has WTitten it. Praised be this sheet, that he may gain entire deliverance from his sins. This sDig-ishags-r/ser-gyis-spu-gi’i has been com- pleted in two days.” ' For explanation of this sentence 1 refer to p. 5G. To face p. 142. Plate V to VIII. rs o 9 Ph o h-H < cc c < C CT) 'Tj W < 't? if '►8 tf fr) k k Ir k Ir ^rtr i/ ffir B“ U tT «> k 1/ ir ,k ►e cf h~ j?D k !■’?■ «)) fb M" cmf u for p /'ir B" ir B" /'cr B" Iff" k i7 F Iff" w k >7 /'jr k jff" k fi) If? k M" fk ir Lf cr) /B" Lf p- k B" /PT B" Iff" fcT' C7 !7 b L/ if »€ cf cf k 'f if cp k »B}) k If ir hT B3? cf u p If? Iff" K> p fB" k B" Vp» k i«7 k W" B" ir- if fcT' if pi) ir F k i7 F k «ri?^ k /'Hlf S-«r p k B" /PT . B" Iff" tfcr P" Jff" Iff" 'le F k rtJ5> B" fpF h/ lf> if ftff- tb k )R2> k If ir B^ FT) k k k tpD Ic-? Iff" n if fp- cb k k Lf ir ('Z' iff" 1-k if m p k Iff" if fc<- >e /'•r fE5) If? /■." p k B" /'PT B^ Iff" fcT' p /Ir Iff" k k ^rt€ cf b p) k k b puf <^cf Iff" "le F k )B> fb p k B" /■R- B" b ccr- 17 Iff" k b /'F ? HT 7 if fc<- fb k IB5) k If ir Lf i?K" ir p k i7 Hff" I? k B" /'rr B~ b ctr- p /'Ir b If nr f 7 4 Lf 6C<" fb k If 5 > k If ir "le cf H le cf b p) k iF rtj> k Lf rr) jT /b if /'p k k B" /R" B" b p k k IB)) ic^ b 6PT iF tr p b? tb ir rjir cb J-ie k k B" /'R- B" b 6C«" p /'Ir Iff" p cf ir ir ir 17 cf ir cf ir If ir 5 -p k te cf b > 7 > lT /nr lb V ib i — ? w ir f'cf ^F Ir p if ip" cb k IB> k Lf ir ir i» k f7 cr M" / Ei- i7 ir p lb hf F k k B^ /'R^ B^ b /:c<" p /Ir !-p k 'lei p b p) k i-k /rp k IB)) k If ir B" ir b 3 b ir "le p b p) k ir k B" E? p k ^F IB}) cb k If IT) ir ifP^ M" B" fcf p b ir k B" ^pD if /'ire" i_r cp- W" i Iff" if (fb p b 6t<" k b Flf p rb IB}) k *Lf ir rir F k IB}) If ir b IB}) ,ir 1-E_ cf k If ir i-F IB}) 'le. cf ir 'Ilf i7 B" iri) F 6E}> ir cb fk if /;p- fb k IB}) !-F F 'le cf ir 1*^ ir F ir nr b w k >7 cr b If k IB> k If ir B" i^ tif k F ^F ^ • H (fin) F PART II. • ■ 4 - CHAPTER XII. THE TIBETAN PRIESTHOOD. Materials contained in Reports of European Travellers. — Fundamental Laws. — Hierarchical System. — Organisation of the Clergy. — Principles of its constitution. — Revenues. — Grades amongst the Lamas. — Number of Lamas. — Occupations. — Diet. — Dress. ’ Reports of European Travellers. By Lamaism Europeans designate that peculiar form of Buddhism which developed itself from Tsonkhapa’s institutions in Tibet and soon spread over all Central Asia, where it took deep root. Our knowledge of this most modern form of Buddhism is also of no long date ; for to penetrate into Tibet was always a matter of great difficulty, both on account of the impediments presented by the general great elevation of the country, as also by the jealous and hostile feelings of the natives towards foreigners. The supremacy gradually obtained by the Chinese Government has but increased the difficulty; 10 146 THE TIBETAN PEIESTIIOOI). even quite recently it has proved its hostile disposition, notwithstanding the treaties signed after the last war in Chinad The tirst Europeans who penetrated into Tibet were Christian missionaries. In the year 1624 a Jesuit, Pater Antonio de Andrada, travelled as far as Chabrang, the capital of the Giige district of Gnari Khorsum, the Eaja, or Gyalpo, of which was very favourably inclined towards him. The first who reached Lhassa, the centre of the Lamaic church, were the Jesuits Albert Dorville and Johann Gruber, who, in 1661, returned from China via Tibet and Hindostan to Europe. The next who followed them were the Capucine patres Josepho de Asculi and Francisco Maria de Toun, who started from Bengal in the year 1706 and safely reached Lhassa. In 1716 the Jesuit Desideri again penetrated up to Lhassa from the west, through Kashmir and Ladak. The miost important event for our knowledge of Tibetan Buddhism was the Capucine mission under the superintendance of Horacio de la Penna, who, with five companions, arrived at Lhassa in the year 1741; their efforts to propagate the Christian faith had but little success, though they were kindly received by the Tibetan authorities. They collected much valualJe information concerning the geography of the country and the history, religion, manners and customs of the inhabitants. Horacio de la Penna was particnlarly distimruished bv an ardent zeal in the cause of Christianitv; ’ 1 allude to the case of Capt. Smyth, for whom no passports could be obtained; and of Capt. Blackiston, who was obliged to return in the first weeks after his setting out from the shores of China to reach Tibet through China. RErORTS OF EUROPEAN TRAVELLERS. 147 he translated into Tibetan a catechism of the Christian faith, the Doctrina Christiana of Cardinal Belarmino, the Thesanrns Doctrinae Christianae of Tnrlot, and he also compiled a Tibetan -Italian dictionary. The materials brought home by this mission, which a few years after- wards was obliged to leave Lhassa, were examined b}" Pater Antonio Georgi, who in his curious “Alphabetum Tibetanum.” Eomfe 1702, undertook to prove by com- l)arative philology the opinion entertained by the mis- sionaries, that Lamaism was a corrupted form of (.'hristianity. In the year 1811 Manning, according to Princep, made an attempt to pass through Tibet into China; but he was stopped at Lhassa, and not being permitted to go any farther, he was obliged to turn back.^ Li 1845 two Lazarist missionaries. Hue and Gabet, again reached Lhassa from Mongolia ; but after a short sta}', they also had to leave this capital, and were escorted to Macao by a Chinese officer. Since the commencement of this century various journeys have been undertaken into Bhutan, Sikkim, and the western districts adjoining the British territories. Particularly precious are also the publications of Pallas, ' Ritter, “Die Erdkunde von Asien,” Vol. II-,pp. 439-04. H. Princep, “Tibet, Tartarv and Mongolia,” London 185’i, p. 17. For an interesting collection of the views of various missionaries on this subject see Marsden’s note to “iMarco Polo’s Travels,” p. 240. The Popes had hoped the Capucine mission would prove of very great importance for the propagation of Christianity in Central Asia, and had supported them in every way. Pojie Clemens IX. issued a parti- cular Breve concerning Tibet (Ritter, 1. c., p. 459), and the nomination of a Vicarius apostolicus for Lhassa still takes place. The “Annuario Pontificio,” Roma 1862, p. 243, gives as the gentleman in charge of this office Monsignore Giacomo Leone Thomine Demazures, nominated March 27, 1846; he is at the same time the Bishop in partihus ivfideliitm of Sinopolis in Cilicia. 10* 148 THE TIBETAN BEIESTHOOH. detailing the information obtained by him in llnssian Mongolia ; and those of Klaproth — his translation of the description of Tibet by a Chinese officer, as well as the results of his investigations connected with his travels in the regions of the Kaukasus. All the various narra- tives treat principally of the hierarchical system, the regulations and social habits of the clergy and the re- ligious establishments ; the notices on religious ceremonies are very rare. In addition to the above-mentioned sources of information, which have been laid under con- tribution in my endeavour to define, in the following chapters, the nature and characteristics of the Tibetan priesthood and the institutions connected therewith, I have also been enabled to turn to good account the observations made by my brothers during their travels in the Eastern Himalaya and in Central and Western Tibet, in the years 1855 to 1857. Fundamental laws. It is very probable that in the earliest periods of Buddhism all those who embraced this religion, abandoned the world and assisted their master, as much as lay in their power, in propagating his faith. Those who, after having heard Sakyamuni explain his doctrines, desired to become Buddhists, were first obliged to make an ex- plicit declaration 4o that effect, whereupon the teacher proceeded to cut off their hair and beard, and then in- vested them with the religious garments, whereby they were received into the community of the faithful. Later, THE LAITY AND THE PKIESTS. 149 Avhen the number of Buddhists had increased, the neophite ^vas placed for instruction under the charge of an elder disciple, a practice which became general after Sakya- muni’s death. The distinction between lay brothers and priests, and the important dogma that only the latter, as having renounced the world, can obtain Nirvana, was certainly not introduced till after Sakyamuni’s death, although he himself had recognized mendicants, the receivers of alms, who are forbidden to eat other food than that which has been received under certain con- ditions (one being that it has been given in the form of alms); and householders, the givers of alms, who thereby gain merit; but by him both these classes were admitted with equal rights to the advantages promised to his followers. But already the earlier schools (the Hinayana sect) excluded lay brothers from attaining to the per- fection of an Arhat, and to Nirvana ; the Mahayana system admits them, but the present sects of Tibet again raised that strongly marked barrier between the laity and the priests, denying to the former the possibility of attaining to the rank of a Buddha; they may attain Nirvana, but they cannot become “a blessing to the world.” ^ The ascetics are styled in the sacred books Bhikshus, Sramanas, Sravakas, Arhats; and the lay followers, the devotees, Upasakas (in Tibetan Genyen); in the Mahayana Sutras the latter are also called “ Bbdhisattvas who reside in their houses,” the former “Bodhisattvas who have re- nounced the world.” * See pp. 27, 38, 106. Compare also Hodgson, “Illustrations,” p. 98. Hardy, “Eastern Monaeliism,” p. 12. 150 THE TIBETAN PEIESTHOOD. The early disciples of Sakyamiiiii are generally re- presented as wandering about with their royal master; others, in consequence of his frequent exhortations to lead a solitary life, are said to have retired to the forests and woods which surround the settlements, or to have lived in solitary and forsaken houses, which they only left on certain periods in order to betake themselves to Sclkyamuni and listen to his words. Large regular as- semblies, which probably date back as far as Sakyamuni himself, took place when the rainy season was over; during the rains Sakyamuni himself, as well as his im- mediate followers and the hermit - disciples, had taken up their abode in the houses of well-intentioned persons, and had devoted themselves to meditations on such parts of the doctrine as the}^ had not yet clearly understood; they also employed part of their time in the instruction of their entertainers. At the assemblies above men- tioned the Bhikshus reported their success in gaining neophites, discussed various dogmas, and requested a solution of any doubts with which they may have been troubled. Original^ such assemblies were held in the open air; the Viharas, in the sense of monasteries, in which they might otherwise have taken place, did not come into existence till a much later period. The word Yihara, according to its etymological derivation, denotes a place where the Buddhists assembled; and it is in this sense that this term is used in the Sutras, or books eonsidered to contain the words of Sidcyaumni, which always begin thus ; “When Sakya happened to be (viharati sma) at a place;” OEIGIN OF MONASTIC INSTITUTIONS. 151 but later tliis name \vas applied to these houses in which the priests met, and where strangers and the ascetics (who went about collecting alms) found an asylum. The meaning of the word became more restricted still, and was subsequently given to monasteries only, or to those religious establishments, in which those who once enter them are bound to remain for life. It is impossible to determine exactly the yaiious periods during which Yiharas took the form of meeting-houses or, later, of monasteries. In the Hmayana books on discipline they are mentioned only as an appendix to the chapter on the seats, and they were probably erected later than the tem^iles, the first of which is said to have been built in the period of Upagupta, who lived in the third century b.c. The violent attacks of the Bralimans must soon have convinced the Buddhist clergy of the advan- tages to be derived from association; rules were then drawn up for life in community and for subordination, and the beginning of monastic institutions was thus made, which latter were, however, in India, even in their final perfection, widely different from those of Tibetan mon- achism at the present day. In earlier times each Vihara had its own administration and its own chief, and was independent of the others; and it was so even in the seventh centuiw, when Hiuen Thsang resided in India; a hierarchy so thoroughly organized as we now find in Tibet, was never known in India.' ' See Burnouf, “Introduction,” pp. 232 seq., 279 seq., 2S6; Hardy, “Eastern Mouaehisin,’' Chapter HI., IV'., XIII.; VV'^assiljew, “Her Bud- dhisnms,'* pp. -15, 9G. Couipare also Barthclmy St. Hilaire, “Le Bouddha 152 THE TIBETAK PEIESTHOOI), Hierarchical system. The first organisation of the Tibetan clergy dates from King Thisrong de tsan (728 — 86 a.d.), of whom the Bodhimor says that “he gave the clergy a firm consti- tution and divided it into classes.” ^ But the development of the present hierarchical system, which was independent of these ancient institutions, dates from the fifteenth century. In 1417 the famous Lama Tsonkhapa founded the Gcildan monastery at Lhassa, and became its superior ; the great authority and reputation he had enjo}"ed, devolved upon his successors in the abbotship of this monastery, who, down to the present day, are believed to have been men of particular sanctity. But these abbots were soon superseded in influence by the Dalai Lama^ at Lhassa (now the highest in rank of the Ti- betan priesthood), and by the Panchen Kinpoche at Tashilhunpo, ^ who are both considered to be of divine et sa religion,” p. 299. Wilson, “Buddha and Buddliism,” p. 251. The principal cave temples were probably excavated in the period from the commencement of the Christian era to the fifth century after it. It needs hardly be added that the sacred books which represent Sakyamuni himself to have felt the necessity of instituting head priests are interpolated. * Schmidt, “Ssanang Ssetsen,” p. 356; comp. p. 67. ^ Dalai Lama is the title which the Mongolians give to him; Dalai is a Mongolian word meaning ocean. Lama or correctly hlama, is the Tibetan word for a superior. Schott, “ Ueber den Buddhaismus in Hochasien,” p. 32. The Europeans became familiar with this term from the works of Georgi, Pallas and Klaproth. ^ Tashilhiinpo, or in exact transliteration: “5khra shis Ihun po,” is the neighbouring city of chiefly ecclesiastical establishments, about a mile to the south east of Digarchi, “the four-housed (top ?) ” (in Tibetan written 5zhi-ka-rtse, in Kevari zhi-kha-chhen), the capital of the province Tsang, of Chinese Tibet. See the map of Turner, “Embassy;” Hooker, “Himalayan Journals,” Vol. II., pp. 125, 171. Hodgson, “Aborigines of the Nilgiris.” Journ. As, Soc. Beng., Vol. XXV., p. 504. DALAI lama; TAXCHEN lllNPOCliE. 158 origin, and are, consequently, regarded more in the light of gods than of mortal beings. This assumed divine origin gives them a character totally different from that of the Pope of the Roman Catholic church; but then, on the other hand, neither of them has such a wddely-spread acknowledged supremacy as that enjoyed by the Pope of Rome. The Dalai Lama is viewed as an incarnation of the Dhyani Bodhisattva Chenresi, who is supposed to effect his re-incorporation by a beam of light which issues from his body and enters the individual whom he selects for his re-descent.^ The PancJien Rinpoche is considered to be an incarnation of Chenresi’s celestial father, Ami- tabha.^ There is a story relating that Tsonkhapa himself liad ordered his two principal disciples to take upon them- selves a mortal form in an uninterrupted series of re- births, and to watch over the propagation of the Buddhist faith and the maintenance of its purity;^ and according to this account, it was Tsonkhapa who created these two principal clerical dignities. But we learn from Csoma’s Chronological Tables, that Gedun Grub (born 1389 a.d. died 1473) was the first, who assumed the title of Gyelva Rinpoche, “His precious Majesty,” which is applied to the Dalai Lama only; Gedun Grub is, therefore, to be considered the first Dalai Lama, and not the Dharma Rinchen, the successor of Tsonkhapa in the chair of the Galdan monastery. In the year 1445 he ' “Description du Tubet,” Nouv. Journ. Asiatique 1830, p. 23D. Comp. p. 88. ^ See about the dogma of Dhyani Buddhas and Bodhisattvas, p. 51. * “Arbcitcn der russ. Mission in Peking,” Vol. I., p. 310. 154 THE TIBETAN I’BIESTHOOD. also built the large monastery of Tashihinpo, whose abbots assumed the title of I’anchen Rinpoche, “the great teacher-jewel,” and who claimed with much success the same divine nature and temporal power as that till then enjoyed by the Dalai Lama alone. He shares an equal authority and sovereignty as the Dalai Lama, but in ecclesiastical affairs, even in his own territories, his words are considered less divine, his faculties inferior to those of the Dalai Lama. The fifth Gyelva Rinpoche, NgagvangLobzangGyamtso, a most ambitious man, sent to the Koshot Mongolians, who had settled in the environs of the lake Kuku Nor, and requested their assistance against the Tibetan king then residing at Digarchi, with whom he was at war. The Mongolians conquered Tibet, and are said to have made a present of the same to Ngagvang Lobzang. This event took place in the year 1640, and it is from this moment that we must date the extension of the temporal government of the Dalai Lamas over all Tibet.' The Dalai Lamas are elected by the clergy, and up to the year 1792 these elections had taken place unin- ffuenced by the Chinese government; but since this time the court of Pekin, to whom the Dalai Lama is a very important })ersonage in a }>olitical as well as a religious point of view, has taken care that the sons of such per- ‘ Csoma, “Graihmar,” jip. 192, 198. Ritter, “Asien,” Yol. 111., pp. 27i-86. Koppeii, “ Die Kel. d. Buddha,” Vol. II., pp. 129-52. Cunniiighara, ‘-Ladak,” p.389, has understood Csoma’s account as if in the year l(J4t) the Jirtt Dalai Lama had been established, but Csoma decidedly only alludes to the uniting of the temporal government with his ecclesiastical sovereignity. KIIAXl’OS AUBOTS. 15f) sons only as are known I’or their loyality and fidelity shall be elected to this high dignity/ The next in rank to these snbliine Lamas are the superiors of several larget monasteries, of whom some are considered as incarnations, others as common mortals; in either case head Lamas of so high a rank are styled Khanpos.' My brothers saw Khanpos at the monasteries of Liima Yuru in Ladak, and at Tholing in Gnari Xhorsimi. They were natives of Lhassa, and had been appointed by the Dalai Lama’s government for periods of from three to six years, at the expiration of which time they would return to Lhassa. The abbots in smaller monasteries are elected for life by the monks; but the election has to be submitted for approval to the Dalai Lama, who can either sanction or reject it. Other persons superior in rank to the common monks are the Budzad, the superintendent of the choral songs and music during the divine service; and the Gebkoi, who has to maintain discipline and order. These dignitaries are also elected by the monks, and constitute, with the abbot, the council which regulates the affairs of the monastery. Some other dignities which are occasionally * Compare for details Hue, "‘Souvenirs,” Vol. I., p. 2‘J2. Koppen, 1. c., p. 247. ^ In Bhutan the incarnated Khanpos had profited by political circum- stances to make themselves independent of the Dalai Lama. The relations between the ruler of Bhutan proper, the Dharma Rinpoche (called by the Hindus Dharma Raja), and Lhassa seem to be very loose ; and the abbots of the monasteries in the southern valleys have also set up principalities almost independent of the Dharma Rinpoche. These Lamas, styled Lama Rajas by Hermann’s companions, arc very jealous of their power, and endeavoured most cnergically to prevent Hermann from entering Bhutan, by abducting his servants. 15G THE TIBETAN PB,IESTHOOD. found in larger monasteries are mere posts of honour, having no direct influence upon the administration.^ The title of Lama, written in Tibetan Wama, is ap- plied by right to the superior priests only; but just as the Arabic word Sheikh, and other titles of honour and rank in European languages, so also the word Lama has come to be regarded as a title which courtesy requires one to give to every Buddhist priest.^ A particular class of Lamas are the astrologers, the Tsikhan (occasionally also styled Kartsi-pa, or Chakhan = fortune-teller, Ngagpa = one expert in charms), who are allowed to marry and to wear a peculiar phantastic dress. These people are professional fortune-tellers, who are officially authorized to conjure and to exorcise evil spirits, on behalf of and to the profit of the clergy. Common tricks, such as vomiting fire, swallowing knives, &c., are not openly practised, nor would they be allowed, though in other things these conjurers are permitted to play upon the credulity of the ignorant multitude to any extent, and derive as much profit therefrom as they can. The instruments which they most frequently employ in their incantations, are an arrow and a triangle upon which supposed talismanic sentences are inscribed.^ Amongst these astrologers, the Lamas called Choichong, who are said to be all educated at the Garmakhya monastery at * Compare Pallas, “Mongol. Volkcr,” Vol. II., pp. 1 17-37. Hue, “Souvenirs,” 11. i2‘J7. - Compare Hardy, “Eastern IMonachism,” p. 11. Gerard, “Koonawur,” p. Ill), states that he heard the head priests of the monasteries styled Gelong or Guru. ’ For partieulars coneerning eertain eeremonies in which these things are used, sec Chapter XV. THE GOD CHOICHONO. 157 Lliassa, enjoy the greatest reputation, because the god Choichong, or Choichong gyalpo, is supposed to become in- corporated in one of the Lamas belonging to this monastery as often as he descends upon earth. His re-descent becomes manifest by the frequency of miraculous deeds jierformed by a Lama, who is then considered as the favourite instrument chosen by king Choichong. He soon becomes the object of universal worship, which is most lucrative to the monastery; for Buddhists from all parts of High Asia come as pilgrims to Lhassa to receive his benediction; and they consider themselves happy if the valuable presents they offer as an equivalent, are accepted by the incarnate Choichong. — In the monasteries beyond Tibet Choichong astrologers are not frequent; and though the images of king Choichong are met with in most monasteries of Western Tibet and the Himalaya, my brothers never saw a Lama Choichong. ‘ The god Choichong is but one of the “five great kings,” in Tibetan Ku nga gyalpo. These five mytho- logical persons are considered to protect man most effi- caciously against the evil spirits and enable him also to attain the accomplishment of every wish. Their names are Bihar gyalpo; Choichong gyalpo; Dalha gyalpo; Luvang gyalpo; Tokchoi gyalpo. Of Bihar I know par- ticularly that he has chosen the protection of monasteries * Compare “Description du Tubet,” Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., pp. 240, 293. The offerings which are the most agreeable to these kings, and the conditions under which they are to be presented, are detailed in the Ti- betan book entitled Ku nga gyalpoi kang shag, “to make confession to the five great kings.” Of Choichong in particular treats the book Prulku choichong chenpoi Kang shag “to make confession to the incarnation of the great Choichong.” 158 THE TIBETAN PlilESTIIOOH. and roligious establishments; of Dalha that he is the tutelary god of warriors. The images of the five gods are very generally met with in temples and in the private praying -room of laymen: amulet -boxes also not nnfi'equently contain sncli representations. They are also added to an imao’e of the thirtv-five Buddhas of O « confession (see p. 97), in which they are drawn riding phantastic animals. Bihar is riding a red tiger ; Choichong a yellow lion ; Dalha a yellow horse (Khyang) ; Lnvang, the god of the IS^agas (see p. 31), a blue crocodile; Tockchoi a yellow deer. In other pictures, in which one of these gods is the principal object, this very one is drawn on a larger scale than the surrounding figures. Such a picture, bought by Adolphe at Mangnang, in Gnari Khorsum. shows Choichong extremel}" fat and three- headed, riding a white lion with a blue mane; the figure is surrounded by flames.” His side heads are blue and crimson, the central one is, like the body, of flesh- colour. His broad hat and some arms, the symbols of his activity, are gilt; his dress is a tiger’s skin; of which tlie feet are tied round his neck. In the upper part of the picture various domestic animals are sketched, allud- ing to the great merit to be derived from consecrating to him an animal, which then is no more allowed to be killed for private use, but after some time is delivered to the Lamas, who may eat it. Below him are traced three other defenders of man against the mischievous spirits, viz. : Damchan dorje legpa, riding on a camel : Tsangpa, in Sanskrit Brahma (see p. 1 1 4), riding a ram ; Chebu damchan. ridino- a ffoat. CELIBACY, rOYEETY. 150 Organization of the clergy. The principles of its Constitution. Tlie number of obser- vances to be followed, at the present day, by the Lamas, has increased, from ])recepts plain and brief, to an ample code of laws, which contains two hundred and fifty rules, in Tibetan Khrims: they are detailed in the first, or Dulva division of the Kanjur, and have been explained in the well-known works of Hardy and Bur- nonf. ‘ But of this mass of precepts, I direct the atten- tion chiefly to those of celibacy and poverty (which Tsonkhapa enacted anew), because they have been of great imjiortance in forming the present character of the Tibetan priesthood. The violation of the ordinance of celibacy, or even sexual intercourse, is severely punished; nevertheless it is not unfreqnent, particularly in the case of Lamas who do not live in the monasteries. Besides, we know of two in- stances in which, from considerations of public interest, the Dalai Lama has gTanted indulgences to marry to Lamas of royal pedigree. The one instance is reported by Dr. Campbell, who says that a prince of Sikkim obtained this jiermission ; another analogous case is noticed by Moorcroft concerning the Baja of Ladak.^ The vow of ' Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” London 1850. Burnouf, “Introduction,” pp. 234-335. Comp. Csoma’s “Analysis,” in As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 78. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVIII., p. 494. Travels, Vol. I., p. 334. There is a sect in Chinese Tibet which P. Hilarion calls Sa zsya; it allows its priests to marry, and to beget a son, whereupon they abandon their wives and retire into the monasteries. “Arbeiten der russ. Mission,” Vol. I., p. 314. 160 THE TIBETAN PEIESTHOOl). poverty is one of those institutions which seriously affect the public welfare in Tibet, as the monks, so very numerous in every Buddhist country, have to live from the contributions of the lay population. Though the single Lama who has renounced the world is not allowed to possess any thing besides the articles permitted by the code of discipline, the Lama convents may possess landed property, houses, and treasures, and its members may enjoy the abundance of its well-filled store-houses. The revenues are derived from the collecting of alms, from voluntary offerings, from the remunerations for the performance of sacred rites, from the rents of properties, and even from commercial enterprises. Alms are more particularly collected at harvest time, when a number of Lamas are deputed to visit the villages for the purpose of begging for grain. When Hermann was at Hfmis (in Sept. 1856) more than one half of the Lamas were out in the country. Of voluntary offerings the most considerable are those presented to an in- carnated Lama, or given at the annual festivals.^ The greater number of smaller ones are obtained by those monasteries situated along the principal passages over the mountains, as it is the custom for every traveller to repeat some prayers in the temples he meets with, and to leave a small present. The remunerations for attending at births, marriages, illnesses, death, &c., are generally regulated by the officiating priest himself in proportion to the means of those requiring their service. These consist generally in natural products, which apj)ear ' See an example in Turner's Embassy, p. 34;'). GEADES AMONGST THE LAMAS. Kil to be given in advance.* The landed property, which is sometimes even veiy considerable, is either tilled by the dependents, or is let at a high price. The making and selling of images, charms, &c., is another source of considerable income for every Lama; their trading with wool, and in Eastern Tibet with musk, is mentioned by several travellers.' Grades amongst the Lamas. In Tibet the clergy, besides living at the public expense, are also in most districts free from taxes ^ and contributions for public works; and it is on account of these and other advantages that the condition and dignity of a Lama are every where so sought after. It is the custom in Eastern, as well as in Western Tibet, to make the elder son of a family a Lama, and restrictive regula- tions, analogous to those mentioned in the ancient religious books, seem to have lost their force; for all travellers report that any one can become a member of the religious order; the only restriction I know of is this, that in Bhutan the father who wdshes his son to be received as a novice must ask the permission of the Deba and the Dharma Baja, and pay a fee of 100 Deba rupees.^ When any one declares his wish to enter the priesthood, or when he desires to make his son a Lama, the faculties of the novice are examined. In most cases the novices * As an instance of this custom I mention the ceremonies connected with the driving away of the evil spirits from the burial-ground (see Chapter XV., Xo. 9). See also Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., p. 121. See Turner, 1. c., pp. 200, 312. Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. II., p. 61; “Mansaraur Lake,” As. Res., Vol. XII., p. 432. ^ In Ladak, however, the monasteries as such are taxed with considerable sums by the Kashmir government; Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 273. * Pemberton, “Report,” p. 118. Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 277. Turner, “Embassy,” p. 170 Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., p. 321. 102 THE TIBETAX PEIESTHOOD. are boys, and if they are found intelligent enough, they are allowed to take the vows (Tib. Dom), viz. to observe the religious duties connected with the priesthood; and then they become “candidates for orders,” Genyen (an equivalent to the Sanskrit Upasaka).^ The Lamas who have charge of the instruction of the novices, seem not always to treat their scholars well, for several travellers have witnessed rudeness and even cruelty in punishments.^ The grade next to the Genyen is that of Getsul ; an ordinated priest is styled a Gelong; the grades are conferred by a council, before which the candidate has to prove in a public disputation his experience in the sciences he has been taught hitherto.^ Women are also allowed to embrace the monastic life, and we read of female mendicants, the Bhikshums, who have devoted themselves already in the earliest youth of Buddhism with the permission of the founder to an ascetic life. The nuns are styled Gelong-ma in Tibetan; in Western Tibet, however, and in the Himalaya they cannot be very numerous, for m3' brothers never saw any great number of them.^ The clergy are monastic; the greater part of the priests reside in monasteries, others are allowed to live as clergymen in the villages for the convenience of the population, who so frequently require their assistance. • See p. 140. ^ See Dr. Hooker, “Himalayan Journals,” Vol. II., j). 93. Hue, “ Souvenirs,” Vol. I., p. 299. '■* Compare p. 21. ■* Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 278. Hardy, “Eastern Monacliism,” p. 150. tierard, “Kanawur,” p. 120, was told that it is mostly the ugliest women who, having but little chance of getting husbands, retire to convents. HERIMIT LAMAS. 1G3 Hermits also are not rare : they inhabit the highest parts of the valleys, and live from the charity of passers- by. It is characteristic of them that they allow the hair and beard to grow; and the custom is so general that the typical representation of a hermit is always that of a man with long nncut hair and beard. Each chooses a particular rite, and believes he derives from the frequent practice of the same supernatural assistance. A rite very often selected, though I am unable to state for what reason, is that of Chod, “to cut, or destroy,” tlie meaning of which is anxiously kept a profound secret by the Lamas. The recluses are believed to be exposed to repeated attacks on the part of the evil spirits, the enemies of earnest and assiduous meditation; but the beating of a drum is regarded as a most efficacious means of keeping them at a distance.* On certain days those isolated Lamas, the village priests as well as anachorites, are required to revisit the respective * See Moorcroft, “Mansaraur.” As. Res., Vol. XII., pp. 458, 465. Theii’ living in seclusion is also alluded to by the name of Rikhrodpa, which means “one who lives on or amongst hills,” and also “a hermit.” Csoma and Schmidt’s Dictionaries. In pictorial representations of a recluse a drum is a frequent object in one of his hands, while the other very generally holds a cord, typifying the wisdom granted him by the deity as a reward for his strong mind and perseverance. — With reference to the encouragement given by Buddhism in its early days to anachoretism, I wish to remark (see also p. 6, 150) that Sakyamuni himself, as well as all the founders and supporters of the various systems of Buddhism, urgently exhorted to energy in the practise of meditation, as the most efficacious means of becoming emancipated from existence; and that they recommended for these religious exercises the choice of out-of-the-way places little likely to be visited by any one in pursuit of worldly pleasure or gratification. Sakyamuni himself had set the example by retiring to remote places previous to obtaining the Buddhaship, and it was not only duly followed l)y his early adherents, but is also practised by the modern Tibetans. 11 * 1G4 THE TIBETAN PRIESTHOOD. monasteries to wliicli they belong ; and they are punished if they fail to present themselves to submit to this sort of control. In' every monastery there is a list of all the monks forming part of the clerical community.' Number of Lamas. With reference to the number of Lamas I here present the following data. For Eastern Tibet Dr. Campbell gives a list of twelve principal convents at LJidssa and in its vicinity, inhabited b}’' a total of 18,500 Lamas. ^ Surprising as this number is, it is far from representing the entire number of Lamas spread over all the country of Eastern Tibet. In Western Tibet Cunningham has estimated the lay population oi Laddh at 158,000, the Lamas at 12,000, which gives one Lama to every thirteen laymen. In Sp'di the lay population was computed by Major Hay, in 1845, to number 1414, the Lamas 193, or about one Lama to seven laymen.* For the Buddhist countries of the Eastern Himalaya I can give no numbers at all, but only offer some general remarks. In Bhiddn, the number of Lamas in proportion to the lay population in extremely great. In Tassisiidon (i(kra-shis-chhos-grong, the holy town of the doctrine) 1.500 to 2,000 live in the palace of the Dharma Eaja alone; and their number must be considered as one of the chief causes of the poverty of the inhabitants. Pemberton ' Compare Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., p. 339. Pemberton, “Report," p. 117. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. I., p. 203. Schmidt, in Mem. de I'Acad. de Petersb., Vol. I., p. 257. 2 “Notes on Eastern Tibet,” in the Journal of the As. Soc. Beiig., 1855, p. 219. ’ Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 287. “Report on the valley of Spiti,” in the Journal of the As. Soc. of Beng., Vol. XIX., p. 437. OCCUPATIONS. 165 says that the expenses for the maiiitainance of tliis privileged class have repeatedly been made the subject of earnest discussion. ‘ Tn SiJikim also the monasteries and Lamas are described by Hooker as being very numerous and influential.' For comparison I add some data for countries beyond the limits of High Asia. Amongst the Kalmuks it was calculated, when Fallas visited their country in the last century, that tliere was one lama to every 150 to 200 tents. ^ In the environs of Pekin there are about 80,000 Buddhist monks. ^ Ceylon has about 2,500 priests, a number which gives for a total population of two millions one priest to 800 In Berma there is one priest to every thirtieth soul. Occupations. The monks, notwithstanding the re- ligious duties they have to perform, would have plenty of time for the cultivation of larger tracts of land; but the only thing they do in this way is to keep in the best possible condition the gardens surrounding their monasteries, which greatly contribute to their support and comfort: these same gardens are also very often the only places for miles round where fruit-trees, chiefly apricots, are met with. In general the Lamas are an idle set of people, disinclined to either bodily or mental exertion, the ' Turner, “Embassy,” p. 83. Pemberton, “Report,” p. 117. - “Himalayan Journals,” Vol. I., p. 313. ® Pallas “Rcisen,” Vol. I., p. 557. (French edition). ■* Wassiljew, “Her Buddhismus,” p. 18. * The data lor Ceylon and Berma iire taken from Hardy, “Eastern Monaehism,” p. 309. Comiiare p. 11 about the census of Ceylon. 166 THE TIBETAN PEIESTHOOD. majority passing the greater part of the day in revolving prayer-cylinders, or counting the beads of rosaries, though occasionally some are found who are very skilfid in carving blocks of wood and making images of gods, as well as in painting and sculpture. The cleverest Lamas, however, as my- brothers were frequently told, are generally summoned to Lhassa. ‘ Although every Lama can read and write, yet these accomplishments form no favourite occupation among them; and with reference to the slowness of their mode of writing, I may mention that the Lama who copied the document concerning Himis (see p. 183) spent about six hours over it. The illit- erateness of the Lamas has often been regretted. Many were asked for an explanation of the six-syllabic prayer Om niani padme hum, of whose magical influence upon the welfare of man so many religious books treat; and it was not till after repeated inquiries that at last a satisfactory answer was obtained. Schmidt was much surprised at the answers which the Nepalese Buddhists gave Hodgson. “A Tibetan or Mongolian Lama,” he says, “would not have answered his questions so well.” Both Csoma and Hue have observed that the Lamas are not very w'ell acquainted with their sacred literature; Hue says that they excuse their ignorance by urging the profoundness of their religion; and again: “a Lama who knows Tibetan and Mongolian is styled a sage, or wise ' Compare Turner, “EmLassy,” p. 31(!. The activity of the La daki Lamas in the cultivation of land, which Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., p. 340, notices, is actually confined to their gardens. — There was a very skilful carver in wood residing in Spiti at the time of Trebcck’s visit to that province, and his works are highly praised hy this traveller. DIET. 167 man; and if he has also a slight knowledge of Chinese and Mandshu literature, he is viewed as of more than human nature.”* My brothers also v/ere often puzzled by the confused answers they received from the Lamas to any questions either on natural phenomena, or concern- ing their religion or history. The Lamas always pre- ferred talking about matters connected with mystical theology, and it was a comparatively easy affair to obtain from them explanations of the supposed magical properties of particular charms. The Diet of the Lamas is that usual in the country.^ They may eat whatever is offered them in alms, but are not allowed to drink intoxicating liquors: these are, however, taken under the pretext of “being medicine.”^ Animal food is not forbidden, Sakyamuni himself is said in Singhalese legends to have died from eating pork,^ but it is considered as an impediment to the attainment of perfection, as man should view all animated beings as his brethern and relations, and not kill them; there is * Mem. de I’Acad. de Petersb., Vol. I., p. 93. Csoma, Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VII., p. 14. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. I., pp. 56, 299. Compare also Turner, “Embassy,” p. 31 G. ^ About the food of the Tibetans in general, see Turner, “Embassy,” pp. 24, 48, 82, 12G, 129, 136, 195, 220, 245, 343. Pemberton, “Report,” p. 156. Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., pp. 182, 208, 232, 243, 291, 309, 328-332; Vol. II., p. 77 ; “Mansaraur,” As. Res., Vol. XII., pp. 394, 396, 444, 446, 486. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., p. 258. Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 305. “ Wassiljew, “Der Buddhismus,” p. 94. Mooreroft, “Travels,” Vol. II., p. 12, remarks, that he saw at Lama Yiiru the Lamas take Chong, the national liquor, during their religious serviee. Also the fermented drink of the Lepehas, made of millet, is taken in great quantities by the Lamas in Sikkim. ^ Hardy, “Eastern Monaehism,” p. 92. In the Tibetan biographies he is reported to have died from affection of the spine. Schiefner, “Tibet. Lebens- bcschreibung.” Mem. des Savants ctrangers. Vol. VI., p. 292. 168 THE TIBETAN PKIESTHQOI). even a proverb which says — “To eat flesh is equal to eating one’s relations.” ‘ Laymen, however, eat meat of any kind: according to my brother Robert, however, they abstain — in Spiti at least — from partaking of fish, although no satisfactory reason could be alleged by them for their so doing. In order that the monks may not inordinately indulge their appetite for meat, there exist a great many regulations; on certain days no animal food whatever is allowed; the monks are also obliged to abstain from it as often as confession is made, as also at those periods when very sacred religious ceremonies are performed. The principal food consists in rice, wheat, or barley, flour, milk, and tea. The rice is boiled or roasted; the flour is mixed with milk and tea, or formed into un- leavened cakes and seasoned with salt. Such cakes have a taste similar to that of the unleavened bread of the Jews. The tea is made in two different ways; first as an infusion with hot water, as in Europe, and this preparation is called Cha-chosh “tea water;”- secondly in a very peculiar manner, which I will describe in detail from a a recipe obtained by my brothers at Leh: — The tea — loosened brick-tea, — is mixed with nearl}" half its volume of soda, in Tibetan called Phuli. The mixture is then thrown into a kettle filled with the ne- cessarj'^ quantity of cold water, the proportion varying ’ Comp. Wassiljew, 1. c., p. 134. ^ This and the following terms, Phuli and Gurgur, do not occur in the dictionaries. ^ Brick tea is the commercial name of this peculiar kind of tea; it refers to its having a form not unlike that of a brick. It obtains its sha))e and at the same time its consistency by being pressed into a form. diet: 1>RE1>A1{AT10X of tea. 1G9 as in our mode of making tea. When the water is about to boil, the mixture of tea leaves and soda is stirred, an operation continued four to six minutes after the boiling of the water. The kettle is then removed from the fire and the tea is filtered through a cloth into a round, wooden cylinder about three to four inches in diameter and two to three feet high; the tea- leaves are generally considered as useless and are thrown away. The tea is vigorously queried in a wooden tul) (called in Tibetan Gurgur), like chocolate; a large amount of clarified butter is then added (generally double the quantity of the brick tea), and some salt; when the opera- tion of querling is continued. Finally the tea is again thrown into a kettle, mixed vith milk, and heated anew, as it has generally greatly cooled dowui during all the operations just described. This tea, called “Cha,” strongly resembles a kind of gruel, and is taken, together with meat or pastry, at dinner or supper; but it is not allowed to be taken during the performance of religious ceremonies, when tea-water alone, Cha-chosh, is handed round as refreshment.^ On certain occasions the Lamas give grand dinners. To one of them my brother Eobert was invited at Leh ; it had been arranged in honour of the visit of a high Lama from Lhassa. Tea was given in the place of soup, and was handed round all dinner time. A particular honour was shown to the guests by care being taken that their ' As yet this brick tea is used almost e.xclusively, though it is to be hoped that the exertions of the Indian Government to introduce tea grown in the Himalaya and in Assam into Tibet will ere long meet with success. 170 THE TIBETAN PRIESTHOOD. cups should never become quite empty. There were various kinds of meat, some roasted, some boiled, and even some as a kind of pie. No wine was served, but the cooking was really much superior to that generally met with in the country, and much better than could have been expected. On inquiry Eobert learned that the dinner had been cooked by the high priest’s own cook, whom he had brought with him from Lhassa. Dress. The original precepts laid dowm by Sakya- muni for regulating the dress of the priests had been well adapted to the warm climate of India ; later, however, when his faith extended over more northerly and, con- sequently, rougher climates, he himself is said to have allowed the use of warmer clothing, of stockings, shoes, &c. The principal advantage of dress, as taught by Sakya- muni, is to cover the shame of the priest; besides which, it has also other benefits, such as protection from the cold and the attacks of mosquitoes, &c., things which cause disturbance of the mind.' The various parts of the dress of a Tibetan Lama are; a cap or hat, a gown, an inner vest, trousers, a cloak, and boots.’ Ca2)S and hats. The caps are made of double felt or cloth, between which are put charms; in the rainy ' Hardy, “Eastern Monaeliisni,” Chapter XII. ^ In the Himalaya districts and in Western Tibet the predominant colour of the objects of dress is a more or less brillant red; yellow is met with among the sects enumerated p. 72. — About the dress in general notices are also found in Turner, “Embassy,” pp. 82, 86, 242, 314. Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., p. 238. Pemberton, “Report,” pp. 108, 153. Dr. Campbell, in the Journ. of the As. Soc. of Bengal, Vol. XVHI, p. 499. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., p. 111. Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 372. dress: CAl’S AND GOWN. 171 districts of the Himalaya the Lamas wear during the summer large hats of straw. The shape of the caps varies considerably, but it is curious tliat they are all of Chinese or Mongolian fashion, whilst the form of the robes has been adopted from the Hindus. The mode of salutation is also the Chinese as the Tibetans always take off their hat, whilst the Hindus, as a sign of reverence, approach their masters not bare-headed, but bare-footed. Most of the caps are conical, with a large lap, which is generally doubled up, but is let down over the ears in cold weather (see plate XVI. where the laps are let down). The head Lamas wear a particular sort of cap, generally low and conical, similar to those worn by Padma Sambhava^ and mythological deified persons of particular influence upon man’s welfare, as King Bihar; this form is called Xathongzha. Some head -priests of Western Tibet have an hexagonal hat formed of paste- board, and showing four steps diminishing towards the top; or in some cases a kind of mitre of red cloth ornamented with flowers of gold worked in the stuff". This latter kind of cap bears a remarkable resemblance to the mitres of Roman Catholic bishops. Occasional!}^, if the weather allows it, the Lamas in Eastern Tibet, in Bhutan and also in Sikkim, go bare-headed. The gown reaches to the calves and is fastened round the waist by a slender girdle; it has an upright collar and is closely buttoned up at the neck. In Sikkim the Lamas occasionally wear, slung round the shoulders, a kind -of red and yellow striped woollen stole. In general ' See the plutcs in Hooker, •‘Himalayan .Journals,” Vol. I., p. 328. 172 THE TIBETAN BfllESTHOOD. the gown has sleeves, except in the Bhutan Duars, a country where the mean temperature does not go down even in the coldest mouth, in January, below 22° or 18° Fahrenheit. The inner vest has no sleeves, and reaches to the haunches. It is not at all cut to the form of the body of the individual but hangs down quite straight. In Ladak, most of the Lamas wear it over the gown instead of underneath. The trousers are fastened to the waist by a sort of lace running in a drawing hem. The two legs are equi- distant throughout, also in their inner side, as in Fig. a, trousers, philibegs hanging down nearly as far as the knee. The cloak, in Tibetan Lagoi, “the upper garment,” is the distinctive ecclesiastical dress of the monks, in which also the Buddhas, Bddliisattvas and sacred Lamas are represented. It is a long but narrow shawl of wool or sometimes even of silk, ten to twenty feet long, and two ' “Embassy,” p. 86.— The wearing of trousers is a very ancient custom; see the most interesting and complete work of Weiss, “ Kostiimkunde, ’ Vol. II., pp. Sd.h-GTd, who gives many drawings in which the races who in ancient times inhabited Northern and Eastern Asia, are represented with ^trousers. It is altogether remarkable to see their dress but little differing from what they wear now. and not inb. D uring the w inter the trousers are worn over the larger gown as a better pro- tection against the cold. In Bhutan the Lamas, according to Turner,^ wear, instead of DEESS: CLOAK AND BOOTS. 173 to three feet broad; it is thrown over the left shoulder and passed under the right arm, so as to leave bare the right arm. Perhaps the custom of having the right arm uncovered may be explained from the rejection of the castes by Sakyamuni ; for the border of the shawl describes a line across the breast just as the triple cord does, which according to the laws of Menu, the three higher castes alone are allowed to wear; whilst the shawl had been worn b}" all priests, from whatever caste they may have sprung. ‘ The hoots are made of stiff felt, either white or red, and are ornamented with perpendicular blue stripes. They reach up to the calves. The soles are of double-felt, sometimes furnished, besides, with a sole of leather. These soles form a very solid and unyielding support for the foot, protecting it very well against sharp stones, much better than do the shoes worn by the Turkistanis, the sole of which consists of thin leather only, which gives neither protection against the roughness of the ground nor support to the foot; the advantages of the Tibetan boots are, how^ever, sometimes secured by thick felt- stockings. My brothers have seen shoes in use but very rarely, and then only amongst the superiors of the monasteries. To complete the description of the appearance of a Lama I have still to notice various smaller articles generally worn. From the girdle which keeps together * Menu, Chapter II., pp. 42, 44. On ancient sculptures the Buddhas not unfrequently wear nothing but the three strings ; see the drawings in Crawfurd’s .\rchipelngo, Vol. II., and in Foucau.vs Rgya cldier rol pa, Vol. II., Plate I. 174 THE TIBETAX BRIESTIIOOD. the gown, hang a knife-case and several purses or little pockets containing various articles, such as a tooth-brush, a tongue -scraper and an ear -pick, steel and tinder, tabacco or betel-nut, dice used in foretelling future events ; a prayer-cylinder and a Chinese metal pipe are also almost always to be found among the articles fastened to it. The rosaries, in Tibetan Thengpa, indispensable in- struments for counting the due number of prayers, are generally fastened to the girdle, or sometimes worn round the neck.^ The beads amount to 108, which answer to the number of the volumes of the Kanjur; but most of those used by the lay population have a much smaller number of beads, about thirty to forty. The beads are of wood, pebbles, or bones of holy Lamas; the latter have a very high price ; the rosaries of the head Lamas are not nnfrequently of precious stones, particularly of nephrite (the Turkistani Yashein) and of turquoise. To most rosaries are fastened a pair of pinchers, needles, an ear-pick, and a small Dorje.' The amidet-hoxes, in Tibetan Gau (in the Lepcha language of Sikkim Koro, and Kandum, if of wood), are likewise worn round the neck ; and it is not unfrequent to see several fastened to the same string. Most of the ’ Compare Pallas, “Reisen,” Vol. I., p. 563. Turner, ‘-Embassy,” pp. ^61, 336. I. J. Schmidt, “Forschungen,” p. 168. While travelling the Lamas are loaded with many other objects. See Hooker, “Himalayan Journals,” Vol. II., p. 142. ^ Pinchers are in use even amongst the rudest tribes, who go almost naked; for they need them to draw out thorns. I add as another instance of the ancient use of pinchers, that we have found them also in the oldest graves in the Franconian Hills, in Bavaria. mjESS: AMULET LOXES. 175 boxes are i)ointed, iinitatiiig the form of a fig-leaf; but they are also square or circular. The outside is either embossed or painted. Wooden boxes are closed by a slide, which has not nnfrequently a space cut out to allow the image of the chosen tutelary god to be seen. Those of brass have the two parts fitting together like the cover and the lower part of boxes; but hinges are replaced by rings, of which one at least must be connected with each part. A string or a piece of leather can be passed through, and serves to hang up the object as well as to kee]:> it together. The things put into such cases are relics, images of deities, objects which are believed to be dreaded by the evil spirits, and charms.^ I had occasion to examine the following different sorts: — 1. A square wooden box from Gyungul, in Gnari Khorsnm; the box was bound in brass. In the interior were carved on one side one -of the goddesses Dolma (see p. 66), who are supposed to protect against emaciation, having on her left Chenresi (see p. 88) and Amitabha (see p. 53) on her right. The opposite side shows Sakyamuni with the same deities. 2. A leaf-shaped wooden box painted yellow, with red clouds. It contained a figure of Shinje (see p. 93) of tinted clay; at the bottom of the case lay a little medal of hardened barley-paste representing Tsonkhapa * Compare about the kind of charms, Csoma, “Journ. As. Soc. Beng.,” Vol. IX., p. 90.O. 176 THE TIBETAN BKIESTHOO]). (see p. 69) ; it is half an inch in diameter, and was Avrapped in paper covered with charms. 3. A circular box of brass with charms and a sim- ilar medal of Tsonkhapa, covered with gold paint. 4. Three conical brass boxes fastened to one string. The central box enclosed a gilt figure of Tsepagmed (= Amitabha, see p. 129), who is supposed to grant longevity. Also a piece of copper formed to represent a thunderbolt was wrapped in a piece of red cloth as a protection from the effects of lightning. In the smallest box several slips of paper were covered with seals of the Dalai Lama printed in red, which are supposed to pro- tect against death by drowning. I found there also grains of barley and earth. The third box contained several figures of Lha Dolma, and Tsonkhapa (all carefully wrapped in pieces of red silk) alternating with charm-papers. The charms were all w^ritten in small characters, or running hand, but by the friction against the images and grains the papers had been almost reduced to loose fibres. All objects were Wrongly perfumed with musk, and had besides, like every sacred article fabricated in monasteries, an uniileasant greasy odour.' ' Drawings of the different sorts of rosaries, as well as of the amulet boxes described above, from originals obtained by my brothers, will be given in a plate accompanying the “Results of a Scientific Mission to India and High Asia.” CHAPTER XIII. RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. Ceremonies preceding the Erection. — Monasteries. — Historical Docu.ment Relating to the Foundation op the Monastery of Himis. — Temples. — Religious Monusients. 1. Chortens. 2. Manis. 3. Derchoks and Lapchas. Ceremonies preceding the erection. The erection of every new religious building is pre- ceded by a benediction of the ground and by various other ceremonies. The Lamas of the neighbourhood come together, and the highest in rank presents offerings to the deity selected as tutelary god, it being the custom to dedicate every building to a particular god, who is supposed then to protect it against mischievous spirits as well as malignant men, and to bestow every kind of happiness upoij its frequenters. A god very often chosen us patron, is King Bihar (Bihar gyalpo) one of the five 178 KELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. great kings. ^ An image Mliicli my brother Adolphe obtained in Gnari Khorsum represents Bihar in an upright attitude, standing upon the “seat of diamond,” Tib. Dorje- dan, Sanskrit Vajrasana, formed of Lotus leaves. He is trampling upon four human beings of black, red, white and yellow colour; the skulls also of which his necklace is composed are of these colours. His gown is of blue silk (Tib. Darzab), with various ornaments; his cap, of the form I have described (p. 171) as Xathongzha, and his shawl are red. His right hand vdelds the Dorje, in his left is the Phurbn. The picture is meant to re- present a statue placed in a box the four sides of which form a frame separating it from the surrounding figures, which are: the fabulous kings Halha, Luvang, and Tokchoi gyalpo, and three highly revered Lamas. The prayers accompaning the inaugurative ceremonies are read for the prosperity' of the edifice. At the ceremony of laying the first stone prayers are recited for the prosperity of the new temple or place of v'orship; these are then written doMui and deposited with other prayers and certain forms of Jbenediction (Tib. Tashi tsig jod, “blessing speeches”), together with relics and other sacred objects, in a hollow in the foundation stone. When the building is finished, the Lamas again assemble to perform the rites of consecration.^ The restoration of a ruined building is also preceded * See p. 157. - A volume treating of these ceremonies, in which Vajrasattva (p. 53) is addressed, is mentioned by Csoma in his Analysis of the Kanjur, As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 503. Concerning the objects usually enclosed in the Cliortens, see Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 309. MONASTEUIES. 179 by religious ceremonies, wliich bear tlie name of Argai choga, “ceremony of presenting offerings.” Monasteries. The monasteries, in Tibetan Gonpa,^ “a solitary place,” are mostly at some little distance from the villages, and very frequently even on the summit of hills, in a commanding position. Each monastery receives a religious name, in allusion to its being a centre of Buddhist faith: thus the monastery at Himis. near Leh, in Ladak, is called in the historical document relating to its foundation, Sangye chi ku sung thug chi ten, “the support of the meaning of the Buddha’s precepts.” Other instances are Darjihng, in Sikkim, “the far-diffused island (of medi- tation);”" Thohng, in Gnari Khorsum, “the high-floating (monastery) ; ” Mindoling, * “ the place of perfection and emancipation.” Occasionally the monastery is more ancient than the village, which has sprung up afterwards in its immediate vicinity ; in this case, the name of the monastery is transferred to the village, as in Darjiling; whilst in the opposite case, the monastery takes the name of the village, as at Himis. The architecture of the monasteries is that employed ' It is written f/gon-pa. The descriptive designations for monasteries which occur in religious books, such as “house of science” (^tsug-lag-khang), and similar ones, are not in use in ordinary every-day language; and the word chhos-sne, which Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 376, mentions as being given to monasteries was scarcely ever heard by my brothers. ^ Dar-rgyas-^ling. In its complete form the name is preceded by Isam, meaning “thought, meditation.” / ® Quoted in Csoma’s and Schmidt's Dictionaries, voce smin-pa. Tholing is spelled «(tho-lding. — For further details of these names see my brother Her- mann’s Glossary, in E. As. Soc., 18.59. 180 EELIGIOL'S BUILDINGS AND !MONUMENTS. Ibr the houses of the wealthier population of the country; hut they are loftier, and are adorned with a greater number of flags and prayer-cylinders on the roof. The approach to a monastery is also distinguished by a number of religious monuments, as Chortens, Manis, &c.' The materials used in the construction of mon- asteries vary in different districts. Thus, in the Himalaya, where wood is plentiful, they are built almost entire!}’ of timber; and in Sikkim and Bhutan, where the bamboo abounds, they are often constructed of this material, which is occasionally interlaced so as to form a lattice- work. It is a very general custom in these latter countries to build the monasteries upon piles, in order to prevent the lower floor from getting wet or damp in the rainy season ; while the roofs are constructed in the Chinese style, being mostly of the pyramidal or prismatic form, not flat, and projecting considerably over the sides of the building. In Tibet, where trees are very scarce, the walls are made either of stone — which for larger buildings are regularly shaped — or of unburnt, sun-dried bricks, which are cemented with most imper- fectly made lime, or even with clay only. In Ladak and Gnari Khorsum. the roofs of the monasteries are flat, and they are constructed like the ceiling of the * Concerning the houses of the Tibetans in general, see: for Bhutan, Turner, “Embassy,” pp. 50, 61, 93, 142, 177, 180; Pemberton, “Report,” p. 154; for Sikkim, Gleanings in science, Vol. II., p. 179; Hooker, “Himalayan Journals,” in many passages; for Lhdssa, Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., Chapt. II.; for Gnari Khorsum, Moorcroft, “Lake Mansaraur,” As. Res., Vol. XII., pp. 426, 442, 456, 479; for Ladak, Moorcroft, “Travels,” Vol. I., p. 315; Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 312. See also various representations in the “Pa- uor.amas and Views” accompanying the “Results of a Scientific Mission,” by my brothers. monastp:ries. 181 different stories, of small beams of willow or poplar. They are then covered with sprigs of willow, straw, and leaves, and plastered together with clay to render the whole a somewhat compact mass. The roofs of the houses of the head Lamas are, besides, surmounted by the form of a regular cube, terminating in a cone covered with gilt tiles. Xumerous prayer-flags are set up round the roof, as also cylinders about five feet high and two feet in diameter, supporting a crescent surmounted by a pin- nacle similar to the pointed end of a spear. Some cylinders are covered with black cloth, round which are sewn horizontally and vertically white ribbons, so as to form the figure of a cross; in other cases the colours are respectively red and yellow^ The entrance to the monasteries looks tow^ards either the east or the south, the latter position being probably chosen as affording protection against the north winds. The entrance-door is six feet, or sometimes even more, above the ground, with steps leading up to it. The monasteries sometimes consist of one large house several stories high, with occasionally a covered gallery running round outside and used as a promenade. Some- times they are composed of several buildings, containing respectively the temple, house of assembl}’" (also used as refectory), the dw'elling of the Lamas, storehouses for provisions, and the like. These various establishments extend in larger monasteiies, such as Tholing, in Gnari Khorsum, over a large surffice, and are enclosed by a common wall, which, as Cunningham was told, is in- tended to serve as a means of defence; but m3’ brothers 182 RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. observed, tiiat at present it is, in most instances, too weak to lay claim to the name of a fortification, particularly if the establishment is an old one, as Thohng- for instance, which is mentioned in Ssanang Ssetsen’s “Histoiy of the Eastern Mongolians” to have been built 1014 a.d.' The ground-floor is without windows, and is used as a receptacle for pro\dsions; it is generally a little broader than the upper stories. These latter have large windows and balconies. The windows have no panes of glass, but are closed by black curtains, upon which are sewn figimes of a Latin cross, formed of white stripes of stuff.'^ The cross denotes quietness or peace, and is well known in this quality to the Europeans who visit Japan, where the loop-holes of the forts are covered with such curtains in time of peace; when a war breaks out they are all removed. * The upper stories are reached either .by a staircase or by a broad, sloping- beam, in wliich incisions are made to serve in lieu of steps. Each story is divided off into large compartments, in which several Lamas live together; small cells, each appropriated to a single person (as is the custom in Koman Catholic monasteries), are not known in Buddhist establishments. The furniture is most plain; the chief articles are low tables and benches (in the dining- room); bed-steads of rough-hewn planks, with blankets and cushions, and different vessels. All these articles are generallv of very inferior workmansliii). Stoves ' Ssanang Ssetsen, cd. by Schmidt, p. 5i5. ^ See the plates in Turner, and the View of Hiinis by llennann dc Schlag- intweit, 1. c. ’ From an oral communication from Captain Fairholme, K. N. DOCUMENT KELATINC. TO THE EKECTION OF HIM IS. 183 or cliiimieys are unknown in Tibet, and tire is made on the ground where the form of the house allows of it. The smoke, like in the cludets of the Alps, escapes through an opening in the roof. There is no monastery without a temple, and this latter occupies the centre of the building; in large monasteries, where more temples than one exist, the central one is the principal. Each monastery is surrounded by a well-cultivated garden, in which flourish, owing to the care bestowed upon it by the Lamas, groups of poplar and willow trees, as well as apricots. The Lamas have succeeded in growing trees in localities far beyond the ordinary limit of such kind of vegetation. Thus it happens that at Mangnang, in Gnari Khorsum, at a height of 13,457 feet, fine poplars are found. Historical Document relating to the Foundation of the Monastery of Hiniis, in Ladak. The following summary of a curious document of found- ation is now published for the first time. The original, which is carved on a broad stone slab, 24 ft. high, was seen by my brother Hermann on the occasion of his visit to the monastery of Hhnis, in September 1856, and he got an exact copy of it made, of which the i’ollowing is an approximate translation. The occurrence of terms not explained in the dictionaries, and a spelling ditterent from tha temployed in the sacred writings, made 184 EELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. it impossible to give here a literal translation, as has been done with the address to the Buddhas of confession (Chapter XL); yet all the iinportants facts could be de- ciphered which had reference to the time of the erection of the monastery, to the persons who ordered the building, and to those who constructed the edifice.^ The document is di- vided into two paragraphs, which are distinguished in the ori- ginal, printed on Plate IX., by a blank space between them. First paragraph. This begins with a hymn to the Buddhist triad, viz. the Buddha (the author of the doctrine), the Dharma (his law), and the Sangha (the congregation of the faithful).^ “Hail! praise be and benediction! Salutation to the teadiers! To the most perfect, eminent Buddha, who has the characteristic signs and proportions; to the excellent law, which reveals the entire truth; to the congregation of the faithful, who endeavour to become delivered: all honour be to these three Supremacies after a pros- ternation at the feet of the superiors” (here called 61a-ma, comp. p. 156). The remainder of this paragraph relates, in the usual ’ In specimens of modern Tibetan, as e. g. in the treaty between Adolphe and the authorities of Daba (see Chapter XVI., 2), and in geographical names, we find words used which are not met with in literary language ; and, more frequently still, terms presenting a most unexpected orthography. Perhaps we must account for this by phonetic corruption and the gradual formation of dialects', but we must not lose sight of the fact that but few people in Tibet know how to write correctly — an art which, for that matter, was not very general in Europe either but a short time ago, when schools were limited to monasteries. * “The protection derived from these three gems is said to destroy the fear of reproduction, or successive existence, and to take away the fear of the mind, the pain to which the body is subject, and the misery ol the four hells.” Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” p. 209. DOCUMENT RELATING TO THE ERECTION OF IIIMIS. 185 bombastic style, the faithful adherence to Buddhism of Dharmaraja Senge Nam})ar Gyalva, and his father,^ and the universal reverence paid by the Ladakis to the holy triad. It is stated that Senge Nampar ordered to be built on a magnihcent style, and in his residences, - the “Yihara of the three gems,” the Sangye chi ku sung thug chi ten, L e. the support of the meaning of Buddha’s precepts, “whence the sun of the doctrine arose in this countr}' brilliant as the dawn of the day.” This monastery is said to be “the place where originated the entirely victorious (translators) of the three secrets,” in Tibetan ^sang ^fsum, which latter is probably to be referred to the book Gyatoki sangsum, which Jamya Namgyal ordered to be copied in letters of gold, silver, and copper (red). It is further reported, that in the reign of this monarch many most learned and powerful Lamas had come to Ladak and taught the doctrine; we find the following names: “ rfPal-//myam-med-’brug-pa — the master of incom- parable happiness, the thunderer, who has spread Buddhist * Dharmaraja, in Tibetan Choichi gyalpo, or by contraction Choigyal, “king of the law,” is a title applied to the rulers and mythological persons who have furthered the cause of Buddhism. — This king is called by Cun- ningham, “Ladak,” Chapter XII., Sengge Namgyal ; his father is named Jamya Xamgyal. Jamya had been dethroned and emprisoned by Ali Mir, a fanatic Mussalman ruler of Skardo, who had invaded Ladak and destroyed both the temples and the sacred images and books of the Buddhists. But later, when Jamya was re-established in his kingdom, he sent a mission to Lhassa with precious presents, and showed himself in many other ways a very faithful believer in Buddhism. - The word here translated “residences,” in Tibetan pho-brang-rnams, seems, on account of the plural particle mains, to mean “territories, lands.” 18G EELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. doctrine with tlie greatest energy throughout ’Dzam-bu- ^Hng/ but more iiarticularly in tliis country. “rGod-ts' hang-pa,^ whose titles are tlie victorious holding the Dorje, the beloved son of the patron of creatures. ^ “sTag-ts'liang-ras-pa-chhen, the great Bhikshu of the tiger nest, the greatly venerated, who disposes of magical power, and before whom many Lamas have prostrated themselves.^” Second paragraidi. The erection of the convent was entrusted to ‘h/Pal-/dan-rtsa-va’i 61a-ma = the illustrious Boundation Lama — who had dwelt in numerous monasteries, and had become firm and strong in the ten commandments.''’ The edifice was begun in the month Voda, in Sanskrit Uttaraphalgum (the second month), in the male water- horse year, and finished in the male water-tiger year, when the Lama performed the ceremony of consecration, the sign of completion. In the male iron-dog year the ‘ In Sanskrit Jambudvij^a; it is the name given to that quarter of the globe in which India lies.— Concerning the Brugpa sect see p. 74. ^ The construction of the name makes it very probable that this Lama came to Ladak from the monastery God-tsang in Eastern Tibet, to the name of which would then be added the particle pa. * In Tibetan ’gro-va’i-wigon-po, from ’gro-va “a creature,” and w(gon-po “a patron;” a title indicating, that the person so styled is “a saint, a god.” Perhaps we ought to take rGod-ts'hang-pa as an incarnation of Chenresi (see p. 88), as well as grovai gonpo as one of his surnames; he is also styled Jigten gonpo, in Sanskrit Lokanatha, “the patron of the world.” Cunningham, 1. c., heard that this Lama had travelled through India, China, Kafiristan and Kashmir, and had made, and then consecrated an image of Maitreya in Tamosgang, in Ladak. 5 \Vith respect to the meaning of the term rtsa-va’i ?;la-ma sec p. 141. — Concerning the ten commandments sec Burnouf, “Lc Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 44(1; Csoma, “Dictionary,” p. (l!l. DOCUMJiNT KELATING TO THE ERECTION OE HIMIS. 187 monastery was encircled with “a hedge of the ‘spen’ shrub, and outside the Lion entrance were put up along the 'walls and the enclosure 300,000 Manis (or prayer- cylinders).” The document concludes by alluding to the merits which the king, the workmen (h e. the masons, carpenters, porters), and in fact all engaged in the con- struction of this monastery, had derived from their assistance, and mentions in particular the salutary in- fluence which the monastery will exercise in future upon the welfare and salvation of the inhabitants of Ladak. When endeavouring to refer the years which I have given in the preceding part with their Tibetan denomina- tion, to the corresponding years of the Christian era, it must be kept in mind that Senge Nampar Gyalva reigned, according to Cunningham, from 1620-70. Now, calculating by a cycle of GO years, we obtain the fol- lowing years for the dates occurring in this document: — The erection was commenced in 1644; The monastery was tinished in 1664; The 300,000 Manis were put up in 1672. Calculating by a cycle of 252 years, we And the respective dates to be 1620, 1640, 1648. Also the latter years would not be excluded, as they would admit the supposition that the Himis monastery was amongst those which his predecessor Jamya Namgyal had left unfinished at his decease ; but in the present case we must adopt the years 1644-72, since for history it is the cycle of 60 years and not the cycle of 252 years which is used in Tibetan literature. As an instance confirming this 1 quote Csoma, who, in his Chronological Table, a|)plied the 188 RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. cycle of GO years to Tisri’s designations, and obtained results sufficiently in accordance with those derived by Schmidt and Klaproth from Mongolian and Chinese works.* T e m p 1 e s. The exterior of the Ihuldhist temples in Tibet differs in generally widely from that met with in other coun- tries where Buddhism prevails. Whoever has had occasion to see the magnificent temples of Berma, with their curious architecture, will be greatly disappointed on beholding a temple in Tibet; for, with the exception of Lhassa, Tashilnnpo and Tassisudon, scarcely any Tibetan temple })resents extraordinary dimensions or a particularly imposing appearance. The temples are called in Tibetan Lhakhang, and are most generally in immediate connexion with the buildings of the monasteries. There are, however, villages which have a temple only, without a monastery, and in this case the temple stands beside the houses; in hamlets without a temple, where nevertheless a solitary Lama resides, there is a room fitted up in his dwelling-house for the performance of the different rites and ceremonies. The architecture of the temples is simple. The roofs are now flat, now sloping, with square holes serving as windows and skylights, which are shut by a curtain being drawn across them. The walls of the temples look towards the four Concerning the various systems of’ reckoning lime see Chapter XVI. Plate IX. HISTORICAL DOCUMENT RELATING TO THE FOUNDATION MONASTERY OF IIIMIS. IN LADAK. Copied iVom a larye stone fixed in the wall. TKM PJ,ES. 189 quarters of heaven, and each side should be painted with a particular colour, viz. the north side with green, the south side with yellow, the east side with white, and the west side with red; but this rule seems not to be strictly adhered to, as my brother saw many temples \nth all sides either of the same colour, or simply white- washed. The interior of the temples which my brothers had occasion to see ‘ consisted of one large square room, with an entrance-hall in the front; occasionally also entrance- halls — but then smaller ones — are found aloiiQ- the other o three sides of the temple. The inside surface of the walls is whitewashed or covered with a kind of plaster. They are then generally decorated with paintings representing episodes taken from the life of the Buddhas, or images of gods of dreadful countenance. My brothers were told, that the art of fresco painting is practised by a particular class of Lamas, called Pon, who reside in Lhassa when their services are not required for country temples. In the side halls of the temple is generally situated the library, the volumes being regularly arranged on shelves, and w*rapped in silk. In the corners are placed tables bearing numerous statues of deities; and the religious dresses, the musical instruments, and other things required for the daily service, are hung up on wooden pegs along the walls. Benches are also ])laced ' As an example of their construction see the interior of the monastery of Mangnang, in Gnari Khorsum, by Adolphe in the “Atlas of Panoramas and Views.” The interior of the Singhalese temples is very similar to that of the Tibetan temples. See Hardy, “flastern Monachism,” p. 200. 190 EELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. in the temple, upon wliicli the Lamas take their seat, when assembled for prayer. The roof of the temples is supported by two rows of nnornamented wooden pillars painted red, and dividing it into three parallelograms; large silken fans, called Phan, striped white and blue and with unravelled fringed edges, ‘ together with musical and other instruments, are suspended to these pillars; while from the cross- beams hang numerous Zhaltang, or pictures of deities, each fastened to two red sticks, and generally covered with a veil of white silken cloth. The altar stands in the central gallery, and consists of differently sized .wooden benches, beautifully carved and richly ornamented ; the smaller ones are set upon the larger before a partition of planks on which hang bins of the five sacred colours (viz. yellow, white, red, blue and green) held together by a crescent, the convex side of which was turned upwards. Upon these benches are ranged the offering- vessels, statues of Buddhas and gods, and some in- struments and utensils used in religious worshiji; amongst the latter is always seen the mirror Melong which is used in the ceremony Tuisol; then some bells and Dorjes, together with a Chorten containing relics and having occasionally a niche with the statue of some deity; also a vase with peacock feathers and a sacred book is never wanting. The offering vessels are of brass, and similar ‘ These fans are to be understood as tokens of reverence paid to the gods, and answer to the silken scarfs inscribed with sentences whidi Tibetan politeness requires should be offered by visitors or enclosed in letters. These scarfs are called in Tibetan Khatak, or Tashi Khatak, “scarf of l)enediction.’’ TEMPLES. 191 in shape to the Chinese tea-cups; they are filled with barley, butter, and perfumes, iu summer with flowers. Beside the altar is a small bench upon which the offi- ciating Lama ranges the offerings to be consumed in the burnt-oftering, and the ritual instruments he requires in particular ceremonies. — At the end of the gallery stands, in a recess, the statue of the genius loci to whom the temple is consecrated; in some temples his head is shaded by a canopy of cloth, the form of which may be seen from Plate X.; from its central part called Dug (literally umbrella) extend some horizontal ribands, Labri, at the ends of which hang vertical flags, Badang, Sanskrit Pataka. In the entrance-hall, at both sides of the door, and also in the interior of the temple, are several large prayer -cyhnders, which are perpetually kept revolving by the attending Lama. The walls are not unfrequently decorated with views of sacred cities and monasteries, ‘ executed in colours upon paper; these are much ruder than their drawings of gods; they have no perspective, and the houses are traced in front view, but very incor- rectly. A vertical plan of Lhassa, which the Tibetan Lamas honour with the name of a landscape, is almost always amongst these representations of sacred spots; it resembles somewhat the older plans of European cities, drawn from a bird’s-eye view. * Also Turner, “ Embassy,” p. 158, mentions having seen some in the temple of Wandeechy, in Bhutan. 192 RELIGIOrs RUlLDINCxS AND MONUMENTS. Keligious nionuinents. Buddhism has erected various religious monuments, O 7 amongst which are particularly to be mentioned the Chortens, the Manis, and the Derchoks and Ixapchas. 1 . Chortens. The motive for the erection of these monuments is identical to that which gave rise to the frequent erection of the Stupas, or Chaityas of ancient Buddhism in India, of which so great a number have been recently dis- covered in India and Afghanistan and carefully examined.^ But a peculiaritj' of the Chortens is the use which the Tibetans make of them. The name of Chorten denotes at once their nature and object, for its component words /achliod, and 7-ten signify “an offering” and “to keep, a receptacle.” The Tibetan mode of spelling this word would imply that its pronunciation was Chodten, but the “d” before “t” is suppressed, and the “r” is heard, although, according to grammatical rules it should be mute. The Tibetans of Gnari Khorsum, however, pronounce Chogdan; Gerard^ MTites Chosten or Chokten, a designation which appears ' Concerning the ideas connected with Stupas, and the reports about their construction and the objects which have been digged out, see the works of Ritter, “Die Stupas,” Berlin 1834. Wilson, “Ariana antiqua,” London, 1841. Cunningham, “The Bhilsa Topes,” London, 1854. Sykes, “On the miniature Chaityas,” R. A. S., 1856; and “Account of Golden Relics,” R. A. S., 1857. Compare also Burnouf, “Introduction,” p. 346. Respecting their age Wilson, “Buddha and Buddhism,” R. A. Soc., p. 249, is of opinion that the custom of erecting Stupas is somewhat posterior to that of excavating temples and constructing Viharas, or monasteries; the Stupas in the North-west of India were most probably erected in a period commencing with the first years of the Christian era and terminating in the sixth century. ^ “ Kanawur,” ]). 124. CHOKTENS. 193 to be a dialectical modification. Both lie and Cunning- liam* also mention the name Donkten or Dimgten for those Chortens in which relics are deposited — a name wliich seems not frequently used. The ancient Stupas were originally meant as recep- tacles for relics of either the Buddhas or the B5dhi- sattvas and the kings who encouraged the propagation of the Buddhist faith. But already in the early periods of Buddhism Stupas were constructed ex voto as sym- bolical substitutes for a tomb with a sacred relic, either for marking the spot where remarkable incidents in the sacred history had taken place, or for decorating the Yiharas and temples. Their erection is considered as an act of devotion and reverence paid to the Buddhas, and was recommended already in the ancient legends as a most meritorious work. The Tibetan Chortens also serve as relic repositories, as they enclose remains of revered Lamas, sacred VTitings, consecrated objects, &c., deposited therein already at their erection. Chortens containing bones or ashes in a box are erected in the burial grounds; Chortens with writings are of smaller size, and are ranged upon the altars; they typify the Buddha’s mercy. ^ But the predom- inant idea connected with the Chortens is that of their being offering receptacles,^ for no Tibetan passes them without depositing some sort of oblation, either on the * “Ladak,” p. 377. “ See p. 137. ’ Also the Singhalese believe the protection of Buddha not to be obtained by simply going near a Dagopa (= Stupa) or other sacred place, if the passer-by performs no particular act of worship. Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” p. 210, compare also p. 223. 13 194 RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. steps, or in the interior by a small opening leading to a shrine. The objects deposited arc chief!}’ the Satsas, or Tsatsas, which are very generally made on the road by kneading a portion of clay between the tingers; the}’ are conical, in imitation of the form of a Chorten. Other Satsas represent Buddhas, or have a sacred sentence pressed upon by means of moulds; the latter are bought from the Lamas. ' The quantit}’ of Satsas is reall}’ astonishing; it not unfrequently happens that the steps are nearly hidden by the heaps of Satsas. The form of the Chortens varies much more than that of their prototypes, the Stupas. The base of the Stfipa is a cylinder or cube, upon which a body shaped like a cupola is set up. Stupas which have been broken down have been found to bo solid buildings, with a little shrine in the centre only, in which had been deposited the burnt bones of a human being, together with coins, jewels and inscribed slabs. The bones are sometimes enclosed in small cases made of the precious metals. In the Tibetan Chortens this form has in general undergone considerable modifications; the unaltered ancient type has remained limited to the smaller Chortens put up in the temples. The principal difference between a Stupa and a Chorten is that in the latter the cupola is cither surmounted by a cone, or that it is inverted. Tlie most general style is the following: The base is a cube, upon which rests the inverted cupola; this cupola is the prin- ciiial part; it encloses the objects enshrined, and in it is * In ]\Iongolia, the name Satsa, by Pallas called Zaga, is applied to the cones of cla}' only: see his “Mongol. Volker,” Vol. II., pp. KtS, 211. CITOETENS. 195 the hole leading to the space for the offenngs. A graduated pinnacle rises above it, and this is either a cone of stones or a wooden spire; it is surmounted by a disk placed horizontally and a pear-shaped point, or, instead of it, by a crescent supporting a globe and the pear upon that. Chortens of this form occur in every Tibetan district. They are exclusively used in Bhutan and Sikkim, and are also met with in the plans of sacred temples; but in other parts of Tibet several other forms are seen. Of these 1 mention the following: In Ladak a moderately high cone, similar to the roof of a building, and projecting over the border of the inverted cupola, forms its top ; it either rests immediately upon the cupola, or a cube of smaller dimensions is interposed between them. This cone ends in a wooden point similar in shape to the point of a spear, or there is a slender pole the size of which diminishes with the scarcity of wood. Originall}^ a flag with prayers printed upon it was fastened to every pole; but in most cases only rags are left, or the flags have been blown away entirely. In Gnari Khorsum some Chor- tens are more like a tower ; upon a cube as base is placed a body square at the base and slightly pyramidal in form, which, after diminishing a little and again increasing in width, is surmounted by a bell-shaped projecting top, or a bell resting upon a little tower. When new or in good condition it is surmounted by a pole embellished with a flag. The Chortens in the environs of Tholing are plainly pyramidal, consisting of five to six steps; the upper end is a small cube covered by a conical roof. Others can be described in reference to their principal parts as a cube 13 * u 19G RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. notched into several steps, supporting an angular bell-shaped body : these Chortens are very similar to the ancient Stupas. The materials used for the Chortens in the open air are rough stones, bricks,' or clay; they are almost all of solid masonry. The outer surfaces are thickly plastered with mortar, which is coloured red with the dust of pounded bricks. Grooves are formed similar to the panels on European doors, and simple ornaments are delineated in the mortar. Only once, at Gyungul, in Gnari Khorsum, my brother Adolphe saw a hollow' tow^er-chorten, wdiich w^as constructed of planks. It stood close to the mon- astery, and was perhaps but an enclosure for smaller Chortens, similar to those w'hich Gerard had seen in Kanaur,^ wdiere they are open in front; this is not the case wdth the Chorten at Gyhngul, wdiich has four w^alls and no entrance. The height of the Chortens is in general from 8 to 1 5 ft., though a few considerably exceed this latter height, attaining to as much as 40 ft. Those set up in the temples are moulded from metal, or more generally from clay^<=^^ | mixed wdth chopped straw' ; occasionally they are carved of w'ood ; but such Chortens scarcely ' ever exceed four feet; they are often not higher than as many inches. 2. Manis. Mani, originally a Sanskrit w'ord meaning “a precious stone,”® which became naturahsed in Tibetan, is used to ' The custom of hardening the bricks in the sun originated in the power- ful insolation, combined with the very small amount of humidity in the atmosphere. ^ Gerard, “Kanawur,” p. 124. ^ The prayer cylinders are also called “Manis.” MANIS. 197 designate walls of about six feet in height and four to eight feet in breadth, but their length varies much more considerably. The largest hitherto known is that which is situated on the road from the banks of the Indus to Leh; according to Cunningham it has a length of 2200 ft.' Two others at Leh itself Hermann found to be re- spectively 459 and 386 ft. in length. He also measured one at Mandang, near Darjiling, in Sikkim, which was 90 ft.: another at Narigiin was 244 ft. in length. The Manis are constructed in the higher valleys of loose stones only, whilst in the lower ones, where mortar is not so expensive an article, lime is used. Some of the large Manis have a kind of tower at both their ends, occasionally in the form of a Chorte n. with a sacred image in front; if, as is sometimes the case, the Mani is made longer, the old tower remains and a new one is added at the end of the prolongation. Large poles, to which flags with prayers' are attached, are also not un- frequent at the ends of the Manis. Kough, irregularly rectangular stone slabs greatly dift’ering in size, and bearing inscriptions in Tibetan or Lantsa characters,^ or adorned with images of deities, lean against the upper part of the wall or are laid dow'n on the roof of the Mani. The most frequent inscription met with in the stone slabs is the six-syllabic prayer: Om mani padme hum;^ or adorations of Vajrasattva, as: * “Ladak,” p. 378. '■“ See p. 80. ^ This sentence was traced in enormous characters, formed by blackish stones, on the slope of the mountain opposite Lama Yiirru, and was visible at a great distance. 198 llELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. Om, ah, 1mm; vajra guru padma siddhi hum; of Vajra- pani, as; Om Vajrapani hum; or mystical ejaculations, as; Om, ah, hum. Amongst the names of deities engraved on the stone slabs, we frequently find Sakyamuni, Padmapani, Padma Sambhaba, Vajrapani (see Plate II.), and different recluses. The slabs are, according to Cunningham, votive offerings made for the - purpose of obtaining the ful- filment of particular wishes. Travellers, when passing along the Manis, leave them on the left hand, in order to follow the succession of the letters of the inscriptions. ^ H. Dcrcliuks and Lapchas. Almost every building is decorated with tiags, attached to a })ole set up before the edifice, such tiags being- considered efficacious in preventing the evil spirits from doing mischief. Single flags are also met with in front of religious buildings, and along the road; those before large monasteries are often of considerable height; the two largest which my brothers saw were planted in front of the entrance to the monastery of Himis;^ one was 45, the other even 57 ft. in height, and as there is no tree in Tibet attaining such a height, these poles * Gerard, iu his “Kaiiawur,” p. l‘J3, remarks tliat passers-by always leave the Manis to their right, and expresses his belief that superstition is the reason for their doing so ; but niy brothers never saw their people pass them in this way, but always so as to leave the Maui on the left hand; and they were told by several Lamas that the reason for this was, that in so passing by they could follow the characters, instead of having to spell backwards. - See my brother Hermann’s “Views of the monastery of liimis,” in the -Vtlas to the “Kesults of a Seientilie Mission.” DERCIIOKS ANE LAPCHAS. 199 must have been transported with great dilliculty, across the Himalaya. The upper part of these poles was decorated with three concentric rings of black yaks-hair suspended at some distance from each other; whilst in general the poles have but one tuft of yaks-hair surmounted by a gilt spear-end. Tlie flags are called Derchok (the Durchut of Grerard), the heap of loose stones to support the pole, Lapeha; botli terms are doubtless words of popular origin, not occurring in the Dictionaries. The “der” in Derchok might be explained from dar, sill:, a stuff sometimes used for flags. Lapeha is very probably a modification of lab-tse, “a heap,” which also occurs in geographical names, either in the form of Labtse, as in Labtse Nagu and Labtse Chhu, in Gnari Khorsum, or as Lapeha.* Some flags are of a regular shape, and prayers and in- cantations (such as “Om mani padme hum”), invocations of the airy horse (in Tibetan Lungta), the magical figure Phurbu, and others, are printed upon them. These printed flags are fastened to the pole on the longest side, and are prevented from loosely hanging down and folding by horizontal red sticks. Other flags are mere rags of every size and material; such rags are chiefly added by travellers to the Lapehas found along the route, in order to obtain “a happy journey.” Nowhere are Lapehas more numerous than on the highest point of a pass, and not unfrequently one is surprised to find a Lapeha even on * For details I refer to llcrniaiin’s ‘‘Glossary of Geographical names,” 6'. c. Lapeha which forms Part. 11. of Vol. 111. of the “Results.” 200 RELIGIOUS BUILDINGS AND MONUMENTS. high spots situated out of the regular road; the reason is that the frontiers of provinces are likewise marked by irregular heaps of stones, ^ and thus, even on the top of the Gunshankar, in Gnari Khorsum, which attains a height of 19,099 ft., my brothers found a Lapcha. Their Buddhist companions were always most eager to add new flags wherever they passed, or to erect a new Lapcha by making a large heap of stones, in the middle of which they set up one of their almost in- dispensable mountain-sticks, which was then decorated with flags, partly made from my brothers’ handkerchiefs, partly from the bags in which they had kept their provisions, and from pieces of their very dress. When every one had made his contribution to the Derchok, they walked solemnly round the heap whispering prayers. * Comp. Georgi, “Alphabetum Tibetanum,” p. 508. CH.VPTER XIV. REPRESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. Deities Represented.— Methods of executing sacked Objects. Drawings and paintings. — Statues and bas-reliefs. — Characteristic Types. — General attitude of the body and position of the fingers.- — Buddhas. — Bodhisattvas. — Priests, ancient and modern. — Dragsheds. Illustrations derived from Measurements. Deities represented. We learn from the ancient legends, that already in the earliest periods of Buddhism relics and images of the Buddha had been highly honoured; the religious works recommend them to be worshipped, as also the monuments in which the relics are deposited; and we find it mentioned that the images which were sent to royal persons at their desire, were previously inscribed with the sacred dogma “Ye Dharma,” &c., and similar formulae, in order to make them acquainted with Buddhist doctrines.^ Such were the earliest objects of worship; the mode of worship was also very simple ; prosternations were made before the images of the Buddha, flowers and ' Burnouf, Introduction,” p. 337-51. Schmidt, “Grundlehrcn.” Mem. de I’Acad. de St. Petcrsb., Vol. I., p. 238. For the Sanskrit and Tibetan text sec Plate I. 202 EEPRESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. perfumes were offered, and prayers and hymns recited for their glorification. The same simplicity of rite pre- vailed still ill the seventh century a.d., as we learn from Hiuen Thsang, though the objects of adoration and wor- ship had increased in number; for Hiuen Thsang men- tions, that the principal disciples of Sakyamuni were then worshipped, as also the' Bodhisattvas who had excelled in virtue and in the sciences, as Manjiisrl; the Mahayana schools, he says, have adored even all Bodhisattvas without any further distinction.^ At the present day, besides the tilings and persons just mentioned, the mythological Buddhas preceding Sa- kyamuni as well as those who will follow him, their cor- responding Dhyaiii Buddhas and Dhyani Bodhisattvas, are worshipped, and a host of gods, spirits, and deified priests enjoying a local reputation for sanctity. In order to furnish an idea of their immense number, I mention, that the Ti- betan collection of Buddhist images, known under the name “Gallery of Portraits,” contains the drawings of more than three hundred Buddhas, saints, &c., each having his name added beneath.^ Methods of executing sacred objects. Modern Buddhism, in ordei' to facihtate the wor- ship of its many deities, has made representations of ' Barlhclemy St. Hilaire, “Le Buddha ct sa Religion,” p. 288-297. ^ This “Gallery of Portraits” is similar to the Japanese collection of Buddha figures, entitled “the Buddha Pantheon of Nippon,” which was com- piled 1090 and consists of G31 drawings. Prof. J. Hofmann at Leyden has imblished it and illustrated it by annotations in Siebold’s “Nippon, Archiv zur Beschreibung von Japan,” Vol. V. METHODS OF EXECUTION. 203 them in prodigious quantities. Copies are met with every- where, not a temple but contains lots of them ; they are set up in the private houses and in the open air; and title-pages of printed books, nay even the headings of each chapter are frequently embellished either by a black figure, or by a coloured one. This astonishingly frequent application of representations has probably sprung from the belief, that the image, by being consecrated, becomes •‘animated,” amilakho in Mongolian, viz. endowed with the powers of the God whom it represents; addresses, therefore, may be directed not only to the God himself, but also to his respective image.^ The images are manufactured exclusively by the Lamas, who excel herein like their masters the Chinese (who first introduced the images of the Buddha into Tibet), and from wliom they afterwards learned how to over- come many of the technical difficulties connected with the manufacture.^ The monopoly now exercised by the Lamas has chiefly resulted from the belief that prayers directed to representations are efficacious only when the}’ have been executed under prescribed forms and cere- monies, which the clergy alone know how to perform. The ceremonies to be observed are most numerous and various; there are certain days proper for the com- mencement of a particular picture, and others again on ' Sec Schmidt, “Ssanaug Ssetseu,” p. 330. I refer the reader to the legends about the alleged influence of the pictures brought to Tibet by the wives of Srongtsan Gampo on the spreading of Buddhism and the welfare of the Tibetans. Ibidem p. 345. - With reference to Chinese art compare Not! and Gliddon, ‘‘Indigenous Races,” p. 302. 204 REPEESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. whicli alone the eyes are to be painted, these being con- sidered the most important part of the whole picture; besides which during the various stages of progress of each picture other ceremonies and prayers are requisite. Thus, benedictory ceremonies^ have to be performed immediately after the entire completion of the image, in order that in the meantime no malignant spirit (which beings are considered to be always on the watch to do mischief to man) may take possession of it, whereby the prayers would be rendered utterly valueless. Plastic objects, such as statues and bas-reliefs, are not less numerous than drawings and paintings. Braivings and paintings. The patterns for drawings are called Sagpar, and are made by desribing the out- lines of an original drawing with numerous pin-holes, and by rubbing coal-dust into these holes the outlines are transmitted to paper or canvass, prepared with lime and flour-paste; the stratum when dry and hard, is carefully polished with stones before being used."^ The lines are then traced with China ink, and the different parts of the picture covered with colours of a uni- form tint; only few ornaments are shaded. The picture, when comjjleted, is bordered by several strips of silk, called Thonka, generally three in number, blue, yellow, and red; occasionally also irregular rags of other colours are sewed to its borders. As they have no glass, they ' A work embodied iu the Gyut division of the Kanjur also treats of the ceremonies to be performed on such occasions. See Csoma, “Analysis,” As. Kcs., Vol. XX., p. 503. - The Kalmuks and also the Mongolians print the outlines with woodcuts. Pallas, “Mongol. Volker,” Vol. II., p. 105. STATUES AND BAS-EELIEFS. 205 use for protection against dust silk vail-like coverings; and the only part corresponding to the frame of our pictures, is represented by two round wooden sticks, one of v'hich is passed through the upper border, the other through the lower one; they facilitate the hanging up of the picture and at. the same time keep it stretched when hung up. The lower stick is also used to roll the picture upon when sent about. Statues and bas-reliefs. In the construction of these things moulds are used which are filled out with various plastic materials, such as clay, or a kind of papier- mache, or bread-dough; the positive objects are then generally dried in the sun. Metal figures are but rarely made. The statues are often painted or slightly gilt. As a peculiarity I must mention that even butter is used; it is tinted with different vegetable colours before being put into the mould; the head, the feet, and the hands are filled out in the mould with yellow butter, the garments with red, and so on. They remain put up before the sacred images till the butter, by decom- position, becomes intolerable ; they are then thrown away.^ The sharpness of the statuettes and medallions, even of the smallest, is quite surprising. The most esteemed plastic figures are those in which are enclosed relics (as ashes, bones, hair, rags of the garments of saints), or grains first offered to the Buddhas in divine worship. The grains, before being put into the figures, are consecrated again by a particular cere- * Compare also Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. IL, p. 95. In Ceylon temporary images are made of rice. Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” p. 202. 206 EEPRESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. niony, called Ivabne zhugpa. Relics and grains are either mixed with the material of which the figure is composed, or they are enshrined in a small hole at the bottom or back, the hole being called Zung zhug, '■‘Dharam place,” from the Zungs or Dharanis read during the cere- monies of the consecration. The hole is closed asrain by a seal, in order to 'prevent the objects from falling- out or from being taken out ^vithout the fact being- discovered, for then the figure is supposed to have lost all its beneficial influence. Figures containing such sacred objects, are styled Satsa, or Tsatsa, a name which is also given to the chorten-like cones moulded from clay by travellers.^ In the drawings, as well as upon the sculptures a variety of symbolical signs occur. Hodgson has drawn attention in several of his papers to these signs as a means ofdetermining that ruins showing such symbols are certainly Buddhist remains; he has recently published a collection of 110 symbols, which were extracted from Hepalese Buddhist images, books, and engravings on stone — a collection highly important for tracing the extent of Buddhism in earlier periods. In these papers Hodgson points out in several instances the identity of Buddhist symbols with those upon images of Sivaitic deities; but by closely examining- their meaning- with the Buddhists, he came to the conclusion “that the things typified are always more or less, and generally radically, different;” and his opinion is highly supported by Hofmann, who Comp. p. 194. ('HARACTErvIRTIC TYPES. 207 made analogous researches about Japanese writings and images.' Characteristic types. A eomparison of the images of various sacred per- sons shows at once a strongly marked difference in attitude, features, dress, and emblems between the various groups, particularly between the Buddhas, the Bodhi- sattvas, the priests (ancient and modern), and the Dragsheds. General attitude of the body and position of the fingers. The artist who makes a representation of any god, is not allowed to follow his own idea or to make any alteration in the original design. But man}’’ of the gods may be represented in several attitudes recalling some of the glorious and important moments of their life. Thus, Sdhgamuni, with one hand uplifted, denotes his character as a teacher; a sitting attitude, with one hand holding the alms-bowl, the other hanging down over the knee, is chosen to represent him plunged in meditation; a re- cumbent position means his having left the world for ever. PadmapanVs eleven faces and thousand hands and feet refer to the legend about the cleaving of his head. Melha, the God of fire, when driving away the evil spirits, rides a red ram, and has a most horrible coun- tenance; whilst in representations not having for object ' Hodgson, “Illustrations,” p. 209. Journ. of the R. A. Soc., Vol. XVIII., p. 393 ; thirty-three symbols derived from coins have been omitted from considerations of cost. See instead of them the series of 168 compiled by Wilson, Plate XXII., in his “Ariana antiqua.” — Hofmann, “Nippon Pantheon;” remarks annexed to Fig. 1G3, 432. 208 EEPEESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. to show his wrath, his attitude and type are those of a Buddha. The positions of the fingers, also (in Tibetan Chakja, literally an emblem, a seal, in Sanskrit Mudra), have an allegorical meaning. Thus, the right hand hanging down over the knee, vdth the palm of the hand turned out- wards, S}Tnbolizes charity, and is called Chagye chin, “the right hand of charity.” The attitude Kangi nying gar thalmo charva, i. e. “uniting the palms of the hands on one’s heart,” is the following: — The two hands uplifted, a finger of the right hand touching one or two fingers of the left hand, like a man accustomed to use his fingers in explaining his meaning. This attitude typifies “the unity of wisdom with matterj” in Tibetan Thabshes, or Thabdang shesrab, or the assuming of the material forms by the Buddhas and Bodhisattvas for the purpose of spreading the right understanding amongst animated beings. It is certainly not accidental that none of the Buddhist gestures are identical with those made by the Brahmans when per- forming the ceremonies of their creed.‘ The Buddhas are men, but men of the most perfect form, endowed with thirty-two superior beauties, and eighty or eighty- four secondary ones.^ It is in strict conformity with these characteristics, that the Buddhas are represented with soft and smihng features, which are * These have been collected in Mrs. S. C. Belnos’ folio work, “ The Sundya, or daily prayers of the Brahmans.” London 1851. For Buddhist gestures see the plates of Hofmann’s “Buddha Pantheon.” ^ See concerning these, Burnouf, “Lc Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” Appen- dix VIII. Hardy, “Manual of Buddhism,” p. 367. Compare also p. 140. TYPE OF BUDDHA8. 20!) also given to Maitreya, the 1‘uture Buddlia, who in the other attributes is likewise ('qual to the Buddhas wdio liave already appeared. These, the Manushi Bnddhas, are of gold or yellow complexion; both colours are identical, the latter being but the cheaper substitute for gold. The ears are large, the laps rest upon the shoulders; the arms are long; there is a single hair on the forehead, called in Sanskrit Urna; on the crown of the head is a cylindrical elevation, in Sanskrit Uslmisha, in Tibetan Tsugtor, and Irom this rises a conical ornament called in Tibetan Progzhu, or Chodpan, “a head-ornament, a crown, iliadem,” which is almost always gilt. The Buddhists view the Ushmsha as an excrescence of the skull, an inter- pretation, however, which is not supported by the ety- mology of the name, which would restrict its meaning to “a turban,” or “dressed hair.” I believe this curious protuberance to have resulted from the way of dressing the hair practised by the Brahmans, which is decidedly very ancient, and is found to be the same as that on the oldest figures we know. The Brahmans cut away the hair, except that on a circular space on the crown, which they twust into a knot. It is most probable that the Buddhist have conferred upon tlieir sublime masters this prerogative of the highest Indian caste.* ' Burnouf, “Lotus,” p. 5i38, believes this hair-dress to have been adopted as a protection .against the dangerous influence of the sun. — A trace of the original view has also been retained in the Tibetan term Tsugtor for Ushnisha, which is explained in the Dictionaries to mean “a tuft of htiir,” as well as “a sort of excrescence on the crown of the head.” A Nepalese Buddha priest, also, speaking of Yajrasattva’s image at Buddha Gayah, says; “The lock on the crown of the head is twisted into a turban.” Hodgson, “Illustra- tions,” p. 206. 14 210 REPEESENTATIOKS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. The Dhyani Buddhas and the mythological Buddhas liave a white, red, green or blue complexion. The Dhyilni Buddhas are, besides, distinguished by a. third eye on the forehead — the eye of wisdom, in Tibetan Shesrab chan; in those images of Padmapani in which he is represented with a great many hands, this eye is also traced in the palm of his hands. All Buddhas are dressed in the religious shawl, the Bagoi, which is generally folded round the body and over the left shoulder, with a small end coming up over the right shoulder also.‘ Tlie heads are encircled by a glory, typifying a leaf of the sacred fig-tree {ficus re- ligiosa), under whose shadow Sakyamuni had obtained tlie supreme intelligence; in ancient figures this glory is sometimes pointed and oval, like such a leaf, but -in modern representations it has universally a circular i'orm.^ The right hand of the Buddhas is always represented empty, while in the left is often seen the alms-bowl, in Tibetan Lhungzed, in Sanskrit Patra. The predominant posture is the sitting one, the legs being crossed and the soles of the feet turned upwards; it is called Borje kyilkrung. This is said to have been Sakyamuni’s at- titude in his mother’s womb. Images with one foot lianging down over the throne, are not frequent; the European fashion of sitting should be given to Maitre3'a, * For a description of the Lagoi see p. 172. - Sec Hitter, “Die Stupas,” p. 232, 267. Concerning the origin of the \vor.ship of the fig-tree, compare Hardy, “Eastern Monachism,” p. 212. Each Buddha has his peculiar tree. Ibid. p. 2 lb, and “iSIauual of Bud- dhism,” p. 94. TYPE OF BUUmiAS. 211 for this mode is called after him Cliamzhug, sitting-like Cham})a (Maitreya) ; but in the images in our possession lie is figured cross-logged like the others. The Buddhas, whenever they occupy the central part of a picture,^ are seated upon “the throne of lions,” in Sanskrit Simhasana, in Tibetan Sengti, or Senge chad ti, “the seat of eight lions.” The throm^ is so called from the eight lions which support it; in the drawings, however, two lions only are seen in front. Over the throne a cloth is spread called “the upper cover,” Tib. Tenkab, one end of which hangs down, and is decorated with symbols or the figure of a god; on both sides of this Tenkab are not unfrequently seen the heads of two animals, which Hodgson has called “supporters.”^ As each Buddha and Bodhisattva has his peculiar animals, they most materially facilitate the determination of the subject of the picture. In images of Sakyamuni, e. g., two peacocks are frequently drawn at the sides of the Tenkab, the form of their long neck being an allusion to the grass Kusa, of which he had made the cushion he sat down upon under the Bodhi- * The Tibetans like to group together into the same picture several gods, some of whom are represented in formidable attitudes, whilst the others display a smiling countenance. The principal figure is the central one; of the surrounding persons some may have a connexion with him, others have decidedly none. The central figure is very frequently sitting in the middle of a landscape representing the ocean bordered by steep shores beneath him; two snowy mountains rise to the left and right of him; and a dark blue, clouded sky, with the sun and the moon typified by two bright circles, extend above him. Compare Pallas, “Mongol. Volkerschaften,'’ Vol. II., p. 105. - “Illustrations,” p. 43. The mystical signs upon the Tenkab he calls “cognizances, or mudras.” W. v. Humboldt, “Kawi Sprache,” Vol. I., p. 137, compares them with a heraldic crest and its supporters. 14* 212 REPKESENTATIOXS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. tree in order to obtain sii})reme wisdom. Tlie throne has a ricldy ornamented frame, composed of fantastic animals, of which the lower ones are represented lying down, the upper ones standing on the heads of the animals below and raising the fore-feet. On the top of the frame hgures very generally the mythological bird Gam da. ' Tlie interior of the frame is called Jabyol, “back cur- tain,” and is most frequently of a dark colour. The cushion which is upon the throne is a lotus-flower. The BodMsatfvas, the Dhyani Bodhisattvas as well as those of human origin, are represented like the Buddhas, with a smiling countenance and with a glory; their hair is not unfrequently pushed backwards from the forehead and done up into a cone rising above the head, and occasionally showing the curling of the hair; it is em- bellished with several gold galloons. They sit upon a lotus-flower, but the throne of lions is not accorded to them; in images where the figures are represented in a standing position the lotus pedicle grows out of the water. Several segments of a circle beginning at the feet and joining the glory, serve as frames for these pictures. The Bbdhisattvas are never represented with the large religious shawl Lagoi; their dress is a kind of philibeg, which is wound round the legs in the fashion adopted by the modern Hindus. A large piece of cloth is rolled round the waist, one end of which is passed under the leg and then drawn up and fastened to the ' Already in ancient statues these are met with ; sec Crawfurd, Lit. Soc. of Bombay, Vol. II., p. 154, reprinted in his “Archipelago.” Pillars with sculptures of mythological animals are also a frequent ornament in Hindu architecture; I quote as an instance the principal temple at Tanjor. TYJ'E OF BODHISATTVAS. 213 girdle. This mode of covering the privy [)arts is very ancient, for we find it represented in numerous ancient figures;^ it is altogether remarkable how little alteration Asiatic dress and fashion have undergone in thousands of years, whilst in a space of ten centuries Europe has experienced so many variations. A large shawl falls down from the shoulders, the ends floating in the air. The neck, ears, and feet are ornamented with necklace- like ornaments and rings. The objects which the Bodhisattvas hold in their hands have reference to their functions, so frequenth" mentioned in the legends. Thus, Manjusri, the god of wisdom, holds a book and a sword, in allusion to his dissipating the darkness of the mind. The lotus-flower (Padina) in Padmapani’s hands has reference to his birth out of this flower. An object frequently found in the hands is a snare, in Tibetan Zhagpa, wherewith, in a typical sense, to catch men in order to impart to them supreme wisdom. There is an interesting explanation of this symbol given in the Nippon Pantheon,^ in con- nexion with an image of Padmapani; — ‘‘He disseminates upon the ocean of birth and decay the Lotus-flower of the excellent law as bait; with the loop of devotion, never cast out in vain, he brings living- beings iqj like fishes, and carries them to the other side of the river, where there is true understanding.” Priests, ancient and modern. The disciples of 8akya- muni and the later Indian priests are always represented * See Cunningham, “The Bliilsa Topes,” Plate Xll. ’ Nippon Pantheon, Fig. OS. 214 KEPRESENTATIONS OF BUDDHIST DEITIES. with the head uncovered and their hair cut short; a characteristic attribute of the former class is the alarm- stick Kharsil, in Sanskrit Hikilo, with which the Indian Buddhist mendicants made a noise when collecting alms, by shaking it and rattling with the metal rings which were passed round the stick and were prevented from being lost by a frame of metallic wire imitating the out- lines of a leaf.* The figures of the Tibetan Lamas are distinguished by pointed caps. The Dmgslieds, or the gods who protect man against the evil spirits, are always represented with a formidable countenance and a complexion very often quite dark;^ the third eye, the eye of wisdom, upon the forehead has its longer axis in a vertical position. Lha Doljang,^ the deified consort of King Srongtsan Gampo, has it also traced in her hands and on the soles of her feet; these marks have even a surprising accidental resemblance to the nail marks of our saviour. Some are even figured as fantastic beings, with the head or tail of animals. The glory gives place to flames typifying destruction.^ ‘ See Schiefner, “Tib. Lebensbeschreibung,” Mem. des savants etrangers, Vol. VI., p. 323; and Foe koue ki, pp. 92, 355, for a description of the staff of Sakyamuni. In the Kaujur, Do division, Vol. XXVI., we meet with a treatise in which the use of this staff is explained. Csoma, As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 479. The Kharsils engraved upon the official seals of the head Lamas of monasteries end in a trident instead of having a leaf-shaped metallic frame. “ Compare p. Ill, and Pallas, “Mongol. Volkerschaften,” Vol. II., p. 105. ^ See p. 66. ■* Also in the curious manuscript volume on Bermese mythology, presented by Dr. G. v. Liebig to the Munich library (Cim. 102), an analogous ornamental use of flames for the ornaments of the head and of the bracelets is repeatedly met with, even parts of their dress floating away in the wind terminate in flames. TYPE or DllAGSUEES. 215 They are almost naked; the tiger’s skin, with its feet tied under the chin, hangs down behind from the shoulders, and its lower end is the cushion of their seat ; they also wear a necklace of human skulls, and foot and arm rings. Dragsheds represented standing have the legs in a straddling position, the feet not unfrequently resting upon men ; some are seated on animals, generally horses or lions ; but camels, yaks, deer, and even crocodiles, also occur, though never elephants. The colour of these animals often deviates from the natural one ; for green and yellow horses are met with, as well as lions with a green mane, and blue crocodiles. The instruments in the hands of the Dragsheds are for the greater part symbolic of their power over the evil spirits. These instruments are: — 1. The Dorje, in Sanskrit Vajra. It may best be compared with four or eight metallic hoops joined together so as to form two balls; their central axis is a cylindrical staff, the points of which project. In drawings, however, only two hoops are seen, the two others, for want of perspective, absolutely coincide with the axis. Dorjes of one ball only are also met with in drawings, which, for the sake of distinction, I call, in those places where they occur, “half Dorjes.” 2. The Phiirhu, “the nail,” three of which are gen- erally united into a triangle, which is attached to a handle terminating in a half Dorje. 3. The Beckon, “the club or heavy stick,” a staff about as high as a man, with the trident, Tsesum, 216 JlErKESENTATiONS OF EUODHIST DEITIES. in Saiiskiit Trisula, at one end, and a half Dorje at the other. 4. Z]iarcscnt, assumed a thoroughly serious character. Page 236. FESTIVALS. 2.37 at last be approaches the limit of Buddha. Still he professes to be equally fearless, and bids defiance to the woolly-headed priest who carries the alms- bowl from door to door like a common mendicant; but the moment he attempts to pass the limit, he falls down as if dead; and as he is regarded as suffering the punish- ment of the blasphemy he had dared to utter, all who are present applaud the greatness of him whose prowess is thus proved to be superior to that of all other beings.” Sacred days and festivals. Monthly and annual festivals. The monthly festivals are in some countries four in number, connected with the phases of the moon ; in others only three of these days are celebrated, those of the first quarter of the moon, of full moon and of new moon. On these days no animal food should be taken nor any animal killed; and those who do so are threatened with severe punishments in a future existence. To abstain from worldly occupations is, however, not enacted, and as the Buddhist lajunen in the Himalaya and Western Tibet are not very fond of passing the whole day in prayers and in the temples,^ these holy days are not particularly marked in the habits of the population. But the Lamas spend more time in the temples; they perform the ceremony Tuisol, for the taking away of ' The northern Mongolians show in this regard much more devotion. See Pallas, “Reisen,” French translation, p. 562. 238 WOESHIP OF THE HEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEKEMONIES. sins, and they make confession in a more solemn wa}". The confession of sins is preceded and followed by the reading and reciting of passages from sacred books, which occupation is sometimes continued for da}''s, during which time the taking of food and drinking are reduced to a minimum. These austerities, for the deliver- ance from sins, bear the name of Nyungne, or Nyungpar nepai choga. Every layman is allowed to undergo the hardships connected with this kind of confession, but as less painful modes have, in their opinion, the same effect,' the Tibetans — priests as well as laj^men — submit to them only so and so many times a year, and not, as they ought properly to do, three times a month. In general, the Lamas do no more than read certain books and celebrate the ceremony Tuisol; the laymen make prostra- tions before the images of particular gods, and repeat more sentences than on other days. Annual festivals. In almost every month a particular religious festivity is celebrated, and public amusements are got up on such days; the festivities — religious as weU as pubhc — are the most varied at the following periods, which are regarded as the most sacred: About the first of February the festival of the New Year is celebrated; on the fifteenth of the fourth moon (about the beginning of May) honour is done to “Sakyamuui’s having entered the womb of his mother;” on the fifteenth of the seventh moon (in August), before the cutting of the grain, solemn processions are made into the fields, where prayers are offered up and thanksgivings repeated Compare p. 95. THE CEREMONY TUISOL. 239 for tlie blessings of liarvcst ; tlie twenty-fifth of the same month is the anniversary of the death of Tson- khapa. For the particular festivals of these days, which are very grand and diversified in character in places where incarnated priests reside, I refer the reader to the “Description dii Tubet,” translated from the Chinese, and Hue, Pallas, and Klaproth/ My brothers, however, were not present at any of them, and I therefore restrict myself to quoting the works where descriptions of them may be found; but I now give the details which my brothers obtained concerning the ceremonies Tuisol and Nyungne. The Ceremony Tuisol. The Tuisol, “to pray for ablution,”^ ranks amongst the most sacred of the Buddhist rites, and is performed at every solemn assembly for the washing away of sins. Water is poured out from a vessel similar to a teapot, called Mangu, and also Bumpa, over the vessel’s well- cleaned cover, called Yanga, or a particular metallic mirror, Melong, which is held so, that it reflects the image of Sakyamuni which stands on the altar. The water falls down into a fiat vessel, called Dorma,^ placed ' Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., p. 140. Pallas, “Mongol. Volker,” Vol. II., pp. 190-215. Klaproth, “Reise in den Kaukasus,” Vol. I., p. 193. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. I., pp. 96, 291, Vol. II., p. 95. Compare Koppen, “Die Rel. des Buddha,” Vol. II., pp. 309-15. ^ 6Krus, part. pret. from ’khrud-pa, “thoroughly washed, ablution;” ^sol, “to pray, beg for entreaty.” * The terms Mangu, Yanga, Dorma, appear to be local designations, as I could not find them in the dictionaries. In Sikkim the Mangu vessel was called by the Lepcha Lamas Guri, and the vessel for the reception of the water Thepshi. 240 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. H})on a tripod. The Lamas of Griiari Kliorsum informed my brothers that they put into the vessel a bag filled with rice, which they called Brakhug, “rice bag.”' The Ceremony Nyimgne, or Nyimypar nepai choya. This ceremony is performed in its full rigour only once or twice a year; its name means “to continue to abstain,” or “ceremony of continued abstinence.”^ It oc- cupies four days ; the prayers and passages of books read during them are chiefly in honour of Padmapani in his quality as Jigten Gronpo, “the protector of the world,” for his efforts to release mankind from the miseries of life.^ Any layman is allowed to take part in these cere- monies; he has to present himself in the afternoon at the monastery, well washed and in clean garments, with a rosary, a cup called Thor, and a bottle filled with pure water for washing. The first day, “the introductory exercises,” in Tibe- tan called Tagom,^ are performed, preparatory to those of the following day; prayers are recited and passages from sacred books are read under the direction of a learned Belong, who has been deputed by the head Lama. The second day is taken up with Chorva, “the preparations.”' 1 The Mongolians, according to Pallas, “Mongolische Yolker,” Vol. 11, pp. 161, 177 ; perfume the water with saffron, and sweeten it with sugar. ^ sNyung-par “to reduce (in food);” ^nas-pa “to continue;” chho-ga “ ceremony.” ^ Comp. pp. 88, 120. ■* ZTa “to view, theory;” gom “step; ” a literal translation gives; “step to the theory.” THE CEREMONY NYUNONE. 241 The devotees are called at sunrise, and wash and pi-os- trate themselves several times before the image of Pad- mapani. The head Lama then admonishes them no more to violate their vows, and to renew promises previously made; he commands them to confess their sins, and seriously to meditate upon the evils which result from them. He reads with his attendants for about an hour extracts from several books, an act which is called Sobyong, “confession, amendment of the vicious life.” The book Nyungpar nepai choga is then read till ten o’clock, when tea is taken (Cha-chosh, not Cha^j. After this the read- ing of books and the recital of prayers is continued till two o’clock, when a dinner is served, consisting of vege- tables and pastry; animal food is not allowed. After this scanty dinner, prayers and readings are continued till late at night; but at intervals, tea is handed round. Before retiring to rest, the head Lama specifies the various duties of the assembly for the following day, and orders them, as a penance, to slee^) according to “the mode of the lion,” Sengei nyal tab,* viz. to lie on the right side, to stretch out the feet, and to support the head with the right hand. The following day is the principal one; it is styled Ngoishi, “the substance, the reality.” The day is passed in rigorous abstinence from meat and drink — nay, it is not even allowed to swallow one’s saliva; every one has * ’Byor-ba, literally “to come, to arrive,” referring to the purification of sins resulting from these exercises. 2 See p. 168. ^ Seng-ge “the lion;” nyal “to sleep;” stahv “mode.” In this attitude Sakyamuni is believed to have entered Nirvana. 16 242 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND KELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. a vessel before him which ho uses as a spittoon. Weak persons, who are unable to endure for any length of time this ])ainful operation, are occasionally refreshed with some drops of water, and are brought for some moments into the open air. Not a word is allowed to be spoken, and should any body utter one, he is punished by having to sing some luTuns at the height of his voice. All prayers are to be recited in silence, and sinful actions have to be again re- pented of The abstinence from food and drink is con- tinued till the sun-rise of the next day; the head Lama then asks the assembly, whether there are any devotees willing to continue in like manner till the next morning — an operation which is considered a very efficacious means for obtaining deliverance from all sins; it is, however, extremely rare that any one feels strong enough to con- tinue. The head Lama therefore gives permission, to eat and drink, whereupon the assejnbly rise, leave the temple, and partake of a substantial meal, which the pious crowd have prepared for them outside. Rites for the attainment of supernatural faculties. The confidence in the powerful influence of prayers and ceremonies is so common among all Buddhist tribes of High Asia, that every undertaking is begun by them with the recital of incantations and the performance of certain ceremonies by which to appease the wrath of the demons; they, moreover, believe that b}" virtue of the strict observance of the duties connected with such rites. THE ATTAINMENT OF MAGICAL POWEKS. 243 they will in time acquire a miraculous magical energy, called Siddhi, and finally become liberated from me- tempsychosis. This view is not opposed to the prin- ciples of Buddhism, which declare that faculties superior to those with which nature has endowed man can be obtained by meditation, abstinence, the observation of moral duties, and true repentance for sins. This ex- hortation to a moral life, the consequences of which we see illustrated in the sacred books by numerous parables, is well adapted for exercising a favourable influence in mitigating the barbarous customs of the nations professing Buddhism ; but, by errors involved in the misunderstanding of the real aim of virtue, by the non-admittance of a supreme, all-dominating deity, and by the viewing of existence as the cause of all misery, Buddhism was rendered incapable of producing a civilization so general as that developed by Christianity.^ The books in which the magical arts are the most systematically treated are the Tantra Sabahupariprichcha, and the Lamrim of Tsonkhapa, in which every thing having reference to the theory as well as to the practical application is explained in full. In the Sabahupariprichcha- Vajrapani describes to the Bodhisattva Sabahu, in the usual form of a dialogue, the mode of performing various cere- monies, and indicates the prayers and incantations to be used during their performance, in order to acquire ‘ A very interesting dissertation on Buddhism is contained in Barthelemy St. Hilaire’s ‘‘Le Bouddha et sa religion,” Chapter V. Comp, also M. Miiller, “Buddhism and Buddhist Pilgrims,” pp. 14-20. ® The abstract of its contents quoted here has been published in Wassil- jew’s “Buddhismus,” pp. 208-17. See also Burnoufs remarks on the acquire- ment of magical powers in his “Lotus de la Bonne Loi,” p. 310. 16* 244 WORSHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND RELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. tlie Siddlii. Tlie book points out tlie obstacles met with, and specifies tlie signs from which is perceived that Siddhi will be soon obtained ; it also defines its essence and qualities. Eight classes of Siddhi are distinguished: — 1. The power to conjure. 2. Longevity. 3. The water of life, or the remedy (amrita). 4. The discovery of hidden treasures. 5. The entering into Indra’s cave. 6. The art of making gold. 7. The transformation of earth into gold. 8. The acquiring of the inappreciable jewel. Of the highest character are the Siddhis Nos. 1, 3, and 5 ; the degree of perfection to be attained is fixed by the dignity of the man. Those desirous of acquiring Siddhi must renounce the vanities of life, they must strictly observe the moral law, and confess their sins ; they also must apply for an able teacher, in order that nothing be forgotten; when they proceed to perform the rites, they must be shaved, washed, and cleaned. Of particular importance for the success is the scene of their performance. It must be a place not calculated to distract the mind by a variety of objects more or less attractive, or by the possible appearance of wild beasts. The most favourable spots are those where Buddhas and Bodhisattvas or Sravakas dwell. The place must be well swept and otherwise cleaned, and fresh earth must be thrown upon it, in order to make its surface even and smooth. A magical THE ATTAINMENT OF MAGICAL POWERS. 245 circle of the five sacred colours must be drawn, in order to overcome the impediments, the “Vinayakas,” opposed by the demons; for these latter do all in their power to prevent the devotee’s efforts and the incantations from exercising their full effect. Within the circle an altar is erected, upon which various vessels are ranged filled with bread, grain, and perfumed water. The ce- remonies consist in the reciting of incantations and in the presentation of offerings to the kings of magical power, to the genii, and to demons. A Vajra (Dorje) is held during the recital of the incantations; the ma- terial of which this is made varies according to the kind of Siddhi sought. The incantations must be repeated a fixed number of times, as e. g. 100,000 times a day; the number is counted by means of a rosary of 108 beads. They must be recited slowly and distinctly, without rais- ing or lowering the voice; nor is it allowed to make any addition or omission; the most earnest attention must be devoted to the recital, otherwise the end aimed . at cannot be attained.' The thoughts must be predom- inantly directed to the tutelary deity (Tib. Yidam) selected for bestowing success upon the incantations, offerings, &c.; even the way of placing and holding the fingers, the Mudras,^ is important; such positions have to be chosen as typify the attributes of the patronal god. Amongst the offering ceremonies the burnt offering, in Tibetan Chinsreg or Sregpa, in Sanskrit H5ma, is the most im- ' The dcscrij)tion of a rite considered most excellent for concentrating th(> thoughts, is^given further on, in No. 1. ^ Concerning the Madras .sec p. hG. 246 WORSHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND RELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. })ortaiit ; it must be performed with a minute observance of the rules laid down for it.‘ The approach of the moment when the devotee attains the iiossession of supernatural qualities is indicated by various signs, such as agreeable dreams, the diffusion of sweet odours, &c. Particular offerings must then be made to the Buddhas ; only a minimum quantity of food is allowed to be taken for two, and even for four days; and certain Sntras must be read. If, however, notwithstanding the strict observance of all these rules, no marks reveal the approach of the Siddhi, it is a positive token, that un- known reasons have hindered it, which the patronal deity is supposed to reveal to the devotee in his dreams. The rites and Dharams vary according to the deity, whose patrocination is implored; each deity has its par- ticular Dharanis, Mudras, magical circles, offerings, and attributes, Avalokitesvara, ManjusrI, Yajrapani, and numerous other persons, are reported to have made . known to the Buddha their wish to defend his religion, and to grant their assistance to those who implore it; but the Dharams and ceremonies which are suit- able for each of these persons, and the instructions as to their application are not always clear, satisfactory, and complete; explanatory commentaries, have, therefore, been written by famous magicians, which do not, however, always exactly agTee; hence, numerous metliods, “Lugs,” of celebrating the rites, are in ]>ractice. ' For a (le8ciij>tioii of thoso offerinpts see ji. 24S. THE RITE HUBJED. 247 Peculiar ceremonies for ensuring the assistance of the gods. For most of the ceremonies the performance by a Lama is considered indispensable to its due effect; but even if this is not the case, a Lama is charged with it in cases of importance, as the efficacy of any rite is supposed to become increased by the services of a priest; this assistance, however, causes the laymen considerable expense, as the officiating priests tax them according to their means.* The execution by a Lama is not re- quired for the usual libations to the personal genii, nor to those of the house, the country, &c., in whose honour it is the custom to pour out upon the ground some drink or food, and to fill one of the offering vessels ranged before their images before eating or drinking one’sself.^ Also the patting up of prayer -flags (the Derchoks and Lapchas), and the offerings on the sacred spots met with on travels, can be done without the Lamas, who are likewise not required for the efficacy of the mystical sen- tences of magical power, the Dharanls. 1. The rite Duhjed. This rite, the name of which means “to make ready” (viz. the vessels), is intended to concentrate the thoughts. Those who are about to devote themselves to profound medita- tion, place before them a vase-like vessel called Namgyal bumpa, “the entirely victorious vessel,” and a flat vessel ' Coniijare p. 1(50. * This is clone very generally in all counti'ics of Asia and South Eastern Europe. Sec Pallas, “Reisen,” Vol. I, ]>. 5(51. 248 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AXD EELIGIOUS CEEEMONIES. called Lai bumpa, “the vessel of the works/ The Nam- g’yal bumpa typifies abstraction of the mind from sur- rounding objects, the Lai bumpa perfection in ab- stract meditation. These vessels are not put upon the earth, but upon a cloth or a paper on which an octagon frame is drawn, called Dabchad, “octagon;” the vessels are filled with water perfumed with saffron, and strips of the five sacred colours are twisted round them; flowers also, or kusagrass are put into them.^ The devotee, fixing his eyes upon these two vessels, reflects upon the lienefit to be derived from meditation, and is exhorted to intense concentration of the mind. The frame Dabchad has nine compartments, of which each is separated from the next by ornaments represent- ing clouds. In each compartment is inscribed the name of a Dakin! or Yogiiii, in Tibetan Khado, or also Nal- jorva; in the central division are words denoting that it is meant for “the chief of the Dfdcinis,” who is called in the religious books Sangye Khado in Tibetan, Buddha Dakin! in Sanskrit. In a Dabchad obtained by Hermann in Sikkim, the central words are make full, to fill,” fi'/MV, “a ladle, a large simon. * /lEng, “to ])our out.’’ THE BURNT-OFFERING. 251 by the power of Melba, or Melhai gyalpo, “the lord of the genii of fire,” who is always implored on such occasions ; it is believed that with the combustion of the offerings the sins disappear for ever. The address to Melha runs thus: — “I adore thee and present to thee the offerings “for the deceased, who has left this world and has en- “tered the circle, for him who dwells in the assembly of “ the three merciful deities, who are now in calmness “now in wrath.* Pray purify him from his sins and “any violations of the law, and teach him the right way. “ Sarva-agne-dzala-ram-ram.” This prayer is given in Plate X., which is an im- pression from an original woodcut from Eastern Tibet it is placed beneath the image of Melha in a state of calmness. Here he is sitting crosslegged upon a Lotus- flower, holding the blue lotus Utpala {Nelumbiim specio- stim), with joined hands. His head is shaded by the * It is difficult to understand what deities are meant. The phrase would lead us to the three Isvaras, viz. Brahma, Vishnu, and Siva (Schmidt, Mem. de I’Acad. de St. Petersh., Vol. II., p. 23), about whom we might suppose, from the legend concerning Brahma (see p. 114), that they all three place a check upon the doings of evil spirits. If this be the right interpretation, they would become wrathful in the case of activity, according to the views of the Tibe- tans (see p. 111). But I cannot perceive for what reason the deceased, in general, should, as it is here stated, ascend to the region where reside these gods so highly esteemed and so extremely superior to simple man and or- dinary gods: for Shinje (see p. 93), before whom the deceased is brought, dwells in an inferior region. ^ As the intersyllabic points are not in the original woodcut, I give the address here in Roman characters, rendering the intersyllabic points which are omitted by homontal lines; — Yangs - pa-^sum-zhi-khro’i-lha-ts'hogs-dang-gar-dvang-thug6-rje’i-chen-po’i- druiig-pu-’jig-rten-’di-na-pha-rol-du-ts'he-las-’das-pa-dkyil-’khor-la-phyag-ts'hal- lo-)«chhod-pa-’bul-lo. .vDig-.sgrib-sbyang.v-du-^rsol ; ,(/nas-so-i ab-tu-/7Sol ; lam-i/.staii-du-flisol. Sarva-agnc-dza-la-ram-rani. 252 WOKSHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEKEMONIES. Dug (umbrella), to which are added the horizontal ribands Labri and the flags Badang. 2. Gyaspai'^ Chinsreg, “the rich sacriflce,” to obtain a good harvest, riches, &c. The stove is hemispherical, and of a yellow colour; on its bottom is figured ^the word “yam,” the symbol of air. 3. Vangi' Chinsreg, “dhe sacrifice for power,” to ob- tain influence, power, and success in war. The stove is of a red colour and circular, a form s 3 rmbolical of the Lotus-flower; it bears on its under side “bam,” the symbol of water. 4. Bragpo^ Chinsreg, “the fierce sacrifice,” to obtain protection from “untimely death,” as well as to bring down punishment upon the evil spirits who have caused such a dreaded misfortune. The stove is triangular and of a black colour; the character on its bottom, “ram,” is the symbol of fire.^ Plate No. XIV., Lit. a, gives — 'immediately transferred upon paper, as if it were a woodcut intended for print- ing — the surface of a rectangular oblong piece of wood, in which four holes are made, into which bread, paste, butter mixed with grains or similar objects, are pressed and sacrificed as a substitute for the burnt-offering. The characters in the centre are the symbols of the four elements, and the holes show the form of the stoves in which the offerings are burnt. In addition to these figures and symbols there is represented on the woodcut ' rGyas-pa. “ample, copious.’’ - (A’ang, “power.” ^ Drag-po, “fierce, cruel.” * Concerning untimely death see ]i. lOfi. MKUTAT GYALPO, TIII^ LORD OF THE (O^NII OF FIRE. From a woodcut from Eastern Til»ct. > 3 ] ^5^^^ I ff ( I INVOCATION OF UJNGXA. 253 tlie ofticiating Lama, holding in liis left hand the two spoons, emblematical of those used in this ceremony. 3. Invocation of Limffta. Liingta, “the airy horse, the horse of wind,”* occurs in the list of the seven precious things under the name of Tachog, “the best horse of its kind.” This horse is praised in the legends for its extraordinary swiftness. “AVhen the king of the golden wheel, the governor of the four continents (in Sanskrit Maha Chakravartin Raja), mounts it to traverse the world, he sets out in the morning and returns at night without having experienced any fatigue.” The Norvu phrengva reports, that it passes over immense tracts in one moment.^ The Lungta is the symbol of “harmony;” for it unites in harmony the three conditions of human existence, upon the union of which happiness depends ; it strengthens these conditions, so as to cause a union salutary to man. These three conditions of existence and welfare are; Srog, Lus, and Vang. Srog, the vital principle, “breath,” is the basis of existence. Lus, “body,” means the due development of the or- ganic formation of the body. Vang, “power,” means the moral energy enabling- man to abstain from such actions as injure the vital ' j'Lung, “wind;” rta, “horse.” ^ Remusat, in Foe koue ki, p. 128. Schmidt, Ssanang Ssetsen, p. 471. About the seven precious things, see p. 53. 254 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND KELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. principle and the organs of the body, and produce ill- ness and death. It indicates, at the same time, the faculty of averting the dangers which arise from the natural hostility of the elements.* Another faculty of Liingta is the power of depriving the constellations of the planets hostile to man of their obnoxious influence. Moreover, the efficacy of any Dha- ranl, or mystical sentence, for happiness in this existence is supposed to become more certain by the presence of Lungta, and from this belief it has become customary to add to such Dharams a horse supporting the precious stone Norbu, or a figure allegorical of the horse, or at least an address directed to Lungta. The plates brought home by my brothers, exhibit specimens of tliis practice. The Dharams are Sanskrit, and are written with Tibetan, and occasionally also with Lantsa characters. The purposes aimed at, and the deities implored by them vary; in most of them, however, we meet with “Om mani padme hum,” and “Om Vajrapani hnm,” Dharams meant for Padmapani and Vajrapani. The horse stands in the centre of plate No. XL, and bears the precious stone Norbu. In other copies it is running towards the left border, whilst the letters run as usual from left to right ; in the present plate ' As often as the element which at a person’s birth occurred in the denomination of the year comes in contact in “the cycles of years” with a hostile element, the years in which this takes place are unlucky ones; health is endangered and failure in one’s undertakings may be expected. This idea refers to the belief of the Tibetans in an influence of the elements upon the welfare of man. See Chapter XVII. To fioe p. 254- Plate XI. MYSTICAL SENTENCES, WITH THE EIGCRE OE THE AIRY HORSE. The letters are here inverted, the same liaving been cut in the block itself in their positive form. T U =1 fi.’ :^:y t - \ ^ '’’■'•■••tJ# ■1 . «i fsj-" *« *ir» ^41 '.'’.wjjsi <*' 4 P* ' 6 ■ ' ■ rr » tr. 'S, _ r vA>^ Plate XII. FORMS OF INVOCATIONS OF LUNGTA, THE AIRY HORSE. 1. Pi'iiil I'rom a Tibelan woodciil, I'roiii Sikkim. 2. Coiiit'.s of formula', oblaineii al Ibe monastery of Hi'mis, in Ladak. cs > \ rNVOOATION OF LUNGTA. 255 every tiling has the oj)i)osite direction, the maker decidedly not taking the trouble to invert his own work. Such irregularities are not very unfreqnent, particularly it the plates are not intended to be printed on paper, but only to make impressions on articles of food. As allegorical signs occasionally substituted for the figure of the horse we sometimes find the anagrammatic form of the prayer Ora mani padme hum in Lantsa characters, or the Lantsa letter Om, encircled in either case by a glory, with the characters Ba and Bam at its sides. Other invocations of Lungta have no central ornament. The addresses directed to Lungta personally are generally limited to the lower part of the table ; a most potent imploration of it is the one printed on Plate XII., No. 2; it runs thus: “Wealth, the friend of sharpness, Lungta of breath, of body, of power, may you increase and grow like the new moon.” In tables on which are inscribed this prayer, the four corners of the image are almost alwa}"s filled out with the figures or with the names of a tiger (Tib. Tag), a lion (Senge), a bird (Khyung), and a dragon (Brug); and a Dharanl is frequently inserted before the imploration of the Lungta, running thus: “Tiger, lion, bird and dragon, may they too co-operate to a complete union; sarva- du-du-hom.” In order that the Lungta produce its proper elfect, the colour of the cloth or paper upon which it is printed, is also of importance; the rules concerning the modalities are, however, very simple; and if the right colour is not at hand, it may be supplied by rags of 25G WORSHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND RELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. the required colour, which are cut into triangles (in- dicating' that they are Phurbus), and fastened along the lower border of the table. The implorations of Lungta do not require the performance by a Lama, neither do the ceremonies more complicated still which have been established for increasing the probability of success,' and this belief may also be one of the reasons of the frequent application to Lungta. 4. The Talisman Changpo. This talisman, which means “the keeper, the holder,” is believed to protect man from the machinations of the evil spirits and to enable those who hang it up in their houses, or who wear it as an amulet, to resist the tempt- ations to sin prompted by these demons. The form of this talisman is circular, as seen in Plate XIII. In the centre is a smaller inner circle; in a second, larger circle is traced a star, and along the inner side of this circle and in the eight intersectional compartments formed by the corners of the star are inscribed the names of hostile spirits. Outside the circles are seen a male and a female, the arms of the one figure tied with chains to the feet of the other. This Plate is a print from a woodcut; the block had been so much used that the original sharjmess was quite gone, and the wood had become cracked. ' There are several books in which is detailed what may he done besides. I’liUc XIII. THE TALISMAN CIIANGPO. PYoin Daba, in Gnari Klnirsiim. THE MAGICAL FIGUEE PHURBU. 257 5. The magical figure Phurhu. The Pliurbu, literally “a peg,” “pin.” or “nail,” is drawn as a triangle upon paper covered with charms; the handle has the fonn of a half-dorje. The Euddhists attribute to the Phurbu the faculty of iireventing tlie evil spirits from inflicting mischief, or of expelling them, in case they have already begun to exercise their baneful influence. It is believed, that even the mere presence of the ivord Phurbu prevents the evil spirits from entering the houses and from injuring those who carry it as an amulet; the sentence Phur- bui-clab-vo, “I cast thee with the nail,” is therefore repeated in many books' which treat of the evil spirits; the point of a Phurbu, if directed towards the side where evil spirits dwell, drives them away, and brings them to ruin. Generally, three Phurbus, enclosed by flames, are traced upon the same paper; this is fixed on paste-board or thin boards. In case of an illness, or when any mischief has been done wliich is supposed , to have originated with evil spirits, the head of the family — or if he is wealthy enough to engage a Lama, the Lama — accompanied by the family and relatives, goes round the house, turning the point of the Phurbu in all directions, and uttering incantations at the height of his voice. * III the book Dug karchan, “provided with a white umbrella,” this sen- tence is added to the name of the twenty evil spirits who are mentioned there. 1 7 258 WOESHIP of' THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEEEIM OKIES. Tlie accompanying woodcut shows the arrangement of tlie Phurhn. Tlie two Tibetan characters in the central part of the figure stand for r/Gra (pronounced Da), which means “ enemy,” and for /jGegs, pronounced Geg, “evil spirit.” The human face between the smaller Phurbus is that of Tarn- din, in Sanskrit Haya- grlva. Tamdin is a Dragshed who is con- sidered to take a very prominent part in pro- tecting man against the evil spirits. A dorje projects from his head; and under the chin is inscribed the mystical syllable Ah. The oblong rectangle next his face and the hexagon contain a Dharani several times repeated, which threatens all the “evil spirits who dwell above the earth.” The Dharanls in the following rectangle are directed against the Geg who inhabit the east, Shar, the south-east, Sharlho, and the south, Lho. The Dha- ranls in the joint of the triangle and at the beginning of the first large line in the triangular part keep off the evil spirits occupying the south-east, Lhonab. Each Dharani finishes with the words “destroy, bring to ruin.” The Dharanls are Sanskrit, written with Tibetan characters. THE MAGICAL FIGUEE PHUBBU. 259 On the handles of the two smaller Plmrhns is in- scribed the mystical syllable 1mm. The other charms in the triangle begin with “Ah Tamdin,” a mystical form of imploring this god. They keep off the evil spirits who dwell in the north-east, Nub- jang, in the north, Jang, and in the other quarters of the world and it is declared that the wearing of such a Phnrkha,^ “sharp Phurbu,” serves as a protection against all mischief originating in any of these quarters. Each of these Dharanls is Sanskrit, which, like numerous other charms, cannot well be translated in detail, and termin- ates with the syllables hum phat, a charm, of which the chief of the Dakinis says, in the Norvu phrengva, “Cry- ing with the voice of concealment hum and ihliat, I shall keep in order the innumerable legion of Dakinis.”^ At the end of the inscription it is said that this DharanI is particular!}’’ directed against the spirits inhabiting the air, and against that class especially called rGyal-po-rgyas- ’gong-shin-dre-sron-dre. The Dharanls inscribed on the handle, and the joint of the triangle, are always addressed to Tamdin; those with which the triangle itself is filled may vary, as any one who orders a Phurbu may have Dharanls directed against such evil spirits as he considers particularly hostile towards himself. Those Phurbus are considered the most efficacious to which Dalai Lama and Panchen Rinpoche have composed • Concerning the quarters of the world, which are ten in number, see p. 126. ^ Kha, “bitter,” bere in the sense of sharp. ^ Schmidt, “Geschichte der Ostmongolen,” p. 468.— Compare also p. 247. 17* 2 Go ^VOBSHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. tlie Dliaraiiis; such Phurbus as can prove this claim fetch a high price. Tlie Phurbus also form an important article of trade for the Mongolian pilgrims returning from Tibet, who never fail to assert that the Dharams on their Phurbus are the composition of the Dalai Lama. G. The Ceremonies Tlmgdam kantsai} ^Vhenever the assistance of any one of the many Drag- sheds is sought by ceremonies, the prayers recited and the offerings made to him, must follow in a certain order: 1. - The ceremonies with hymns praising the power of the god implored, and enumerating his attributes. This is called Ngontog,^ “to cause the eminent understanding.” 2. The region where the god dwells is described, the technical term being Chandren, “to cite.” 3. The offerings are laid on the altar; Chodpa “the sacrifice.” 4. Prayers are spoken imploring the remission of sins; an act called Shagpa, “repentance, confession.” 5. Kantsai, the presentation of objects “to make content.” The mode of offering consists in the conse- cration of the objects to the gods, which, hereafter, can no more be used for worldly purposes. The offerings are, in some cases, weapons and living- animals, one of the chief objects being an arrow, to which * Thugs-dam “prayer;” ftskang “satiate, to make content;” rdzas “sub- stance, wealth.” ^ w(Xgon “clear, eminent;” ?-togs “understanding.” INVOCATION OF NAGPO CHENPO. 2G1 five silken strips of the five sacred colours are fastened, called Darnai janpa, “ornament of five strips of silk,”' as well as a disk of brass, called Melong, “a mirror,” upon which the mystical syllables om, tram, ah,^ hri, hum are inscribed as here follows: — om tram ah hri hum Feathers, also, are attached to the arrow ; they must be selected from such birds as are known favourites of the Dragshed implored ; thus, to Lhamo the arrow presented is ornamented with the feathers of the raven, to Gonpo (Mahadeva) with those of a kite. Between the feathers small strips of paper are inserted on which are written certain charms, which are also inscribed upon the point and the shaft of the arrow. When the act of imploration is over, the arrow is stuck perpendicularly into the ground, a position from which it can only be removed by the astrologers. 7. Invocation of Nagpo Chenpo, hj moving the arrow. i^agpo Chenpo, in Sanskrit Mahakala, is supposed to grant success in undertakings and to protect from the hostility of mischievous spirits in general; but the cere- * Dar “silk,” sna “end, strip,” Znga “5;” rgyan-pa “ornament;” the nga “5,” was suppi’essed in the pronounciation. ^ Csoiua, “Grammar,” p. 105, explains om to be mystical interjection, denoting the essential body or person of a Buddha, or any other divinity. Hri is a mystical very powerful imploration of Chenresi. 2G2 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEEEMONIES. iHony of “moving the arrow,” is also performed for the purpose of discovering the perpetrators of a theft. The head Lama of the monastery in which the cere- mony has to take place begins it, amidst the loud sound of cymbals, drums, and pipes, with the reading of cer- tain passages from a book which treats of Nagpo Chen- po’s faculties, of the Dharaihs communicated by him to man, of his hatred towards the evil spirits, and of the offerings which are most agreeable to him. The Lama concludes this lecture by threatening the malignant spirits with Nagpo Chenpo’s wrath, if they do harm to those who have ordered the performance of this ceremony. He then hands to a novice a large and heavy arrow trimmed with feathers, strips of silk, and slips of paper inscribed with invocations to Nagpo Chenpo. The novice, who has taken a seat upon a carpet of white felt, holds this arrow with one hand, the point resting perpendicu- larly upon the palm of the other; by a slight shaking and turning he brings this point into motion, and gradually lets the arrow fall on the ground; his shakings become more violent as soon as the point has left the palm of his hand and moves on to the ground; he then seizes it with both hands, and by convulsive shaking he keeps it constantly moving. But the spectators believe the arrow to go on by its own power, and the shakings and tremblings of the priest to be the natural conse- quences of its spontaneous motion. The novice continues to turn the arrow for several hours, during wliich he has perhaps walked over as many miles, and he only ceases to move it, when his hands THE CEREMONIES YANGUG. 2t)8 sliow blisters or when his strength is exhausted. The halt of the arrow is taken as an unmistakeable mani- festation that the evil spirits have been driven away; or if the arrow has been moved for the discovery of a theft, that its perpetrator is to be looked for in the direction pointed out. The novice then returns with his arrow to join the Lamas, who in the meantime have been engaged in singing hymns, and reciting the prescribed prayers ; some concluding hymns are sung, and the arrow is solemnly handed over to him who had ordered the ceremony. 8. The Ceremony Yangug. The aim of this ceremony, Yangug or Yangchob, “to call for luck, to insure luck,”^ is to implore Dzambhala or Dodne vangpo,^ the god of wealth, to grant riches. An arrow is offered similar to that used in the purchase of the assistance of the Dragsheds (No. 6), but the disk attached to it has a central perforation and four groups of lateral ones, as substitutes for the mystical syllables; the feathers on the shaft of the arrow are those of a black eagle, and round the five strips of silk is wrapped a band of white cloth covered with some Dharams, and terminating in two loops.* These notices also present additional illustrations of the address to the Buddhas of confession (Chapter XL). Every contribution to its ex- ])hination was the more welcome to me, as the novelty ’ jrYaug “luck,” ’gugs “to call;” skyob*' “to protect.” ’ jrUod-nas “from the beginning;” rfvang-po “ruler, the entirely powerful.' ® The arrow I have also seen traced on an astrological table. 2G4 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEEEMONIES. of tlie object so considerably increased the difficulty of entering into the full particulars. We found it mentioned there (see p. 137), that in the period of the destruction of the universe the performance of the ceremony Yangug will be more frequent than the pious acts which afford })urification from sins. The representations of Dzambhala show him generally surrounded by the eight other gods granting riches, who are styled Namthosras, in Sanskrit Yaisravanas; these per- sonages are always represented holding in the left hand a rat with a jewel in its mouth, a supposed symbol of fer- tility. Dzambhala himself is in all pictures represented riding upon a white lion with a green mane, his right hand supporting the Gyaltsan, in Sanskrit Dhvaja, a kind of banner with a floating cloth which typifies victory. His eight companions bear in the right hand the following- objects : 1 . A precious thing, in Tibetan Kinchen; 2. The flat vessel Lai Bumpa (see p. 247); 3. A small house several stories high, Khangtsig; 4. A pick-axe, Dungtsi; 5. A sword, Kalgri ; 6. The precious stone Norbu ; 7. A sword, Kalgri ; 8. A clasp-knife, Digug. — A detailed account of the doings of these gods and of the meaning of the ar- ticles they hold, is given in the book Gyalpo chenpo namthosras clii kang shag, of which the St. Petersburg Academy has a copy. My brothers once saw an image in which the mytho- logical Buddha Dfpankara, (see ]). 131), in Tibetan Mar- medzad, and a Buddha of medicine,” in Tibetan Mania, were associated with Dzambhala instead of his eight com])amons. CEREMONIES IN CASES OF ILLNESS. 265 9. Ceremonies performed in cases of illness. The remarks offered here are partly taken from the Tibetan book on medicine published by Csoma, and partly based upon observations made by my brothers. The Tibetan book' enumerates three principal and four secondary causes of diseases. The three principal causes are: 1. Lust, or desire; 2. Passion, or anger; 3. Dullness, or ignorance. By the first wind is caused; by the second bile; by the last phlegm. The four causes of a secondary nature are; 1. Season, with respect to cold and heat; 2. Any evil spirit; 3. Wrong use of food; 4. A bad course of hfe. The book contains use- ful hints, as to the course to be pursued in order to remain free from illness, and also gives a number of rules with respect to food, occupation, conduct of life in conformity with the different seasons, &c. The symptoms of diseases are indicated, and the questions are given which are to be addressed by the physician to the patient respecting his food, occupation and the circumstances how the disease first arose, its progress, and the pain felt. The several remedies prescribed against diseases are enumerated, 1,200 in number, which maybe reduced to four classes: medicine, manual labour, diet, and manner of life. * It is entitled Gyut zhi, “the tract in four parts,” and is declared by Csoma to be the principal work on medicine in Tibet. For an analysis of it see Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IV., p. 1-20. It is not introduced into the large collections of the Kanjur and Tanjur, which contain several other works on medicine; see Wilson, Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. I., p. 4. Gleanings in Science, Vol. III., p. 247. For further notices on medicine, compare also the “Description du Tubet,” in Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., p. 257. Trail, “Kamaon,” As. Res., Vol. XVI., p. 222. Pallas, “Mongol. Volker,” Vol. II., p. 338. 206 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEREMONIES. My brothers had never seen or heard of any medicine having been taken, or any surgical operation undertaken, which was not preceded and again followed by addresses to the Buddhas of medicine, in Tibetan Manias, “the supreme physicians,” and by the performance of certain ceremonies supposed to increase the sanative power of the medicine. The Manias are eight in number ; they are the imaginary Buddhas who are believed to have created the medicinal plants. When men set out to collect such plants they implore the assistance of the Manias, and their names are uttered when the medicine is prepared and taken; their names or images are also generally printed at the commence- ment of books treating on medicine. The greatest number of prayers are addressed to them when the pills “Mani” are prepared, which are employed only in cases of very serious illness. The ceremonies accompanying the pre- paration of these pills are styled Manii rilbu grub thab, “preparation of the pill Mani.”^ The Manis are made of a particular kind of bread-paste, with which particles of the relics of a saint have been mixed in the form of powder or ashes. This paste is moistened with consecrated water, and kneaded up with ordinary bread-paste, from which are then made the smaller pills to be taken by sick persons." The vessel with the water and paste is [)ut upon a circle divided into six sections and a smaller central circle; in this centre stands the syllable “hri,” a mystical and very powerful imploration of Chenresi ; in each ' Mani “a precious stone,” ril-bu “a globular figure, a' pill;” grub “to have done; made ready;” thab.s- “means, method.” - These pills are identical with those mentioned by Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. 11., p. 27S, as highly esteemed. CEEEMONIES IN CASES OF ILLNESS. 267 of the six sections is inscribed a syllable of the prayer Ora raani padrae hiini. As long as the paste remains in the water (the prescribed time ranges from one to three weeks) some Lamas (who are not allowed to eat meat during this period) recite all day long particular prayers in honour of the Manias. With reference to diseases caused by ghosts and evil spirits, the 73rd. Chapter of Part lA^. of the book men- tioned enumerates twelve kinds, the 77th. eighteen. The causes, symptoms, and remedies are also enumerated. About these kinds of diseases and the methods of curing them my brothers learned the following particulars. Each malignant spirit causes some particular disease. Thus Kahu‘ inflicts palsy, in Tibetan Zanad; fifteen other de\dls, called Donchen Chonga,^ “the fifteen great evil spirits,” cause children to fall sick, &c. When the Lama physician who has been called to a sick man, has deter- mined the illness to have been occasioned by a malignant spirit, he proceeds to examine into the circumstances, in order to detect the causes which have allowed the spirit to gain influence over the patient, and the means he employed to make him sick. When the illness is in- significant, as in cases of cold, hoarseness, hght wounds, &c., it does not take, according to the behef of the Tibetans, much trouble to drive away the evil spirit; the remedies consist either in charms, which the patient has to wear, to affix to the door, or to read; or a noisy music is performed, before which the evil spirits are supposed to ' See p. 115. ^ ,(/Pon “an evil spiiit;” chhen “great;” 5cho-/nga “fifteen.” 2G8 AVOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEEEMONIES. yield ; or the very Dragslied who is the particular enemy of the offending evil spirit is implored, and his image is hung up after having been carried in procession round the house ; or the Phurbu is applied. These are the most common methods employed for the recovery of health; but it lies in the nature of this matter that these rites should vary considerably. In cases of serious illness, particularly when the sick man is no more able to rise, the evil spirit is supposed to have crept into the house in the shape of an animal, and to dwell in this form near the sick man. The first business of the Lama then is to find out the form which the evil spirit has assumed, in which endeavours he finally succeeds by various ceremonies very much of a character akin to juggling. An animal is formed of clay or bread-paste by means of a wooden mould, of which he carries with him a variety for selection,^ and the soul of the spirit is compelled to leave the assumed brute form, and to enter into the representation of it; for this purpose magical circles are traced and incan- tations recited for some time. When the evil spirit has lieen confined, by these means, the Lama reads passages out of certain books, and hands the moulded animal over to the patient to burn or to bury it; prints of it are also pasted on various parts of the house and are only removed when the disease has disappeared. If this means is not attended with success, and the sick man dies, it is averred that the illness was a punishment for immoral actions committed in some former existence. ‘ Specimens of such blocks arc given in Plates Nos. XIV. to XVI. I'lale XIV. PRINTS FROM SLIPS OF \\ OOD USED IN TIBET AS A SUPPOSED PROTECTION AGAINST EVIL SPIRITS, No. 1; from Sikkim. riiUi- XV. purN rs fko:m sups of wood used rx Tibet as a supposed protection a(jAinst evil spirits. \(i. 2; I'rom Sikkim. II^^B^BH3B|||^^SB||BBijS^^PiiW WIwBiWBhBw ^KH^SSBBjr_ \ ^^SgJ^ \ )B|B|^£9 ■ 1 K b, c. ^mitB B faiDaW^Syi ^Bp[v^^9 riiitc XVI. P1{1NTS FROM SUPS OF AVOOD USED IN TIBET AS A SUPPOSED PROTECTION AGAINST EVIL SPIRITS. No. 5; from Sikkim. FUNERAL RITES. 209 1 0. Funeral rites. The funeral (Tib. Shid) of a layman generally ter- minates, where circumstances allow of it, in the burning of the body, although the practice of exposing the corpse on the hills as a prey to wild animals, formerly a very common one, is even now sometimes resorted to on ac- count of the scarcity of wood.^ • The ceremony of burn- ing the body is performed upon an altar of a cubical form; in larger towns several of these are kept ready for immediate use; thus there are twelve such altars at Leh, surrounding the burial ground. In countries where wood is plentiful, as in Bhutan and Sikkim, enough is employed to render the combustion complete, nothing remaining but ashes; but in Tibet it often happens that quantities of the bones remain unconsumed, which are then carefully collected, together with the ashes, and buried.^ The bodies of the Lamas are not burnt: they are ' For descriptions of various kinds of funerals see Nouv. Journ. Asiat., Vol. IV., p. 254. Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. U., p. 347. Cunningham, “Ladak,” p. 308. * Concerning the mode of collecting the ashes in Eastern Bengal and Assam my brother Hermann gave me the following details: — A cloth about three feet square is fastened at its four ends to canes about three to four feet high, which are driven into the earth; into this cloth, thus forming a sort of trough, the ashes, bones and remaining pieces of charcoal are gathered, and left to be dispersed by the wind, or gradually decomposed by the rain and heat. The tribes of the Khassia hills, where the amount of rain exceeds that of any known country, although it is limited to a duration of three to four months, have a most curious practise of keeping their dead till the rainy season is over; as long as the heavy rains last no combustion in the open air would be possible. They put the corpse into trunk of a hollow tree, and fill this up with honey, a process which prevents decomposition for several months, even in these hot and moist regions. 270 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEEEMONIES. buried in a reclining attitude (not exactly in a sitting posture), with the knees brought up to the chin, and the whole corpse laced together into as small a space as possible ; occasionally they are put into a cloth bag. In general, the graves are not dug; the grave-yard being selected in places abounding with stones, the corps is simply laid down on the ground and concealed beneath a heap of stones. The erection of Chortens over the dead is limited to exceptional cases. With the remark- able toleration so characteristic of Buddhism, my brothers were allowed to open and examine some of the graves near Leh, and they even induced a Lama to undertake the boiling of some corpses for the purpose of cleaning and preparing the skeletons, though the latter process had to be concealed from the population in general. The corpses taken out of their graves were not decomposed; the great dryness of the atmosphere had caused the flesh to shrink to a hard leathery substance covering the bones, and this jdelded but very slowly to the action of the boiling water. The length of several corpses compressed in the way just described was found to be from 2^/2 to 3 feet. During the process of combustion and interment prayers are recited and various ceremonies performed; offerings are presented to the god of the fire, Melha; the Zhiba Chrinsreg, to obtain the remission of the sins of the deceased,^ is also performed. A ceremony which precedes the interment consists in the purchase of the burial-ground from the lord of the f/round, in Tibetan For its description see p. 249. FUNEEAL EITES. 271 8adag gyalpo. The lord of the ground, and the mis- chievous spirits obeying him, are supposed to do mis- chief, from innate malice, to the dead in his future existence, as well as to his surviving relatives in their present one. The lord of the ground can be pacified by the purchase of the burial ground, while the other malignant spirits are banished by charms and rites, in which reverence is paid to the three gems, viz. to Buddha, Dharma, and Sanga.^ These rites are said to have been taught to man by Manjusri, the god of wis- dom. The relatives of the deceased inform the astro- logers, who are considered to have intercourse with Sadag, of the amount they propose to pay to Sadag, either in the form of cattle or money, and request them to per- suade him to be satisfied therewith. Invariably the answer is returned, that Sadag, who is represented as insatiable, Avants more for his pacification than the amount offered. When, finally, the necessary sum has been settled, - the graA^e is marked out, and the astrologers proceed to expel Sadag and all the other malignant spirits in the following terms : “Lord of the ground, and you Mahoragas," hear my command and order, which I issue with the ceremonies prescribed by the sacred law of the god Manjusri and of the three gems. I drive the arrow not into the eyes, not into the feet, not into the bowels of the evil spirits. Lord of the ground, but into the earth, in order to * See p. 184, Note 2. ^ Mahdragas, in Tibetan Tophye chenpo, are terrestrial dragons superior to man. See Foe koue ki, Engl. transL, p. 133. 272 WOESHIP OF THE DEITIES, AND EELIGIOUS CEREMONLES. render propitious the interior mischievous spirits. Genii, if you do not obey my order, I will break your heads with my dorje. Hear my order : hurt neither the deceased (his name is here repeated) nor his surviving relatives. Do them no damage, neither injure them, nor teaze them, nor bring misfortune upon them.”^ The Lama then drives the arrow into the ground, where it remains until the dead person is buried. ‘ From an oral communication from a Lama. CHAPTER XVI. THE SYSTEMS OF RECKONING TIME. 1. Calendars and Astrological Tables. — 2. The various Modes of Chronology. The cycle of 12 years. Counting back from the current year. The cycle of 60 years. The cycle of 252 years. — 3. The Year and ITS Divisions. 1. Calendars and astrological tables. The Tibetans received their astronomical science from their neighbours in India and China; the Chinese also becoming their teachers in the art of divination. Their acquaintance with the astronomical and calendrical systems of these nations coincides with the propagation of the Buddhist religion by the Chinese and Indian priests, to whom they are also indebted- for the respective systems of defining the year.^ Both systems are based upon a * In the “Description du Tubet,” translated from the Chinese by Klaproth in Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., p. 138, the Chinese consort of King Srongtsau Gampo and her suite are stated to have brought the Chinese system into Tibet in the seventh century a.d. 18 274 THE SYSTEMS OF BECKONING TIME. unit of sixty years, differing, however, in the modes of denominating the years. The Indian denomination is called in Tibetan Kartsis, “ white mathematics ; ” the Chinese method, on the other hand, goes by the name of Naktsis, “black mathematics,” a term also extended to the “black art,” or the science of divination and of astrological calculations.^ The Tibetan designations for almanacs are Leutho," Lotho, or Ritha; they are sketched by the Lamas. It is a very general custom to append to the almanacs various tables for astrological purposes. These additional tables differ Mudely in contents as well as in size; they are rarely wanting for the following purposes : Gabtsis,^ “ the concealed calculations,” are tables framed upon the common calendrical system, the occasions for which they are consulted being most various. Grubtsis,^ “the perfect astronomy,” for deciding the character and influence of the planets. Tserab las-tsis® is the name of the calculations for the duration of life, and of the fate of man. Bagtsis® are the tables consulted in cases of marriage. Shintsis^ are those used to find an answer to inquiries respecting the form in which the dead shall be re-born. * Nag, “black;” rtsis, “mathematics;” t?kar, “white.” These names have decidedly originated from the Tibetan names for India and China, which are called respectively “white plain,” Gya-gar, and “black plain,” Gya-nag. Kartsis, however, is also used for “Astronomy,” or “Astrology,” but it is then spelt skar-rtsis, from skar, a star. ® The name Dalow for calendar, occurring in Turner, “Embassy,” p. 331, is probably a dialectical modification of this word. ® Gab, “a shelter; concealed, dubious;” rtsis, “mathematics.” ^ Grub, “perfect.” ® Ts'he, “time, lifetime;” rabs, “genealogy;” las, “work, fate.” “ Bag, “a bride.” ' pShin, “a corpse.” THE VAEIOUS MODES OF CHRONOLOGY. 275 Naktsis, which also designates the art of divination in general, is predominantly applied to tables by means of which the lucky and unlucky times affecting a particular individual, with the reasons of their being so, can be determined. Several tables of this kind will be described in a subsequent chapter. Tables relating to particular classes, such as Rajas, Lamas, and the like, are less frequently met with. 2. The various modes of chronology. The various systems of reckoning time have already been the object of the most learned and successful researches by Csoma and Ideler. I give an abstract of their results on account of the connexion of the calen- drical systems with the interpretation of the astrological calculations; this affords me, at the same time, the oppor- tunity of combining with it the informations which Hermann obtained from natives during his stay in Sikkim. 1. When any thing is to be defined referring to a period not too distant from the present time, it is not the practice to use a standard unit of sixty years, but a cycle of twelve years is employed instead, each year bearing the name of an animal,^ which names are in- variably repeated in the following order; — * Respecting the origin and introduction of this cycle which is generally called “the Tatar,” see Ideler, “Ueber die Zeitrechnung der Chinesen,” pp. 75, 78. He believes it to have first arisen in Western Asia. Klaproth finds it mentioned for the first time in Chinese books in the year 622 a.d. Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. XV., p. 145. 18 * 27G THE SYSTEMS OF EECKONTNG TIME. 1. Ji, the mouse. 2. Lang, the ox. 3. Tag, the tiger. 4. Yos, the hare. 7. Ta, the horse. 8. Lug, the sheep. 9. Prel. or pre, the ape 5. Brug, the dragon. (). Brul, the serpent. 10. Ja, the bird. 11. Chi, the dog. 12. Chag, the hog Thus, when a particular year is to be specified, the Tibetan term for year, Lo, is added to the name of the animal, and it is called Ji-lo, “mouse year;” Lang-lo, “ox year,” &c.^ When the date of an event which has taken place previous to the present duodecimal era is to be indicated, the number of cycles that have passed since the time in question is first put down, and by adding to it the number of the animal year the entire sum of years is accurately arrived at. 2. In books, as well as generally in conversation, the dates of past events are not unfrequently determined by counting back from the current year. For instance, the present year being 1863, the birth of Tsonkhapa, which occurred in 1355 a.d., would be said to have taken place 508 years ago. This method is also applied in the Baidurya Karpo, from which Csoma has extracted his liighly important chronological table.^ 3. A cycle of sixty years seems to have been in very general use in Tibet a long time ago.^ As a novelty, * Csoma, “Grammar,” p. 147. ^ Csoma, “Grammar,” p. 181; Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., p. 369. ® It is curious that the present generation of Tibetans are unacquainted with the historical data of its origin and antiquity. They account for the introduction of this cycle by the supposition that the idea had been taken from the average length of human life. Such, at least, was the assertion of Chibu Lama, the political agent of the Raja of Sikkim, and of several other Lamas. CYCLE OF SIXTY YEAES. 277 it was ordained, probably in the eleventh century a.d., that the cycles of sixty years should be counted from the year 1026, which is the year next to 1025, in which the Kala Chakra system had been introduced into Tibet (see p. 47). The year 1026 being the first year of the first cycle, 1086 became the first year of the second cycle. If the number of the cycles that have already elapsed were regularly added in books and documents to the de- finition of the current year, this system would be as precise as our way of counting by centuries; but the number of the cycle being omitted before the year to be determined,^ the reader frequently finds it no easy task to assign the correct era by weighing and comparing dates of an indirect nature. The year 1026 was also the first year of the con- temporaneous Indian cycle, and thus the identity of the Tibetan and the Indian order of years within the cycle became possible. The first, second, third year, &c., of any Tibetan cycle is consequently the first, second, third year, &c., of an Indian cycle ; the number of cycles, however, do not accord with each other, the Indian not dating from the year 1026, but from one, or even two other and anterior epochs.^ It is already long ago, at least under the dynasty Han, or 206 b.c., that the Chinese began to measure time by cycles of sixty years, a period formed by the com- binations of a decimal and a duodecimal series. But ’ As ail e.xample see the historical document relating to the Hhiiis monastery, p. 183 ; and the Uaba document, p. 278. * * See Csoma, “Grammar,” p. 148. 278 THE SYSTEMS OF BECKONING TIME. between the Chinese cycle and that of the Indo-Tibetan the coincidence was not perfect, a third year of the Chinese cycle being coeval with the first of the Tibetan cycle, and so on. This difference, however, remained without any influence upon Tibetan chronology so long as China possessed no political weight in the country; but when the Chinese government, in 1718,‘ made Tibet a dependency, it soon followed that the inhabitants were obliged to adapt the cyclic order of their years to that of the Chinese, and this could only be effected by ad- vancing the number of the year throughout by two. Thus two years are virtually cancelled from the Tibetan calendar, so that the cycles commence two years earlier than before the change; c. g. in 1864 instead of 1866. The altered chronology is used at present in all official matters, and is generally adopted for private business. In support of this explanation I quote the document from Daba.^ It is dated from the sixth month (month ' Koppen, “Die Religion des Buddha,” Vol. II., p. 196. ® It is styled Lam-yig-dang-ming-dang-yar-na, “ Road prescription, and also denomination how far up,” and was made at Nyugchang, a halting place about eight miles south of Daba. Adolphe engaged to pay a sum of “six Srang (ounces) of gold” (= about #60) to the Chinese officer residing at Daba, if he or his brother Robert should cross the Satlej river; his head man, called Bara Mani, or also simply Mani, pledged himself to pay this sum. The treaty was written by the Chinaman himself, who added, instead of his signa- ture, the official seal; Adolphe, having no seal at hand, stamped it with the but-end of his riding-whip. — The Lama Gombojew transcribed the original into capital letters, in which it is also printed on Plate XVII. But here again (comp. p. 183) occur so many deviations from the terminology of the sacred books, that it was impossible to arrive at a translation. Prof. Schiefner, who had kindly looked for analogous documents in modern dialects in the St. Petersburg libraries, did not find any which would have afforded the means of detailing quite literally either the Daba or the Iliniis document. To fac« p. 278 Plate XVn. TREATY BETWEEN ADOLPHE SCHLAGINTWEIT AND THE CHINESE AUTHORITIES OF DABA. This was in reference to the Routes he and his brother Robert should be allowed to take in Gnari Khorsum. gi:.- 333- v ja-y >-5' ^ ^ zjj’^zi|-33-i]yn|5r57i|5;7 7j|uj?;-'ya|-zr|ttio^’zi|^5/7 ?jr.‘ |a-§5/- g]i:- a- uj^- 5/oj-^- ^c7-e^s;g5/-zj|5^i:-cyg-«5i5/-a|^5r|5J-j^a| 77 77 - (I : 5 > ' --Vi ^^ ■■’ 7 ■' W-4 • »/\ 4 > . CYCLE OF SIXTY YEAES. 279 of July) of the wood-hare year. This year is the fifty- second in the cycle. If fifty-one is added to 1806 (not fifty-two, because 1806 is the first year of a new cycle, the fourteenth of the Indo-Tibetan chronology), we obtain the year 1857; but my brothers were in Daba in 1855, which year can only be found by deducting two years (compare p. 287).^ Within these cycles of sixty years the single years are denominated differently in the Indian and in the Chinese manner. According to the Indian principle, each yeai- is called by a particular name; these Sanskrit terms the Tibetans have simply translated into their own language.'^ In imitation of the Chinese mode^ of reckoning time the sixty years of the cycle are designated in the following way. The twelve animals already mentioned are five times repeated in the order given above, and are coupled with the five elements, each of the latter being introduced * Csoma, though alluding to a difference between the Indo-Tibetan and Chinese cycles (“Grammar,” p. 148) does not take into consideration the predominant use of the Chinese system, when he says that the year 1834 is the 28th of the current cycle. From the reasons given above, the 30th will be found the correct number. In Cunningham’s example (“Ladak,” p. 395) the Indo-Tibetan cycle is also applied.— I must further observe that Csoma was misinformed, when he speaks of the difference between the commencement of the Chinese and the Indo-Tibetan cycle as one of three years instead of two, saying that “the Tibetans give the designation of first to the fourth year of the Chinese cycle.” — I may still draw the attention to another deviation, which is easily made by Europeans when counting the years in the cycles. In calculating the difference between any given year and the first of the respective cycle, the tw’o numbers are to be taken in- clusive; if, e. g., a cycle begins in 1806, the year 1851 is not the forty-fifth, as Cunningham reckons it (p. 396), but the forty-sixth year of the series. ^ Csoma, “Grammar,” pp. 148, 1.50, where the sixty names may be found. ® For this method see the memoir of Ideler, “Ueber die Zeitrechnung der Chinesen.” Berlin, 1839. 280 THE SYSTEMS OF BECKONING TIME. in the series twice in immediate succession. "We obtain, therefore, sixty combinations each differing from tlie other. The years are then distinguished in two ways: they are either called by the names of the element and animal combined, or by the names of the colour of the element and the animal combined. A combination of the one form is, e. g., water-hog year; and the same com- bination, in the second form, blue-hog year. Water-hog or blue-hog year stands for the 60th of the Indo-Ti- betan cycle. If the names of the years are given in full detail, a gender is also added to the combinations of element and animal, this being represented alternately by pho, a particle denoting the masculine gender, and mo, the feminine particle; and the gender of every combination is, therefore, defined by its very position in the cycle. The year beginning the cycle has the element and animal masculine, the next year has the same element and the successive animal both feminine; and the same alternations of the gender being kept up throughout, it results that every year the numeral of which is an odd number, as 1,3, 5, &c., must be mascu- line, while the years represented by the even numerals 2, 4, 6, &c., are feminine. It must be noticed that a distinctive power is not conferred by the addition of these particles, as at first might appear to be the case. — The natives employ the mode of counting by colours when pointing out a year in an almanac, because the elements are there rejiresented by colours and symbolical signs, and not by words;’ on all other occasions the ’ buhiiiidt, j^irel'acc to Ssanaiig Ssctscu's history, j). 20. CYCLE OF SIXTY YEARS. 281 name of the element is more usually resorted to. The following table shows the succession of the elements and their colours, from which no deviation is made in count- ing time. Tibetan name. Translation. Colour. Shing wood green Me fire red Sa earth yellow Chag iron white Chu water blue.‘ In order to facilitate the determination of our era in Tibetan terms, I append, as an example, the following- table, which contains the Tibetan mode of counting and the numbers now' used in compliance wdth the Chinese prescription. The table is, at the same time, selected so as to embrace seventy-five years belonging to three different cycles.^ * When the animals constituting the cycle of sixty years are traced for astrological purposes, and not for the mere reckoning of time, the succes- sion of the colours corresponding to the elements is given differently from that mentioned above, in order to avoid a coincidence with the colour given to the animals. Their order is given in the next chapter. — The Lamas have many works to explain the system upon which the chronology by the cycle of sixty years is based. A very comprehensive and at the same time detailed hand-book on this subject is the work Yangsal Domi (as it is generally pronounced), meaning “a clear -burning lamp for luck.” The number of its leaves somewhat exceeds 500 and it also contains notices of the astrological arts. A copy of this book is also to be found in the St. Peters- burg Ubrary. ^ In China the cycles date back to a period so remote, that I cannot here enter into any details respecting this part of the subject; and I simply confine myself to the remark, that the cycle 1864 to 1923, which is Xo. XV. in the modified Tibetan chronology, is in China Proper No. LXXVI. See Ideler’s “Zeitrechnung,” p. 60. 282 THE SYSTEMS OF BECKONING TIME. TIBETAN CHRONOLOGICAL TABLE of the cycle of sixty years. Year Tibetan E r a. of the Counting from Modified so as to bring it into correspon- dence with the Cninese numbers of the veare Christian 1026. • within the cycle. Era. Nos. Nos. of the year with- of the year with- Tibetan denomination, of the of the corresponding to the present number of the cycle. in the cycle. cycle. in the cycle. year within the cycle. 1852 (XIV.) 47 (XIV.) 49 Water-Mouse. 1853 48 50 » Ox. 1854 49 51 Wood-Tiger. 1855 50 52 » Hare. 1856 51 53 Fire-Dragon. 1857 52 54 » Serpent. 1858 53 55 Earth-Horse. 1859 54 56 » Sheep. 1860 55 57 Iron-Ape. 1861 56 58 » Bird. 1862 57 59 Water-Dog. 1863 58 60 » Hog. 1864 59 XV. 1 Wood-Mouse. 1865 60 2 » Ox. 1866 XV. 1 3 Fire-Tiger. 1867 2 4 » Hare. 1868 3 i 5 Earth-Dragon. 1869 4 6 » Serpent. 1870 5 7 Iron-Horse. 1871 6 , 8 » Sheep. 1872 7 9 Water-Ape. 1873 8 10 » Bird. 1874 9 11 Wood-Dog. 1875 10 12 » Hog. 1876 11 13 Fire-Mouse. 1877 12 14 )) Ox. 1878 13 15 Earth-Tiger. 1879 14 16 » Haic. 1880 15 17 Iron-Dragon. 1881 ' 16 18 » Serpent . 1882 17 19 Water-Horse. )f the iristian Era. 1883 1884 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1900 1901 1902 1903 1904 1905 1906 1907 1908 1909 1910 1911 1912 1913 CYCLE OF SIXTY YEAES. 283 TIBETAN CHRONOLOGICAL TABLE. (Continued.) Tibetan Era. Counting from 1026. Modified so as to bring it into correspon- dence with the Chinese numbers of the years within the cycle. N( of the cycle. )S. of the year with- in the cycle. Nc of the cycle. >s. of the year with- in the cycle. Tibetan denomination, corresponding to the present number of the year within the cycle. (XV.) 18 (XV.) 20 Water-Sheep. 19 21 Wood-Ape. 20 22 » Bird. 21 23 Fire-Dog. 22 24 » Hog. 23 25 Earth-Mouse. 24 26 » Ox. 25 27 Iron-Tiger. 26 28 » Hare. 27 29 Water-Dragon. 28 30 » Serpent. 29 31 Wood-Horse. 30 32 » Sheep. 31 33 Fire- Ape. 32 34 » Bird. 33 35 Earth-Dog. 34 36 » Hog. 35 37 Iron-Mouse. 36 38 » Ox. 37 39 Water-Tiger. 38 40 » Hare. 39 41 Wood-Dragon. 40 42 » Serpent. 41 43 Fire-Horse. 42 44 » Sheep. 43 45 Earth-Ape. 44 46 » Bird. 45 47 Iron-Dog. 4G 1 48 )> Hog. 47 49 Water-Mouse. 48 1 .50 » Ox. 284 THE SYSTEMS OF EECKONING TIME. TIBETAN CHRONOLOGICAL TABLE. (Continued.) Year Tibetan E r a. of the Counting from Modified so as to bring it into correspon- Chi-istian dence with the Chinese numbers of the vears 1026. within the cycle. Era. Nos. Nos. of the year with- of the year with- Tibetan denomination. of the of the corresponding to the present number of the cycle. in the cycle. cycle. in the cycle. year within the cycle. 1914 (XV.) 49 (XV.) 51 Wood-Tiger. 1915 50 52 » Hare. . 1916 51 53 Fire-Dragon. 1917 52 54 » Serpent. 1918 53 55 Earth-Horse. 1919 54 56 » Sheep. 1920 55 57 Iron-Ape. 1921 56 58 « Bird. 1922 57 59 Water-Dog. 1923 58 60 » Hog. 1924 59 XVI. 1 Wood-Mouse. 1925 60 2 » Ox. 1926 XVI. 1 3 Fire-Tiger. 4. Another method of counting is that based on a cycle of 252 years; it was made known for the first time in Georgi’s “Alphabetum Tibetanum,” and again reported by Huc.^ From the above mentioned elements and animals a cycle of 252 years is formed by imputing to the masculine and feminine particles a discriminating- power, and thus multiplying the combinations. The first * Hue, “Souvenirs,” Vol. II., p. 3(i8. The combination of the animals with the elements, as given by Georgi in his “Alphabetum Tibetanum,” pp. 404-69, is altogether arbitrary, for by this way the elements follow each other twelve times, whilst in all these modes of chronological combination every element is taken but twice and then followed by the next. CYCLE OF TWO HUNDKED AND FIFTY'-TVVO YEAKS. 285 twelve years of this cycle are counted by tlie names of the twelve animals only; the next sixty years (13-72) by coupling them with the five elements (each being in- troduced twice, as described in the preceding table); the period from 73 to 132 is denominated by affixing the masculine particle “pho” to the combinations; that from 133 to 192 by appending the feminine particle “mo.” The years from 193 to 252, as Abbe Hue concludes, are distinguished by the alternate employment of pho and mo till the end of the cycle. This is not quite clear. If it were to be understood that, in this last series, a male combination alternates with a female combination, we should obtain only those terms which are already contained in the periods from 73 to 192. As one com- bination which would provide the addition of the 60 years required for completing the sum of 252 without a repeti- tion, and which could be brought into final accordance with Hue’s words, I might suggest the uniting of elements and animals of different genders. According to this mode, the year 193 has the element male and the animal female, 194 has the same element female, the animal male, 195 has the next element male and the animal female, 196 the same element female and the animal male, and so on; while in the previous series the entire combination is of the same gender in both its parts. In this, however, there is a theo- retical disadvantage which ought not to be overlooked. When completely worked out, it would not conclude mth 252, but would proceed as far as 312; for sixty more combinations, differing from those already obtained, are 286 THE SYSTEMS OF RECKONING TIME. at once formed, if we continue the series by now mak- ing the first element female and the first animal male, and then the same element male and the next animal female, &c. Perhaps the following combination may not be un- worthy of our attention, since it equally excludes re- petitions, and has besides the advantage of not extending the series beyond 252, In the group from 13-72 the genders of the elements are undecided, the animals also have no particle appended; failing this, however, usage warrants us in regarding them as males. This suppo- sition is confirmed by the representations wherever they are distinct enough; moreover, in verbal explanations the male nouns are almost exclusively used, as, e. g. ram in stead of sheep, &c. In the concluding series from 193 to 252 the gender of the elements might also be con- sidered to remain undefined, while the animals might all be taken as females. The combination of two parts of diverse gender rather seems not to be in contradiction with what we may suppose to be intended in Hue’s words; and the combination of the elements with female animals, besides, derives probability from its being that particular connexion which projierly completes the series in form as ivell as in number. As an illustration of the combinations resulting, I add a list of all the years in the cycle of 252 in which the mouse, the first of the series of animals, occurs. Year 1. Mouse. „ 13. Wood-mouse. THE YEAK AND ITS DIVISIONS. 287 Year 73. Male wood-mouse. „ 133. Female wood-mouse. „ 193. Male wood, female mouse. {Hue). Wood, female mouse. {ScJilagintiveit). This cycle of 252 years is not in general use; Csoma heard nothing at all about it, neither did Cunningham; nor did my brothers find it actually employed. As an instance, I may mention that the date wood-hare year of the Daba document gives, according to the 252 years cycle, the year 1845, if we begin with 1026 as the first, — 1843, if we correct it for the modifications recently introduced; while it must be 1855 (see p. 277). This cycle may, however, be expected to be in use in the very centres of the Lamaic institutions, such as Lhassa, Tashilunpo, &c.^ At some distance from Lhassa it seems to be no longer known, even if it were ever employed; the Lamas in Sikkim were not acquainted with it. 3. The Year and its Divisions. The year with the Tibetans is a lunar one, i. e. the phases of the moon regulate the duration of the month, and twelve such months — after the lapse of which nearly the same season begins to return — are the basis of the definition of the annual period. Twelve of these lunar * The cycle may, however, perhaps be tried when examining older do- cuments. The historical document relating to the foundation of the monastery of Himis allows at all events of an interpretation by applying the 252 years cycle, compare p. 187 ; but it appears to be the more general custom to denominate the years also in historical treatises by the cycle of 60 years. 288 THE SYSTEMS OF RECKONING TIME. months are equal to 354 days, 8 hours, 48 min., 30 -G sec. — a total wliich is less than the solar year by 10 days, 21 hours, 0 min., 11 sec. The Tibetan year nominally amounts to 360 days; and in order to bring it into accordance with the moon, one day,^ from time to time, is not counted at all. But as this does not occur witli exact regularity, the months and years do not always begin on the same day as the Chinese months and years.^ The difference between the lunar and the solar year is compensated by the Tibetans by inserting, for every period of nineteen years, seven intercalary months (Tib. Dashol) ; the error then remaining is not more than about two hours for this period, for seven lunar months give 206 days, 17 hours, 8 min., 20 sec,, and the inferiority of the lunar year for 19 years is altogether 206 days, 15 hours, 3 min., 29 sec. It is only after about two centuries that the error amounts to one day.'* With respect to the principle which is followed in the inter- calation of the seven months I am not in possession of any details. Csoma says, that generally one month is inserted every third year.^ The year begins in February with the appearance of ' “Description du Tubet,” in Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., p. 137. In his Souvenirs (Vol. II., p. 370) Hue states that, owing to the belief in lucky and unlucky days, many are omitted altogether, and are then counted by the number of the preceding days. ^ See Ideler, as quoted above, p. 165. ® In the Julian calendar the difference is much gi'eater, amounting in 128 years to a whole day. Madler, Populiire Astronomie, p. 522. * Csoma, 1. c., p. 148, and Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., p. 137. THE YEAE AND ITS DIVISIONS. 289 the new moon.' The twelve months, in Tibetan Dava, are called the first, second, third month, &c., from one to twelve, or also by the names of the cyclic animals with the word “Dava” added.^ Tlie months art? sub- divided into thirty days, in Tibetan Tsei, which are quoted by their numerals, and into weeks, in Tibetan Gnngdnn. Within the week the days bear the names of the snn, moon, and five planets.^ Certain symbolical signs are also connected with the different days, as in the following enumeration: Number of the day within the week. Celestial body. Tibetan name. Symbolical sign. 1 The sun. Nyima. A sun. 2 The moon. Dava. A waning moon. 3 Mars. Migmar. An eye. 4 Mercury. Lhagpa. A hand. 5 Jupiter, Phurbu. Three nails. 6 Venus. Pasang. A garter. 7 Saturn. Penpa. A bundle. The days are subdivided into twenty-four hours, each hour into sixty minutes, in Tibetan Chusrang. ' So my brother Hermann, the Chinese description of Tibet, and Hue. Turner, however, was informed that the first month was January; “Embassy,” p. 321. ^ Cunningham’s “Ladak,” p. 396. Csoma and Schmidt, Dictionaries sub voce zla. ’ In the Chinese description of Tibet it is said that the five elements are introduced in the denomination of the days_of the week, but I have found nothing at all tending to confirm the statement. 19 CHAPTER XYII. DESCRIPTION OF VMIOUS TABLES USED FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. Importance attribi’ted to Astrology. — I. Tables for indicating ldcky and ENLUCKY Periods. 1. The elements and cyclic animals. 2. The spirits of the season. 3. Figures and oracles for determining the character of a given day.— II. Tables for direction in important Undert.akings 1. The square tortoise. 2. The circular tortoise. — III. Tables of Destiny in cases of Sickness. 1. The human figures. 2. Allegorical figures and dice. — IV. Tables of Marriage. 1. Table with numerals. 2. Table with cyclic animals. — V. A Soothsaying Table with notierous Figdres and Sentences. Importance attributed to astrology. The Tibetans, like all primitive nations, attribute to the position of the sun in reference to the constellations, to the planets, to the direct active interference of gods and spirits, and such like, a very considerable influence upon the welfare of man in this and in future existences. To their priests, the Lamas, they ascribe the faculty of tleciding what circumstances are to be considered as favour- able, and what unfavourable, for counteracting the effect of influences prejudicial to man, and for obtaining the assistance of benevolent spirits. These ends they seek to IMPORTANCE ATTRIBUTED TO ASTROLOGY. 291 attain by the performance of certain ceremonies and the presentation of various offerings; and nearly every in- dividual case requires to be accompanied by a ceremony/ the efficacy of which does not, however, depend upon its being performed by any particular Lama, although the services of a Lama in great repute for sanctity are considered to increase the chances of the ceremony’s producing the desired effect. But with respect to the science of “divination,” having for object the determin- ing of the character of a day, the residence for the time being of the gods, &c., the Lamas are not held to be equally endowed, one as the other. Those who have made a particular study of astrology, are applied to in all important cases having reference to the public wel- fare, as well as on such occasions as the marriage or the death of men of rank and wealth ; whilst for subjects of minor importance every Lama is considered well-in- formed enough to giv'e the required decision. In every monastery there is at least one divining Lama, who is then styled “the astrologer;” and larger ones even have one of the famous Choichong astrologers.^ These latter have a particular school in the monastery Garmakhya at Lhassa, whilst the ordinary astrologers are instructed in the science by an elder priest; the principal part of their preparatory labours is the profound study of numerous mystical works. The decisions of the astrologers are pretended to be ' Some of the ceremonies considered the most efficacious, and therefore the most frequently performed, have been described in Chapter XV^. - See p. 156. 19 * 292 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. tlie result of mathematical calculations, combined with due observation of the phenomena to be taken into con- sideration for the case in point. The corresponding ]ihenomena and their value vary considerably; there are, liowever, certain rules respecting the different modalities, and the explanation of these rules forms the subject of numerous books on astrology. The deference paid^ to the Lamas in such things depends to a great extent upon the observance of secrecy with reference to the com- binations employed and the ceremonies performed; these things are kept a perfect secret to Tibetans as well as to Europeans; and even Chibu Lama, who, in his inter- course with Europeans, had laid aside many a superstition, showed great reserve in communicating to my brother Hermann the clue to symbolical designs, or such like; although neither Chibu nor any other Lama ever showed any particular hesitation to sell such objects, when no detailed explanation was demanded. The St. Petersburg libraries, also, contain but few in which the rules for their interpretation are given. Even the different provinces have each its own pecuhar principles of di- vination, and are but indifferently acquainted with the operations practised by, and the formularies in use among their neighbours. Many of the tables and symbolical diagrams described further on proved quite a novelty to the Lama Gfombojew, when he was requested to tran- scribe for me into capital letters those sentences which in the original were written in the small characters. To the difficulties of obtaining information was added that arising from the vagueness with which all natives IMPOKTANCE ATTRIBUTED TO ASTROLOGY. 203 speak when attempting any explanation, even of subjects far less mystical than astrology and divination. Tins may be offered as an excuse for the following details not being so complete and satisfactory as might be desired. And, besides, I could not well alter them much, as in their existing state they were best calculated to make us acquainted with the notions of the Tibetans concerning the natural phenomena and the functions ol their gods. Tables used for the following purposes shall be described : 1. Tables for indicating lucky and unlucky periods. 2. Tables of direction, to determine towards what part of the compass the face of a man is to be turned when praying, and what direction his feet must take when he is about to set out on an important under- taking. 8. Tables of destiny, consulted in cases of illness. 4. Tables of marriage, employed to arrive at a know- ledge of the chances of happiness afforded by some pro- posed matrimonial alliance. 5. A soothsaying table, with numerous figures and sentences. I. TABLES FOR INDICATING LUCKY AND UNLUCKY PERIODS. 1. The elements and nicUc animals. Rules and regulations connected with or having reference to the calendar, as is the case with the table here described, 294 TABLES FOE ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. are mostly combinations of the figures used in chronology, viz. the twelve cyclic animals and the five elements. The technical term for such a table is Gabtsis (see p. 274). In the present case their divinatory combination forms part of a large roll not unlike in fonn to the documents of classical antiquity, on which are also delineated most of the diagrams subsequently described. It came from Lhcissa, and Hermann, meeting with it at Darjiling, seized the opportunity and bought it. The Gabtsis is composed of eight lines. 1. 30 elements. 2. Colours of the elements. 3. 60 cyclic animals. 4. ] 5. > Three rows of numerals. 6 . ) 7. Sentences, now rubbed off. 8. Heads of the animals. Total length; 2 Engl, ft., 1 inch; breadth: 4 inches. The first and second lines are each subdmded into thirty compartments; the upper line contains the con- ventional figures for the elements,^ the lower their colours. The series of these figures and colours, and the objects represented are the following: ' The same figures are also used to symbolize the names of the sixty years adopted from India. — A detailed explanation of these signs is contained in the astronomical book Yangsal Domi, about which see p. 281. THE ELEMENTS AND CYCLIC ANIMALS. 295 No. curr. Figures in the first line. Colours in the second line. Elements designated. 1 A cone of sacrifice. ’ White. Iron. 2 Flames. Red. Fire. 3 A tree, the symbol of the vital principle. “ Green. Wood. 4 A basin® filled with fruits. YeUow. Earth. 5 A cone of sacrifice. White. Iron. 6 Flames. Red. Fire. 7 Waves. Blue. Water. ' 8 Ornaments upon the basis of a Chorten. Yellow. Earth. 9 A conch.'* White. Iron. 10 A tree. Green. Wood. 11 A river in a defile. Blue. Water. 12 A fortified temple. Yellow. Earth. 13 Flames. Red. Fire. 14 A tree. Green. Wood. 15 A river in a narrow bed. Blue. Water. 16 Nails (the Phurbu ®). White. Iron. 17 Flames on an altar. Red. Fire. 18 A tree. Green. Wood. 19 Two altars. Yellow. Earth. 20 A cone of sacrifice within a basin. White. Iron. 21 Flames. Red. Fire. 22 A waterfall. Blue. Water. 23 The lower part of a Chorten. Yellow. Earth. 24 Two swords crossed. White. Iron. 25 A tree. Green. Wood. 26 A plate with food. Blue. Water. 27 Slopes of mountain with shrubs.® Yellow. Earth. 28 Flames. Red. Fire. 29 A tree. Green. Wood. 30 A waterfall. Blue. Water. We see from this list, that in four instances the same element returns after having been succeeded by three * It represents either a Satsa (see p. 194), or a Zhalsai (see p. 228). - This tree occurs again on the table described under No. IV, 2, where some details will be given. ® This basin is meant for the Patra, or alms-bowl, carried by the Buddhas and priests in representations. See p. 210. ^ By a conch the Lamas are convoked to prayers. ’ Concerning the Phurbu, see p. 257. ® This is the usual foreground in the landscapes within which are figured gods. Sec p. 211. 20fi TABLES FOB ASTKOLOGICAL PURPOSES. others, and in two instances this is the case after it had been followed by six. The third line shows the twelve cyclic animals in the form of human figures, standing upright and clad in the religious garment; but the head is that of an animal. 'Phe colours of the head, garment, and girdle are the following : No. curr. Name of the animal. head. Colour of the garment. girdle. 1 The mouse. Blue. Green. Green. 2 The ox. Yellow. Green. Blue. 3 The tiger. Green. Red. Green. 4 The hare. Green. Red. Yellow. f) The dragon. Yellow. Yellow. Green. r, The sei’pent. Red. Yellow. Blue. 7 The horse. Red. White. W'hite. s The sheep. Yellow. White. Red. 9 The ape. White. Blue. Green. 10 The bird. White. Blue. Blue. 11 The dog. Yellow. Green. White. 12 The hog. Blue. Green. Red. The colour of .the head is important for the luckiness and unluckiness of days; if it be the same with the colour of the birthday, the day is an unlucky one, but the probability of misfortune can be counteracted by offer- ings to the tutelary genii. The fotuih, fifth and sixth lines contain Tibetan nu- merals in compartments tinted with the colours belong- ing to the respective numbers. 180 numbers are in- scribed, 60 in each horizontal series. They follow each other in the order here given; — THE ELEMENTS AND CYCLIC ANIMALS. 297 l‘J87G54321987(j54321987G543219876543219876543219876543219876.'i 4321987654321987654321987G54321987654321987Gr>432198765432198 7G54321987G54321987G54321987G54321987G54321987G5432198765432 Each number has a colour wliich is not a different one for every one of the nine numbers, but wliich is never changed for the same number ; 1 is white ; 9 is red ; 8 is white ; 7 is red ; G is white ; 5 is yellow ; 4 is green ; 3 is blue; 2 is black. These numerals so coloured are called “the nine blots,” in Tibetan Meba gu, in Mongohan Manijera.' The succession of the Mebas is considered as important in many respects; its chief use is to indicate the years particularly dangerous to existence, which, ac- cording to the notions of the Tibetans return every tenth year; these are the years, they say, in which “the birth-meba has to consolidate.” As birth-meba is taken that number in the fifth line (the second line of the series here detailed), which happens to be just beneath the animal in the sign of which a man has been born; and in the arrangement described this Meba returns every tenth year, and is also the central number of nine compartments, the single numbers of which are exactly identical with those of a group ten, twenty years, &c., distant. The dangers of these critical years, coinciding with the “ consolidations of the birth-meba,” can be averted by the ceremony Kuibal chenpoi dokjed, “to turn back (the evils) in the name of the great tortoise,”^ ‘ «Me-ba, “a blot, blotch;” dgu “niue.” Comp. Pallas, “Mongol. Volker.,” Vol. II., p. 229. ^ Rus-«bal, “tortoise;” chhen-po’i, “of the great;” i(zlog, “ to tui-u back;” byed, “ to do.” About the ideas respecting the tortoise, details will be found at No. II., 1. 298 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. which the rich generally have performed for them by the Lamas in such years. In the seventh line thirty sentences had been written, but they had been almost entirely blotted out already when Hermann got the original. In the eighth line the heads of the sixty animals are repeated, two in one compartment, to indicate the phases of the moon. Another table for the same purpose obtained by Adolphe in Gnari Khorsum has the form of a square; round a tortoise in the centre are grouped three times the twelve cycbc animals; in the first series each is repeated once, in the two other series they are re- peated five times, to constitute the number of sixty. As a curious deviation from the list of the animals given above, I have to mention that, instead of the ox, we meet an elephant. Between the two spaces filled with the animals are traced the 180 compartments, tinted with the colour of the Mebas and containing the correspond- ing numerals. In other divisions of the square the. sym- bols of the sun, the moon, and the planets Mars, Mer- cury, Jupiter, Venus and Saturn (see p. 289) are added, alternating with squares containing the nine Mebas. 2. llte spirits of the season. Amongst the causes of the luckiness and unluckiness of days are included the periodical migrations of the spirits in- hal)iting the regions above the earth. The two kinds of spirits, tlie good and evil ones, are sup])Osed to shift their THE SPIKITS OF THE SEASON. 299 abodes, partly every day, partly contemporaneously with the phases of the moon, the commencement of a new season, &c. They perform their migrations with unequal velocity, and therefore, the combination of the spirits varies for every day. It is very important to man, as is believed, to know which kind of spirits have arrived the very day on wliich he begins an undertaking; if the good spirits are more numerous than the bad ones, the day will be a lucky one, and the more so if the man’s tutelary deity is amongst the good spirits. This belief naturally offers a w'ide field of intrigue to the Lamas, who alone are able to decide the actual movements of the spirits. Amongst the evil spirits particular attention is to be paid to the abode of four demons, who, in astrological maps of the sky, are typified by the following figures: a black dog; a monster with a human body and the tail of a dragon, meaning a Mahoraga, in Tibetan Tophye chenpo ; a man on horseback; and, finally, the fabulous bird Garuda. Their images are always encircled by a double square frame; the inner one is divided into twelve compartments, in each of which the name of a cyclic animal is written; the outer frame contains Dharanis supposed to be able and willing to hinder obnoxious attempts of the evil spirits. To each of these demons also a season is as- signed; the black dog rules the spring, the Mahoraga the summer, the man on horseback the autumn, the bird Garuda the winter. The linear arrangement of such a table is here given: the squares show the position of the respective four demons, the surrounding numbers the succession of the names of 300 TABLES FOB ASTKOLOGICAL PUKPOSES. the twelve cyclic animals; the outer space is that contain- ing the Dharanis. 5 6 7 S 4 Black dog 9 3 demon. 10 2 1 12 11 •5 6 7 8 4 3 Riding demon. 9 10 2 1 12 11 5 6 7 8 4 3 Dragon demon. 9 10 2 1 12 11 5 6 7 8 4 3 Bird demon. 9 10 2 1 42 11 3. Figures and oracles for the character of a dag. A day which, according to its number in the series of the days of a year, should be lucky, may for the individual man Ijecome fatal by circumstances originating from the time of his birth and other important epochs in his life. But there are days which are lucky under alt circumstances, whilst others are invariably unfavourable. The stability as well as the variable character of the thirty days of each month is illustrated by tables divided into thirty principle comi)artments; the compartments show the symbolical figures of the single days, and below each is written a mystical sentence which reveals its character. Such a taljle allows one to predict whether the chances of an undertaking arc increased by the character of the PIGUEES AND OKACLES FOE THE CIIAEACTEE OF A DAY. 301 (lay, or whether man needs tlie assistance of a Lama, to tell liim from which sxhrit or from wliat direction danger threatens, as also to indicate the means of averting it. The answer is considered to be derived from most complicated computations; the cyclic animals and the elements of the present year, the abode of the tutelary deity, the birth-meba, and many other things must be taken into consideration. Only the most expert astrologers are believed to have the neces- sary knowledge, and consequently the remuneration demanded for their assistance and cooperation is high; so that none but the great and wealthy possess the means of getting indicated the reasons which render one day lucky, another unlucky. Chibu Lama said that such tables were generally consulted only by Rajas, and that copies of the book in which this kind of calculation is detailed are very rare in every Buddhist country; no copy had to be was in Sikkim. The table which will be here described also forms part of the great roll which was bought by Hermann during his travels in 1855, who even obtained some explanations about the general meaning of the sen- tences. When I continued the analysis, first by get- ting transcribed the sentences which in the original are written with small characters, which could be done but very imperfectly, as by the frequent use of the roll about one-half of the squares had become quite illegible by friction, I found, also here, so many words used not introduced into Tibetan literature as known hitherto, that all that could be deciphered with sufficient accuracy was 302 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. some tew words; these I add in brackets to the verbal native information. 1 now give the description of the table. In the upper left-hand corner (in space Xo. I.) Manjusri^ is represented sitting upon a throne; in the opposite corner (in Xo. tl.j is the sword of wisdom, an emblem of his superior knowledge. Each of these two figures occupies the longitudinal space of two squares and the breadth of one. The rest of the plate is filled up bv the following thirty figures and their corresponding sentences. ^Vlthough the arrangement is very plain, the dehneation, combined with the numbers, will facilitate the represent- ation to the reader of the position of the symbols. 1. A bird; good. 2. An elephant; middling. 3. The bird Garuda; good. 4. A wheel, the Buddliist symbol typifying the preaching of the Buddhas, as also the circle of existences, and the supreme power of the fabulous fabulous kings Chakravartin.^ Good. 5. A bird; bad. (Words below: nine, bird, danger, evil spirit, tiger; dgu, bya, ^nod, ’dre. stag.) 6. A box within a frame; middling. I. 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 II. 14 8 9 10 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 29 25 26 27 28 29 30 ’ See p. 65. - See p. 127. FIGUEES AND OKACLES FOE THE CHAEACTEE OF A DAY. 3()3 7. Pot to keep water for worship. Good. (Tliirteen, mouse, ox, two ; ftclm-^^sum, byi, chu-dgu-pa. bya, byi, _l r|j • ■; ' ' |;ei V': ■'•’••.T.-5 ^rrf * •« . ■ f» ; ‘ rVl '^*‘i N. ¥> THE SQUARE TORTOISE. 309 In order to discover the region required, various circumstances have to be taken into consideration; of the numerous books in which they are detailed the greatest variety of rules is contained in the books Yangsal Domi (already quoted p. 280 ), Chungpa kundus tsis, and Thangshin-gi tsis. The astrologers are very re- served in communicating these laws; this would make their art too popular and would deprive it of the char- acter of sublime mysticism and science, with which they now array it. All I can say is this; A quantity of numerals corresponding to the number of years of the questioner is inscribed successively in the nine com- partments of a circle in the order in which the sym- bolical names of the quarters of the world are enumerated in the following verses: — “The centre, the heaven, the iron, the mountain and “The fire, the water, the earth, the tree, the air, turning.” The centre means the nadir, the tenth of the regions of the uni- verse which the Tibetans acknow- ledge (the ninth region, the zenith, is omitted). From the number which takes the place of the nadir, the succession of the others depends; which number has to occupy the centre I do not know, I have been only informed that attention must be paid to the sex, as the central number is one with males, another with females. Air Fire Earth (North-west) (North) (North-east) Tree (West) Centre Iron (East) Mountain Water Heaven (South-west) (South) (South-east; ’ The Tibetan text is printed sub Xo. I., 1, in Plate XVIII. 310 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. When the central number has become known, the other numerals are grouped so that the next higher is written in the compartment heaven, the next higher in the com- partment iron, and so on as detailed in the verses. If the number 9 is reached, it is not 10 which follows but the series is continued again with 1, 2, &c., till the quantity of the numerals inscribed is identical with the number of years of the questioner. The highly mystical character of the rules concerning the distribution of the Mebas seems to be well illustrated by those respecting the influence of the sex upon the calculation; they are brought in the form of verses, and run thus: “The year of man must be counted by the sign of the heaven, turning like Bon, “The year of women like the doctrine (chos).”^ For facilitating the correct inscription of the numerals in the succession required, such representations of the tortoise have not only in their own centre a circle with nine compartments and the numerals inscribed in due order, but beneath the tortoise an appendix of eight other circles is added, which show the due succession of the numerals in case any one of the nine numerals should fall into the central position. Also our large roll contains, in Tibetan characters, the following eight combinations bordered by circles: ' For the Tibetan text see Plate XVIII., No. 1. Bon the dictionaries explain by an adherent to the Bon religion, about which see p. 74. The book hsTan-rtsis-’dod-sbyin-^j^ter-bum-zhes-bya-va-g^zhugs, “Accomplishment of the desire for instruction in astrology, vessel of the hidden treasure,” which Hermann obtained in Sikkim, has, added, on leaf 25, in a linear arrange- ment, several Lugs, or “methods” of computation. THE CIKCULAR TORTOISE. 311 1 6 8 3 8 1 8 4 6 6 2 4 y 2 4 2 4 6 7 9 2 5 7 9 5 7 3 7 9 5 3 5 1 1 3 8 2 7 9 9 5 7 5 1 3 7 3 5 1 3 5 8 1 3 4 6 8 6 8 1 fi 8 4 4 6 2 9 2 7 2 4 9 2. The circular tortoise. The shell of the tortoise drawn as a circle is par- ticularly used for calculating from the combination of the planets with the constellations at the time of one’s birth, from the birth Meba, and other moments, which deity an individual man has to address as tutelary god in every year of the sixty years circle. Its surface shows; Head of the Tortoise. 1st. Compartment. A central circular space contain- 312 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. iiig the nine Mebas, identical with the central part of the square tortoise-shell described p. 305. 2nd. to 9th. Compartments. These consist of eight con- centric divisions subdivided by eight radii into eight parts each; the resulting 64 spaces contain inscribed the numbers I here give in their cyclic succession ; and I begin where I have placed the numbers in the preceding diagram of con- centric circles, going through the circle from left to right. 2d. 1 3 8 7 2 9 4 5 3d. 2 4 9 8 3 1 5 6 4th. 3 5 1 9 4 2 6 7 5 th. 4 6 2 1 5 3 7 8 6th. 5 7 3 2 6 4 8 9 7th. 6 8 4 3 7 5 9 1 8th. 7 9 5 4 8 6 1 2 9th. 8 1 6 5 9 7 2 3 Fire (North) Earth (North- east) Iron (East) Heaven (South- east) Water (South) Moun- tain. (South* west) Tree (West) Air (North- west) The elementary name of each space and its respective position in the compass I have added in explanation at the foot of the numbers; and if we look again for these elementary colours in the succession of heaven, iron, moun- tain, fire, water, earth, tree, air, we at once remark that then the horizontal successsion of the numbers is exactly the same as in the eight groups of nine divisions each, page 310, where the next higher Meba is also inscribed in the succession of heaven, iron, &c. 10th. Compartment- This last circle is divided into ALLEGORICAL FIGURES AND DICE. 313 64 spaces; in 60 the names of the cyclic animals (byi, ^lang, &c.) are written; the four remaining symbolical figures of the four principal points of the compass occupy a position as on our geographical maps; fire, or the north, being next to the head of the tortoise; Phurbu, or east, to the right ; water, or south, at the tail ; leaves, or west, to the left. HI. TABLES OF DESTINY IN CASES OF SICKNESS. 1. The human figures. Sixteen human figures are drawn in two rows; in cases of sickness seeds or small pebbles are cast upon them to foretell the development and final result. The succession of these human figures and O Upper line. 1. A woman with a hook. 2. A woman with a spoon. 3. A man with a firebrand. 4. A Lama with a water vessel on his back. 5. A woman falling down from sickness. 6. A man with empty hands. 7. A Lama wearing a yellow trimmed hat. 8. A woman holding a dag- ger. their appendices are; — Lower line. 9. A woman with an axe. 10. A Lama holding a vessel. 11. A Lama with his left hand supporting a book. 12. A woman holding a vessel. 13. A woman with hands raised in prayer. 14. A woman with a water vessel on her back. 15. A woman with food for cattle in her hand. 16. A Lama with a sacred stick. 314 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. 2. Allegorical figures and dice. A rectangular table 6 inches long, and 4 inches broad, divided into 24 parts. The squares 1, 2, 3, 4 are filled up by representations of the twelve cyclic animals, in groups so ar- ranged that one animal is ridden by three others. They are con- sidered here as introductory figures and have their par- ticular importance when a marriage is contracted, but not in reference to sickness ; they shall be explained in the subse- quent section, IV, Squares 5 to 16 are the spaces which contain the objects and sentences consulted in illness; they are: 5. Two coniferous trees. 6. Buildings during inunda- tion. 7. Two coniferous trees. 8. One tree, 9. Two sacred buildings. 10. Two eyes. The sentences in 10 to 16 are written in running-hand with abbreviations, so that a literal transliteration was not possible for square 12. These sentences^ follow in the succession my diagram gives: — 1 1 . The flourishing (green) tree of life will be broken now or later. — No. 1. 12. [The golden tree will now be broken]. — This, however, stands under the image of the buildings in inundation, in which no allusion to a tree could be discovered. 1 3. The tree of the blue colour of turquoise will be broken now or later. — No. 2. * Number 12, of which the exact translation could not be given, is marked by brackets. In the other sentences the numerals after “No.” have reference to the Tibetan text in Plate XVIII., II. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 TABLES OF MAKKIAGE. 315 14. The tree rfPag-6sam-shing ^ -will be broken now or later. — No. 3. 15. The celebrated houses and enclosures will be destroyed now or later. — No. 4. 16. Now or later the e3'es of death shall meet you, — No. 5.' The spaces 19 to 24 represent the six surfaces of a die. The dots upon dice used for soothsaying purposes show here the following arrangment, one half of the dots being white, the other black. oo*»o o* • o • Oo«*o O* • The dice are either cubes, like the European ones, or rectangular parallepidedons, sometimes comparatively very long. The latter, in consequence of their fonn, have two sides blank. o o o o • • • o • o • o • o • o o • O • o • o o • o IV. TABLES FOR MARRIAGE. 1. Table with numerals. One diagram of this kind shows a table of nine squares, each dmded again into nine spaces; the central is a rectangle, in which is inscribed a short sentence; the eight surrounding ' It is a fabulous tree which accomplishes every wish. Schmidt. “Tibet. Lexicon.” “ A great number of similar oracles have been compiled in the book .led-tho yangi zamatog “handbook of oracles.” 316 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. spaces contain each the number of aMeba. The arrangement of the numerals is as given in the accompanying figure. The sentences in the rectangles were explained to Hermann to run thus:^ I. Medicine of the sky, true. II. Medicine of the sky, middle. III. Medicine of the sky, partly true. IV. Imaginarily true according to man’s knowledge. V. Of middle fortune, mediocre (the Lama said: Imaginarily true, but doubtful). VI. Imaginarily true, and bad by imagination. VII. Utterly bad. Vni. Likely to be bad. IX. A little better than the regular bad ones. This table is consulted by the parents of the young people to be married, who throw a sacred seed upon it; ' The inscriptions had been so much injured that I could only verify the fifth. TABLES OF MAERIAGE. 317 the inscription of the square upon which the seed rests, is taken as the general character of the answer as to the felicity of the ensuing marriage, but the answer allows a variety of interpretations, according to the birth Meba of the young people, and to the Meba of the square, if the seed happens to rest upon a numeral and not upon the inscription. Also the elements under which they were born, are taken into consideration. In this respect it is universally admitted that the circumstance, that the elements under which the young people were bom are not the same would entail discord and strife, if the element which is superior in power were not neutralized by ceremonies which, of course, can only be performed with efficacy by the Lamas. The relations of the elements are detailed in the following sentences ; their Tibetan text is given in Plate XIX., II. “ The mother of wood is water, the son of wood fire ; “The enemy of wood is iron, the friend of wood earth ; “ The mother of water is iron, the son of water wood ; “The enemy of water is earth, the friend of water fire; “The mother of iron is earth, the son of iron water; “The enemy of iron is fire, the friend of iron water; “The mother of earth is fire, the son of earth iron; “The enemy of earth is wood, the friend of earth iron.” These notions ' are evidently founded upon con- siderations on the conditions of growth and decay of the existing objects; for wood, or the plants, grow in ' Comp. Pallas, 1. c., p. 23G. 318 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. the earth and are fed by water; wood furnishes the material for fire, but wood, or trees, are felled by iron. Iron (shovels) are indispensable for irrigation-canals, to furnish the plants (wood) with the necessary water, of which, however, the}' are deprived to a certain extent by the earth, into which a .part sinks and is lost.’ Fire again renders possible the use of water for cooking, and thus increases its importance for man. 2, Table ivith cyclic animals. All the tribes of Central Asia^ suppose that the different natures of the elements which constitute the cycle of twelve years, cause mutual affection or aversity; the rules, however, which the Tibetans have established on this head, are very arbitrary; they believe, e. g. that the* bird would pick the horse, &c. They speak of six varieties of relative feelings, viz.; very great affection; mediocre affection; indifference; disinclination; great hatred; deadly hatred. Deadly hatred is incurable, and under such auspices young people should, properly, not be permitted to marry; but if the parties are wealthy and liberal, the hatred may be prevented from breaking out. All other relations of the animals can be modified — the infiuence of the unfavourable weakened or totally counteracted, that of the favourable strengthened and increased. Diagrams in the divisions of which such groups of animals are formed, are very frequent; their arrangement ‘ The general dryness of the climate in Tibet makes cultivation much more dependent upon irrigation than in nearly any inhabited part of the globe. * Comp. Pallas, 1. c., pp. 2.36, 263. Tj face p. 313. Plate XIX. DIVINATION FORMULA. TAKEN FROM FIGURE-TABLES FROM GNARI KH6RSUM. 1. For the interpretation of oracles. The oracles to which they refer are given on Plate XX. 1 . 2 . 3. T 6 . 33-ZJlU)5/‘o^V^5t 7 7 9 . uj::^-^5rzT|^5|-5^5r|i5/7 7 12. uj3^-|^-f^-o^5r|s5/7 7 2. Rythmical sentences concerning the influence of the elements, for good or bad, upon a proposed marriage. 1. 2. i|q-zj|uj5/‘5^^-js5/7 7 «;zr]uJ5/‘575r^5/7 7 10. 13 . 11 . 14 . 2(i:;-^-*-oi-5[g-»7 7 3 . 5. ^Tl|5r3q-5/'‘y^zi|^’5'«.7 7 7 . 4. 6 . 8 . 5T^^-^C,-‘y5r^Tl|5/-^il]5/7 7 ^ . *flf » I, V w • r^' ^ %r'^‘ir : P\\^ ‘*^‘i • »f r^ . I ■ <• ' ‘I't - 4 ..♦.»' S 'rit^i r .. 'M/l ' V ► ^V v'^iHWsr > '. ' • ‘^' % ij#y 'I'-i' 'V' ‘ • • ' . ' •"•^•r ■ •r 4J5i *4t!^ ^ , '• ' T:ry. 2 i ■] ■ j^;>, ■' .iii i 4 ^y 'd; va j i , f: :‘^-(lP^* ’ - r* • ' '^‘v *r^jD^ ■ ‘ ■ -4' ^ '*'*• ’• ' ^^'V*!'^ •>'''■. 4 2Ti '4 #^U' J J '* 1 *^ . . ■ '-‘I 4.» . ^ .t: / .4! V^ > *■-' ^ • ■ * }•■ . u » TABLK WITH CYCLIC ASIUALS. 319 is either that the head of two animals are delineated M’ithin one division, or that their names are inscribed instead : occasionally also an animal is ridden by a monster in human shape with the heads of one or even more of the cyclic animals. AVhether the hatred or dis- inclination will become fatal to the couple, is determined by the casting of dice. Tables of this sort had been appended to the astro- logical roll from Lhassa (see p. 293). The one which shows the combinations of animals between which feelings of averseness very probably exist, has 3G compartments; the twelve squares of the first two lines have the heads of the animals drawn turned away from each other ; the remainder contain their names ; the entire series is this: — Tiger Hare Dragon Serpent Horse Sheep Ape Bird Dog Sheep. Mouse. Ox Hare Tiger Serpent Dragon Sheep Horse Bird Ape Hog Dog. Ox Mouse Dragon Ox Horse Hare Ape Serpent Dog Sheep Mouse Bird Tiger Hog Serpent Mouse Ox Tiger Bird Dragon Hog Horse Sheep Ape Hare Dog Horse Hog Ape Ox Dog Hare Mouse Serpent Tiger Sheep Dragon Bird Sheep Dog Bird Mouse Hog Tiger Ox Dragon Hare Horse Serpent Ape 320 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. Another combination shows the animals which may but do not necessarily prove unfavourable; it comprises four divisions, and in each is seen an animal ridden by a monster with the heads of three animals. In the first division the hog is ridden by the bird, serpent and dog; in the second the ape by the mouse, sheep, and tiger; in the third the tiger by the horse, ox and ape; in the fourth the serpent by the dragon, the hog and hare. These figures are the same as those wliich occupy the four first spaces of the table which is described on p. 313, as used for consulta.tion in cases of sickness. Y. A SOOTHSAYING TABLE WITH NUMEROUS FIGURES AND SENTENCES. It was but after great hesitation on the part of the Lamas that Adolphe and Robert obtained this table at Mangnang, in Griiari Khorsum ; they were repeatedly as- sured that no other copy could be procured, except after much delay, direct fi’om Lhassa. As my brothers did not succeed in obtaining information from the Lamas of Mangnang concerning its application, I addressed myself to Mr. Schiefner, in order to obtain details about ana- logous objects; but though he inquired with his usual kindness about such materials, I remained limited to the translation of the inscriptions, and, for the interpretation of the figures, to the analogy of the forms with those on other tables. A SOOTHSAYING TAHLE. 321 The original is 2 1 inches long, and 1 8 inches broad ; its principal part is divided into 78 rectangles which contain either a figure, or a sentence, or both combined; some, however, are empty. Along its sides two vertical stripes are left to receive explanatory directions for the use of the table; of these, however, one is empty. In order to facilitate the explanation, I give as usual tlie outlines of the compartments; where a number is omitted, the space is empty. B ^ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 — 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 — 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 56 57 58 59 60 B1 62 63 64 65 66 68 69 70 71 72 75 76 77 78 1 in the translation here given the sentences, in order to the distinguishing of them from the figures, are placed between marks of quotation. 21 322 TABLES FOE ASTEOLOGICAL PUEPOSES. A. The central table with its figures and sentences. The numbers at the commencement of the line have reference to those in A of the preceding diagram; the numbers at the end of the sentences refer to Plate XX., where the respective sentences are printed in Tibetan characters. 1. “The celestial chair, is it empt}" or not?” (No. 1.) 2. A lion. 3. “The twisted snare, shall it slip through (under the object) or not?”^ (No. 2.) A twisted rope. 4. The skin of a man. 5. The walls of a rehgious establishment. 6. “Shall every track be lost of the residence of the king of eloquence or not?”^ (No. 3.) A Lama. 7. “The peacock beneath the throne of lions,^ shall it be victorious or not.” (No. 4.) 8. The peacock riding a lion: this is a symbol of the throne of lions. 9. “The residence of turquoise colour, shall it be destroyed or not?” (No. 5.) The figure is meant for an altar with a cone of sacrifice (Zhalzai)^ upon it.” 10. A string of beads, symbolizing human skulls. 1 1 . The vessel Namgyal bumpa,^ with flow'ers put into the neck. 12. “The golden Dorje, shall it open itself like a * The snare, in Tibetan Zhagpa, is a symbol of power, see pp. 213, 216. It occurs again sub Nos. 18, 21, 48. The words in parentheses are paraphases of the Tibetan texts. “ ManjusrI is meant, the god of eloquence and wisdom (see p. 65). 3 See p. 211. ‘ See p. 228. ^ See p. 247. Plate XX. (QUERIES AXD AXSWERS. TAKEN FROM A SOOTHSAYING TABLE FROM GNARI KIi6RSUM. ^e^'^S-SqX,'i^C;-WB!J'Sl-^C;7 7 2. 13. 3. 14. A 16. 'y*goi‘^»?/‘5qir-?T|-^T:§'^iaV9!r|;»»s'a'^i,r r 1 1. |«%'qz.-T)-3g|i;-srJj'51-S5]7 7 22. m \ . ff?.? V. 4 ; -‘Vf ^Sf' I;: ' Tf r • * 1 . t'* < ' *- % ) .•*< ' i'. ♦'-• A SOOTHSAYING TABLE. 323 flower (appear) in the sky?” (No. 6.) A Dorje, the symbol of power. ‘ 13. “The bad speech of the unbelievers,^ will it come forth or not?” (No. 7.) 1 4. An unbeliever. 15. “The mat, shall it be made to melt (be destroyed) by fire or not?” (No. 8.) A figure similar to a chess-board. 16. The Phurbu, the symbol of power over the evil spirits. (See p. 257.) 17. A circle for divination. 18. Twisted ropes, meaning the snare. (Comp. Fig. 3.) 19. “The celestial .... and the twisted .... shall they be cut or not?”^ (No. 9.) 20. The figures of “Byang-bu” and “Thai;” the former is a stalk with green leaves, the latter a parallel- ogram fastened to a stick. 21. The snare (comp. Fig. 3.). No meaning found for the respective sentence. 22. An arrow with ribands. 23. Two astrological instruments. 24. The trident, the symbol of power over the evil spirits. (See p. 215.) 25. “The magistrate’s residence shall it become empty or not.” (No. 10.) 26. A bridge, of which three arches are seen. , ' See p. 215. - In Sanskrit Tlrthika; see p. 25. ® The two Tibetan words which I could not translate, are byang-bu, and thal. Byang-bu the Dictionaries explain by “a title, an address;” for thal they give “dust, ashes,” for thal-mo they have “palm of the hand.” 21 * 324 TABLES FOE ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. 27. “The magic wand, shall it break or not?” (No. 11.) Two staffs, one standing upright, the other Avitli its upper end bent. 28. The walls of a religious building. (Comp. Fig. 5.) 29. A Lama. 30. A Lama. 31. “The enclosure of the fire-place of the followers of the Bon religion, shall it be empty or not?” (No. 12.) 32. A priest of the Bon religion, holding a sword and a shield. 33. “The excellent horse ‘ and the man, shall they go away in opposite directions or not?” (No. 13.) A man on horseback. 34. A sword. 35. A bow in a case, and a quiver with four arrows. 36. An arrow without ribands. 37. “The shoes, shall they be carried away by the water or not?” (No. 14.) 38. Two shoes standing on the slopes of a hill. 39. “The divine astrology, shall it become known or not?” (No. 15.) Two astrologers in religious garments. 40. A bow and a arrow. 41. Two fishes swimming in water. 42. A bird sitting upon a flower. 43. Water. (Comp. Fig. 49.) * The Lungta, or airy horse is to be understood here, and its faculty of keeping off the dangers which might arise from the disharmony of the cyclic animals, the elements and the planets. See Plate XL, and p. 2b3- A SOOTHSAYING TABLE. 325 44. “The garment and the umbrella with the handle of turquoise, shall it hill down (to the earth) or not?” (No. 16.) The handle of a turquoise. 45. “The lodgings, shall they be destroyed by the servant, or not?” (No. 17.) Walls. 46. A Lama wearing the magic mirror. 47. A snare hanging down from a rope. (Comp. Fig. 3.) 48. Several snares hanging down from a rope. 49. “The spring of the universe, shall it dry up or not?” (No, 18.) It must refer to Fig. 43. 50. “The paternal house, shall it come into the pos- session of the enemies, or not?” (No. 19.) Walls. 51. “The magic mirror, shall it appear or not?” (No. 20.) The mirror supported by a flower. 52. Three Lamas. 53. full-blown flower. 54. Five arrows and a bow, 56. “The pillars (of the Buddhist faith) and the thousand offerings, shall they be spread far and wide, or not?” (No. 21.) Three vessels for offerings upon a table. 57. Three Lamas, the first clad in red and green; his two companions are left uncoloured. 58. A Lama with the magic mirror, 59. A Lama clad in red, leaving the house. 60. Its upper part is filled with the point ot the arrows and bow (comp. Fig. 54.); to its lower and reaches the flower from the square under- neath. 61. “The white genius of the excellent land, shall he submit himself or not?” (No. 22.) 326 TABLES FOR ASTROLOGICAL PURPOSES. 62. A sentence, bnt no meaning was found. 63. A conch, with which the Lamas are summoned to prayers. 64. The magic mirror. 65. A leaf. 66. An open flower, its upper part is formed by the magic mirror. 68. A hog. 69. A pillar (supporting a monastery, or Buddhism in general). 70. An altar with an oft'ering vessel, and a flame burning under it. 71. Walls. 72. A house. 75. The black celestial dog.* 76. A 3^ak. 77. A tiger. 78. A hare. B. Directions for finding out the due answer. The numerals at the commencement are those in B of the diagram on p. 321, and those at the end of the line refer to the Tibetan texts in Plate XIX, 1. 1. “Begin to count the terrestrial fortress from the celestial king.” (Manjusri.) (No. 1.) 2. [The quantity of letters which could be read was not sufficient to guess the meaning]. (No. 2.) 3. “Count the water from the tiger.” (No. 3.) 4. “Count the earth from the tiger.” (No. 4.) * See ji. 209. CONCLUDING REMAKKS. 327 5. “Count the iron from the tiger and the hare.” (No. 5.) (i. “Count the fire from the hare.” (No. 6.) 7 “Count the wood from the hare.” (No. 7.) 8. “Count the water from the hare.” (No. 8.) 9. “Count the preceding (hare) from these three (elements).” (No. 9.) 10. “Count the fire from the tiger.” (No. 10.) 11. “Count the water from the ape.” (No. 11.) 12. “Count the preceding (ape and tiger) from the five (elements).” (No. 12.) 13. “Count the subsequent from the five.” (No. 13.) 14. “Count from the year of the heaven.” (No. 14.) Having arrived at the conclusion of the descriptive ])art of [this volume, I may be allowed to add still a few remarks, though of a general bearing, in allusion to the contributions which the inquiries into Buddhism have afforded for the explanation of monumental remains in Europe, particularly in Norway, as well as for the interpretation of ancient mythological terminology. Prof. Holmboe of Stockholm, when comparing the tumuli and long walls extant in many parts of Norway with the Topes in India and Afghanistan and the Chortens and Manis of Tibet, found so many surprising analogies, that he at length declared that, in his opinion, it is highly probable, “the teachers of Buddhism advanced as far as Scandinavia, after having passed through the vast provinces 328 TABLES FOE ASTEOLOGICAL PUEPOSES. of Russia.” And, what may be more unexpected still, even in Mexico Buddhism was discovered to have had followers as late as the 1 3th century, a circumstance made evident from the details and descriptions contained in a Chinese author of the end of the fifteenth century of our era concerning “the far distant land into which pious men and heavy storms had transferred the sacred doctrine.”^ ’ For details see Holmboe, “Traces de Buddhisme en Norvege,” p. 69. Even the name of the god Odin, or Wodan, the highest god in German mythology, Holmboe says, may be referred to Buddhist terms and to the Sanskrit word Budh and its derivations Buddha, Bodhin, Bodhdn, Bodhant. The change of h into v has taken place already in Sanskrit, and the dropping of the V in the ancient language of Norway is said to be very frequent in words in which it is followed by o or «<. — A brief summary, with critical remarks, of Holmboe’s book is given by Rajendralal Mitra in Joum. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXVII., p. 46. ^ See Neumann, as quoted by Lassen, “Indische Alterthumskunde,” Vol. IV., p. 749. — In the United States of America, too, artificial mounds have been found bearing such a curious analogy with the tumuli in Norway, that it has been suggested by American antiquarians, that a people coming from Norway discovered America already about the year 1000 of our era. Rafn, as quoted by Holmboe, p. 23. A P P E N I) I X. A. LITERATURE. AN ALPHABETICAL LIST OF THE WORKS AND MEMOIRS CONNECTED WITH BUDDHISM, ITS DOGMAS, HISTORY, AND GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION. TITLES OF THE PERIODICALS AND COLLECTIVE PUBLICATIONS CONSULTED.— ALPHABETICAL LIST OF THE AUTHORS. The following register gives the full title of all notable publications on Buddhism, including memoirs contained in periodicals, as well as separate works. The literature of the various languages of Europe is so vast that T dare not hope that this hst is sufficiently detailed and complete. But I may be allowed at least to add, as an apology for my compilation, that I was not aided by . a previous enumeration of this kind. For official assistance I am particularly indebted to the director of the Koyal and State Library at Munich, Professor Halm. An arrangement of the literature in reference to the principal objects is easily found in the “Index,” where the respective publications are added to the other details. 332 ABHANDLUNGEN. GLEANINGS IN SCIENCE. TITLES OF THE PERIODICALS AND OTHER PUBLICATIONS EXAMINED. (The words in brackets are the abbreviations I use.) Abhandlungen der koniglichen Akademie der Wissenschaften zu Berlin. Up to 1860. (Abb. d. Berl. Akad.) Akbeiten der russischen Mission in Peking. Deutsche Ueber- setzung von Abel und Mecklenburg. Berlin, 1858. Vols. I., II. (Arb. d. russ. Mission.) Archiv fiir die wissenscbaftlicbe Kunde von Russland, von Erinan. Vols. I. to XX. (Erman’s Arcliiv.) Asiatic Researches, or Transactions of the Society instituted in Bengal. Calcutta. Vols. I. to XX. The octavo edition is distinguished by 8°. (As. Res.) Bulletin scientitique jmblie par I’Academie des Sciences de St. Petersbourg. Vols. I. to X. (Bull. sc. St. Petersb. Acad.) Bulletin de la classe historico-philologique de T Academic Im- periale des Sciences de St. Petersbourg. Vols. I. to XIV. (Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb.) Bulletin de PAcademie Imperiale des Sciences de St. Peters- bourg. Vols. I. to V. (Bull. St. Petersb. Acad.) Chinese Repository. Canton. Vol. 111. (Chin. Rep.) Denkschriften der k. k. Akademie der Wissenschaften in Wien. (Denkschr. d. Wien. Akad.) Cleanings [n Science. ‘i. Calcutta. Vols. 1. to 111. (Glean, in sc.) JOUENAL ASIATIQUE. MEMOIRES. 333 Journal Asiatique, ou Recueil de Memoires, d’Extraits et de Notices relatifs a I’histoire, a la philosophie, aux sciences, a la litterature et aux langues des peuples orientaux. Vols. I. to V. (Journ. As.) Journal of the American Oriental Society. New-York. (Journ. Amer. Or. Soc.) Journal of the Asiatic Society of Bengal. Vols. I. to XXX. (Journ. As. Soc. Beng.) Journal of the Bombay branch of the Royal Asiatic Society. Vols. I. to V. (Journ. Bomb. R. As. Soc.) Journal of the Ceylon branch of the Royal Asiatic Society. Colombo, 1845, 1848, 1850, 1853. (Journ. Ceylon. R. As. Soc.) Journal of the Indian Archipelago and Eastern Asia. Singapore. New series. Vols. I. to III. (Journ. Ind. Arch.) Journal (also Transactions) of the Royal Asiatic Society of Great Britain and Ireland. Vols. I. to XIX. (Journ. R. As. Soc.) Journal des Savants. Paris. From 1820-1856. (Journ. des Sav.) Journal of the Shanghai Literary Society. (Journ. Shanghai Lit. Soc.). Madras Journal of Literature and Science. Madras. New Series. Vols. I. to VII. (Madras Journ.) Memoires de ITnstitut Imperial de France, Academie des In- scriptions. (Mem. de ITnst. de France.) Memoires presentes a I’Academie Imperiale des Sciences de St. Petersbourg par divers savants. Vols. I. to VI. (Mem. des sav. etrang. St. Petersb.) 334 MEMOIEES. BAETHELEMY ST. HILAIEE. Memoires de I’Academie Imperiale des Sciences de St. Peters- bourg. Serie I. to VII. (Mem. de I’Acad. St. Petersb.) XouvEAU Journal Asiatique ou liecueil de Memoires, d’Ex- traits et de Notices relatifs a I’histoire, a la pliilosophie aux langues, et a la litterature des peuples orientaux. Paris. 1826-1861. (Nouv. Journ. As.) Transactions of the Literary Society of Bombay. Vols. I. to III. (Trans. Lit. Soc. Bombay.) Zeitschrift der deutschen Morgenlandischen Gesellschaft. Vols. I. to XI. (Ztschr. d. d. Morg. Ges.) Zeitschrift fiir die Kunde des Morgenlandes. Vols. I. to V. (Ztschr. f. d. K. d. ^lorg.) ALPHABETICAL LIST OF THE AUTHOES. Ackermann, B. The history and doctrine of Buddhism. 1829. Anderson, W. An attempt to identify some of the places men- tioned in the Itinerary of Hiuan Thsang. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVI., p. 1183. See also for other publications on this subject: Cunningham, Muller. Critic, diss. : Cunningham, Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVII., Part. I., p. 476; Part. II., p. 13. Bailey, E. C. Note on some sculptures found in the district of PeshawTir. Joum. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXL, p. 606. See also on this subject a paper by Jaquet. Barthelemy St. Hilaire; Sur les travaux de M. Eugene Burnouf. Journ. des Sav., 1852, pp. 473, 561. Du Buddhisme. Paris, 1855. BAKTHELEMY ST. HIL. BOEHTLINGK. 335 Bakthelemy St. Hilaiee; Le Bouddha et sa religion. Paris, 1860. For critical dissertations by this author see: Burnouf, Foucaux, St. Julien. Bazin, M. Recherches sur I’origine, hhistoire et la constitution des ordres religieux dans I’empire chinois. Nouv. Journ. As., Y. Serie, Vol. VIII. (1856). Benfey, Th. Bemerkung zu einer Mittheilung des Megasthenes in Bezug auf Indische Geschichte. Zschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. V., p. 218. Einige Bemerkungen iiber die Gbtternamen auf den indoscythi- schen Miinzen. Ztschr. d. d. Morg. Ges., Vol. VIII., p. 450. Bennet, C. Life of Gaudama, a translation from the Burmese book entitled Ma-la-len-ga-ra Wottoo. Journ. Amer. Or. Soc., Vol. III., pp. 1-165. Bekgmann: Nomadische Streifereien unter den Kalmiicken in den Jahren 1802 u. 1803. 4 Vols. 1805. (Compare also Morris.) Bigandet, Legend of the Burmese Budha, called Gaudama. Journ. Ind. Arch., Vol. VI., pp. 278, 499; Vol. VII., p. 159; Vol. VII., pp. 349, 373; Vol. IX., pp. 139, 325, 483. Biot. For critical dissertations by this author see Burnouf. Bikd, J. : Historical Researches on the Origin and Principles of the Buddha and Jaina Religions. Journ. Bombay R. As. Soc., Vol. II., p. 71. Bochingee, J. J. : La vie contemplative, ascetique, et mona- stique chez les Indous et chez les peuples Bouddhistes. Strasbourg, 1831. Boehtlingk: Rapport sur un memoir intitule: “Eine tibetische Lebensbeschreibung Sakjamuni’s, des Begriinders des Buddha- thums,” ira Auszuge mitgetheilt von A. Schiefner. Bull, hist.- phil. St. Petersb. Vol. V., p. 93. 33G BOHLEN. BURNOUF. Bohlen, P. V. : De Buddhaismi Origine et Aetate conscripsit Petrus a Bohlen. Regiment. Pruss., 1827. Das alte Indien, mit besonderer Riicksicht auf Egypten dar- gestellt. 2 Vols. Konigsberg, 1830. Hrockhaus, H. ; Soma Deva, Griindung der Stadt Pataliputra und Geschiebte des Upakosa. Leipzig, 183 . 0 . See also on this subject a paper by Francklin. Buchanan, Fe. ; On the religion and literature of the Burmas As. Res., 8°. Vol. VI., p. 136. Buenes, a.: Account of the Jain temples at Mount Abu in Guzerat. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. II., p. 161. Travels into Bokhara; being an account of a journey from India to Caboul, Tartary and Persia. 2 Vols. 1834. See also Epbinstone. Burney, H. St.; Translation of an Inscription in the Burmese language, discovered at Buddha Gaya, in 1833. As. Res., Vol. XX., p. 161. See also about this town a paper by Kittoe. Critic, diss.: Lassen, Chr.; Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. L, p. 108. Discovery of Buddliist Images with Deva-nagari Inscriptions at Tagoung, the ancient Capital of the Burmese Empire. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., -Vol. V., p. 157. Critic, diss.: Lassen, Chr.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. L, p. 228 . Burnouf, E. (et Ch. Lassen) : Essai sur le Pali, ou la Langue sacree de la presqu’ile au-dela du Gange, avec six planches lithographiees. Paris, 1826. BUKNOUl’. CALLAWAY. 337 Burnouf, E. (et Cli. Lassen): Observations grammaticales sur (juekiues passages de I’Essai de MM. Burnouf et Lassen. Paris, 1827. Introduction a I’Histoire du Buddhism Indien. Paris, 1844. Critical diss.: Boer, E.: Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XIV., Part II., p. 783; Biot; Journ. des Sav., 184.5, pp. 233, 257, and 337. Le Lotus de la Bonne Loi, traduit du Sanskrit, accoinpagne d’uu commentaire et de vingt et un memoires x’elatifs an Buddhisme. Paris, 1852. Critical diss.: Barthelemy St. Hilaire; nine articles in Journ. des Sav. 1854 and 1855 (in connexion with Foucaux’s Rgya Teller Rol pa). A. Weber, “Indische Studien,” Vol. III., p. 135. For critical diss. by this author see Remusat, Upham. Burt, F. S. ; More Danams from the Sanchi Tope near Bhilsa, taken in impression. Joura. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VIE, p. 5G2. See also about this tope: Cunningham, Prinsep. A description, with drawings, of the ancient stone pillar at Allahabad, called Bhim ten’s Gada or Club, with accom- panying copies of four inscriptions engraved in different char- acters upon its surface. Journ. &c. Vol. III., p. 105. See also for other papers on this pillar: Hodgson, Mill, Prinsep, Troyer, Tumour. Callaway, John: Yakkun Nattanncma; A Cingalese Poem descriptive of the Ceylon System of Demonology, to which is added: The Practices of a Capua or Devil Priest, as described by a Buddhist: and Kolan Nattannatva, a Cingalese Poem, descriptive of the characters assumed by natives of Ceylon in a Masquerade. London, 1829. 338 CAMPBELL. COUET. Campbell, A.: Journal of a trip to Sikkim. Journ. As. Soc. Bong., Vol. XVIII., p. 482. Diary of a Journey through Sikkim to the frontiers of Thibet. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXL, pp. 407, 477, 563. Carey, W. ; An account of the funeral ceremonies of a Burman Priest. As. Res., Vol. XII., p. 186. Carte, W. E.; Notice of Amulets in use by the Trans-Hima- layan Boodhists, with remarks by Csoina de Kords. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IX., Part. II., p. 904. Catalogue des Manuscrits and Xylographies Orientaux de la Bibliotheque Imperiale Publique de St. Petersbourg. 1852. Chapmann, I. 1. ; Some additional remai’ks upon the ancient city of Anurajapura or Anuradhapura and the Hill Temple at Mehentele in the island of Ceylon. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XIII., p. 164. Chitty, S. C. : The sixth Chapter of the Tiruvathavur Purana. Journ. Ceylon R. As. Soc. 1845. No. I., Part. I., p. 63. Colebrooke, H. T.; Observations on the sect of Jains. As. Res., Vol. IX., p. 287. C^ONGREVE, H. : A brief account of the ancient Buddhist Sculp- tures at Masulipatam. Madras Journ., Vol. VI., May 1861, p. 44. Court, A.; Further information on the Topes of Manikyala, being the translation of on extract of a manuscript memoir on ancient Taxila. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. III., p. 556. Note on the brown liquid contained in the cylinders from Manikyala. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IIP, p. 567. See also for other papers on this tope: Cunningham, Prinsep. L’RAWFURI). CSOMA DE KOROS. 33f) Crawfurd, J. : On the ruins of Boro Budor in Java. Trans. Lit. Soc. Bomb., Vol. II., p. 154. History of the Indian Archipelago. Edinburgh, 1820. Vols. I., II., III. CsOMA DE Koros: Translation of a Tibetan fragment, with remarks by H. H. Wilson. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. I., p. 269. — Geographical notice of Tibet. Journ. &c., Vol. I., p. 121. Note on the origin of the Kala-Chakra and Adi-Buddha Systems. Journ. &c., Vol. II., p. 57. Translation of a Tibetan passport. Journ. &c., Vol. II., p. 201. Origin of the Shakya race, translated from the La, or the 26th volume of the niDo class in the Kah-gyur, commencing at the 161st leaf. Journ. &c., Vol. II., p. 385. Extracts from Tibetan works. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 57. Analysis of a Tibetan Medical Work. Journ. &c., Vol. IV., p. 1. Notices on the different systems of Buddhism extracted from the Tibetan authorities. Journ. &c., Vol. VII., Part. I., p. 142. Critical diss.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. IV. Enumeration of Historical and Grammatical works to be met with in Tibet. Journ. &c., Vol. VH., p, 147. Critical diss.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. IV. Remarks on the “Notice of amulets in use by the Trans- Himalayan Boodhists by W. E. Carte.” Journ. &c., Vol. IX., Part. II., p. 905. 22 * 340 CSOMA DE KOEOS. CUNNINGHAM. CsOMA DE Koeos : Interpretation of the Tibetan inscription on a Bhotian banner, taken in Assam. Jonrn. &c., Yol. Y., p. 2G4. Translation of a Tibetan sloka found on a wliite piece of China scarf. Journ. Ac., Yol. ^ p. 384. — Analysis of the Tibetan work entitled the Kah-gyur. As. Res., Yol. XX., pp. 41, 393. Abstract of the contents of the ilstan -/«gyur. As. Res., Yol. XX., p. 553. Notices on the life of Shfikya. As. Res., Yol. XX., p. 285. A Grammar of the Tibetan language, in English. Calcutta, 1834. Essay towards a Dictionary, Tibetan and English. Calcutta, 1834. — — A brief notice of the Subhashita Ratna Nidhi of Saskya Pandita. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Yol. XXIY., p. 141 ; Yol.XXY., p. 257. Cunningham, A.; Correction of a mistake regarding some of the Roman coins found in the Tope of Manikyala opened by M. Court. Journ. &c., Yol. III., p. 635. See also for other papers on this tope; Court, Prinsep. An account of the Discovery of the Ruins of the Buddhist City of Samkassa. Journ. R. As. Soc., Yol. VII., p. 241. Opening of the Topes, or Buddhist Monuments, of Central India. Journ. R. As. Soc., Yol. XIII., p. 108. The Bhilsa Topes, or Buddhist monuments, of Central India. London, 1854. Ladak, physical, statistical, and historical; >vith notices of the surrounding countries. London, 1854. CUNNINGHAM. ELPHINSTONE. 341 Cunningham, A.: Verification of the Itinerary of Hivan Thsang through Afghanistan and India, thi-ough the first half of the 7th. century. Journ. &c., Vol. XVII., Part. II., j). 13. Verification of the Itinerary of Hivan Thsang through Ariana and India, with reference to Major Anderson’s hypothesis of its modern compilation. Journ. &c., Vol. XVIL, Part I., p. 476. See also the paper of Muller. Satraps, with Greek inscriptions. Journ. &c., Vol. XXIIl., p. 679. An Essay on the Aiaan order of Architecture as established in the Temples of Kashmir. Journ. &c., Vol. XVIL, Part II., p. 274. Davis : China and the Chinese. German edition by Drugulin. Stuttgart, 1852. Deshautekayes: Recherches sur la Religion de Fo, professee par les Bonzes llo-chang de la Chine. Journ. As. 1825, pp. 150, 228, 311; 1826, pp. 40, 74, 179, 219. Eckstein, Baron d’ ; Theologie et Philosophie booddhiques, coni- parees a celles des Vedantins. (In the article, entitled: “Xara- sinha Oupanichat”). Nouv. Journ. As. 3® serie, Vol. II. (1836), p. 470. A critical revieiv is noticed under Julien. Edkins, E. : Translation of a Shastra Buddhist. Journ. Shanghai Lit. Soc., 1858. No. 1. {See also Wilson). Notes of a Correspondence with Sir John Bowring on Bud- dhist hterature in China, by Prof. Wilson. With Notice of Chinese Buddhist works translated from the Sanskrit. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XVI., p. 316. ElphinstoNE, M. : An account of the kingdom of Caboul, and its dependencies in Persia. Tartary, and India. 181!). See also Burnes. 342 EKSKINE. FOUCAUX. EKSKraE, W. : Account of the cave temple of Elephanta. Trans. Lit. Soc. Bomb. Vol. I., p. 198. Note to F. Dangerfield’s “Account of the caves near Bang called the Panch Pandoo.” Trans. &c., Vol. II., p. 194. Observations on the remains of the Buddhists in India. Trans. &c., Vol. III., p. 494. Fa Hian: The Pilgrimage of; from the French edition of the Foe koue ki of MM. Remusat, Klaproth, and Landresse. With additional notes and illustrations. (Anonymous. Cunningham quotes Laidley as the author.) Calcutta, 1848. 8°. For an other paper on the Itinerary of Fa Hian see Kittoe. Feegusson, J. : On the Rock-cut temples of India. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. VIII., p. 30. Also Prddished in 8°, with an Atlas in Roy. Fob, London, 1845. F INLAYSON ; The Mission to Siam and Hue, the capital of Cochin China, in the years 1821-22. With a memoir by the author, by Sir Th. St. Raffles. 1826. Foebes, J. : Notes on the Buddhas, from Ceylonese authorities: wdth an attempt to fix the dates of the appearance of the last four. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. V., p. 321. Critical diss.: Lassen, Chr.: Ztschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. 1., p. 235. Foucaux, Phil. Ed.: Specimen du Gya-Tcher-Rol-Pa. Partie du Chapitre ^TI., contenant la naissance de ^akya-Muni. I'cxte Tibetain, traduit en fran^-ais et accompagne de notes. Paris, 1841. FOUCAUX. GEOEG I. 343 Foucaux, Phil. Ed.; Ivgya Tclier Ilol pa, ou Developpement des jeux, contenant Tbistoire du Bouddba (^akyamuiii, traduit sur la version Tibetaine du Bkah Hgyour, et revu sur Toriginal Sanscrit (Lalitavistara). 2 Vols. Paris, 1847. Critical diss.: Schiefiier. Bull, bist.-phil. St. Petersb. Vol. VII., pp. 118, 225, 261, 501. — Bartbelemy St. Hilaire; nine articles in connexion with Burnoufs “Le Lotus de la Bonne Loi.” Journ. des Sav. 1854. 1855. For other papers on this histoiical book, see: Lenz, Rajendralal Mitra. Parabole de I’enfant egare, formant le Chaptre IV. du Lohis de la Bonne Loi. Paris, 1854. Grainmaire de la Langue Tibetaine. Paris, 1858. Le Tresor des belles Paroles; choix de sentences, composees en tibetain par le Lama Saskya Pandita, suiries d’une elegie tiree du Kanjur, traduites pour la premiere fois en frangais. Paris, 1858. Fkancklin, W.: Researches on the Tenets and Doctrines of the Jeynes and Boodhists; conjectiu’ed to be Brahmaues of ancient India. London, 1827. Inquiry concerning the site of ancient Palibothra, conjectured to lie within the limits of the modern district of Bhaugul- poor. Parts. I-IV. London, 1815-22. For another paper on this town see Brockhaus. Feiedekich: Over Inscriptien van Java en Sumatra, voor het eerst ontcjferd. Batavia, 1857. (lABET, see Hue. (xEOEGl, A. A.; Alphabetum Tibetanum. Missionum apostoli- corum cominodo editum. Roma>, 1762. 344 GEKAKD. HARINGTOK. (lERARD, A.; KoonaAvur, edided by G. Lloyd. London, 1841. (lOGERLY, D. J, : On Buddhism. Journ. Ceylon R. As. Soc., 1845. No. L, Part L, p. 7; 1848, p. Ill; and 1853, p. 1. (trindlay, R. M. ; An account of some sculptures in the Cave Temples of Ellora. Trans. R. As. Soc., Vol. II., p. 326. See also on these temples the papers of Sykes, Tod. DE Guignes, J. : Recherches historiques sur la rehgion Indienne, et sur les livres fondamentaux de cette religion, qui ont ete ti'aduits de ITndien en Chinois. Acad. R. d. Inscript., Vol. XL Paris, 1780. Histoire generale des Huns, des Turcs, des Mongols, et des autres Tartares occidentaux &c., avant et depuis Jesus Christ jusqu’a present. 4 Vols. 1756-58. Gurius, O.; Das Geluhde der Buddhisten, und die Ceremonien ihrer Ablegung bei den Chinesen. Arb. d. russ. Miss., Vol. II., p. 315. GutzLAFF, C. ; Remarks on the present state of Buddhism in China. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XVL, p. 73. Halbertsma, j. H. : Het Budhism en zyn stichter. Deventer, 1843. Hammer-Purgstall; Ueher einen halb buddhistischen, hall) moslimischen Talisman. Denkschr. d. Wien. Ak.ad., Vol. L, 1850. Harington, J, H.: Introductory remarks to Capt. Mahony’s paper on Ceylon, and the doctrines of Buddha. As. Res. 8°. Vol. VHL, p. 529. HARDY. HODGSON. 34.5 Hardy, K. Spence: Eastern Monachism: an Account of the origin, laws, &c., of the order of Mendicants founded by Gotama Buddha. London, 1850. A Manual of Buddhism, translated from Singhalese Manu- scripts. London, 1853. Cntical diss.: A. Weber, “Indische Studien." Vol. III., pp. 117-35, Hay, W. C.; Report on the Valley of Spiti. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XIX., p. 429. Hilarion: Die Beziehungen Cliina’s zu Tibet. Arb. d. russ. Miss. Vol. I., p. 313. Hodgson, B. H.: Notices on the Languages, Literature, and Religion of the Bauddhas of Nepaul and Bhot. As. Res., Vol. XVL, p. 409. Sketch of Buddhism, derived from the Bauddha scriptui'es of Nepaul. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. II., p. 222. Quotations from original Sanskrit authorities in proof and illustration of his Sketch of Buddhism. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. V., pp. 28, 71. Critical diss.: Lassen: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d, Morg., Vol. L, p. 234. European Speculations on Buddhism. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 382. -Further remarks on M. Remusat’s Review of Buddhism. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 425. Notice on some ancient inscriptions in the characters of the Allahabad column. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 481. For other papers on this column see also: Burt, Mill, Prinsep, Tumour. HODGSON. 84() Hodgson, H. H.: Note on an iusci-iption fromSamath. Journ.&c., Vol. IV., p. 196. See also on this inscription the paper of Sykes. Notice on Adi Buddha and of the seven mortal Buddhas. Frinted under the title : Classification of Newars, in Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 215. Remarks on an Inscription in the Banja and Tibetan (U’chhen) characters, taken from a Temple on the confines of the Valley of Nepaul. Journ. &c., Vol. IV., p. 196. Account of a visit to the Ruins of Simroun, once the Capital of the Mithila Province. Journ. &c., Vol. IV., p. 121. Note on the Primary language of the Buddhist witings. Journ. &c., Vol. VI., p. 682. Cridical diss.: Lassen: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg. Vol. III., p. 159. {Of the same subject treats an) Extract of Proceedings of the R. As. Soc. January, 1836. A Disputation respecting Caste by a Buddhist, in the form of a series of Propositions supposed to be put by a Saiva and refuted by the Disjjutant. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. III. On the extreme resemblance that prevails between many of the Symbols of Buddhism and Saivism. Quarterly Oriental Magazine, 1827. Nos. 14, 16. All these papers are repi’inted in: — Illustrations of the Literature and Religion of the Buddhists. Serampore, 1841. - The Pravrajia, Vrata or Initiatory Rites of the Buddhists to the Paja Kand. Illustrations, p. 212. — Notice on Buddlust symbols. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XVIII., p. 393. HOFMANN. IMPEY. 347 Hofmann: Buddlia Pantheon von Nippon. With an Atlas of 03 Plates. Vol. V. of “v. Siebold, Archiv 7.ur Beschreihung von Japan.” Leyden. Holmboe, C. a.; Trace de Buddhisme en Norvege avant Pin- troduction du Christianisme. Paris, 1857. A brief summary is given by Rajendralal Mitra in the Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXVII., p. 46. Hookee, J. D.; Himalayan Journals. 2 Vols. London, 1854. Hue et (jtABET: Souvenirs d’un voyage dans la Tartarie, le Tibet et la Chine pendant les annees 1844, 1845, 1840. Vols. I. and II. 1853. Notice sur la Priere bouddhique: Om mani padme hum. Nouv. Journ. As. 4® Serie. Vol. IX., p. 462. Les quarante-deux points d’enseignement proferes par Bouddha, traduit du Mongole. Nouv. etc., Vol. XL, p. 535. See on this Sutra also the paper of Schiefner. Le Christianisme en Chine, en Tartarie and en Thibet. Vols. I.-IV. (Also translated into English.) Hullmann, C. D.: Historisch-kritische Abhandlung iiber die Lamaische Religion. Berlin, 1795. Humboldt, W. v. : Ueber die Kawi Sprache auf der Insel Java, nebst einer Einleitung iiber die Verschiedenheit des mensch- lichen Sprachbaues und ihren Einfluss auf die geistige Ent- wickelung des Menschengeschlechts. Berlin, 1836. Ideler ; Ueber die Zeitrechnung der Chinesen. (Read in the Berl. Ac. 1837; printed with addenda 1839.) 1]S1PEY, E. ; Description of a colossal Jain figure nearly 80 feet high, discovered on a spur of the Satpurah Range. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVllL, Part II., p. 918. 348 JACOB and WESTEKGAAKD. JULIEK. Jacob, L. G., and Westergaakd, N. L.: Copy of the Asoka Inscription at Girnar. Journ. Bomb. li. As. Soc., April 1843, p. 257. Japan, nach den besten vorhandenen Quellen gescbildert von einem Vereine Gelehrter. 1860. Jaquet, E.: Notice sur les decouvertes arcbeologiques faites par Honigberger pendant son sejour dans I’Afgbanistan. Nouv. Journ. As. 1836, p. 234; 1837, p. 401. Compare in reference to Peshaur the paper of Bailey. • fJoiNViLLE; On the Religion and Manners of the People of Ceylon. As. Res. 8°. Yol. VII., p. 397. Jones, J., Taylor: Some account of the Tbrai Phun. Journ. liid. Arch. 1851., Vol. V., p. 538. JuLiEN, Stan.: Memoires sur les Contrees Occidentales, traduits du Sanskrit en Chinois, en Pan 648, par Hiouen Tbsang, et du Chinois en Frangais. Paris, 1858. Vols. I. and II. Critical diss.: Baron d’Eckstein. Nouv. Journ. As., 5® Serie, Vol. X., p. 475 et seq. Bartlielemy St. Hilaire: eight articles in Journ. des Sav. 1855 and 1856. For fui'ther critical disser- tations see: Anderson, Cunningham, M. Miiller. Listes diverses des noms des dix-huit ecoles schismatiques qui sent sorties du Bouddhisme. Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. XIV. (1859.), p. 327. Renseignements bibliographiques sur les relations des Voyages dans ITiide et les descriptions du Si-yu, qui out etc compo- sees en Chinois entre le 5® et le 18® siecle de notre ere. Nouv. Journ. As. 4® Serie, Vol. X. (1847.), p. 265. JULIEN. KLAPKOTH. 34!) JuLiEN, Stan.: Concordance Sinico-Sanskrite d’un nombre con- siderable de titres d’ouvrages bouddhiques, recueillie dans un catalogue chinois de I’an 130G, et publiee, apres le decbilfre- ment et la restitution des mots indiens. Nouv. Journ. As. 4® Serie, Vol. XIY., pp. 351-446. Histoire de la Aue de Iliouen Thsang et de ses voyages dans I’Inde entre les annees 629 and 645 de notre ere. Paris, 1853. Critical diss.: Schiefner: A: Melanges Asiatiques. Vol. 11. Kishen Kant Bose : Some account of the country of Bhutan. As. Res., Vol. XV., p. 128. Kittoe, M. ; Note on an Image of Buddha found at Sherghatti. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVI., Part I., p. 78. Note on the sculptures of Bodh Gya. Journ. &c., Vol. XVI., Part. L, p. 334. Compare also on Buddha Gaya the paper of Burney. Notes on Places in the Province of Behar, supposed to be those described by Chi-Fa-Hian, the Chinese Buddhist priest who made a pilgrimage to India, at the close of the 4th. century. Journ. &c., Vol. XVI., p. 953. Klaproth, J. : Reise in den Kaukasus und nach Georgien. Vol. I. and II. 1812. Beleuchtung und Widerlegung der Forschungen iiber die Geschichte der Volker Mittelasiens von I. J. Schmidt. 1824. Critical diss.: Sylvestre de Sacy. Journ. des Sav., 1825. 350 KLAPEOTH. KOWALEWSKY. Klaproth, J. : Description du Tubet, traduite du cliinois en msse par le Pere Hyacinthe, et du russe en frangais par M***; revue sur I’original chinois et accompagnee de notes. Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. IV., pp. 81, 241.; Vol. VI, pp. 161, 321. Fragmens Bouddhiques. (Extrait du Nouv. Journ. As., Mars 1831.) Paris, 1831. Table Chronologique des plus celebres patriarches et des evenements remarquables de la Religion Bouddhique, redigee en 1678, traduite du Mongol et commentee. Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. VII. (1831), p. 161. Explication et Origine de la formule bouddhique Om mani padme bourn. Nouv. Journ. As., Vol. VIE, p. 185. For his edition of Tirakowsky see this name. Knox; The ceremonial of the ordination of a Burmese priest. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. III. Koppen, C. F. ; Die Religion des Buddha und ihre Entstehung. Vols. I. and II. Berlin, 1857, 1859. (Vol. II. is also entitled: Die lamaische Ilierarchie und Kirche.) Critical diss.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg. Vol. XVIII. (1859), p. 513. Gottinger Gelehrte Anzeigen, 1858, p. 401. Korosi, see Csoma de Koros. Kowalewsky: Mongolian Crestomathy (written in Russian). Kasan, 1836. Vols. I-III. Extrait d’une lettre addressee a !M. Jacquet (que les livres bouddhiques sont quelquefois echanges a Kiakhta entre des fourrures russes). Nouv. Journ. As. 3® Serie, Vol. VII. (1839), p. 181. LASSEN. LEPSIUS. 351 Lassen, Chr. ; Zur Gescliiclite cler griechischen und indoscy- tisclien Konige in Baktrien, Kabul und Indien, durch Ent- zifferung der altkabulischen Legenden auf ibren Miinzen. Bonn, 1834. Also in Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IX., pp. 251, 339, 449, 627, 733. Ueber eine alte indiscbe Inschrift der kgl. Satrapen von Surahstra, •worin Chandragupta und sein Enkel Asoka er- wahnt werden. Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. IV., p. 146. Eine auf einer Kupfertafel in Sattara gefundene Inschrift Varavarma’s aus dem J. 1104. Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. ^lorg. Vol. VIE, p. 294. Indiscbe Alterthumskunde. Vols. I. to IV. Critical dissertations by this author are noticed under: Burney, Burnouf, Csoma de Kerbs, Forbes, Tumour. Latter, T. : Remarks on a Boodhist Coin. Joura. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XIII., Part. II., p. 571. On the Buddhist Emblems of Architecture. Journ. &c., Vol. XIV., Part. II., p. 623. Lenz, R. : Analyse du Lalita-Vistara-Pourana, Pun des principaux ouvrages sacres des Bouddbistes de PAsie centrale, contenant la vie de leur propbete et ecrit en Sanscrit. Bull. sc. Petersb. Acad., Vol. I., pp. 49, 57, 71, 75, 87, 92, 97. Compare about this historical book: Foucaux, Rajendralal Mitra. Lepsius, R. : Ueber chinesische und tibetische Lautverhaltnisse und liber die Umscbrift jener Sprachen. Berlin, 1861. (From the Abb. d. Berk Acad., 1862.) 352 LOGAN. MARSHALL. Logan, J. R. ; The West Ilimalaic or Tibetan tribes of Assam, Burma, and Pegu. Journ. Ind. Archip. New Series, Vol. II., pp. 68, 230. Low, J. St. : General Observations on the contending claims to antiquity of Brahmans and Buddhists. Journ. iVs. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVIII., Par,t. I., p. 89. On the Buddha and the Phrabat. Journ. K. As. Soc., Vol. III. (183.5). Gleanings in Buddhism, or translations of passages from a Siamese version of a Pali work termed in Siamese “Phra Pat’hom;” with passing observations on Buddhism and Brah- manism. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVII., Part. II., p. 72. M'^CxOVAN, D. j. : An Inscription from a Tablet in a Buddbist Monastery at Ningpo, in China. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XIII., Part. L, p. 113. Makenzie, C. ; Account of the Jains, collected from a priest of this sect. As. Res., Vol. IX., p. 244. Marco Polo: The Travels of Marco Polo in the thirteenth century, by TP. Marsden. London, 1818. A recent paper of Thomas, “Zu Marco Polo, aus einem Cod. ital. Monacensis,” read in the Bavarian Academy of science, March 4, 1862, contains many a geographical detail concern- ing the places visited by tins audacious traveller. Malcolm, Sir John: Inscriptions from the Boodh Caves, near Joonur. Communicated in a letter to Sir John Malcolm. Journ. 11. As. Soc., Vol. IV. (1837), p. 287. Marshall, W. H.: Four Years in Burmah. I860. MASON. MORIS. 353 Mason, Fr. : Mulamuli, or the Buddhist Genesis of Eastern In- dia from the Shan, through the Talaing and Burman. Journ. Amer. Or, Soc., Vol. IV., p. 103-19. Masson, Chr. : A memoir on the buildings called Topes. London, 1841. (Reprinted with further remarks on coins in Wilson’s Ariana Antiqua.) Narrative of various journeys in Balochistan, Afghanistan, the Panjab and Kalat, during a residence in those contries. Vols. I-IV., 1844. Mill, W, H. : Restoration of the Inscription No. 2 on the Allahabad Column. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. III., pp. 257, 339. See also for other papers on this column: Burt, Hodgson, Prinsep, Troyer, Tumour. Restoration and translation of the Inscription on the Bhitari Lat, with critical and historical remarks. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VI., p. 1. MooRCROFT, W., and Trebeck, G. : Travels in the Himalayan ; Travels in Hindustan and the Panjab; in Ladakh and Kash- mir; in Peshawar, Kabul, Kimduz and Bokhara. Edited by H. H. Wilson. London, 1841. Vols. I. and II. A Journey to Lake Mansorovara in Undes, a province of Little Tibet. As. Res., Vol. XIL, p. 375. Moore, G. : The lost tribes and the Saxons of the East and of the West, with new views of Buddhism, and translations of Rock-Records in India. London, 1861. Moris: Expose des principaux dogmes Tibetains-Mongols. Ex- trait de I’ouvrage de D. Bergmann. Journ. As. 1823, p. 193. 23 354 MULLEK. NOKRIS. Muller, Max: The languages of the seat of war in the East. With a survey of the three Families of Language, Semitic, Arian, and Turanian. With an Appendix on the Missionary alphabet, and an Ethnographical Map, drawn by A. Peter- mann. London, 1855. — — Letter to Chevalier Bunsen, on the Classification of the Turanian Languages. Journ. As. 1823. p. 193. Buddhism and Buddhist Pilgrims. A review of Mr. Stanisl. Julien’s “Voyages des Pelerins Bouddhistes.” Reprinted from the “Times” of April 17th. and 20th., together with a letter on the original meaning of Nirvana. London, 1857, For other papers on Buddhist pilgrims see; Anderson, Cun- ningham, Fa Hian, Schiefner, Neumann, C. F. ; Coup d’oeil historique sur les peuples et la litterature de I’Orient. Nouv. Journ. As. ; 2® serie, Vol. XIV. (1834.) Mexico im fiinften Jahrhundert nach Christus. Nach chine- sischen Quellen. Ausland, 1845. The Chatechism of the Shamans, or the Laws of the Priest- hood of Buddha. Translated from the Chinese. London, 1831. Neve, Fel. ; De I’etat present des etudes sur le Bouddhisme et de leur application. (Extrait de la Revue de la Flandre, Vol. I.j Gand, 1846. Le Bouddhism, son fondateur et ses ecritures. Paris, 1854. Nil (Archbishop of Yaroslaw): Buddhism in Sibiria. (Written in Russian.) St. Petersb. 1858. Norris, E. : On the Kapur-di Rock inscription. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. VIIL, p. 301. OVERBECK. PICKERING. 355 Overbeck: Jets over Boeddhoe en zyne Leer. Verb. d. Batav. Genoot.. Vol. XL, p. 293. Pallas, P. IS.: Beise durch verschiedene Provinzen des Rus- sischeu Reiches. 3 Theile. St. Petersburg, 1773-1801. Saramlungen historischer Nachrichten iiber die Mongolischeii Vblkerschaften. 2 Theile. St. Petersburg, 1776, 1801. Palladji, O. : Das Leben Buddhas. Arb. d. russ. Mission, Vol. II., p. 197. Historische Skizze des alten Buddhismus. Erman’s Arch. Vol. XV. (1856), p. 206. Also contained in: Arb. d. russ. Miss., Vol. II., p. 467. Lebensbeschreibung des Buddha’s Schakjamuni. Erman’s Arch., Vol. XV. (1856), p. 1. Pauthier: Faits relatifs au culte Bouddhique, d’apres les sources Chinoises (in the article entitled ‘‘Examen methodique des iaits qui concernent le Thien-tchu”). Nouv. Journ. As.; 3® serie, Vol. VIII. (1839). Pa VIE, T. : Etude sur le Sj'-yeou-Schin-tsuen, roman bouddhique chinois. Nouv. Journ. As. ; 5® serie, Vol. IX. p. 357, and Vol. X., p. 308. Pemberton, K. B.: Report on Bhutan. Calcutta, 1839. Perry, Erskine: Account of the great Hindu Monarch, Asoka, chiefly from Lassen’s “Indische Alterthumskunde.” Journ. Bombay R. As. Soc., Vol III., Part. II., p. 149. Pickering, Ch. : The Buddhist Caves. United States exploring expedition. Philad., 1848., Vol. IX., p. 349. 23 * 35U PITSCHUEINSKI, PRINSEP. I’lTSCHURiNSKi, Hyacynth: Description of Tibet in its actual state. (Written in Russian.) St. Petersb. 1828. PoSTANS, W. ; An account of the Jain temple at Badrasir; and ruins of Badranagirs in the province of Cutch. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. YU., Part. I., p. 431. pRiNSEP, J.: Intei-pretation of the most ancient of the inscrip- tions of the pillar called the Lat of Feroz Shah, near Delhi, and of the Allahabad, Radhia, and Mattiah pillar, or Lat, in- scriptions which agree therewith. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VI., p. 566. In reference to these pillars see also; Burt, Hodgson, Mill, Troyer, Tumour. Note on the Facsimiles of the various Inscriptions on the ancient column at Allahabad, retaken by Edw. Smith. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 114.; Vol. VI., p. 963. Note on the Facsimiles of Inscriptions from Sanchi near Bhilsa, and on the drawings of the Buddhist monument presented by Captain W. Murray. Journ. &c., Vol. VL, p. 451. On the Edicts of Piyadasi, or Asoka, the Buddhist monarch of India. Journ. &c., Vol. VII., Part. I., p. 219. Discovery of the name of Antiochus the Great, in two of the edicts of Asoka. king of India. Journ. &c., Vol. VIL, p. 156. ■ Note on Inscriptions at Udayagiri, and Khandgiri, in Cuttak, in the Lat characters. Journ. &c., Vol- VL, p. 1072. PEINSEP. — KEMUSAT. 357 Prinsep, J.; On the coins and relics discovered by Chev. Ventura in the tope of Manikyala. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. III., pp. 313, 436. See also on this Tope the paper of Cunningham. Note on the Coins discovered by M. Court. Journ. &c., Vol. III., p. 562. For additions and corrections see: Cunningham. Essays on Indian Antiquities, historic, numismatic, and pa- Iseographic of the late, to wliich are added his “Useful Tables,” illustrative of Indian History, Chronology, modern Coinages, Weights, Measures, &c. Edited, with notes and additional matter, by Ed. Thomas. Vols. I. and II. London, 1858. Rajendralal Mitra, Babu: Buddhism and Odinism, their similitude; illustrated by Extracts from Professor Holmboe’s Memoir on the “Traces de Buddhisme en Norvege.” Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXVII., p. 46. The Lalita-Vistara, or Memoirs of the life and doctrines of Sakya Sinha. Vol. V. of the Bibliotheca Indica, by Roer. See also the translation of Foucaux, and Lenz. Remusat, Abel: Note sur quelques epithetes descriptives de Bouddha. Journ. des Sav., 1819, p. 625. — — Sur la succession des 33 premiers patriarches de la religion de Bouddha. Journ. des Sav., 1821, p. 4. Apergu d’un Memoire sur Torigine de la Hierarchie Lamaique. Jouni. As., Vol. IV., 1824, p. 257. Melanges Asiatiques, ou Choix de morceaux de critique, et de memoires relatifs aux religions, aux sciences, a I'histoire, et a la geographic des nations orientales. Vols. I. and 11. Paris, 1825. 358 REMUSAT. RENOU. RemL'SAT, Abel; Nouveaux Melanges Asiatiques, on Recueil de morceaux, &c., Vol. I. and II. 1829. Essai sur la cosmographie et la cosmogonie des bouddhistes d’apres les auteurs chinois. In the “Melanges Asiatiques.” La Triade Bouddhique^ (in the article entitled “Observations sur trois Memoires de De Guignes inseres dans le tome XL. de la Collection de I’Academie des Inscriptions et Belles- Lettres. et relatifs a la religion samaneenne). Nouv. Jouru. As., 2« serie, Vol. VII. (1831), pp. 265, 269, 301. Observations sur I'histoire des Mongols orientaux, de Ssanang- Ssetsen. Paris, 1832. Memoires sur un voyage dans I'Asie Centrale, dans le pays des Afghans, et des Beloutches, et dans I'lnde, execute a la fin du IV® Siecle de notre ere par plusieurs Samaneens de Chine. Mem. de I’lnst. royal de France, Acad. d. inscr. 1838, p. 343. Foe koue ki, ou Relations des Royaumes Bouddhiques. Voyages dans la Tartarie par Fa Hian. Paris, 1836. Critical dissr. Neumann; Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Vol. III., p. 105; and two articles by E. Burnouf in Journ. des Sav., 1837, pp. 160, 358; and H. H, Wilson, in Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. V. (1839), p. 108. For remarks on these voyages see Kittoe; an English translation of Rerausat’s work is noticed under Fa Hian. Melanges posthumes d’histoire et de litterature orientales, Paris, 1843. Bexou et Lathy: Relation d'un Voyage au Tibet par I’Abbe Krick. Paris, 1854. RITTEE. SCHIEFNER. 359 Ritter, C. : Die Stupas, oder die architektonischen Denkmale an der indo-baktrischen Konigsstrasse, und die Colosse von Bamian. Berlin, 1838. See also the Narrative of Burnes. Die Entstehung der lamaischen Hierarcliie und der weltl. Suprematie der Chinesen iiber das Volk der Tiibeter. “Ei’d- kunde,” Vol. III., pp. 274-87. Salisbury, E. : Memoir on the history of Buddhism. Journ. Amer. Orient. Soc., Vol. I., pp. 79-136. Salt, H. : Account of the caves in Salsette. Ti*ans. Lit. Soc. Bombay, Vol. I., p. 41. ScHiEFEER, A. ; Tibetische Studien. Einleitung und erster Ar- tikel. Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb. Vol. VIII., pp. 212, 259, 292, 303. Beitrage zur Tibetischen Lautlehre. Bull. &c., Vol. VIII., pp. 267, 337. Ueber den sogenannten Artikel. Bull. &c., Vol. VIII., p. 341. Ueber die Verschlechterungspeiioden der Menschheit, nach buddhistischer Anschauungsweise. Bull. &c., Vol. IX., p. 1. Beiicht liber die in Peking fiir die Akademie angekauften tibetischen Werke. Bull. &c., Vol. IX., pp. 10, 17. Das buddhistische Sutra der zweiundiderzig Siitze. Bull. Ac., Vol. IX., p. 65. Ueber das Werk; Histoire de la vie de Ilioiien Thsang, Ac. Bull. Ac., Vol. XL, p. 97. Ueber eine eigenthiimliclie Art tibetischer Composita. Bull. Ac., Vol. XV.. p. 7. 360 SCHIEFNEB. SCHMARDA. ScHiEFNER, A. : Erganzungen und Berichtigungen zu Schmidt’s Ausgabe des Dsanglun. St. Petersb., 1852. Eine tibetische Lebensbeschreibung Sakyamuni’s. Mem. des sav. etrang. St. Petersb. Vol. VI., p. 231. Buddhistiscbe Triglotte, d. h. Sanskrit-Tibetiscb-Mongobsches Worterverzeichniss. St. -Petersb., 1859. Sur le grand nombre des Buddhists. Bull. St. Petersb. Acad., Vol. V., No. 5. Schilling he Cannstadt, Baron: Bibbotbeque bouddhique, ou Index du Gandjour de Nartang. Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb., Vol. IV., p. 321. Mahay anasutra, d. i. das ehrwiirdige, mit Namen “Das un- ermessliche Lebensalter und die unermessbche Erkenntniss.” Ed. by the Imp. Academy. St. Petersb., 1845. Schlagintweit, H., a., and E. he: Kesults of a scientific Mission to India and High Asia. The Atlas contains various representations of Buddhist temples, monasteries and objects of Buddhist worship. Emil : Ueber das Mahayanastitra Digpa thamchad shagpar terchoi. Bull, der bayer. Akad., 1863, p. 81. (Also contained in Chapter XI. of this volume.) ScHLEGEL, Ee., Professor: Mode of expressing numerals in the Sanskrit and Tibetan language. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. IIP, p. 1. ScHOEBEL, C. : Le Bouddha et le Bouddhisme. Paris, 1857. ScHMARHA, L. K. ; Reise um die Erde in den Jahren 1853-1857. Braunschweig, 1861. (Vol. I. in reference to Buddhism in Ceylon.) SCHMIDT. 30 1 Schmidt, I. J.: Forschungen im Gebiete der alteren religibseii, politischen und literarischen Bildungsgeschicbte der Volker Mittel-Asiens, vorziiglich der Mongolen und Tibeter. St. Petersb., 1824. Wiirdigung und Abfertigung der Klaproth’sclien “Beleuch- tung der Forschungen &c.” Leipzig, 1826. Ueber die Verwandtscbaft der gnostisch theosopbischen Leh- ren mit den Religionssystemen des Orients, vorziiglich des Buddhaismus. Leipzig, 1828. Geschichte der Ostmongolen und ihres Fiirstenhauses, ver- fasst von Ssanang Ssetsen Chungtai dschi der Ordus; iiber- setzt von St. Petersb., 1829. For critical diss. see: Klaproth, Remusat. Die Thaten Bogda Gessers Khan’s, des Vertilgers der Wurzel der zehn Uebel in den zehn Gegenden. Fine ostasiatische Heldensage, aus dem Mongolischen ubersetzt. St. Petersb., ■ 1839. Ueber das Mahayana und das Prajna Paramita der Bauddhen. Bull, scient. St. Petersb. Acad., Vol. L, p. 145, and Mem. de I’Acad. de St. Petersb., Vol. IV., p. 124. Ueber die Begriindung des Tibetischen Sprachstudiums in Russland und die Herausgabe der dazu nbthigen Hiilfswerke. Bull. sc. &c., Vol. L, p. 28. Ueber Lamaismus und die Bedeutung dieses Namens. Bull. sc. &c., Vol. L, p. 11. - Ueber einige Eigenthiimlichkeiten der Tibetischen Sprache und Schrift. Bull. sc. &c., Vol. 111., p. 225. 362 SCHMIDT. SCHOTT. Schmidt, I. J.; Ueber den Ursprung der Tibetischen Schrift. Mem. de I’Acad St. Petersb., Vol. L, p. 41. Ueber einige Grundlebren des Buddhismus. Mem. &c., Vol. I., p. 93. Ueber die sogenannte dritte Welt der Buddhaisten. Mem. &c., Vol. II., p. 1. Ueber die tausend Buddhas einer Weltperiode der Einwoh- nung, Oder gleichmassigen Dauer. Mem. &c., Vol. II., p. 41. Grammatik der Tibetischen Sprache. 1839. Tibetiscli-deutsches Worterbuch nebst deutscliem Wort- register. 1841. Dsanglun, der Weise und der Thor; aus dem Tibetischen ubersetzt und mit dem Originaltexte herausgegeben. 1843. For Addenda and corrections -see Schiefner. Der Index des Kanjur. St. Petersb., 1845. - — and Boehtlingk, 0.: Verzeichniss der tibetischen Hand- schriften und Holzdrucke im Asiatischen Museum der K. Akademie der Wissenschaften. Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb., Vol. IV., Nos. 6, 7, 8. ScHONBERG, E. VON: Blick auf die buddhistischen Felsen- tempel Indiens. Zeitschr. d. deutsch. Morg. Ges., Vol. VII. (1853), pp. 101-3. Schott, W. ; Ueber den Doppelsinn des Wortes Schamane, und iiber den tungusischen Schamanencultus am Hole der Mandshu Kaiser. Abb. Berl. Acad. 1842. SCHOTT. STEVENSON. 363 Schott, W. : Ueber den Buddhaismus in Hoch-Asien und in China. Abb, Berl. Acad. 1844. Selkirk; Recollections of Ceylon, after a residence of nearly thirteen years; with an account of the church Missionary Society’s operations. 1844. SiEBOLD, Ph. Fe. V. : Nippon, Archiv zur Beschreibung von Japan und dessen Neben- und Schutzlander &c. 5 Yols. Leyden, 1837. Sirr: China and the Chinese, their religion, character, customs, and manufactures, &c. 2 Yols. 1849. Smith, J. ; Specimen of a Burmese drama. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VIIL, p. 535. Spiegel, Fr.: Kammavakya, Liber de officiis sacerdotum Bud- dhicorum. Palice et Latine primus edidit, atque adnotationes adjecit. 1841. Anecdota Palica. Nach den Handschriften der kgl. Bibliothek in Copenhagen im Grundtexte herausgegeben, iibersetzt und erklart. Leipzig, 1845. Stevenson : Analysis of the Ganesa Purana, with special re- ference to the history of Buddhism. Journ. R. As. Soc., Yol. YIII. (1846), p. 319. On the intermixture of Buddhism with Brahmanism in the religion of the Hindus of the Dekhan. Journ. R. As. Soc., Yol. YII. (1843), pp. 1-8. — — An account of the Buddho-Yaishnavas, or Yitthal-Bhaktas of the Dakhan. Journ. R. As. Soc., Yol. YII. (1843), p. 64 364 STRACHEY. TENNENT. Strachey, H. Captain: Narrative of a Journey to Cho Lagan and Clio Mapan. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XVII., Part. II., pp. 98, 128, 327. Stuhr: Die Religionssysteme der heidnischen Volker des Orients. Berlin, 1836. Sykes, H. W. : On a Catalogue of Chinese Buddhistical Works. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. IX. (1848), p. 199. An Account of the Caves of Ellora. Trans. Lit. Soc. Bombay, Vol. III., p. 265. See also on these caves: Grindley, Tod. On the Miniature Chaityas and Inscriptions of the Buddhist religious dogma, found in the ruins of the Temple of Sarnath, near Benares. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XVL, p. 37. See also on the fundamental dogma of the Buddhist faith: Hodgson’s paper on Sarnath. Specimens of Buddhist inscriptions, with symbols, from the West of India. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. VI., Paid. IL, p. 1038. Sylvestre de Sacy : A critic is noticed under Klaproth. Taylor, Cooke; Ancient and modern India. Revised and con- tinued to tke present time by Mackenna. 1857. Tennent, Sir, Emerson : Christianity in Ceylon, its Intro- duction and Progress under the Portuguese, the Dutch, the British, and American Mission ; with an historical Sketch of the Bramanical and Buddhist Superstitions. London, 1850. TENNENT. — TUENEE. 3()5 Tennent, Sie, Emeeson: Ceylon, an account of the island, physical, historical, and topographical; with notices of its natural histoi’y, antiquities, and productions. London, 1859. Thomas, E.: Note on the present state of the excavations of Sarnath. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. XXIIL, p. 469. (For further notices see Vol. XXV., p. 395.) For his edition of J. Prinsep’s Useful Tables see Prinsep. Thomson, T. D. : Western Himalaya and Tibet. London, 1852. Timkowski: Travels of the Russian mission through Mongolia China, and residence in Peking in years 1820-21. With cor- rections and notes by Klaproth. 2 Vols. London, 1827. Tod, J. : Remarks on certain sculptures in the Cave Temples of Ellora. Trans. R. As. Soc., Vol. II., p. 328. See also about these caves: Grindley, Sykes. Toeeens, L. ; Travels in Ladak, Tartary and Kashmir. London, 1862. Troyee, a.: Announcement of the work: Histoire du Bouddha Sakya-Mouni, par Ph. Ed. Foucaux. Nouv. Journ. As. 4® serie, Vol. XIV., pp. 252-4. Remarks upon the second inscription of the Allahabad pillar. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. III., p. 118. In reference to these pillars see also: Burt, Hodgson, Mill, Prinsep, Tumour. Turner, S. : An account of an embassy to the Court of the Teshoo Lama in Tibet; containing a narrative of a journey through Bootan, and part of Tibet. London, 1800. 366 TURNOUR. UPHAM. Turnour, G . : Account of the Tooth relic of Ceylon, supposed to be alluded to in the opening passage of the Ferog lat in- scription. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Yol. YI., p. 963. Further Notes on the Inscriptions on the columns at Dehli, Allahabad, Betiah, &c. Journ. &c., Yol. YI., p. 1049. See also in reference to these columns: Burt, Hodgson, Mill, Prinsep, Troyer. Examination of the Pali Buddhistical Annals. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Yol. YI., pp. 501 and 713; and Yol. YIL, Part. 11., pp. 686, 789, 919, 991. Critical diss.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Yol. 111., p. 157, and Yol. lY. The first Twenty Chapters of the Mahawanso: and a prefatory essay on Pali Buddhistical literature, originally published as an introduction to the above-mentioned portion of the Mahawanso and to the epitome of the historj’ of Ceylon, and the historical inscriptions, printed in the Ceylon Almanac of 1833 and 1834. Ceylon, 1836. The Mahawanso in Roman characters, with the translation subjoined, and an Introductory Essay on Pali Buddhistical Literature. Examination of some points of Buddhist Chronology. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Yol. Y., p. 521. Critical diss.: Lassen, Chr.: Zeitschr. f. d. K. d. Morg., Yol. L, pp. 235-9. Upham, E. : The history and doctrine of Buddhism, popularly illustrated ; with notices of the Kappoism, or Demon worship, and of the Bali, or planetary incantations of Ceylon. London, 1829. I'PHAM. WEBER. 3G7 Upham, E.; The Mahavansi, the Rajaratnacari, and the Rajavali, forming the sacred and historical books of Ceylon; also a collection of tracts illustrative of the doctrines and literature of Buddhism. Translated from the Singhalese. London, 1833. Critical diss.: Burnouf, Journ. des Sav., 1833, 1834, ViGNE, G. T. : Travels in Kashmir, Ladak, Iskardo, &c. 2 Vols. London, 1842. Wassiljew, W. : Notices sur les ou\-rages relatifs au Buddhism qui se trouvent dans la bibliotheque de I’Universite de Kasan. Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb., Vol. XL, p. 337. Notices sur les ouvrages en langues de I’Asie orientale qui se trouvent dans la bibliotheque de St. Petersbourg. Bull. &c. Vol. Xin.. Nos. 14 et seq. Der Buddhismus, seine Dogmen, Geschichte und Literatur. Deutsche Uebersetzung. St. Petersb,, 1860. Notice is given of this work by A. Schiefner, in Bull, hist.-phil. St. Petersb., Vol. XIII. Weber, A.; Die neueren Forschungen iiber das alte Indien. Printed in the “Histor. Taschenbuch von F. Raumer.” 3rd. series, Vol. VL, 1854, pp. 103-43. Ueber das Qatrunjaya Mahatmyan. Ein Beitrag zur Ge- schichte der Jaina. Leipzig, 1858. Indische Skizzen. Berlin, 1857. Die neuesten Forschungen auf dem Gebiete des Buddhismus. Separatabdruck aus den “Indischen Studien.” Vol. III., p. 1. Berlin, 1853. 368 WESTERGAARD. WILSON. Westergaard, N. L.; a brief account of the minor Bauddha caves of Beira and Bajah, in the environs of Karli. Journ. Bombay Branch R. As. Soc., Vol. I. (Aug. 1844), p. 438. Ueber den altesten Zeitraum der indischen Geschichte mit Riicksicht auf die Literatur. — Ueber Buddha’s Todesjahr und einige andere Zeitpuhkte in der alteren Geschichte Indiens. Translated from the Denish by Stenzler. Breslau, 1862 WiLEORD, T. : An Essay on the sacred Isles in the West, with other essays connected with. As. Res., Vol. YllL, p. 245. For other memoirs by this author see As. Res., Vols. II., III., IV., V., VI., X. Wilson, H. H. ; Ariana antiqua. A descriptive account of the antiquities and coins of Afghanistan: with a memoir on the buildings called Topes, by E. Masson. London, 1841. 4°. Buddhist Emblems. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. VI., p. 451. Analysis of the Kah-gyur. Journ. As. Soc. Beng., Vol. I., p. 375. Buddhist Inscription of King Priyadarsi. Journ. &c., Vol. XVI., p. 357. On the Rock inscription of Kapur di Giri, Dhauli and Ginar. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XII., p. 153. On Buddha and Buddhism. Journ. &c., Vol. XIII., p. 229. Note on the Literature of Thibet. Glean, in Science. Vol. III. p. 243. Notes of a Correspondence with Sir John Bowring on Bud- dhist Literature in China. With notices of Chinese Buddhist Works translated from the Sanskrit. By E. Edkins. Journ. R. As. Soc., Vol. XVL, p. 316. WILSON. YULE. 3G9 Wilson, H. H.: Notices sur trois ouvrages bouclclhiques regus du Nepal par Noiiv. Journ. As., 1831, p. 97. Wilson, J. ; Memoir on the Cave Temples and Monasteries and other ancient Buddhist, Brahmanical, and Jaina remains of Western India. Journ. Bombay R. As. Soc., Vol. III., Part. II., p. 36, and Vol. IV., p. 340. Yule: A narrative of the Mission sent by the Governor General of India to the Court of Ava in 1855, with notices of the Country, Government and People. With numerous Illustrations. London, 1858. 24 V- .r . I * <■ - ■’/ 4 'nv :A -t. ::•«.>> ;? 1 K f ?■ ^,- ^ •'r!' %;, ^ -TV 'n' '- ■ Wf: Jl 7 p .^ ^ 4 ■ #•„':' ^ -,r 1 "^ m ^-»- *‘^T 7 - ■kf* •. I »iir^^ 1 i . 1 i * "^ . SrM‘- .. '•>0 i ■ . ' 'V »< ‘ ‘‘ :v/ Ti##: # ,:?.Vj ^^’-. ■ *.v.- -- ■' * . 4 . « Y pikA, '•■ ».-■ ‘i'sK-si-.tiP'il It ,.=»■, ■ - » ' i4t^^ 'vV- -jt; / ■ -J -^J- X-., «r . * -‘* ' * t- ' vlliiSbilSt f i 1 :»■ B. GLOSSAKY OF TIBETAN TERMS, THEIR SPELLING AND TRANSLITERATION. WITH QUOTATIONS OF THE EXPLANATION CONTAINED IN THIS VOLUME. ALPHABETICALLY ARRANGED. In order to facilitate the printing, the spelling in native characters has been excluded from the text, and I present here a general synopsis in which every term met with in the preceding parts can easily be found. The first column gives the pronunciation; the second the Tibetan spelling; the third the transliteration; in the fourth the page is added in which details about the re- spective term are contained. The Tibetan terms may be monosyllabic or they may consist of several words, but the Tibetan language also shows frequent examples of compositions; several words which of themselves have a distinct meaning, and are as such in general use, often occur combined and form- ing one term. 372 GLOSSARY OF TIBETAN TERMS. Many words show a considerable dift'erence between the pronunciation and the spelling. In most cases the difference is based upon grammatical rules; in others we have to explain it by supposing the influence of dialects, in consequence of which many words have become invested with a form different from that which they have in the classical stationary language of the sacred Buddhist literature. I have already had occasion to allude to this introduction of numerous new forms into the modern popular Tibetan, when analysing the historical document obtained at Himis (see p. 183). The alphabet I use for the transliteration in the third column is given in full detail p. xi-xiv. The consonants not pronounced are printed in Italics; the Tibetan inter- syllabic points are rendered, as is usually done, by small horizontal lines. AliGAI CH0('.A C’HA. S73 Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Argai clioga. Arga’i-cliho-ga. 179 Atisha. A-ti-slia. 09, 1.-5G Badanfj. Ba-dang. 191 Bagtsis. Bag-»-tsi.s. •274 Bardo. Bar-do. 109 Bardo phrang- grol gyi sol deb jig grol gyi pavo zliechava. Bar- do-’phrang- sgrol-gyi-^sol- ’debs- ’jigs-sgiol- gA'i-c/pa’- VO - zbes- bva- va. 110 Bccbon. Be-cdion. 21.5 Bihar gyalpo. Bi-har-rgyal-po. 177 Bon. Bon. 74 Braklujg. ’Bras-khug. 240 Brikungpa. ’Bri-khung-pa. 74 Bromston. ’Brom-ston. 69, 73 Brug. ’Brug. 255, 27G Brugpa. ’Brug-pa. 74 Brul. sBruI. 276 Budzad. c^Bu-Tndzad. 155 Bumapa. c/Bu-nia-pa. 32 Biimpa. Buni-pa. 239 Cha. Ja. 169 374 CHAG — CHODPA. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Chag. ^Chag.9. •>8I Chagpa thogmeci. Phyag5 - pa - thogs- i med. 32 Cliagtong khorlo. Phyag-stong-’klior- lo. 89 Chagye chin. Phyag-^yas-sbyin. 208 Chakdor. Phyag:-?*dor. •' cr 1 Cliakna dorje. Phyag-na-rdo-rje. i Cliag zhipa. Phyag-izhi-pa. 89 Chakhan. Phva-»ikhan. •/ 1.30 Chakja. Phyag-rgya. oG, 208 Cliakna padnia Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. i Chodpan. Chod-pan. •20>.) Chogi dang])i)i mClihog"- <>:i - dan«r- o o o sangye. po’i-sangs-rgyas. 50 Choichi gyalpo. Chhos - kyi - ^'gyal- 1 1 po. 185 Choichi gyalpoi ' Chhos - kyi - rgyal- slied dul. po’i-shed-’dul. 110 Choicliong. Clihos-skyong. 15G Choigyal. Chhos-j’gyal. 93, 185 Chorten. TnChhod-rten. 192 & ae(j Choiva. ’Byor-ba. 240 Chos ku. Chhos-sku. 38 Chu. Chhu. 281 Chugchig zlial. iChu-gchig-zhal. 89 Chungpa kuadus ’Byung-pa-kun -’diis- tsis. rtsis. 309 Chusrang. Chha-srang. 289 Da. Da .307 Da. ■ c?Gra 109, 25: Dabchad. ’Dab-i>’gyad. ! ! 248 Dachan. , sGra-^chan. 115 Dallia gyalpo. c?Gra-lha-rgyal-po. 157 Damchan dorje ' Dam-chan-rdo-rje- legpa. 1 ' legs-pa. 158 Danipai de. ■ ^ 1 i Dam-pa’i-.«de. 1 1 39 ■25 * 371 ) DAKNAI — DOM. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Ibige. Darnai janba. Dar-^na-^nga’i- 2C1 i)-gyan-pa. Darzab. Dar-zab. 178 DasboJ. Zla-Zishol. 288 I Java. Zla-ba. 289 Dava dag-pa. Zla-ba-grag.9-pa. 41 Decliad. A ^ sDe-i?-<>-vad. 109 Decbog- ^De-mcbbog. 108 Deoliogi gyiit. ^De- well hog - gi- rgyud. 109 Dejung. ^De-’byiing. 47 Devacban. Z»De-ba-clian. 101 Dezliin sliegpa. De-Z»zhin-^slieg5-pa. 4. 126 Digpa tbamcliad tiliagpar terclioi. sDig-pa-tham«-cliad- isbags- par-^ter- clihos. 128 Digsbag ser cbi sDig-^shags ^ser- pugri. gyis-spu-gri. 124 Digug. Gri-o’ug:. O c> 264 Do. toDo. 78 Dodne vangpo. ^Dod-na.s-Jbang-po. 268 Doljang. r*i- sGi'ol-/jang. 66 Dolkar. sGroIc^-kar. 66 Dolma. sGrol-ma. 66 Dolzin. CN Grol-zin. 42 Dom. sDom. 106, 162 DONCHEN— DT'XGTSI. 377 Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. ■ Page. Donclien cliong.u ^Don - ehlien - 6dio- /nga. 207 Dondnnipai den Don-dani-pa’i-iden- pa. pa. 3'> Doije. rDo-ije. 21.T Dorjecliano;. rDo-rje-’chhang’. 50 -tsis. 274 Gungdun. (/Gung-idun. 289 Gyalchenzhi. /•Gyal-cbhen-6zbi. 109 Gyalpo clienpo ?Gyal-po-cbben-po- namthoras clii kanjj sliaiT- 7-nam-tbos-sras-kyi- 5skang-Z»sliags. 264 Gyaltsan. /•Gyal-mts'ban. 264 Gyclrap salvai rGyal-raba-^sal- ba’i- melong. me-long. 71 Gyelva rinpoche. ?Gyal-ba-riii-po-cbbe. 15a Gyut. >'Gyud. 48, 56, 78 Gyut zhi. C\ rGvud-izbi. 265 11 ala hala. Ila-la-ba-la. 115 Ilei'uka. lle-ru-ka. 108 Ja. B Bya. 276 Jabycd. /•Gab-yol. 212 Janijaiig. ’Jam-c?byanga. 65 Janipaijang liiai ’Jam-pai-c/bvaiig^- tliania sJiesrab od. lha’i- tba-ma-sbes- rab-'od. 97 Jang. Byang. 259 Jed-tlio yangi za- Z»;-Jed-tlio-A'aii<>--Ka’. 7. '5 Kadanipa. ilva’-^danis-pa. 7. Kalba. sKal-ba. 93 Kanjur. 6Ka’-’gyiir. 7 8 <0 sef/. Kantsai. JsKang-rdzas. 260 Kapala. -n-sj-ai Ka-pa-la. 216 Kargyutpa. ilva’-rgyud-pa. 73 Karniapa. Karnia-pa. 74 Karts is. 01- c?Kar-rtsis or sKar- rtsis. 156, 274 Kartsi-pa. sKar-rtsis-pa. 156 Kliado. jnKba’-’gro. 248 Khain. p;?) Kliani. 307 Kliangtsig. Kang-Z»rtsig5. 264 Klianpo. wKlian-po. 155 Kliarsil. Q,p;i^-i3^Q) ’Kliar-^sil. 214 Kliatak. Kha-^tags. 190 Klien. h Klien. 307 Ivhetiip c'liakdor mKhas-grub-])hyag- gyatso. ?-dor-rgya-?nts'ho. ' 97 Khctup sangye. ?«Kbas-grub-sang5- rgyas. 97 Kliiral. 1 Klii-ral. 76 KHON — LEUTHO. 381 Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Pa<^e. Klioti. Klioi'lo. Kliorloi ])lianyon. Kliorten. Klirlin. Khyung. Kontseg. Kundzob chi clcn- pa. Ku nga gvalpo. Ku nga gyalpoi kans: shair. Kuntag. Lahri. Labtse. Lagoi. Lai buni])a. Lama. Lam rim. Lang. Langclar. Langpo. Lantsa. Las. Leutho. Klion. ’KIioi’-lo. ’Klior-lo’ i-])liaii-V()ii. ’Klior-i/-ten. Khrim.v. ’Khviinir. 'T* (/Kon-Z»/-tsegs. • Kun-/'dzob-gyi-/.»(lon- pa. sKu-/n<>:a-r<>'val- po. aj:q*5 5]s 'us^'5 ni- ij/:^ oj^ Oirs-’n •V5 ^ .sKii-^nga-rgval-po’i- 6skang-Sshag.v. Kmi-^ctags. 6La-bri. Lab-tso. ^La-gos. Las-biim-j)a. />La-ma. Lam-rim. ^Laiig. lyLang-dar. ^Lang-])o. Lan-t.s'Iia. Las. Le’ii-tlio. ;io7 5.'i 2 2 II 150 255 < H .55 157 157 .51 101 100 172 248 1 50 ■7, 101 270 08 54 80 05 274 382 l.HA — MAGLON. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. . Transliteration. Page. Lha. •■a 1 1 Lha. 01, 108 Lliaclien. Lha-chhen. ] 234 Lhappa. Lhag-pa. 289 Lhakliang-. Lha-kbang. 188 Lhamavin. Lha-ma-yin. 92, 109 Lliamo. Lha-nio. 112, 119 Lhatug. Lha-plirug. 2.34 Lho. Lho. 258 Llionub. oj*s;z] Lho-nub. 258 Lhungzed. Lhung-ized. 210 Lhunpo. Lhun-po. 92 Li. Cv Q) Li. 307 Lo. oT Lo. 276 Longchod dzog- Longs-apyod-rdzogs pai ku. pa’i-sku. 38 Lonpo. iLon-po. 53 Lotho. nT'g Lo-tho. 274 Lotsava. iiij'-sq n^ Lo-tsava. 70 Lug. Lug. 276 Lug. Luga. 246, 310 Lugrub. WT A.-Lu-sgrub. 30, 136 Lugzar. iLug-^zar. 250 Lungta. !j^-7 j /-Lung-j-ta. ' 253 Luvang gyaljio. ^Lu-(/baug-rgyal-po. 1 57 Maglon. c?^Ia<>'-Zdon. 54 MAN I - NAM CllU. 383 Phonetic Transcription. 1 Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Mani. Mani. 196, 229 Mani choskhor. Mani-cbbos-’khor. 2;!0 Mani kambuni. Mani-6ka-’kuni. 84 Manii rilbu grub c\ev c\ Mani’i -ril - bu - grub- thab. tliabs. 266 Mania. A’Man-Zila. 266 Me. •v Me. 281 Meba gu. 5Me-ba-o?gu. 297 Melba. Me-Iha. 207, 2.">1 Melong. Me-long. 2.i9 Mi. C\ Mi. 92 Migmar. CV Mig-c/mar. 289 Monlani. sMon-lam. 119 Muliding. CN c^ Mu-li-ding. 113 Myalba. (/Myal-ba. 92 Myangan las Mya - ngan - las -’das- daspa. pa. 98 ^Ivan^das. V O Myang-’das. 7 8, 98 Nagpo chenpo. Xag-po-chben-po. 261 Naktsis. Xag-rt.sis. 274 Xaljor chod])a. rXal-’byor-spyod-pa. 32 Naljor ngonsiini. rXal - ’bvor -7nn'S. 260 Xgovo cliig. Xgo-bo-^clug. 4 2 Xgovonyid mod- Xgo - bo - nyid - mod- par mi'.ava. par-A’inra-ba. 4;$ Xoi'bu. Xor-bu. 5;{ Xubjang. Xub-byang. 269 Xyangdas ^ Xyangan las daspa. ( Xyigmaj)a. see under Myangdas, Myaiigan las daspa. /■Xvig-nia-pa. 72 Xvima. Xvi-nia. 2a. •s’Xyoms-jia. 64 N vmigno. .vXvung-ynas. 96. 240 XYT'XGPAI; — F'HURHUI. 3>- kod. zhing-ikod. 101 Onibu., ’Om-bu- 228, 249 I’adiiin jungne. Padma-’bgung-^gna:<. 67 Pa<^. ^Pags. 2.4.3 I’aldan llianioi d Pal - /dan - lha-nio’i- kans: .shajr. /iskang-Zisliags. 112 Panchen Pin- Pan - chhen - rin - po- poclic. chhe. 154 Parkha oliakja A'Par - klia - phyag- chad. j’gya-irgyad. 407 Pasang. Pa-sangA. 289 Penpa. Apen-]>a. 289 Phag. 5JJI1 Phag. 276 Pliagpa chenresi. ’Pliags-pa-Apyan-ras- 'tJ ^zhigA. 89 Phagpai denpa ’PhagA-pa’i-idcn-pa- zlii. /izhi. 16 Plialchcn. 3(ai*53^ Phal-chhen. 78 Phan. 0 ^ 5 )^ ’Phan. 190 Pliarcliin. Phar-phyin. 44 Phurbii. Phur-bu. 215, 257 Phurbui davo. Phur-bus-^dab-bo. 257 PHURKHA — SAKYAPA, 38 C Phonetic Page. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Transcription. t Pliurkha. Phur-klia. •2.59 Prel. r 5Prel. 27(5 I’rogzhii. Pi'Og-zhu. •209 Priilku clioichoiif;- 6-Prul - sku - chhos- chenpoi kang shag. skyong-chhen -po’i- ^skani>*-ishao:s. o o 157 Prulku tliongva sPrul - sku- mtbong- dondan. ^ xi ^ ba-don-Man. 97 Prulpai ku. sPrul-pa’i-sku. 38 Rabne zhugpa. Rab-^nas-Z>zhugs-pa. •20(5 Rabsal. Rab-^sal. 96 Ralgri. ^01-^ Ral-gri. 264 Ralpachen. Ral-pa-chan. 7(5 Rangi nying gar Rang-gi-s nying-gar- tlialmo cliarva. 9 Z3 tlial-mo-sbyar-ba. 208 Rikbrodpa. Ri-khrod-pa. 163 Rimate. c\ -N Ri-ma-te 113 Rinchen na dun. c\ Rin-chlien-sna-idun. 53 Ritba. Ri-tha. 274 Ruibal cben])oi Rus-sbal-chben-po’ i- dokjed. 6zlog-byed. 297 Sa. Sa. 281 Sa cbupa. Sa-Z»chu-pa. 1 126 Sadag gyalpo. Sa-idag-ygyal-po. 271 1 Sagpar. Sag-par. i 204 1 1 Sakyapa. i ^ Sa-skva-pa. 1 1 73 SAMTAN — SHIXJE. as 7 Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Samtan iSani-^taii. o4 Sang'bai ilagpo. ^Sang-ha’i-6dag-po. .■)(» Sangve clii ku Sangs-rgyas-kyi-sku- sung thus: chi ten. ^siing - thug*- - kyi- rten. 179 Satsa (^C'owy). Tsatsa. D, f Sa-chchha. 194, 206 Sa tsonia. Sa-’ts'ho-ma. 5 Semtsanio. Sems-tsam-mo. .69 Sengc chad ti. Seng - ge - ^>>-gyad- JJ1 khri. 21 1 Sengei nyal tah. Seng-ge’i-nyal-stahs. 241 Senge Nampar Seng - ge -mam - par- Gyalva. rgyal-ba. 18.5 Sengti. Seng-khri. 211 Shagpa. ' iShags-pa. 260 Sliakya Thuh-pa. Shakya-tlmb-pa. 4 Shar. Shar. 258 Sliarllio. Shar-lho. 258 Shecha rahsal. Slies-hya-rah-^sal. .3(15 Slierchin. Sher-pliyin. .33, 78 Shesrah ralgri. Shes-rah-ral-gri. 66 Shesrah chan. Shes-rab-spyan. 210 Shid. c\ Shid. 269 Shing. c\ Shing. 281 Shinje. ^Shin-rje. 9.3 388 SHI NT, SIS — TII ABKHUNG. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Sluntsis. r CN CN 57 Sliin-?’tsis. ■271 Sobvong. ^So-sbyong. <».-) Sregpa. Sreg-pa. 24<» Sronglsan ganipo. Srong-Z»tsan-sgani-])(). 05 Sringan. Sri-ngan. 109 Ta. 1 ?'Ta. •27G Tachoftdo. 12.5 Thegpasum. Theg-pa-^suuj. 104 Thengpa. Phreng-pa. 174 Thisrong de tsan. Khri-srong-Me-Atsan. 67 Thonglam. sjgg-o!?) ?«Thong-lam. 54 Thonka. wThongs-ka. 204 Thor. Thor. 240 Thothori Nyan Tho-tho-ri-^nyan- tsan. itsan. 63 Thugdam kantsai. Thugs-dam-Jakang- rdzaa. 260 Thugje chenpo Thuga-rje-chhen-po- chugchig zhal. ichu-gchig-zhal. 89 Thumi Sambhota. Thu-mi sam-bho-ta. 65 Togpa nyid. rToga-pa-^nyis. 42 Tokchoi gyalpo. Tha-’og-chhos- rgyal-po. 157 Tongpanyid. sTongs-pa-nyid. 33 Tophye chenpo. ^To-’phye-chhen-po. 271 Tsang. rTsang. 39 Tsangpa. Ts'hanga-pa. 114 26 390 TSATSA — VUMED. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Tsatsa (Comp.Satsa.) Chha-chlia 194, 206 Tsavanas. rTsa-ra-nas. 95 Tsei. Ts'hes. 289 Tsemo. rTse-ino. 54 Tsepagmed. ^ s ^ Ts 'be-c?pag-med. 129 Tserab las-tsis. Ts'he-rabs-las-rtsis. 274 Tsesum. rTse-^sum. 215 Tsikhan. rTsis-mkban. 156 Tsonkhapa. Tsong-kha-pa. 69 Tsovo. •v-'S'V" ^Tso-vo. 51 Tsugtor. ^Tsug-for. 209 Tsulkbrim kyi Ts'hul - khrims - kyi- phungpo. phung-po. 43 Tsunpo. ^Tsun-po. 53 Tuisol. ^Krus-^sol. 95, 239 Tungshakchi san- (^Tung-Z)shags-kyi- gye songa. sangs-rgy as-so-^nga . 96 Urgyen. Ur-gyan. 67 Urgyenpa. Ur-gyan-pa. 73 Utpala. Ct-pa-la. 66 Vajrapani. Vajra-pani. 114 Vano'i chinsreg-. o o rfVang-sbyin-sreg. 252 Vuchan. cZVu-cban. 80 Vumed. c?Vu-nied. 80 YAB — ZODMANAS. 391 Phonetic Transcription. * Tibetan Characters. i ! Transliteration. Page. Yab yum chudpa. Yub-yum-’khyud-pa. 112 YangcLob. ^Yang-skyobs. 263 Yano-dao: den. Yang-dag-5den. 39 Yangsal domi. ^Yang - ^sal - sgron- me. 281 Yangug. ^Yang-’gug«. 263 Yidag. Yi-dags. 92 Yidam. Yi-dam. 245 Yong grub. Yong« grub. 34 Yos. Yos. 276 Zamatog. Za-ma-tog. 64 Zanad. ^Za’-nad. 267 Zastang. Zas-^tsang. 4 Zhagpa. Zhags-pa. 213, 216 Zhalthang. .^Qi-gc; Zhal-thang. 190 Zhalzai. Zhal-zas. 228 Zhanvang. ^Zhan-c?bang. 34 Zhine lhagthong. Zhi-^nas-lhag- TOthong. 54 Zhiva. c\ Zhi-ba. 108 Zhivai chinsreg. Zi-ba’i-sbyin-sreg. 230 Zhiva tso. c\ Zhi-ba- mts'ho. 67 Zin. Zin. 307 Zodmanas zhiva. ^Zod-nia-na.s-zhi-ba. 33 26 * 392 ZODPA — ZUNG. Phonetic Transcription. Tibetan Characters. Transliteration. Page. Zodpa. &Zod-pa. 54 : Zon. Zon. 307 Zundui. ^Zungs-isdus. 96 Zung. ^Zungs. 55 Zung zhug. ^Zungs-izhugs. 206 c. ADDITIONS TO CHAPTEK XI, pp. 122 — 42. In reference to the Address to the Buddhas of Con- fession Prof. Ph. Ed. Poucaux of Paris had the kindness to communicate to me some details taken from a copy contained in the Imperial library. The Paris document, which had not yet been published, enables me to supply the hiatus at the end of Part I. of my original, which was here considerably injured ; it also shows that the separa- tion into two parts is an arbitrary alteration, for the concluding sentence of Part I. should be carried on to the phrase beginning Part II.; at the same time the concluding sentence of Part I. differs in my original from the Paris document. Beginning with page 7, line 3 of the native print in Plate V., the Paris document runs as follows: — “When they care but for actual pleasures; when bad actions shall be accumulated; when there shall be no more gratuities; when there shall be enemies, war, and illness, and famine be spread; when many shall be heaped up in the interior of those heUs, mNar-med, where are the human beings who have performed bad actions; — might then they meet this sDig-6shags-grter-chhos. The prayer of the teacher ALu-sgrub, will be spread ; the 394 ADDITION. creatures of this period of distress and misery shall read it, and on account of telling it with loud voice, all sins shall be taken away. This hidden doctrine, a protector of creatures (delivered) by the divine, the best A’Lu-sgrub, which had been concealed under the treasures, like the rock-lion in the grove of reeds, ^ will be spread as a blessing.” This passage tells us also that Lugrub, or Nagar- juna (see p. 29), is viewed as the author of this prayer. The copy which I had occasion to translate also varies in the title. At its head it has written the words: “Repentance of all sins, doctrine of the hidden treasure;” in the text it is denominated “the golden razor which takes away the sins.” The Paris document has this latter title also at the head of the treatise ; it is styled sDig-^»shags-^ser-gyi-spu-gri-zhes-bya-va-/)zhugs-so, “this is the golden razor of the confession of sins.” Another deviation still to be noticed is the omission of the concluding prayers and of the details in reference to the writer and the time it took him to copy it. Also the Dharanls differ; the Paris copy has the Sanskrit sentences “Om supratishthita vajraya; subhani astu sarva jagatam; sarva mangalam; yasas maha.” I add in Roman characters the text translated above, and a list of the readings of the Parisian text which differ from mine; the pages and lines quoted are those of Plates Nos. V. to Vlll. ‘ An allusion to Sakyamuni’s retirement and austerities in the woods previous to his obtaining the Buddhaship. Tibetan text in Koman characters ; page 7, line 4 to 9. Ts' he - phyi - ma - ma - drin - ’di - ka - bsam - pa’i - das ; dus-kyi-ma-lan-las-ngan- bsags - pa’i - Ian ; dus - mi - ’gyur - te - mi - mi-rnams-’gyur-bas-lan ; pha-rol-dmag- ts' hogs-nad-dang-mu-ge-dai'-ba’i-dus ; dmyal-mnar-med-du-skye-ba’i-sems-chau- las - ngan - chan - mang - po-yod-pa-de-rnams-kyi-nang-na-bsags-pa-chan-’ga’-yod- pas ; sdig - bshags - gter - chhos - ’di - dang - ’phrad - par-shog-ches-slob-dpon-klu- sgrub - kyi-smon-lara-btab-pa-lags-so ; ’di-bskal-pa-snyigs-ma’i-sems-chan-bsags- pa - chan - rnams - ky is - ’di - klog - dang ; kha - ’don - byas - na-sdig-pa-thams-chad- byang - bar - gsungs - so ; ’di-grong-chig-na-bzhugs-na-grong-khyer-de’i-sdig-pa- thams - chad-byang-bar-gsungs-so ; gter-chhos-’di-’gro-ba’i-mgon-po-klu-sgrub- snying - pos - lhas - smig - mang - ts' hal - gyi - brag-seng-ge-’dra-pa’i-’og-tu-gter-du- sbas-nas-smon-lam-bstab-skad. Readings differing from my original. Page 2, line 1; thams-chad-bshags-pa’i-mdo. » 3 ’khor-lo-bskor-du-gsol. » 5 baidu’rya. » 6 gzugs-lta-bu’i. » 6 rnam-par-spras. » 9 gser-gyi-gdugs-nam-mkha’-lta-bu’i. » 10 to 11: ’jig-rten-gyi-khams-kun-tu. » 3 I) 1 bag-ts'ha-ba-mi. » 3 gang-la-la-zhig-gis-yi-ger-bris-sam ; ’chhang-zhing-klog-gam. » 8 zhing-’od-bzang-po-na. » 4 » 5 to 6: chhos-kyi-dkor-la. >> 5 » 5 bzhon-pa-zhon-pa’i-sdig-pa-’dag-go. » 6, 8, 10: sdig-pa-’dag-go. » G » 10 gser-gyi-spu-gri. » 13 snags-byed-pa’i-dus. » 3 ma-grol-grol. M 12 ’khor-mi-sred-do. *> 8 » I gchig-la-’dus ; don-dain-par-sems. ' of* Mffil A ''■'h FV---W ^ : ' » . , , c?!/' ^ ,-,^, ,‘^* *w •***^*vj| 'iW. « I'jf init t t ^ fi 4 ^ . ((*■ ' " *'**^ ^ t*’ * • • U *< 4 »‘Vft*l|i^i(iii<(i‘iv‘ ‘'^ H *' ' N' ^\ij -,t}jk>f ■t#N_ • imt*/ i''‘^. 4 (v£^W' T <} • **« M • ■ ' "'^V * ^’ . ; .^' .* •*• , V- '’S'l'* I-! .. . ’j *•* . .fi/iiilib> tliit f#o^' [! : \1^^< (' ‘fti^‘ ' ^ "** '. <’ ft !«t V !,*»'> ^ '\ ,1**^' ’ * ‘l| ■'>; (|ff’.**f^l -** ,«v -• ■» H’!' ■■i^ ^ A-*- l-i/ii^&*^’'' ni '•^ < ‘£j#w n . V' x1 ii INDEX. The names of the authors quoted in the text have been excluded, as the various publications on Buddhism have been enumerated, in the alpha- betical order of the editors, in the Appendix “Literature,” pp. 331-69. The Tibetan terms are given in native characters, and exact translitera- tion in the Appendix “Glossary,” pp. 371-93. Terms of more frequent occurrence and greater importance again. Adi Buddha, the supreme and eternal Buddha, 50. Alaya, or soul, the basis of every thing, 39, 44. Alphabet used for transcription, XI. Amitabha, the Dhyani Buddha, corre- sponding to Sakyamuni, 52, 84. — Atlas, Plate III. Amitayus, a name given to Amitabha when implored for longevity, 98, 129. Amrita, the water of life, 114. Amulets, 174. Anagamin, the beings who have entered the third of the four paths leading to Nirvana, 27. Anupadaka, a name designative of the Dhyani Buddhas, 51. have been referred to in this Index Arhat, the beings who, by having en- tered the highest of the four paths leading to Nirvana, have gained emancipation from re-birth and acquired supernatural faculties, 27, 44, 127. Arrows, used in ceremonies, 260, 261, 270. — A drawing occurs on Plate XX of the Atlas. Aryasanga, an Indian priest, 32, 39. Astrologers, 156. Astrology and astrological arts, 273, 290. Astrological tables, for indicating lucky and unlucky periods, 293 ; — for di- rections in important undertakings, 304; — consulted in cases of sick- ness, 313 for marriage, 315. Atlas, Plates XIX, XX. Asuras, evil spirits, 92. 398 INDEX. Berma, Reports on, 33G, 350, 352, 3G3. Bhagavat, a name of the Buddha, 4. Bhikshu, Bhikshuni, “a mendicant,” 149, 1G2. Bhutan, Date of the introduction of Buddhism into, 71. — number of Lamas in Tassisudon, 1G4. — Reports on, 349, 355. Bihar Gyalpo, the protector of religious buildings, 177; Atlas, Plate IX. Bodhisattvas, candidates for the Bud- dhaship, 28. — later application of this word, 149. — their faculties, 3G. — representations of, 212. Bon, a sect in Tibet, 74, 137. Brahma, implored for protection against evil spirits, 114, 158, 235. An image occurs among the additional figures , on Plate X of the Atlas. Brikungpa, a sect in Tibet, 74. Brugpa, a sect in Tibet, 74. Buddha, the historical, see Sakyamuni. Buddhas, their faculties and bodies, 7, 29, 38, 44. — signs of beauty, 140, 208. — representations of, 208, 221. — measurements of Buddha figures, 216. Buddhapalita, an Indian priest, 41. Buddhism, present area of, and number of adherents, 11. — traces of it in Norway, 327. — in Amerika, 13, 328. — fundamental dogma, 15. — number of precepts, 24. — oi’igin of sects, 21. — extirpation in India, 9, 22. — favourable influence in the mitiga- tion of barbarous customs, 243. Buildings, religious, 177. Burnt-offering, 249. Calendars, 273. Cave temples, see Rock temples. Ceremonies, religious, 227. Ceylon, number of Ljmas, 165. — Works on the Buddhist religion in, 337, 344, 345, 348, 363, 364, 365, 366. 367. Changpo, a talisman, 256. — A copy taken from a Tibetan wood-cut faces this page. Chenresi, one of the names given to Padmapani, the protector of Tibet, 88. I China, Date of the introduction of I Buddhism into, 71. I — number of Buddhists, 11 — of I Lamas at Pekin, 165. I — Works on the Buddhist religion in, 33.5, 341, 344, 345, 347, 348, 3.52, 354, 355, 362, 363, 364. Chinsreg, the burnt-offering, 249. Choichong, the god of astrology, and protector of man against evil spirits, 156; Atlas, Plate X. Chorten, Meaning and forms of the, 192. Christians, Numbers of, 13. Chronology, The various modes of, in Tibet, 275. Chronological table for the years a.d. 1852-1926, 282. Clergy, fundamental laws, 148. Confession obtains remission of sins, 94. — Public, in Tibet, 239-242. — Buddhas of, 96, 122, 263, 393. Cosmogonical system, 51, 136. Csoma de Koros, his studies of Tibe- tan, 82. Cycle of 12 years, 276; of 60 years, 277 ; of 252 years, 284. Dabchad, “octagon,” a magical figure, 248; Atlas, Plate XVI. Dakini, female spirits, 248. Dalai Lama, the highest in rank of the Tibetan priesthood, 152. Darjiling, meaning of the name, 179. Derchoks, prayer-flags, 198. DharanI, mystic sentences ; also the books detailing their application and advantages, 48, 55. INDEX. 399 Dhannakaya, the body obtained by the Buddhas when leaving the world for ever, 38. Dharniaraja, the king of the law, 93, 185. Dhyana, abstract meditation, 52, 54. Dhyani Buddhas, celestial Buddhas, the manifestations of the human Buddhas in the world of foi-ms, 51, 210 . Diet of the Lamas, 167. Dipankara, an imaginary Buddha, 131 ; Atlas, Plate XI. : the priest with the conical cap. Doljang, a Chinese princess and deified consort of king Srongtsan Gampo, 66; Atlas, Plate VII. Dolkar, a Nepalese princess and deified consort of king Srongtsan Gampo, 66 . Dolma, a name comprising Doljang and Dolkar, 66. Dorje, a symbol of power over the evil spirits, 215. Dragsheds, the protectors of man against the evil spirits. 111, 214, 233. Dramas, Performance of religious, 232-236. Drawings and painting of deities, 204. Dress of the Lamas, 72, 170. Dubjed, a rite intended to enable one to concentrate his thoughts, 247. Dzambhala, the god of wealth, 263; Atlas, Plates VIII., XL Foundation-Lamas, 136, 141, 186. Festivals, monthly and annual, 237. Funeral rites, 269. Gautama, name of the Buddha, 4. Gedun, the Tibetan term for clergy, 133. Gelong, an ordained Lama, 137, 162. Gelukpa, a sect in Tibet, 73. Glory, 210. Glossary of Tibetan terms, 371. Gods, genii, and malignant spirits, 107. Guhyapati, a name of Vajradhara, 50. Hells, 92, 134. Hermits, 163. Himis Monastery, in Ladak, 179, 183. Hinayana system, “the little vehicle,” 19. Hri, an imploration of Padmapani, 261. Illnesses, Causes and remedies of, 265. Isvaras, The three, 251. Jaina sect, an offshoot of Buddhism; dissertations on this sect, 335, 336, 338, 343, 347, 352, 356, 363. Japan, Buddhism in, 40, 306, 348, 363. Kadampa, a sect in Tibet, 73. Kala Chakra, the most mystical system of Buddhism, 46. Kaladevi, see Lhamo. Kalmuks, 12, 165. Kalpa of destruction, the period when the universe is dissolved, 136. Kanjur, a compilation embodying the works translated from Sanskrit into Tibetan, 78. Kapilavastu, Site of the town of, 4. Karmapa, a sect in Tibet, 74. Kargyutpa, a sect in Tibet, 73. Kasyapa, the supposed predecessor of Sakyamuni, 132. Kaundinya, a Buddha to come, 132. Khanpo, an abbot, 155. Kings, The five great, 157. Kirghises, 12. Kite, devoted to Mahadeva, 261. Ladak, Date of the introduction of Buddhism into, 71. — Number of Lamas in, 164. Lama, meaning of the word, 156. — Grades amongst the, 159. — Numbers of, 164. 400 INDEX. Lamrim, a famous book written by Tsonkhapa, 77, 104, 243. Lapcha, a heap of stones to support a pole with prayers, 198; Letters of the Tibetan alphabet formed in the 7th century a.d., 67. Lhamayin, malignant spirits, 109. Lhamo, implored for keeping off the evil spirits, 112, 119, 235; Atlas, Plate I.; the figure riding a horse. Literature, the sacred Tibetan, 76. — European, on Buddhism, 331-69. Lotus, the symbol of highest perfec- tion, 66, 120, 213. Lungta, the Airy Horse, 253; Atlas, Plate XVH. Madhyama, 43. Madhyamika schools, 32, 68. Mahadeva, 261. Mahakala, 261. Mahayana system, “the great vehicle,” 30. Mahoragas, terrestrial dragons, 271. Maitreya, the Buddha to come, 32, 88, 209, 211 ; Atlas, Plate V. Mani, low walls against which stone slabs bearing inscriptions or images of deities are leant, 196. — prayer-cylinders, 229. — pills to be taken in cases of ill- ness, 266. Mani Kambum, an historical Tibetan work, 77, 83, and seq. ManjusrI, the god of wisdom, 65; Atlas, Plate VI. Mania, a Buddha of medicine, 266; Atlas, Plate V, XL: the uncovered figures. Manushi, or human Buddhas, 51. Meba gu, “the nine blots,” 297. Meditation, 24, 36, 39, 44, 47, 54, 163, 248. Melha, the lord of the genii of fire, | 207, 251. Metempsychosis. 91. Monasteries, 179. | Monuments, Religious, 177, 192. Month, names for, and numbers of days, 287. Mudra, a conventional sign formed by a certain placing of the fingers, 56, 208, 245. Musical instruments, 228. Mysticism, the system of, 46. Nagarjuna, also Nagasena, an Indian priest, 30, 101, 136, 394. Nagas, fabulous creatures of the na- ture of serpents, 31. Xagpo Chenpo, implored in the cere- mony “moving the arrow,” 261. Nidanas, The twelve, 23. Nirmanakaya, the body in which Bud- dhas and Bodhisattvas dwell upon earth, 38, 127. Nirvana, “blowing out,” utter extinc- tion of existence, 27, 42, 98, 100, 354. Nyigmapa, a sect in Tibet, 72. Nyungne, or Nyungpar nepai choga, a solemn kind of confession, 95, 240. Odan, or Wodan, supposed to be derived from the root hudh, 328, note. Offerings, 228. Om mani padme hum, the powerful six -syllabic prayer delivered to man by Padmapani, 84, 120, 266 ; Atlas, Plates XIV., XV. Padmapani, the particular protector of Tibet, 52, 63, 83, 88; Atlas, Plate IV., XII. Padma Sambhava, an Indian sage, 67, 136; Atlas, Plate XIII. Panchen Rinpoche, the incarnated Lama residing at Tashilhunpo, 153. Pandita Atisha, an Indian priest, 69, 136. Paramarthasatya, one of the two truths by which the emptiness of things is demonstrated, 35, 41. INDEX. 401 Paramitas, the six transcendental vir- tues, 36. Paratantra, existence by causal con- nexion, 34. Parikalpita, the supposition, or error, 34. Parinishpanna, the unchangeable true existence, 34. Piitaliputra, Site of the town of, 21, 336, 343. Patra, the alms-bowl, 210, 295. Peacocks, occur in representations of Sakyamuni, 211. Phurbu, an instrument for keeping off the evil spirits, 215, 257 ; Atlas, Plate XVIII. Pictures of deities, 190, Atlas, Group I. Plastic representations of deities, 205. Prajna Paramita, the supreme intelli- gence “arriving at the other side of the river,” 33. — also the title of a large compila- tion, 78, 98. Prasanga - Madhyamika, an Indian school, now the most reputed in Tibet, 41, 68. Pratyeka Buddhas, beings arrived at supreme intelligence, but inferior to the Buddhas, 28. Prayers, 117. Prayer-cylinders, 120, 229. Prayer-flags, 198. Precious things. The seven, 53. Pretas, imaginary monsters, 92. Printing, Art of, in Tibet, 80. Priesthood, the Tibetan, 146-76. Rahu, a monster, 115, 267. Ranja alphabet, 80. Raven, devoted to Lbamo, 261. Re-birth, 90. ReHcs, 175, 193, 194, 201, 205. Revenues of the Lamas, 160. Road-prescription, a document in re- ference to the routes my brothers should be allowed to take in Cen- tral Tibet. 278. Rock temples in India, 152, note. — Dissertations on, 342, 344, 352, 355, 359, 362, 364, 365, 368. Rosaries, 174. Sadag, the lord of the ground, 271. Sakyapa, a sect in Tibet, 73. Sakridagamin, the beings who have entered the second of the four paths leading to Nirvana, 26. Sakyamuni Buddha, the founder of Buddhism, his life and death, 3, 86, 167. — period of his existence, 7. — innumerability of his existences previous to the reception of the Buddhaship, 130. — his images, 207; Atlas, Plate I.: the central figure. — native biographies, 335, 337, 339, 344, 351, 355, 357, 360. Samapatti, the acquirement of in- difference, 54. Samatha, the state of perfect tran- quillity, 54. Sambhala, a country in Central Asia, 47. Sambhogakaya, the body obtained by the Buddhas when becoming perfect in intelligence, 38. Samsara, the circle of existences, 36, 87. Samvara, female genii, 108; Atlas, Plate II.: the figures placed within circles. Samvritisatya, one of the two truths by which the emptiness of things is demonstrated, 35, 41. Sanskrit Works; period when they were written, 32. Santa Rakshita, an Indian priest, 67. Satsa, or Tsatsa, a cone or plastic figure enclosing sacred objects, 206. Sects in India, 21. — in Tibet, 72. Shinje, the lord of the dead, 93. 402 INDEX. Siddhiirtha, the name given to Sakya- muni at his birth, 4. Siddhi, or supernatural faculties, Rites for arriving at, 56, 243. Sikkim, Date of the introduction of Buddhism into, 71. Skandhas, the essential properties of sentient existence, 43. Soothsaying, The art of, 156, 290.* — a table with numerous figures and sentences, 320; Atlas, Plate XIX. Spirits, The, of the season, 298. Spirits, Malignant, 109. — means for defeating their obnoxious machinations, 247-72. Sramana, “ an ascetic who restrains his thoughts,” 18, 149. Sravaka, “hearer,” 18, 149. Srongtsan Gampo, king of Tibet, born A.D. 678, died 698, 65. Srotapatti, the beings who have en- tered the path leading to Nirvana, 26. Statues of deities, 205. Sthaviras, the sixteen, 97. Stupas, conical monuments erected in India over rehcs, or to the glory and memory of Buddhas, saints, &c., 192. — Dissertations on, 334, 337, 338, 340, 348, 353, 356, 357, 359, 364, 365, 368. Sugata, a name of the Buddha, 4. Suicide does not annihilate existence, the cause of pains and sorrows, 138. Sukhavati, the abode of the pious who have been rewarded wdth de- liverance from metempsychosis, 42, 98. Sunyata, emptiness or nothingness of things, 33. Tamdin, a protector against the evil spirits, 110, 259. Tanjur, a compilation embodying the works translated from Sanskrit into Tibetan, 78. Tantras, rites for the acquirement of supernatural faculties ; also the books detailing these rites, 48, 56. Tantrica ritual. The, of the Hindus, 48. Tashilhunpo, meaning of the name, 152. Tassisiidon, meaning of the name, 155. 164. Tathagata, an epithet of the Buddhas, 4, 15, 126. Tea, Preparation of, 168. Temples, 150, 188. Thisrong de tsan, king of Tibet, born A.D. 728, died 786, 67. Thothori Nyantsan, king of Tibet in the 4th century a.d., 63. Tholing, meaning of the name, 179. Thugdam Kantsai, ceremonies for en- suring the assistance of gods, 260. Thumi Sambhota, an Indian priest who formed the Tibetan letters, 65. Tibet, Date of the introduction of Buddhism into, 61. Tibetan language and dialects, 65, 82, 184, 374. — grammars and dictionaries, 83. — native books quoted. Titles of, 66, 71, 72, 78, 84, 97, 101, 109, 110, 112, 114, 123, 157, 202, 257, 264, 265, 281, 305, 310, 315. Tirthikas, Brahmanical sectaries, 25, 323. Tortoise, the basis of the universe, 297, 305. Trisula, the trident, 216. Triyana, “three vehicles,” or three gradations in spiritual capacities, in perfection, and final reward, 104. Truths, The four excellent, 16. — The two, 35. Tsonkhapa, the great Tibetan Lama of the 14th. century a.d., 69. Tuisol, “to pray for ablution;” cere- monies for getting rid of sins, 95, 239. INDEX. 403 Universe, The ten regions of the, 126, 307. Untimely death, 109. Upasaka, a lay follower, 98, 149, 162. Urgyenpa, a sect in Tibet, 73. Urna, the single hair on the forehead of Buddha figures, 209. UshuTsha, an excrescence of the skull, 209. Utpala, see Lotus. Vairochana, a fabulous Buddha, 129. Vaisravanas, gods granting riches, 264; Atlas, Plate VIII. Vajra, a symbol of power over evil spirits, 215. Vajradhara, a name of Adi Buddha, 50. Vajrapani, the most energetic pro- tector of man against the evil spir- its, 114; an image faces also this page. Vajrasattva, the god above all, 50; Atlas, Plate II. Vicarius apostolicus, still nominated for Lhassa, 147. Vihara, a monastery, 150. Week has seven days, their names, 289. Wheel, a symbol expressive of the preaching of the Buddhas, &c., 127, 302. Worship, Objects of, 201. — daily service, 227. — sacred days and festivals, 237. Yangug, or Yangchob, a ceremony for insuring luck, 263. Year, names for; number of months, days, &c., 287. Yoga, abstract meditation, 40, 47. Yogacharya system, 32, 39, 67. THE END. Leipzig; — P rinted by F. A. Brockhaus. r ■■ > . ( I < ai.i f y '■//(',' i!inunii;i 11(1 .■■v_ / ,• ■■ ni t\i ' !' !' i; r); (• (• t; f (HI ( t( /'/‘a it Hi (t '( V \t ( i'l ticniiiitiiii Hi'iinJ . t: (■ 'i (■' t! (■ ( {■'('(' (‘ f i' I' !( n !• i <• i‘ ( ( i i'iij I' >' III- iii( , * /; r !' /' /■■ H (■ I- (> II / i; li i ( r (' (■( 1 1 f St . X V ^ ^ ; ir 5 *4 tr ■? t « * 5 - t V. r t 1 ; ? V V ^ t c ^ : r •/ f » f t * » t / * t t * • P t f f •'• . \ 'Vi ^ S *► " *r • \ t ^ « V ' » ' ^ ' * ' ' ‘ , . <■ « . » i I i , . . ' ^ . V. V % ^ ^ ^ ^ r . ' V, f \ i i i i *■' i { { i \ { \ \ i { ( '• ■' ' ( i!-'- 1 -i i i •!(■,■ i i '* i ( { ( ( : (}( ( i'i •{<((< {U\i(H tti:(: ! t iidiiii i({i i\{i ( if ‘^r /'(!/. if/finnui nfi'r -ft ;• ;■ ms at/ r ^ t [ /, h / r tf a /j t> i> ^ ff p i' . ^ ^ H ^ s 6 it ,f i if f t : i ^ ^ t f : P j ■; ( { / , ■ ( ( / ' V ? >f 't A .V . •- .'. ’■ f t n "A . . . ’> U l{ n un p 0 :} h: u .fiiftii S r> !< I A a g !' ,f u i. a 6 •/ n !• If J :f > P ^ H f J i .* s / i t i 1 1 i i i t i i t i »/ •?’* w, ■. :.■-■/ - /• . '/.'// ./.'If f. / . .■ H. . If ■■ J ,ig . f , n>t .: a, i, . I. If ff J i> J P n L . P P t‘ d , J t a f } t J ( I I i \ ) t \ - •• • ...•» .' ; / .. .' / ■* ' . ■ ;• « .- a a ,f - f * . f- f t p t. ^ . ;• P a a ^ p fP .' :• a 4 f d < *■ i t 4 f $ { § ( i h H t •• ■■ H .■•!■ ... I .s f. /; .' ;■ f! Jt f ^ ft t, ■ y a P .i L ft .. L . ■■ r f / / t t r /• t } i r a t ■ f » d .-.■ f is . , a P, a 4 t } r a f } i ( t J ( ) ) 4 / .'. - .■ ' V .- ;: '■ -A ^ ^ C'Ci ^ \ s ’ ( \ V % ( % ^ C V ^ V \ \ V f \ \ \ \ \ i 4 \ \ \ \ ' \ V * ii \ i ( ( ( ( ( ^ '.[ ^ V, - ^ ^ ^ -/.v'..' ^ ^ ^ » i, V\ i ^ \ ^ V \ x ^ \ ^ ^ ^ \ ^ ^ \ \ \ \ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ ' X ( \ ^ \ \ ' ,1 . !, ■ ■■, I - a • d f -f •■ * .• :• i . .- d r d d t p f P - ■ I * i e ' 4 .! a t a t 1 1 1 ) 4 { I 4 t .. . ; .. V - ^ ^ ^ ^ ^ x\ \\({ \ ». ^ » \ \\ ^ \ X \ %% \ \\\ ^ > \ \ X \ \ ^ \ X X ( \ \ \ \ \ ,1 . !, ■ ■■, I - a • a f -f •■ * .• :• i . .- •• : s ’■ 4 i- m- a ■! t d r d d t P f P - ■ I * i t ' 4 d P t t t t t t ) 4 ( f ( t ,. , '• *.**'r^' *••*%»♦»%•>•• XX **. x»'«x\xx\x\\xx\\xr\xx»\%\\x\*'XX\X\\’iXV\S\ X y<. . . - ■: ■ ■% ■• -V « V V. V, v( • i r X, X A tM\ X X \ X \ . X X \ t i i ^ • t. V X X \ \ \ \ \ X ' \ V \ X \ X i \ \ X \ X X * X X ^ ^ ^ \ X \ ^ ^ ( X \ ^ \ ^ d ., . • / . . • . . , • , , . . . '. /■ . .. , , ' f .t i •■ ■ ■ t ■ , d f J .■ d d d d ,• 4 M P - d t a a i a a t { a 4 r / 4 4 t t 4 ( .> XX \ XX Xt’. XX'‘X*V%XX%*x»XXXXXXXXX\\\\X\XXX\\X\\X\>X :/ • , ■■■..• 1. : . f a f , d t d d S r a a f it 11(4 f t 4 ( a 4 t\(i\l M . *>. A-A.«. V, •♦vxv'Ntvx*, ^»-«'*»»«^<’'-Xvv*‘''"»X>xxx\\vxxxxx«X\X\\\XXXX\XX\X\\\\ . • . . - , . ^ ■ .. . . ././•. . ,^adi 4, faa4C4tr4attft}(t4! » . . T ' . fcV.,.. . ..xx’‘»'''''’‘'%->’X*^**'x«xxxX'^^XXXXX^XXXXXXXXXXXXXXX\'XX\^\XX^rX>XX^\X\\ \ , u V, V ... \. A X X V X X X < X ^ * *X ■ X V X X X X X < X X X i X X ) X XX ** % X X X X X X X ».x X s X X \ X X X X X V \ X C \ \ \ X X X X \ \ \ \ ?/ • ' •■ • . • . ...- i : ^ s : r 1 u -i ■;:. . r .. // •■ t t .i ^ ,. ,■- .: , - d . ■ .- . a'P.^.ttiiftaaCitft ,A X X.. v-XX\n XX. -'V'».X^X'^x*V\XXX\XXXXXX\\XV\X\\XXXX\\X\\\XXX\\X\\%XXN\X\XX\XX\' - . ' . . ■ V . .. , ^ V . ,' . J ■■■ ,11 t. I" f .t ■• ■ . S d r • ‘ P f d . * f t a “ t a a a a 4 a t a a A ^ n^v* ♦\v'->XXX%*X’f»-. XXX\". X«'‘X-. X%x*sxX»XXXX'%VXX\\X\X\XViXXXXXXX%X\X\XVXXXX\\\W\X>\ ^ « X X X X ^ X V X, n •'' X X X % X. \ X X X X X X X, V X ’\ X X X •. X X ^ X \ ' <• ♦. X. X X X i X X X X. X. X \ V. \ X X •. X ’ • X X X X X \ \ X X X X X X A,■•X\XX^X.XX^X^.V^Xxi^X»^XXX^XX^X^\>^^VXX XXX%XX\XXXXXX\X\’-. >X»XX\\XX\\XXXX\>XXVXX\V\\>X>\ , ♦ • ■• .V <• ,» . • ' J - f .- - • -• • . ■ ‘ f a ! a a f f f 4 a i i a XXS».X\XXXXXXX\\XX\XX\XX\XXXXXX*XXXX\\\\XW. wx\ . / - . . . < • ■• • d ' * ’ ‘ 4 ■«“ e a ' ,f a / f a ? a f ■' a a a a / •\XX>-. xxx\xX%\\\VXXXXX\XiX\XXxxXXX\\S\>\\\X\\X kVXXXXX\XiX\XXxxXXX\\S\>\\\X\\X /> . i k d t d f / f t a ■ a a t , a a t a a } ^\\XX\X\VXAXSy\X\X\>x, X\y. \ J \ X X X X ■^ \ \ X X ^ ‘ > “ X X -. A \ X X X X = 'ix' X**XX\X^XXX\XXXX\\X\\\(\>\\\\'^ VXX\X^fX\XXXxXXXXxxxXXXXXXXXXXxyV';XV\>X\\V\X\\»JX\\\\\\\\\\ XxXX\\Xv'.\XX\V\XXXV\X\X\\VX\i\\XXXXXXXX'\\XX\\\\J^J^\\ *XXXXXXXX‘i.XXX’^fXxXXX\XX^ •S .^XX/A« > .^xxxx ■• X ''. '\ X v.V, V' A X X X X X X X X X X ^ X X X X * X AA XXXXXXXXXXXXX < - VX ♦ XX X XX »xxxx »\X\\\XXVX\X\\\\X\\W\ • ! ■ ■ • _• / ; > ■ (fit ‘ ! f I I ■. xx\xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx\X\xxx\xxx\^xxxx^\x\\\\XNX\jX>\\jX i',AAAAAA‘iXA\XAX\\AAA\\\\V\AX^ATi\\\A\A\\VV\'V»V'V\\\\>\\S\ V' ' j ; . ■ i , i t i i > ‘ ‘/'X«AAAA’.AAAi\Ati.XXAA,AAAA\X^’i' 4 X? y 1 li- -..(svaaaaAAAAAW' AXX^'SiX^A’'.'>A“''Xii’.'i‘.A%\\\AA'.\\\'.'V.'. W.V»'y\"i\\^)\yi \ ‘i “ ' - *1 '• \ \ *i *. \ i \ \ \ \ \ '. *> Vi\\\Vd.\\\\\V,\\\\\ i\ A -U a S i'S, . ‘i T, V. ■»' 'I'iWW -.'ii'i". X'.'.'. ■.■.■. ‘.V* y ' ■ ■■ : \ 'i ^ M A A A ^ M. \ A ^ 't 4 A 1 , • 5 , A . -■ 'i ' I. V •', A ‘ V V \ \ X A 'r. A ‘ '. *. '. "s A ‘4 \V.'.'. \ \ \ \ WW.WW \ \ ' f i •; :A'\-*-V.AAnAAAAAA-i^\\U'\A^V./.\'AA%‘. '. . \ '.Ai. 'lAXtAAA^A A'iA ; 'i.A ,•■, ',x\AV.-.- 4 ' A\aA 1 ,AA\\A- K^SWWWAWWWS' I % ■. ’i % * % ■. '. i '• ■ '• '. '